AI Terminal

MODULE: AI_ANALYST
Interactive Q&A, Risk Assessment, Summarization
MODULE: DATA_EXTRACT
Excel Export, XBRL Parsing, Table Digitization
MODULE: PEER_COMP
Sector Benchmarking, Sentiment Analysis
SYSTEM ACCESS LOCKED
Authenticate / Register Log In

A.P. Møller - Mærsk

Annual Report Feb 6, 2025

3372_10-k_2025-02-06_f12a9bf5-eeb1-4975-962b-3cc37e87ba62.pdf

Annual Report

Open in Viewer

Opens in native device viewer

Annual Report 2024

About this report

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) has prepared an integrated Annual Report in 2024 and no longer publishes separate sustainability and financial reports.

The 2024 Integrated Annual Report

In accordance with the Corporate Sustainability Reporting Directive (CSRD), the 2024 Annual Report has been prepared as one report, integrating the sustainability and financial reports and embedding the mandatory European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS). As a result, the new sustainability statement has been included in the Management Review. The sustainability statement is prepared in accordance with sections 99a, 99d and 107d of the Danish Financial Statements Act.

The 2024 Annual Report is prepared using the 'incorporation by reference' method, where some required disclosures as per the ESRS are not included in the sustainability statement and are instead integrated into other parts of the Annual Report and the Remuneration Report.

Incorporation by reference

Mandatory disclosures as per the ESRS which have been placed outside of the sustainability statement have been marked as such and are presented within the body of text, (example of incorporation by reference ESRS-X §X), or with the disclosure requirement reference in the top corner, indicating that the full page, column or table is referenced.

A list of information and data points that have been placed outside of the sustainability statement can be found in the index of information of the sustainability statement, see page 56.

The Annual Report's consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards as adopted by the EU and further requirements in the Danish Financial Statements Act. The Annual Report furthermore provides detailed disclosures of the company's performance, strategy, corporate governance, sustainability statement and financial results, including the Q4 results.

Remuneration Report and policy

The Remuneration Report provides a full overview of the remuneration of the Board of Directors and the Executive Board of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S.

The remuneration policy outlines the principles of remuneration design, the total remuneration by components and how each component supports the achievement of the strategy, long-term interest and sustainability of the company. Both the report and the policy are available at investor.maersk.com/governance/policies-and-charters

Corporate governance statement

The statutory corporate governance statement for A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S forms part of the Management Review of the Annual Report and includes the status of compliance with the 'Recommendations for Corporate Governance' issued by the Danish Committee on Corporate Governance in December 2020 and implemented by Nasdaq Copenhagen.

Tax Report

The Tax Report presents the tax strategy and tax principles as approved by Management. Additionally, insights into the tax impact on business activities and tax contributions are provided in the Tax Report. The Tax Report is available at maersk.com/about/tax-principles.

Additional reports

The Annual Report for Maersk in PDF format, the XHTML version submitted to the Danish Financial Supervisory Authority and additional reports with complementary information can be downloaded here: investor.maersk.com/financial-reports

Find and follow

Contents

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

12 Our purpose
13 Business model
14 Market environment
17 Strategy
20 Risk management

General disclosures Environmental disclosures Social disclosures Governance disclosures

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Highlights 2024

17 January Gemini Cooperation announced

Maersk and Hapag-Lloyd signed a long-term operational collaboration agreement to start in February 2025, with the target of delivering schedule reliability above 90% for services under the Gemini scope of trades, once fully phased in. During October, it was announced that the Cape of Good Hope network would be utilised initially.

9 February Announcement of SBTi validation of climate targets

Maersk's greenhouse gas emission targets were validated by the Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi) to be in line with net-zero 2040 and the Paris Agreement's 1.5-degree pathway towards 2030 – an industry first under SBTi's new Maritime Guidance.

17 February Ane Mærsk

Ane Mærsk, the world's first large dual-fuel methanol vessel, made its maiden voyage on green methanol, arriving in Tanjung Pelepas, Malaysia. The vessel was named after Ane Mærsk Mc-Kinney Uggla.

30 April Svitzer demerger

Maersk's Towage business, Svitzer, was demerged and separately listed on Nasdaq Copenhagen, resulting in the distribution of Svitzer shares to Maersk shareholders.

13 July Maersk Swan

Maersk's first Boeing 777F, Maersk Swan, arrived in Billund, Denmark.

4 November First dual-fuel retrofit

Maersk Halifax was converted into the world's first retrofitted dual-fuel methanol vessel.

22 November Breaking ground of Suape Terminal

Construction began on Latin America's first 100% electrified container terminal in Suape, Brazil. The terminal is expected not only to accelerate regional development, but will also increase container handling capacity by 55%.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Executive Summary

Letter from the Chair and the CEO

Cold chains and climate change

Ruakura, New Zealand

Cold chain logistics are crucial to global food supply chains and a key opportunity to reduce greenhouse gas emissions. In 2024, Maersk opened the Ruakura Superhub integrated cold chain facility in Hamilton, New Zealand.

Ruakura enables customers, including Fonterra, New Zealand's largest dairy company, to seamlessly transfer goods between various transport modes along the strategic Auckland-Tauranga trade corridor, which handles 65% of the country's freight.

The cutting-edge facility includes rooftop solar panels, rainwater collection and reuse as well as electric vehicle charging stations, and uses CO 2 instead of ammonia in all freezers.

LETTER FROM THE CHAIR AND THE CEO

Commitment to lead in a changing world

Entering 2024, we anticipated a challenging year ahead. With constant care, we proactively took steps in 2023 to align our organisation and cost structure with the expected subdued market demand and a contrasting increase in industry capacity. These measures proved vital as the year brought its share of unforeseen obstacles, testing our resilience and ability to navigate uncertainties in ever-shifting global circumstances.

The Red Sea became a focal point of disruption in 2024, with attacks by Houthi forces resulting in unacceptable safety risks for crew and cargo along a critical trade route. Initially uncertain in duration, the crisis persisted throughout the year, underlining the vulnerabilities of global supply chains.

Increased freight rates driven by the situation in the Red Sea, combined with our ability to capitalise on higher-than-expected demand, strong operational execution and cost discipline, led us to repeatedly raise expectations through out the year, ultimately delivering results significantly above initial guidance.

Value for customers and strong cost discipline

We sustained progress in both customer satisfaction and cost management despite the unexpected operational implications and added costs of re-routing vessels around the Cape of Good Hope.

To provide the best possible service during times of high volatility and low visibility, we leveraged our hub terminals and invested in additional capacity and equipment to mitigate disruptions. Still, the situation presented signifi cant challenges for all Ocean customers. We were pleased that our handling

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

of the situation was recognised as the best in the industry, reflected in a 28% improvement in customer satisfaction over the course of the year.

At the same time, our focus on cost management, productivity improvements and efficient asset utilisation helped mitigate cost pressures and ensure operational resilience.

Driving energy transition to future-proof customer supply chains

During the year, we welcomed seven new dual-fuel methanol vessels to the fleet, while also progressing on our fleet renewal programme with an order of 800k TEU of new capacity, comprising 50-60 dual-fuel vessels, scheduled to enter into service between 2026 and 2030. These vessels will replace end-of-life ships and will be a combination of owned and time-chartered vessels, ensuring flexibility while maintaining ownership of essential tonnage.

Industry expectations point to a multi-fuel future, and we are preparing to manage a fuel portfolio that supports our network while aligning with the transition toward low-emission energy solutions.

Vessel re-routing around the Cape of Good Hope increased emissions, which combined with inflationary pressures impacting the demand for lower-emissions transport, underscored the need for regulatory solutions to drive a timely transition.

Network of the future

In early 2024, we announced the Gemini Cooperation, our network of the future, which was officially launched on 1 February 2025. Throughout the year, we focused on preparing for the implementation of this new modular network designed to move our customers' cargo in a more reliable and efficient manner. The network is enabled by our own hub terminals, supported by investments to ensure fast and efficient transhipment. Once fully phased in, we will reduce stops per loop by approximately 40% and shorten loops by around 15% in terms of sailed miles, ultimately leading to improved asset turnover.

The higher asset turnover translates to increased flexibility in the deployment of our fleet, while the new network also enables further reductions in our overall cost base. With an aspiration of 90% reliability in the Gemini network, we are significantly improving quality for customers and strengthening our end-to-end logistics offerings.

Continued progress with focus on profitable growth

We continued to make progress in our Logistics & Services business, addressing the operational challenges in Ground Freight and Warehousing that marked the beginning of the year. We experienced good momentum across our product portfolio and regions, with increased volumes and new customer wins. This resulted in an improved EBIT margin, reaching 3.6% for the full year 2024.

The higher profitability was driven particularly by stronger performance in our most integrated end-toend service, Lead Logistics, as well as favourable rate developments in Air and operational efficiency gains across all products.

We enter the new year with a logistics business that is stronger and more resilient at its core and remain committed to work towards achieving our EBIT margin target of above 6%.

During 2024, we concluded the integration of LF Logistics, with 10,000 colleagues and 155 warehouses fully incorporated into the Maersk network. Not only did we retain all key clients, we also attracted new customers along the way and strengthened our global contract logistics capabilities through the adoption of the Maersk Warehouse Management System.

APM Terminals delivered record revenue, achieving an impressive 16% year-on-year increase, driven by higher volumes, tariffs and storage income. Volume growth led by significant increases in North America and the restored operations at our Mumbai terminal helped offset challenges in the Red Sea region.

This strong performance combined with disciplined cost management boosted the EBIT margin to 29.8% and drove a return on invested capital of 13.5%.

The strength of our terminal business was further supported by the renewal of key concessions in Santos, Brazil, and Aqaba, Jordan. Meanwhile, we continued to invest in growth, including two greenfield projects in Brazil and Croatia, expanding the portfolio of world-class gateway terminals.

The right strategy for an era of rapid change

As we enter 2025, we face a year of continued geopolitical change and potential instability, but also one offering significant opportunities to advance our strategic intent. We are confident in our ability to further strengthen our foundation and provide our customers with a competitive advantage by delivering flexible logistics solutions capable of navigating highly transformative times.

We extend our heartfelt thanks to all A.P. Moller - Maersk colleagues worldwide for their tireless efforts and steadfast commitment to supporting our customers and advancing the development of our company through ever-changing circumstances.

Our gratitude also goes to the Executive Leadership Team and the Board of Directors, with a special welcome to Allan Thygesen, who joined the Board in 2024. Finally, we extend our deepest gratitude to our customers.

Robert Mærsk Uggla Chair of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S

Vincent Clerc CEO of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S

Annual Report 2024

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Prevailing in a year of supply chain disruptions

FINANCIAL SUMMARY

2024 was a year with macroeconomic pressures, geopolitical tensions and unpredictability. Despite this, A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) showed resilience in 2024 and doubled down on core logistics activities, supporting the integrator strategy. Following the unprecedented pandemic peak in 2022 and the inventory correction seen in 2023, 2024 reflected a strong rebound in profitability, far surpassing pre-pandemic levels and culminating in the third-best year in Maersk's history.

Revenue EBIT USDbn USDbn

5,000

10,000

0

Container demand, while starting to weaken in Q4, remained relatively strong as Ocean volumes increased from the previous year and minimally decreased from Q3. Ocean loaded freight rates declined by 18% from the Q3 peak as anticipated capacity began to enter the market. Despite rate volatility in the logistics industry, revenue remained stable in Logistics & Services. Terminals finished the year strong, with a 17% increase in revenue year-over-year.

Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4

Freight rates peaked as supply chain pressure did not dissipate during the quarter and demand continued to be strong. Geopolitical tensions persisted, acting as the main source of volatility for the economy and for trade and logistics. Volumes were up across segments, and

Revenue continued to increase sequentially as the Red Sea situation became entrenched. Container demand strengthened, and supply chain disruptions continued. Revenue per move increased in Terminals, and increasing volumes in Logistics & Services resulted

Coming out of a year of normalisation, Q1 results reflected the disrupted network and supply chain impacts of the Red Sea situation. While freight rates consequently went up, they were partially offset by the normal seasonal volume decline in Ocean. Cost control measures

(USD 51.1bn) (USD 3.9bn)

EBIT increased by USD 2.6bn with positive impacts from higher freight rates and improved volumes across all segments.

2024 6.5
2023 3.9
2022 30.9

Free cash flow USDbn 5.1bn

(USD 4.0bn)

Free cash flow increased by USD 1.1bn due to increased profit for the year by USD 2.3bn, partly offset by the negative effect of increased net working capital compared to the unwinding seen in 2023, as well as increased CAPEX.

For specifics on the financial performance, see pages 26-27. For 2024 guidance, the roadmap to 2025 and the ESG targets towards 2040, see pages 28-29.

8

Financials

SUSTAINABILITY SUMMARY

Progress on ESG commitments towards 2030

In 2024, A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) continued to mature roadmaps and processes and took tangible steps to fully integrate ESG into the company's business, delivering progress towards its environmental, social and governance commitments despite an uncertain and challenging operating environment.

Green fuel transition

Maersk welcomed seven dual-fuel methanol vessels to its fleet in 2024, as well as the Maersk Halifax – the world's first retrofitted dual-fuel methanol vessel. Maersk also announced a renewal plan for its owned and time-chartered fleet with some 50-60 dual-fuel vessels totalling 800k TEU to begin service in 2026-2030.

In 2024, Maersk entered into another significant longterm offtake agreement for biomethanol fuel. The first volumes from this agreement are expected in 2026. Maersk's combined methanol offtake agreements now meet more than 50% of the dual-fuel methanol fleet demand in 2027.

2024 83.5 59.8 2030

Maersk continued increasing the energy efficiency of its fleet through more energy-efficient operations and new technologies. This lowered the emissions intensity of ocean operations, EEOI, from 11.7 in 2023 to a record low of 11.1 in 2024. However, despite the improved efficiency, Maersk's absolute greenhouse gas emissions increased from 2023 to 2024.

This was mainly driven by the Red Sea situation that continued to re-route vessels around the Cape of Good Hope in 2024, with knock-on capacity shortages and port congestion, requiring faster sailings to keep the Asia-Europe supply chains running. At the industry level and for Maersk, these disruptions contributed to increased emissions which could not be offset by progress in energy efficiency and the transition to green fuels, underscoring the need for regulatory solutions at a global industry level. Maersk remains committed to its climate targets and transition plan towards 2030.

Scope 3 target -22%

Scope 2 target -100%

Safety

GHG emissions, m tonnes CO2e/year

Climate change 1.53

(1.14 LTIf)

LTIf

In 2024, the lost time incident frequency rate increased from 1.14 to 1.53, driven by increases in lost time incidents in our Logistics & Services and APM Terminals businesses, as well as an improved reporting culture.

2024 2023
2022
1.53 1.141
0.93
1 2023 restated from 1.11.

Diversity 35% (35%) % headcount

The share of women in management roles for the year was 35%1, which is comparable to 2023. Maersk's target is to reach 40% by 2025.

Scope 3 GO TO OUR TRANSITION PLAN 2024 2023 2022
Scope 2
Scope 1
Scope 1 target
-35%
35% 35% 33%
9 1 Excluding seafarers.

2023 2024 2030

59.8

82.8 83.5 77.7

2022 (baseline)

Scope 3

Five-year summary

Income statement 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020
Revenue 55,482 51,065 81,529 61,787 39,740
Profit before depreciation, amortisation
and impairment losses, etc. (EBITDA)
Depreciation, amortisation and impairment
12,128 9,591 36,813 24,036 8,226
losses, net 6,220 6,615 6,186 4,944 4,541
Gain on sale of non-current assets, etc., net 222 523 101 96 202
Share of profit/loss in joint ventures and
associated companies
369 435 132 486 299
Profit before financial items (EBIT) 6,499 3,934 30,860 19,674 4,186
Financial items, net 317 428 -629 -944 -879
Profit before tax 6,816 4,362 30,231 18,730 3,307
Tax 584 454 910 697 407
Profit for the year 6,232 3,908 29,321 18,033 2,900
A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' share 6,109 3,822 29,198 17,942 2,850
Underlying profit 6,095 3,954 29,703 18,170 2,960
Balance sheet
Total assets 87,697 82,5781 93,680 72,271 56,117
Total equity 57,947 55,090 65,032 45,588 30,854
Invested capital 50,564 50,430 52,410 44,043 40,121
Net interest-bearing debt -7,373 -4,658 -12,632 -1,530 9,232
Cash flow statement
Cash flow from operating activities 11,408 9,643 34,476 22,022 7,828
Repayments of lease liabilities 3,051 3,226 3,080 2,279 1,710
CAPEX 4,201 3,646 4,163 2,976 1,322
Cash flow from financing activities 3,500 16,805 14,135 7,900 5,618
Free cash flow 5,114 3,967 27,107 16,537 4,648

1 Restated in 2024. Refer to note 1.1 general accounting policies in the consolidated financial statements for details.

Financial ratios 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020
Revenue growth 8.6% -37.4% 32.0% 55.5% 2.2%
EBITDA margin 21.9% 18.8% 45.2% 38.9% 20.7%
EBIT margin 11.7% 7.7% 37.9% 31.8% 10.5%
Cash conversion 94% 101% 94% 92% 95%
Return on invested capital after tax (ROIC) 12.3% 7.4% 60.4% 45.3% 9.4%
Equity ratio 66.1% 67.1% 69.4% 63.1% 55.0%
Underlying ROIC 12.0% 7.5% 61.2% 45.7% 9.6%
Underlying EBITDA 12,133 9,771 36,843 24,036 8,324
Underlying EBITDA margin 21.9% 19.1% 45.2% 38.9% 20.9%
Underlying EBIT 6,356 3,962 31,244 19,808 4,231
Underlying EBIT margin 11.5% 7.8% 38.3% 32.1% 10.6%
Stock market ratios
Earnings per share, USD 387 227 1,600 941 145
Diluted earnings per share, USD 387 227 1,595 938 145
Cash flow, operating activities per share, USD 723 572 1,889 1,155 399
Dividend per share, DKK 1,120 515 4,300 2,500 330
Dividend per share, USD 155 74 623 381 55
Share price (B share), end of year, DKK 11,905 12,140 15,620 23,450 13,595

Share price (B share), end of year, USD 1,668 1,800 2,242 3,576 2,246 Total market capitalisation, end of year, USDm 25,698 28,541 39,135 64,259 41,957

For definition of terms, see page 203.

Corporate governance

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

The integrator

Seattle, USA

Long-haul routes take flight

Air cargo is an essential and integrated part of many customers' global supply chains, particularly for high-value goods or those requiring rapid delivery. However, it remains one of the most challenging transport modes to decarbonise due to the scarcity and high cost of sustainable aviation fuel.

In 2024, Maersk expanded its fleet with two Boeing 777F aircraft, among the most fuel-efficient freighters in the industry – especially for long-haul operations. The first aircraft, the Maersk Swan, was delivered at a ceremony at Boeing's headquarters in Seattle, USA.

Annual Report 2024

Performance

Corporate governance Sustainability

Financials

8.8m+ sqm

700+ container vessels deployed, 12m+ FFE transported

OUR PURPOSE

Improving life for all by integrating the world

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) is an integrated logistics company working to connect and simplify its customers' supply chains. As a global leader in logistics services, the company has 100,000+ customers, operates in almost 130 countries and employs 100,000+ people. Maersk is committed to reaching net-zero emissions by 2040 across the entire supply chain with new technologies, new vessels and green energy solutions.

& Services
8,800k+ sqm warehousing
capacity worldwide across
500+ sites
Countries with EV truck solutions
in operation or under trial
14
First Mile volumes
managed (m FFE)
6.8
Terminals*
Moves in 2024 13.1m
Vessel calls 13,980+
Operating facilities across
29 countries; 3 new port projects
54

12

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

What we depend on

Purpose-driven people and our culture Our talented, diverse team of 100,000+ employees across around 170 nationalities.

Our brand

For over a century, we have built partnerships with customers, enabling them to prosper by facilitating global trade.

Natural resources

Our business relies on natural resources such as steel for our assets and fossil fuels and biomass for conventional and green fuels.

Stakeholder relationships and partnerships We rely on constructive relationships with customers, suppliers, employees and authorities as well as other key stakeholders.

Assets and end-to-end delivery network Our assets, supplier relationships and logistics expertise ensure resilient supply chains.

Financial capital

We have a strong balance sheet and are committed to remaining investment grade-rated.

Technology and data

Technology and data are key to connecting and simplifying supply chains.

BUSINESS MODEL

Our business and how we create value

A.P. Moller - Maersk is a purpose-driven company. The increasing complexity in global supply chains drives the need for integrated logistics. We aim to fulfil that need by responsibly delivering better, simpler and more reliable outcomes for our customers.

Operational excellence is achieved through the enablers of ESG, Technology and People. Customer and operational synergies are unleashed from the integrated businesses of Ocean, Logistics & Services and Terminals. See page 18.

Value created for

Our customers

We aspire to provide truly integrated logistics for 100,000+ customers' supply chains, while helping them meet their decarbonisation commitments.

Our people

We keep our people safe and engaged while offering equitable and interesting career paths.

Society

By integrating global logistics, we improve the flow of goods and materials that sustain people, businesses and economies the world over and contribute to improved quality of life and prosperity.

The planet

Maersk is a significant emitter of greenhouse gases and we are committed to realising netzero emissions by 2040.

Shareholders

In our transformation to become the integrator of container logistics, we continue to innovate and grow shareholder value.

MARKET ENVIRONMENT

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance Sustainability Geopolitics and climate change disrupt supply chains

Geopolitics and climate change left a deep mark on supply chains in 2024, yet economic growth remained surprisingly resilient, resulting in strong demand for container trade and logistics services. 2025 will once again challenge customers' supply chains and require partnerships to navigate a complex landscape, shaped by geopolitical uncertainties, climate and cybersecurity risks, regulatory shifts and technological innovation.

Geopolitical and environmental events reshaped supply chains in 2024

The geopolitical landscape of 2024 has profoundly influenced global trade and logistics, introducing challenges and redefining established flows. The re-routing of vessels around the Cape of Good Hope has altered trade routes and absorbed significant shipping capacity, causing new strain on global supply chains.

Simultaneously, trade tensions between China and the West have escalated. Both the US and the European Union implemented new import tariffs on Chinese goods in 2024. The focus on electric vehicles signalled the intent to protect strategic domestic industries. Tariffs, however, are not the only policy tool affecting trade. Security concerns are increasingly impacting supply chains, through sanctions and export controls for example.

Adding to the complexity, climate events have taken a toll on logistics infrastructure. In 2024, 219 extreme weather events were recorded, an increase of 83% compared to 2023, causing widespread damage. The intense hurricane season in the US and the devastating floods in Spain not only caused high death tolls, but also paralysed regional logistics. Enhancing terminal infrastructure has become not just a matter of sustainability, but a critical factor for maintaining resilience in an increasingly volatile environment. Labour unrest has further disrupted shipping and logistics in 2024, forcing shippers to implement advanced inventory strategies and leaving operators grappling with backlogs.

Amid these disruptions, the global economy has shown resilience, though growth remains uneven across geographies and industries. On the consumption side, growth is led by the US, where goods demand remained elevated throughout 2024, with a growth rate of 2.3% year-over-year until November. On the production side, global growth is driven by China, where the economy continues to be characterised by manufacturing overcapacity and weak domestic demand. In the Euro Area, retail sales (excluding food and fuel) finally showed improvement, growing 2.6% year-over-year in Q3 and 2.3% year-over-year in the first two months of Q4, following two years of flat development. However, announcements of plant closures from established

companies underscore the structural issues with European manufacturing that pile on top of the cyclical downturn of the sector. Expectations for a European recovery in 2025 have been downsized by analysts as CEO confidence tumbled in November. Despite an uncertain outlook, global container demand and trade remained robust throughout 2024.

Container trade and logistics in 2024: a year of unexpectedly strong demand

The global container market went through a robust recovery in 2024, with growth estimated around 7% for the full year (Figure 1). Import volumes were particularly strong into North America (14%) and Latin America (12%). Far East imports were remarkably weak (1%) while imports into Africa came out negative (-1%) (Figure 3). All verticals showed healthy growth, and the strongest verticals were Technology, Retail and Lifestyle.

Export growth out of China was the ultimate growth driver in 2024. During the year, China continued to increase its footprint in all regions, except for North America. The Chinese share of global exports increased from 32% in 2019 to 34% in 2023 and is estimated to be around 36% in 2024 (Figure 2). The reason for this development is overcapacity in the Chinese manufacturing sector, which has driven export price deflation in 2023 and 2024 and improved the price competitiveness of Chinese exports. Simultaneously, European and North American shares of exports declined in 2024 compared to 2019 by 2.9 and 2.0 percentage points, respectively.

On the supply side of the container market, nominal capacity expanded by 10% in 2024, driven by a large influx of deliveries. Around 3m TEU of new capacity has been delivered, equivalent to more than 10% of the fleet. However, despite the large influx of new vessels, capacity remained scarce. Not only did demand keep surprising shippers and carriers to the upside, but the Red Sea disruption meant additional capacity was needed to cope with the re-routing of key services around the Cape of Good Hope. Consequently, freight rates rose substantially. The Shanghai Containerized Freight Index (SCFI) increased from around 1,000 on the eve of the escalation of attacks in mid-December 2023, to a peak of almost 3,750 at the beginning of July 2024. On average, the SCFI was around 150% higher in 2024 than in 2023.

Source: Maersk Strategic Insights.

1 Data based on actuals until and including: November 2024 – Container trade, October – Air freight forwarding and September 2024 – Contract logistics. 2 The remainder of 2024 data is based on estimates.

Financials

Source: Maersk Strategic Insights.

Global air freight forwarding demand started the year on a weak foot but gradually gained momentum. Fullyear growth is estimated at 6%. October, the latest actual available, marked a high at 11%. Demand has been supported by Red Sea-induced modal shifts from Ocean and continued strong growth within e-commerce, especially out of Asia. Growth not only strengthened, but also broadened throughout the year, with import volumes growing across all regions and all verticals (with the exception of automotive) contributing to positive developments. On the export side, Far East Asia stands out for robust growth, while on the import side, Europe led the recovery. During 2024, supply struggled to keep up with demand that often surprised on the upside, especially during the second half of the year when strikes and supply-chain issues delayed the delivery of new aircraft. To accommodate demand growth, frequency of flights and tonnes per fleet increased. Utilisation, however, is highly unbalanced, with capacity being constrained on select headhaul routes and severely underutilised on the same backhaul. The balance is both a drag on volume growth and push on rates, which hovered around 2.1 USD/k in 2024, which is low compared to recent years but one third higher than 2019 levels.

Contract logistics

Contract logistics demand increased by around 3% in 2024, driven by US consumer spending and manufacturing in China. Demand was weaker in Europe where low production levels in Germany counterbalanced strong growth in emerging fulfilment markets like Poland and moderate growth in the rest of the region's

Figure 3 Container import and export by region in 2024 year-on-year % change

Source: Maersk Strategic Insights.

1) Data on geographical regions excludes intra-regional.

2) Data includes actuals for Q1-Q3 and estimates for Q4.

3) Colours indicate growth strength based on the 2024 growth relative to the 2011-19 average growth.

larger economies. India's contract logistics market saw double-digit growth, supported by higher levels of both production and consumption, as well as some base effects from a weak second half of 2023.

Warehousing vacancy rates steadily increased throughout 2024 in the US, reaching 6.7% in Q4. This was driven by shippers adjusting operations after the demand normalisation of 2023 and an influx of speculative construction adding to capacity. Despite the rise, vacancy rates remain low compared to historical averages. In Europe, vacancies followed a similar trend, climbing to 5.9% in Q3.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Advanced warehouse automation is the dominant trend in this market. Fulfilment and distribution operations demand higher efficiency due to ongoing e-commerce growth and rising labour costs. Simultaneously, investments in automation technology are becoming more accessible and easier to implement.

Ground freight in US and Europe

Ground freight demand experienced subdued growth in both the US and Europe. In the US, demand fell by 0.6% year-over-year over the first ten months of 2024, with stabilisation mid-year followed by sequential growth in the second half. Truckload demand mirrored the downturn in the manufacturing sector, which saw consistently weak production volumes. Less-than-truckload volumes faced sharper fluctuations, but while overall demand was weak, growth in e-commerce, particularly heavy and bulky last-mile shipments, helped partially offset declines. While truckload demand in the US remained weak throughout 2024, supply, driven by small fleets and owner-operators, was high. Truckload spot rates have been rising since mid-2024, with a stronger surge in Q4. However, contract rates have been on a downward trajectory throughout 2024. The less-than-truckload market faced capacity constraints due to disruptions from Yellow's bankruptcy, which significantly impacted terminal networks. These constraints outweighed the effects of weak demand, leading to sustained rate increases over the course of the year. In Europe, road freight demand remained flat, hindered by weak manufacturing output. As a result, rates have fallen from the Q3 2022 peak, although due to a structural increase in costs across the region rates remain above 2021 levels.

The outlook for 2025: Major challenges call for strong partnerships

More balanced economic growth in 2025

Economic growth in 2025 is expected to expand further, with Oxford Economics forecasting global economic growth at 2.8%. Western central bank rate cuts are expected to stimulate demand. While there is no shortage of risks, the baseline view is that growth is also expected to find a better balance across industries and geographies, leading to a more sustainable trajectory. Beyond the macroeconomic landscape, five more trends are poised to shape global trade and logistics in 2025: geopolitics, climate change, e-commerce, AI applications and attention to cyber resilience.

Geopolitics as a dominant force

While the Middle East shows signs of progress towards resolution at the start of 2025, a resolution to the conflict in Ukraine remains elusive. Simultaneously, the list of geopolitical strains on supply chains continues to expand with uncertainty over heightened tariffs on US imports as well as tighter export controls on critical goods, sanctions and a renewed interest in industrial policies. The impact of US tariffs will be larger depending on their level, the coverage of countries and goods, partners' retaliation and the risk of tariffs in third countries against Chinese manufactured goods as they look for new markets. Heightened scrutiny of rules of origin and non-tariff barriers will likely add another layer of complexity to the daily operations of trade and logistics. The diversification of sourcing strategy will continue under the push from geopolitics.

Rising risks of climate change

Projections suggest that climate change will only intensify throughout the decade, with losses from adverse extreme weather events likely to rise as 2024 surpassed 2023 as the hottest year on record. Logistics providers are expected to respond by investing in climate-resilient assets and diversifying supply chains, as insurance costs can be prohibitive. For many, this may involve recalibrating operations to mitigate risks from hurricanes, floods and other climate-driven disruptions. A stronger commitment to decarbonisation is essential to move away from fossil fuel-powered equipment and achieve net-zero greenhouse gas emissions.

e-commerce's push and pull

The global e-commerce market is set to sustain its growth trajectory into 2025. The expansion of crossborder direct-to-consumer platforms plays an important role, and, in fact, airfreight shipments for e-commerce continue to beat records. This surge calls for a robust direct-to-consumer supply chain strategy for all players. However, the US Customs and Border Protection is considering stricter de minimis rules and increased declaration requirements, which could impact the tax-free import thresholds currently benefitting e-commerce shipments.

Generative AI – early stages of impact

Generative AI (GenAI) and Agentic AI are gaining traction, with record funding for research, data centre expansion and grid upgrades. While the technology's transformative potential for supply chains and logistics is being discovered, early applications are emerging. GenAI is being deployed to automate non-critical back-office processes, such as customer service and administrative tasks (e.g. AI Agent Assist). Over time, its influence is expected to extend to front-line operations including warehousing, execution of supply chain management, terminal management and transportation systems to facilitate decision making through advanced analytics and real-time data sharing. AI is key to achieving much-desired visibility and transparency.

The call for cyber resilience

In 2024, ransomware attacks on terminals and logistics providers intensified, highlighting the critical role of logistics networks as prime targets for cybercriminals. The growing sophistication of cyberattacks on critical infrastructure is driven by advances in AI, increased connectivity of software and devices and rising geopolitical tensions. These cyber threats not only have the potential to disrupt operations, but also pose significant safety and environmental risks. Logistics leaders are increasingly adopting a comprehensive, ecosystem-wide approach that includes collaboration with customers, suppliers and other third parties to improve resilience.

Stronger together

As 2025 unfolds, businesses will need to navigate a complex landscape shaped by geopolitical uncertainties, climate and cybersecurity risks, regulatory shifts and technological innovation. The ability to adapt will define the winners in an increasingly volatile global marketplace and will call for strong partnerships. Despite a charged external environment, demand is expected to grow in the range of 3.5% to 5.5% for container trade, 2% to 4% for air freight forwarding, and around 3.5% for contract logistics.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

STRATEGY

The integrator

In 2024, A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) advanced its transformation into the integrator of container logistics while navigating a landscape of market disruptions. The company focused on connecting and simplifying customer supply chains, delivering greater transparency, control and resilience in response to heightened volatility and global supply chain challenges.

2024 – a year of continued transformation

In 2024, Maersk took further strides in its transformation to an integrator of container logistics. The company continues to simplify and connect customer supply chains, offering greater transparency, tighter control and enhanced efficiencies. This progress reinforces Maersk's commitment to creating an integrated logistics experience, tailored to the evolving needs of its customers.

The integration of the company's extensive Logistics & Services portfolio with its differentiated and reliable Ocean transport network remains a key driver of Maersk's strategy. Significant operational synergies between Terminals and Ocean will be realised with the new Gemini network, which leverages the company's own Ocean volumes to stabilise terminal operations while optimising performance and minimising risks.

Despite the heightened market volatility and supply chain disruptions in 2024, driven by ongoing geopolitical tensions and fluctuating global demand, Maersk's strategy remains resilient. New customer wins and industry recognition validated the integrator model, as businesses across industries, geographies and scales continue to buy into the company's comprehensive logistics solutions. Customers see the tangible value Maersk delivers, from operational excellence to sustainable practices.

Progress amidst change

The foundation of Maersk's strategy is built on three pillar enablers: a strong commitment to ESG, technology innovation and the expertise of people. In 2024, Maersk's ability to navigate a complex global logistics environment while keeping customer needs at the forefront has been a hallmark of the company's success, and it shows that Maersk's pillars have provided solid foundations for the strong performance. The group's focus on customer centricity and operational agility continues to differentiate Maersk as a global leader in container logistics.

The company's long-term vision, introduced in 2017, becomes more of a reality every year. Key milestones, including the official launch of the Gemini Cooperation from 2025, will continue to drive Maersk's transformation. Today, as market dynamics shift and customer needs evolve, Maersk's integrator model remains essential to delivering superior service quality, reliability and global reach.

The road from a conglomerate to the integrator of logistics

2017

The vision Maersk's vision to become the integrator of container logistics was introduced, and the Hamburg Süd acquisition was closed

2019

Simplified customer experience

The commercial frontlines of Ocean and Logistics & Services were merged to improve customer interaction and accelerate organic growth

2020

Acquisitions to bridge identified capability gaps Performance Team and KGH Customs Services

Reorganisation

The reorganisation of Ocean and Logistics & Services completed and integration of the Safmarine brand, Damco air freight and LCL to improve customer experience and end-to-end service delivery

2021

e-commerce capabilities acquired

Acquisitions to bridge capability gaps within the e-commerce space with Visible, B2C Europe and HUUB

2022

Integrated logistics, air and contract logistics offerings expanded

Acquisitions of Pilot and Senator, adding to Maersk's supply chain and air capabilities as well as LF Logistics to complement contract logistics

2023

2M break-up

The 2M alliance termination in 2025 announced with the goal to enable the Integrator strategy and unlock higher value for Maersk's customers

Reorganisation

New organisation introduced to pivot on the transformation strategy

First methanol-capable vessel in the world Delivery of Laura Mærsk

2024

Ocean network

Maersk entered into a long-term operational collaboration with Hapag-Lloyd from February 2025 named Gemini Cooperation

Demerger of Svitzer

Continued journey for Maersk to simplify its business and focus on integrated logistics

Scaling up low-carbon fuels fleet

Seven new dual-fuel methanol vessels set sail in 2024 and 800k TEU capacity of dual-fuel vessels was secured with delivery by 2030

Bringing the integrator strategy to life

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Logistics & Services Ocean Terminals

Successfully navigating continued disruption

2024 marked yet another period of global disruption, with the on-going effects from the Red Sea situation, the continued war in Ukraine, and strikes impacting key elements of the global logistics infrastructure. Amid this turbulence, Maersk has remained committed to supporting its customers as they navigate an increasingly complex and uncertain environment. These challenges underscore the critical role that the company plays as a trusted partner, delivering resilient, end-to-end supply chain solutions that empower customers to adapt and thrive in a rapidly evolving market. Building on 2024 and the last few years, disruption in global supply chains is no longer an exception; rather it is becoming a constant. This new reality aligns closely with Maersk's strategy to be a partner to our customers, offering integrated, reliable and flexible solutions. The company's strong organic growth in 2024 reflects the success of this approach and is a symbol of the satisfaction and trust from all customers.

Executing excellence

Operational excellence remained central to Maersk's focus in 2024. The group strengthened core capabilities, continued the integration of acquisitions and invested in advanced technologies to enhance service delivery and efficiency. This focus translated into margin improvements during the year, demonstrating the value of disciplined execution and innovation. Looking ahead, Maersk is positioned to lead the transformation of global logistics. In a world where resilience and agility are essential, the company is committed to supporting customer success. Together with all valued employees, partners, and customers, Maersk is shaping a sustainable, connected future for global trade.

adaptability.

Adapting to new challenges

Innovating for the future

As global business environments shift, the demand for a resilient and flexible supply chain is at an all-time high. In 2024, geopolitical instability and market disruptions caused an unplanned need for extra capacity, resulting in uncertainty and freight rates volatility. Ongoing conflicts and port closures strained capacity, intensifying the need for

Volatility became a defining feature this year and is here to stay, further amplifying the complexities of supply chain management. Disruptions are the new normal, with fluctuating trade routes, sudden shifts in demand and environmental concerns shaping the global trade landscape. Port congestion, exacerbated by labour strikes and capacity constraints, added further challenges to maintaining smooth operations. In response, Maersk continued refining its Ocean network to offer industry-leading service quality and efficiency. In an increasingly uncertain world, the company is prepared to meet evolving customer needs while maintaining operational excellence and driving innovation.

A key 2024 milestone was the advancement of the Gemini Cooperation with Hapag-Lloyd, which will take effect in early 2025. This forward-thinking partnership, combined with enhanced network design, will allow the company to adapt to ongoing market changes while aiming to deliver the industry's top reliability of above 90% for services

The company continues to deliver on its sustainability and longterm goal of achieving net-zero emissions. In 2024, Maersk deployed seven large dual-fuel methanol vessels (113k TEU capacity) and initiated ordering 50-60 (800k TEU capacity) additional owned and timechartered dual-fuel vessels as part of the fleet renewal programme. Maersk will continue to maintain a disciplined approach to capital

under the Gemini scope of trades, once fully phased in.

expenditures while optimising its fleet capacity.

Delivering strong performance

In 2024, Terminals continued to be a crucial component of Maersk's integrator strategy, enhancing network stability through the hubs and delivering consistent and resilient earnings through the gateway terminals. The segment delivered another year of strong performance, driven by sustained top-line growth and unwavering focus on operational excellence, leading to margin expansion and improved cash flow. This steady track record reflects the underlying strength of the business, despite recurrent external disruptions and geopolitical uncertainties. Globally, Terminals' portfolio remains fundamentally resilient, reinforcing confidence in the terminal industry outlook.

Continuing to deliver value for our stakeholders

Terminals consistently creates value for all shipping line and landside customers, local communities, and host governments by pursuing high operational quality and efficiency. Leveraging standardisation and industry-leading capabilities, Terminals is the trusted operator of strategic infrastructure in the locations where it operates. Its commitment to the ESG agenda and fostering local growth is steady, as proven by significant progress in electrifying terminals and developing green grid solutions. Building on its results, Terminals actively invests in developing, expanding and upgrading key port locations worldwide.

Terminals also fulfils the pivotal role of operating hubs, to support the seamless execution of the Gemini network. To ensure readiness for the new network launch in 2025, Terminals has future-proofed its hubs network through extensive investments in physical infrastructure and technology. These efforts drive best-in-class productivity and enable a new standard of close operational collaboration between Ocean and Terminals.

Performance

ESG SBM-1 §40a i-ii SBM-1 §40e-g

ESG at the centre of Maersk's Purpose and Values

Maersk's ambitious ESG commitments are an integral part of its business strategy and a prerequisite for success as the global integrator. Building on over a decade of commitment to sustainability progress, Maersk's ESG strategy charts an ambitious course, with ESG as core to the company's Purpose and Values. The strategy encompasses Maersk's material sustainability impacts, risks and opportunities and is centred around three core commitments – taking leadership in the decarbonisation of logistics, ensuring that our people thrive at work by providing a safe and inspiring workplace and operating based on responsible business practices. These commitments are delivered across 10 ESG categories, each with defined roadmaps and governance.

Differentiating by decarbonising customers' supply chains

Maersk sees the growing strategic importance of ESG and sustainability amongst its customers, with some having increasingly mature and ambitious commitments. Meeting the customers wherever they are on this journey and helping them achieve their ambitious decarbonisation targets is essential to Maersk's ESG and business strategies. Customers across all regions and segments, particularly those close to endconsumers such as Fashion & Lifestyle and FMCG, also face increasing expectations from their customers to have low-emission supply chains. Maersk proactively collaborates with customers to shape the products, services and technologies that can support their sustainability ambitions. This includes ECO Delivery – Maersk's emissions-reduced product family for Ocean, Inland and Air freight, and Emissions Dashboard – enabling customers to view and manage their logistics greenhouse gas emissions across all transportation modes.

The company believes that operating based on responsible business practices, being recognised as an ESG leader in external ratings valued by customers and investors, such as EcoVadis and CDP, is a true differentiator.

For more details on ESG strategy and performance, see the sustainability statement, pages 53-135.

Accelerating digital transformation

In 2024, Maersk made significant progress on its process and technology transformation journey. This serves to accelerate growth through scalable platforms, delivering better quality and customer outcomes as well as unlocking user productivity. The key highlights include:

  • Significant improvement in process maturity enabling end-to-end standardisation
  • Acceleration of modern platforms roll-out, including Maersk's Landside Platform (TMS) – executing inland transportation on one platform and delivering a better customer and supplier experience; a unified, global Warehouse Management System (WMS) – replacing 50+ legacy applications, optimising and managing the operations of warehouses and distribution centres; and the roll-out of a global Air platform – enabling timely execution for customers and an improved user experience.
  • Automation and optimisation of operations within terminals

With this strong foundation in place, in 2025, the company will accelerate value realisation from technology, delivering better results for customers while improving productivity.

The power of AI

AI, particularly Generative AI, represents a tremendous opportunity to drive value realisation and step-change Maersk's strategy execution. The company invests in a plethora of AI initiatives, leveraging traditional AI/ ML and Generative AI techniques. Several of these AI/ML initiatives are well entrenched into operational execution, yielding measurable benefits. Generative AI initiatives are showing success proof points as the company targets agentic workflow automation. One example is the roll-out of CX Agent Assist, which supports Maersk's Ocean CX colleagues by significantly reducing the turnaround time for customer queries. The company continues to approach AI with speed, ensuring benefits are reaped and with caution, ensuring compliance with fast-developing regulations.

Technology People

Investing in talent and leadership

In 2024, Maersk continued the execution of its People Strategy, reaffirming its commitment to investing in colleagues and empowering teams to excel, support one another and deliver value to customers. As the logistics landscape evolved throughout the year, the company prioritised supporting employees by focusing on team enablement, leadership development, scaling frontline capabilities and fostering a thriving work environment.

To retain and attract top talent, Maersk remains dedicated to being an employer of choice by offering meaningful development opportunities and cultivating an environment that values diverse perspectives. Building on its refreshed performance management culture, the company emphasised continuous development through initiatives like the Maersk Academy, a one-stop shop for learning resources, and a mentorship framework designed to empower colleagues to achieve business goals while advancing their careers. Leadership programmes further equipped leaders to guide and support their teams effectively, strengthening diverse and inclusive talent pipelines.

Maersk's commitment to creating an engaging and inclusive workplace remains central to its efforts, integrating Diversity, Equity, and Inclusion (DE&I) principles to ensure all colleagues feel safe, valued and able to thrive in their careers.

For more details, see pages 109-125 in the sustainability statement.

Annual Report 2024

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

RISK MANAGEMENT

Managing the risk landscape

Risk management at A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) is focused on supporting the strategic objectives in the medium term and ensuring the longevity of the company's business model in the longer term. Maersk's Enterprise Risk Management framework provides a consistent and mature method for identifying, assessing, mitigating and monitoring key risks.

Identifying Maersk's key risks

The Enterprise Risk Management (ERM) framework at Maersk ensures that all business areas and functions identify potential risks impacting their objectives and operations. This process involves risk reporting from various business areas and functions, complemented by interviews with individual executives to obtain a comprehensive view of the risks to the company's objectives.

The identified risks are then assessed and consolidated into an enterprise-wide risk landscape. Following this, the Executive Leadership Team reviews the consolidated risk landscape to determine the key risks for the company. These key risks are subsequently discussed and validated by the Board of Directors.

Managing Maersk's key risks

Key risks are assigned to an executive owner who is responsible for managing the risk, ensuring that appropriate controls are in place and implementing necessary action plans to keep or bring the risk within risk tolerance. To maintain proper oversight, key risk developments and mitigation progress and effectiveness are monitored and reported throughout the year using agreed metrics. The annual risk report provides a status on the key risks and the effectiveness of mitigation efforts. Additionally, the Board of Directors holds deep dive sessions with executive risk owners throughout the year to discuss selected key risks. Figure 1 provides an overview of Maersk's ERM governance structure.

Changes to the key risks

Figure 2 depicts the 2025 key risks to Maersk's business objectives. The 2025 risk landscape remains relatively stable and in line with previous years. Some of the continuing risks are externally driven risks associated with the market and the general business/operating environment for global trade (Ocean profitability, Geopolitical tension, Cyberattack, and Legal and regulatory compliance). Other continuing risks are internally driven and associated with the ongoing transformation (Logistics growth, Technology roadmap, and Decarbonisation).

There are three new key risks in 2025. These are the risks that the new Gemini network will not perform as intended (Ocean network), that the company fails to renew and add new terminal concessions (APM Terminals growth), and that the company fails to respond effectively to supply chain shocks like COVID-19 and the Red Sea disruption (Supply chain resilience).

Three key risks have been removed. Mergers and acquisitions integration is no longer a significant concern as our acquired companies have been largely integrated over the past few years. Organisational capabilities including retaining and attracting talent has become less of a risk as the transformation of the company progresses. Last, Process excellence is now forming part of the Process and technology transformation risk.

Aligned assurance

The effort to further mature enterprise risk management in Maersk continued during 2024. With the ERM framework being performed consistently across the company, the current focus is on enhancing the assurance that the company's key risks are managed effectively within defined risk tolerances. To that end, the company adopts an aligned and risk-based approach to assurance, ensuring that 1) enterprise risk tolerances are tangible and relatable at a process and control level, 2) controls link back to enterprise risks, 3) the scope, purpose and methodology of each assurance provider is clear and without duplication and 4) assurance providers have the capabilities required to deliver their respective scope of assurance.

Figure 1 Overview of governance structure

20

Figure 2

Risk continuing from 2024 New risk

Strategic

Risks associated with current and future business plans and strategies

Ocean freight rates

1

2

5

7

Financial loss from significant drop in freight rates over a longer period

Geopolitical tension

Escalation of geopolitical tensions and political uncertainty impacting future supply chain

Process and technology transformation Failure or serious delay in execution of technology roadmap

Decarbonisation Failure to decarbonise at desired speed

APM Terminals growth Failure to renew and add new terminal concessions 10

Compliance

9

Risks associated with non-compliance with rules and/or policies

Legal and regulatory compliance Being hit by a large compliance case

Key risks to the

2025-2029 business plan

Maersk categorises risks into four different areas to provide the appropriate level of governance and oversight to effectively manage these risks.

Operational

Operational

Risks associated with business activities and operations, procedures, people and systems

Ocean network New network not performing as intended

Logistics growth 4

Failure or serious delay in achieving the targeted growth in Logistics

Cyberattack 6

3

8

External or internal attack resulting in service unavailability or data breach

Supply chain resilience Failure to respond effectively to supply chain shocks

Financial

Risks associated with potential financial losses

1 2 3
NEW RISK
4 5
Ocean freight rates Geopolitical tension New Ocean network Logistics growth Process and technology
transformation
Risk owner .
CPO - Ocean
Year-on-year risk movementIncreasing
Risk category .
Strategic
Risk owner
CCAO
Year-on-year risk movementIncreasing
Risk category .
Strategic
Risk owner .
CPO – Ocean
CEO - APM Terminals, COO
Year-on-year risk movement New risk
Risk category
Operational
Risk owner
CPO – Logistics & Services
Year-on-year risk movement Stable
Risk category
Operational
Risk owner
CTO, CSO
Year-on-year risk movement Stable
Risk category .
Strategic
What is
this risk
The profitability in Ocean could deteriorate
and potentially be negative for a prolonged
period. The risk is driven by the potential
for supply and demand imbalances in the
Ocean freight market. A significant drop in
rates over a longer period could lead to
a significant financial loss.
Escalation of geopolitical tension may have
a strong and immediate impact on the
future supply chain through disruptions in
supply, demand and logistics infrastructure
and, eventually, fragmentation of supply
chains and changed trade patterns. This is
particularly the case where tension mounts
to military conflict and/or trade sanctions
being applied.
The new network may not operate as
intended and deliver the targeted results in
terms of reliability and costs. In the short
term, this could be driven by inability to
respond to the multiple changes required. In
the longer term, this could be driven by hubs
capacity and flexibility or meltdown, leading
to lower reliability, increased costs and loss
of customer confidence.
Maersk faces a risk of not being able to
deliver profitable growth in the logistics
business within the envisaged period of
time, which would impact the ability to
execute on the integrator strategy and
realise financial targets.
A serious delay or failure to execute the
technology roadmap and to standardise
core end-to-end business processes will
have a material negative impact on Maersk's
growth vision as an end-to-end integrator
of global container logistics.
How we
manage it
Maersk has limited levers to impact the
overall demand for container shipping and
cannot influence the market rates. With the
focus on managing rate exposure via reve
nue optimisation during different cycles in
the market, product differentiation as well
as cost strategy to effectively reduce the
unit cost, the company will, all else equal,
continue to reduce the impact.
Maersk monitors geopolitical developments
and takes adaptive steps as required, includ
ing reducing exposure to critical suppliers,
evaluating alternative procurement options,
implementing adequate payment profiles,
creating external communication plans and
advancing business continuity planning.
Maersk is focused on the implementation of
the plan to ensure smooth transitioning to
the new Ocean network during the phase-in
period (February-May 2025). Close collabo
ration with Hapag-Lloyd is in place to ensure
required governance, data and reporting.
Differentiated growth will be achieved by
focusing on markets where Maersk has
an existing right to win, restoring margins
through execution of turnaround plans and
accelerating operational excellence through
process standardisation and platform mod
ernisation. The focus is also on optimal
asset deployment, driving cost effective
ness and productivity and gaining competi
tive advantage.
Maersk focuses on stabilising and modern
ising core applications and infrastructure
and driving progress on platform-to-plat
form integration opportunities to enhance
the overall transformation in alignment with
the Maersk Integrator Strategy. In addition,
Maersk is committed to delivering a Process
Maturity Roadmap which includes end-to
end process designs, metrics and control
implementations.
Risk
tolerance
High: Maersk assumes margins will continue
to be under pressure in the short to medium
term. In addition, the geopolitical landscape
makes the industry extraordinarily volatile.
High: Maersk aims to have multiple options
in place for several procurement categories
and to be able to adjust the network and
capacity in the ocean business to accommo
date for potential disruptions and changes
in customer needs and trade patterns.
Medium: Maersk targets high schedule reli
ability, reduced port call hours and unit cost,
mainly driven by the leaner mainliner, hub
capacity and shuttle service operated by
Maersk.
Medium: Maersk targets large and profit
able volume growth across its Warehous
ing, Landside, e-commerce and Air products
through organic growth and opportunistic
acquisitions, cost reductions and increased
productivity, driven by automation through
platform roll-outs.
Medium: In 2025, Maersk continues to tar
get significant progress in the implementa
tion of best-in-class technology platforms
and automate its processes to support end
to-end supply chain solutions and underpin
customer convenience and satisfaction.
Potential
scenario
The increase in vessel capacity in the market
combined with a significantly lower demand
lead to a drop in freight rates that continues
for longer than expected
Military conflicts or comprehensive and
long-lasting naval blockades leading to
obstruction of major network routes and
potential wide sanctions inhibiting trade
in major markets affected.
Lack of smooth transitioning to the new
Ocean network and/or an insufficient level
of the network's resilience creates chal
lenges associated with the reliability and
unit cost that result in loss of business and/
or customers.
Lack of profitable growth at the envis
aged pace in Logistics & Services delays the
implementation of the integrator strategy
and keeps the company exposed to the
financial volatility of the Ocean segment.
Unsuccessful implementation of digitised
supply chain solutions causes a loss of the
digital competitive advantage and customer
dissatisfaction and impacts the company's
reputation and financial performance.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

22 A.P. Moller - Maersk

Annual Report 2024

6 7 8
NEW RISK
9 10
NEW RISK
Cyberattack Decarbonisation Supply chain resilience Legal and regulatory
compliance
APM Terminals growth
Risk owner .
CTO
Year-on-year risk movement Stable
Risk owner .
COO
Year-on-year risk movement Stable
Risk owner .
COO
Year-on-year risk movement New risk
Risk owner
CCAO
Year-on-year risk movement Stable
Risk owner
CEO – APM Terminals
Year-on-year risk movement New risk
Risk category
Operational
Risk category .
Strategic
Risk category
Operational
Risk category
Compliance
Risk category .
Strategic
What is
this risk
As Maersk becomes increasingly digital
ised, more devices and control systems are
connected online and there is an accelera
tion in adoption of automation and robotics,
resulting in a wider technology surface. This,
compounded with ever-increasing external
threat capabilities puts more pressure on
systems to be cyber threat-resilient.
It is imperative for Maersk to decarbonise
its end to-end supply chain at a speed
that meets the expectations of customers,
investors and society, and in a way that
generates business value for Maersk and
its customers
The increase in supply chain shocks caused by
disruptive events such as natural disasters,
armed conflicts or major operational inci
dents is making it even more important to
be able to respond effectively to avoid busi
ness interruption, a drop in service level and
added costs and at the same time maintain
operational and commercial agility to capture
potential upsides associated with such events.
The legal and regulatory landscape in which
Maersk operates is complex and the com
pany could be subject to compliance cases
in connection with violations of anti-cor
ruption laws, anti-trust regulations, interna
tional sanctions and/or data privacy.
In order to deliver profitable growth and
continue to deliver important support to the
Maersk integrator strategy, APM Terminals
must extend certain essential concessions
that are expiring as well as secure new
locations at good terms for years to come.
How we
manage it
Maersk continues to execute its cyber
security programme, strengthen business
continuity plans and enhance its cyber
threat resilience. Over the recent years,
the company has continued to enhance
capabilities to control impact through
appropriate preparedness and response
procedures.
The regulatory support in terms of a global
carbon tax is essential for supporting the
decarbonisation at the speed required and
therefore Maersk strongly supports the pro
gress. At the same time, Maersk continues
to enhance its product offering to support
customer demand along with initiatives
to decarbonise the value chain through
technological improvements.
Maersk ensures critical processes and
dependencies are continuously identified,
business continuity plans are prepared and
tested and asset management and contract
ing strategy are sufficiently agile to respond
effectively to unexpected events.
Maersk has global and regional sub
ject-matter experts in each compliance
area and a robust compliance programme
designed to fulfil global requirements. The
company has implemented many initiatives
to improve focus and emphasis through
a whistleblower system, regular risk assess
ments, screenings and robust controls,
targeted in-person trainings and e-learning
sessions.
A newly established concession excel
lence team is supporting the terminals in
their relations with governments and local
authorities to ensure the APM Terminals
value proposition aligns with local expecta
tions. At the same time, there is a continued
focus on improving operational excellence
and driving revenue growth. For new
projects, actions focus on prioritisation
of projects and on defining a clear joint
venture strategy.
Risk
tolerance
Low: Maersk aims to avoid a material
cyberattack through increased threat intel
ligence, capabilities that protect, detect
and respond to threats and building digital
resilience with business segments, third
parties and wider supply chains.
Medium: Maersk targets achievement of its
commitments in a financially viable way.
Medium: Maersk targets a robust supply
chain without sacrificing profitability.
Low: Maersk is committed to ensuring com
pliance with all applicable laws and regula
tions in all the countries where it operates.
Medium: APM Terminals targets to renew
existing concessions important for the
Maersk Ocean network in addition to a
number of new locations every year.
Potential
scenario
Direct or indirect attack(s) on Maersk's or
its business partners' network due to dig
itisation, threat sophistication or inherent
vulnerabilities from, e.g., new M&A envi
ronments cause severe business disruption
and/or data breaches leading to financial
losses and loss of customer trust.
Maersk fails to reach its 2030 decarbonisa
tion targets due to cost disparity between
fossil fuels and reduced GHG emission fuels
and insufficient uptake in the Eco-products
offered.
A supply chain shock disrupts operations,
resulting in delays, increased costs,
decreased customer satisfaction and
potential long-term reputational damage.
A violation of compliance regulation causes
severe reputational damage and substantial
legal fines, damages and costs.
Unsuccessful negotiations with local
governments lead to inability to extend
concessions and win new concessions
at good terms.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

23 A.P. Moller - Maersk

Annual Report 2024

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

ESG risks

In compliance with the EU Corporate Sustainability Reporting Directive (CSRD) requirements, Maersk conducted the double materiality assessment in 2024. As part of this assessment, Maersk established the financial impact arising from the potential sustainability-related topics. The topics covered by the financial impact assessment for 2024 are climate change, pollution, ship recycling, retaining and attracting critical talent, working conditions, equal treatment, other work-related rights (forced labour, data privacy), ethical use of data and AI, supplier relationships, corruption and bribery and tax. The quantified financial impact of each of the topics is established through scenario-based modelling. For the results of the double materiality assessment, see pages 66-68 and for details on physical climate-related risks specifically, see page 88.

Emerging risks

Maersk considers how megatrends and uncertainties can have both positive and negative impacts on the company's longer-term value drivers. Risks and opportunities derived from these megatrends and uncertainties are identified through an externally facilitated workshop considering uncertainties pertinent through the five lenses shown in Figure 3. In 2025, the radar reveals a very dynamic emerging risk and opportunity landscape with multiple uncertainties related to technology disruption, to drastic shifts in the geopolitical, social and economic environment and to environmentally driven shifts in our business environment.

Two of the emerging risks might have a significant impact on Maersk's business model.

1 Technology advancements/AI

Rapid advancements in technology and use of AI could lead to the creation of new tech/AI based business models and/or customers taking a more dominant role in integrating their own supply chains, thereby making the Maersk integrator value proposition less relevant.

2 EU depowered

Current political priorities and the economic situation in the EU combined with China and US investments and progress in new technologies could lead to the EU falling further behind in terms of innovation and competitiveness. On top of other trade restrictions, this would negatively impact all European-based companies in terms of competition and access to markets globally.

Anchored in technological, economic, social, environmental and geopolitical trends, new uncertainties to our value drivers are emerging.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Performance

Financial review

Putting gender diversity front and centre

Chennai, India

In 2024, Maersk transformed operations at one of its Container Freight Station (CFS) warehouses in Chennai, India, by introducing a complete shift run entirely by female employees. This initiative underscores Maersk's dedication to enhancing gender diversity across all roles and job levels.

In addition to transforming our operations, such initiatives challenge the status quo in the traditionally male-dominated logistics industry sector. Women at this CFS are supported through comprehensive training programmes that cover professional and personal safety, as well as the many skills necessary to excel in warehouse operations.

Annual Report 2024

Financial review

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk)'s profitability for 2024 was strong, reflecting the progressively strong container demand following the situation in the Red Sea beginning in late 2023, which exacerbated supply chain disruptions throughout the year, primarily impacting the Ocean business through peak freight rates coupled with strong volumes. Strong Ocean profitability was supported by Logistics & Services with increased volumes and Terminals with revenue per move reaching an all-time high during the year combined with higher volume.

Profitability for 2024 improved significantly versus 2023, which was a year of stabilisation following all-time pandemic highs in 2022 as a result of the exceptional market situation. The financial results in 2024 reflect growth across all segments.

Ocean had a strong year, recovering to a positive EBIT in first half of 2024 and reaching exceptional levels in the second half. This growth was primarily driven by high rates and strong volumes, although it was partially offset by increased costs due to the re-routing south of the Cape of Good Hope throughout the year.

Logistics & Services experienced revenue growth stemming from stronger rates and volumes, particularly driven by Air, First Mile, Warehousing and Last Mile. Profitability improved during the year with the majority of the overall increase driven by Air and Lead Logistics.

Terminals revenue increased due to stronger storage revenue and higher volumes, as terminals became fully operational following construction closures in 2023. A continued focus on improvements and cost management ensured solid profitable performance.

A.P. Moller - Maersk consolidated 55,482 51,065 12,128 9,591 6,499 3,934 4,201 3,646
Unallocated activities, eliminations, etc. -1,291 -348 -106 122 -111 281 110 347
Terminals 4,465 3,844 1,601 1,278 1,329 980 580 541
Logistics & Services 14,920 13,916 1,447 1,251 538 446 803 771
Ocean 37,388 33,653 9,186 6,940 4,743 2,227 2,708 1,987
2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023
Revenue EBITDA EBIT CAPEX
Highlights for the year USD million

Financial and operational performance

Revenue increased by USD 4.4bn to USD 55.5bn (USD 51.1bn), with increases across segments. The revenue improvement in Ocean reflects the significant increases in freight rates together with strong volumes in 2024. In Logistics & Services, total revenue increased by 7.2%, mainly driven by Air, First Mile, Warehousing and Last Mile due to higher freight rates and volumes, partially offset by Lead Logistics and Customs Services.

Revenue increased in Terminals as a result of strong volumes and storage revenue, particularly in North America and Mumbai, India, due to the terminal being fully operational again in 2024.

37.4
Ocean, USDbn
Logistics & Services, USDbn
(2023: 33.7bn)
(2023: 13.9bn)
14.9 4.5
Terminals, USDbn
(2023: 3.8bn)
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- ------ ------------------------------------------ --

EBITDA increased to USD 12.1bn (USD 9.6bn) with an increase in Ocean of USD 2.2bn due to higher rates, and improvement in Logistics & Services of USD 196m and in Terminals of USD 323m. The EBITDA margin increased to 21.9% (18.8%).

9.2
Ocean, USDbn
(2023: 6.9bn)
(2023: 1.3bn)
1.4
1.6
Logistics & Services, USDbn
Terminals, USDbn
(2023: 1.3bn)
------------------------------------------------------- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

EBIT increased by USD 2.6bn to USD 6.5bn (USD 3.9bn), impacted by the increasing EBITDA, mainly from Ocean. The EBIT margin increased to 11.7% (7.7%).

Ocean, USDbn
(2023: 2.2bn)
4.7 Logistics & Services, USDm
(2023: 446m)
538 Terminals, USDbn
(2023: 980m)
1.3

Return on invested capital (ROIC), last 12 months, increased to 12.3% (7.4%), as earnings improved throughout 2024.

Financial items, net, decreased to a gain of USD 317m (gain of USD 428m), driven by lower interest income and higher interest expenses, partly offset by foreign exchange rate gains on working capital.

Tax expense increased to USD 584m (USD 454m), reflecting the higher profit before tax.

Net profit was USD 6.2bn (USD 3.9bn), due to the significant increase in operating earnings.

The underlying net profit after financial items and tax of USD 6.1bn (USD 4.0bn) was primarily adjusted for net gains of USD 222m, mainly from vessel and container sales in Ocean of USD 206m.

Unless otherwise stated, all figures in parenthesis refer to the corresponding figures for the same period prior year.

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Cash flow from operating activities of USD 11.4bn (USD 9.6bn) was driven by EBITDA of USD 12.1bn, offset by an increase in net working capital of USD 311m, primarily due to higher trade receivables, translating into a cash conversion of 94% (101%).

Gross capital expenditure (CAPEX) was USD 4.2bn (USD 3.6bn), primarily driven by higher investments in Ocean.

Free cash flow increased by USD 1.1bn to USD 5.1bn (USD 4.0bn), positively impacted by higher cash flow from operating activities by USD 1.8bn, partly offset by higher CAPEX by USD 555m.

Dividend

The dividend for 2023 of USD 1.2bn declared at the Annual General Meeting on 14 March 2024 was paid on 19 March 2024. Withholding tax of USD 157m was paid in Q2 2024.

For 2024, The Board of Directors proposes a dividend to the shareholders of DKK 1,120 per share of DKK 1,000 (DKK 515 per share of DKK 1,000) corresponding to 40% (30%) of the underlying net result as per the company's dividend policy of distributing between 30-50% of the underlying net result to shareholders in dividends.

The proposed dividend payment represents a dividend yield of 9.4% (4.2%), based on the Maersk B share's closing price of DKK 11,905 on 30 December 2024. Payment is expected to take place on 21 March 2025.

Proposed dividend 2025, DKK

Share buy-back

In 2024, Maersk bought back 43,919 A shares and 174,723 B shares, worth DKK 2.8bn (approximately USD 415m) as part of the share buy-back programme, excluding shares bought back for the long-term incentive programme. In February 2024, the Board of Directors decided to suspend the share buy-back programme, with a re-initiation to be reviewed once market conditions in Ocean are settled. The Board of Directors has decided to initiate a share buy-back programme of up to DKK 14.4bn (around USD 2bn), to be executed over a period of 12 months, with the first phase of DKK 7.2bn (around USD 1bn) to run from 7 February up to 6 August 2025. Refer to shareholder information on page 46 for more details. At 31 December 2024, Maersk owns a total of 120,307 B shares as treasury shares, corresponding to 0.76% of the share capital.

Capital structure and credit rating

Net interest-bearing debt decreased to a net cash position of USD 7.4bn (a net cash position of USD 4.7bn at year-end 2023), as cash used for dividends of USD 1.4bn and share buy-backs of USD 556m was more than offset by free cash flow of USD 5.1bn. Excluding lease liabilities, the Group had a net cash position of USD 18.8bn (USD 15.1bn at year-end 2023).

Maersk remains investment grade-rated and holds a Baa1 (stable) from Moody's and a BBB+ (stable) rating from Standard & Poor's.

Total equity increased to USD 57.9bn (USD 55.1bn at year-end 2023), driven by a net profit of USD 6.2bn, partly offset by dividend payments, share buy-backs and the distribution of shares in Svitzer, resulting in an equity ratio of 66.6% (67.1% at year-end 2023).

The liquidity reserve increased to USD 29.0bn (USD 24.4bn at year-end 2023) and was composed of cash and bank balances (excluding restricted cash), term deposits and securities of USD 23.0bn (USD 18.4bn at year-end 2023) and undrawn revolving credit facilities of USD 6.0bn (USD 6.0bn at year-end 2023).

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Financial guidance

Guidance is based on the expectation that global container volume growth in 2025 will be around 4% and that A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) will grow in line with the market. For the purpose of the financial guidance, Maersk assumes that the Red Sea re-opens mid-year for the low end of the guidance, and re-opens at year-end for the high-end. Maersk's outlook for 2025 is subject to considerable macroeconomic uncertainties impacting container volume growth and freight rates.

USDbn
EBITDA
Underlying
6.0-9.0 EBIT
Underlying
0.0-3.0 Free cash flow
(FCF) or higher
-3.0
2024-2025 CAPEX guidance, maintained 10.0-11.0 CAPEX guidance
2025-2026
10.0-11.0

Sensitivity guidance

Financial performance for A.P. Moller - Maersk for 2025 depends on several factors subject to uncertainties related to the given uncertain macroeconomic conditions, bunker fuel prices and freight rates. All else being equal, the sensitivities for 2025 for four key assumptions are listed below:

Factors Change Effect on EBIT (full year 2025)
Container freight rate +/- 100 USD/FFE +/- USD 1.3bn
Container freight volume +/- 100,000 FFE +/- USD 0.01bn
Bunker price (net of expected BAF coverage) +/- 100 USD/tonne +/- USD 0.4bn
Foreign exchange rate (net of hedges) +/- 10% change in USD +/- USD 0.3bn

Forward-looking statements

The Annual Report contains forward-looking statements. Such statements are subject to risks and uncertainties as various factors, many of which are beyond A.P. Moller - Maersk's control, may cause the actual development and results to differ materially from expectations contained in the Annual Report.

Roadmap towards 2025

The mid-term financial targets introduced at the Capital Markets Day in May 2021 relate to the transformation towards becoming the integrator of container logistics.

Consolidated

The return on invested capital (ROIC) (LTM) of 12.3% was above the yearly target of above 7.5% under normalised conditions. Profitability lagged during the first half of 2024; however, the strong result in the second half of the year had a positive impact, bringing ROIC above target. The average ROIC over 2021-2024 was 31.3%, well above the 12% target for the period 2021-2025.

For information on capital allocation, dividends, share buy-back and shareholder return, see shareholder information on pages 45-46.

Ocean fleet size Target: 4.1-4.3 TEUm

4.1m 4.3m 4.3m

Ocean

Ocean's EBIT margin of 12.7% in 2024 was above the target of 6% under normalised conditions and the total average operated fleet capacity continues to remain within the target range of 4.1-4.3m TEU at 4.3m TEU. EBIT Margin Target: >6%

Logistics & Services

Logistics & Services' organic revenue growth of 7.2% in 2024 was below the target of 10%, however began to recover in the latter half of 2024 from the 2023 low. The EBIT margin was 3.6%, below target but up from 2023.

Organic revenue growth Target: >10% 2021 2022 2023 2024 10.0% 7.2% EBIT Margin Target >6% 2021 2022 2023 2024 6.0% 3.6%

Terminals

The Terminals return on invested capital (ROIC) (LTM) was 13.5%, continuing to exceed the expectation of above 9%.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

ESG commitments

Governance Operate based on responsible business practices

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk)'s ESG strategy highlights three core commitments. Each of the core ESG commitments is supported by a set of short, mid and long-term strategic targets of which a subset is linked to the executive remuneration through the long-term incentive programme.

In 2024, Maersk continued to deliver progress towards its environmental and social commitments despite an uncertain and challenging operating environment. Performance against the 2024 targets is reported in the sustainability statement.

Market demand for low-emission transportation was lower in 2024 compared to previous years. Maersk's ability to deliver on our near and long-term science-based targets is dependent not only on our own actions and investments, but also on a supportive external environment. 2025 will be a milestone year as the International Maritime Organization is set to agree on regulation to close the price gap between green and fossil fuels. We remain committed to our 2030 and 2040 science-based targets.

As we are reaching the 2025 target year on our strategic social and governance targets, we will be reviewing these and setting new targets for the coming years.

The targets outlined on the right are defined in detail within the sustainability statement, outlined within the relevant topical section's performance data (Environment, Social and Governance), under accounting policies.

ESG targets Targets towards 2040

100% (93%)

100% (87%)

(reduction of 1%)

(reduction of 15%)

(increase of 3%)

ESG targets towards 2025 (actual performance 2024)

Business ethics Employees (in scope) trained in the Maersk Code of Conduct

Data and AI ethics Employees (in scope) trained on data ethics

Sustainable procurement Suppliers (in scope) committed to the Supplier Code of Conduct 100% (94%)

Safety & security Learning Teams completed following a high potential incident 100% (99%)

30%

40% (35%)

(21%)

Diversity, Equity & Inclusion Diverse nationality of executives

Women in management

Human capital Employee Engagement Survey (EES) percentile rank on global norms

75% (65th percentile)

ESG targets towards 2030

Climate change

35% Absolute reduction in total scope 1 emissions

100% Absolute reduction in total scope 2 emissions

22% Absolute reduction in total scope 3 emissions

Climate change 96% Absolute reduction in total scope 1 and 2 emissions

scope 3 emissions

ESG targets towards 2040

90% Absolute reduction in total

29

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Ocean profitability improved compared to 2023, mainly as a result of increased freight rates by 17%, primarily driven by the pressure on capacity due to the Red Sea situation. Volumes also increased by 3.6% throughout the year, following the increase in demand, overall culminating in EBIT increasing by USD 2.5bn.

Ocean Logistics & Services Terminals

USDm 14,920 EBIT USDm 538 Revenue

Logistics & Services showed a recovery from the previous transitional year, with volume growth across most products, diligent asset optimisation and steady cost management, resulting in an upward trending EBIT.

GO TO OCEAN GO TO LOGISTICS & SERVICES GO TO TERMINALS

Terminals delivered a ROIC of 13.5% with revenue growth in the Americas pushing EBITDA and EBIT to new heights. The combination of inflation-offsetting tariff increases, higher storage and the efficiency gains from higher utilisation helped improve the EBITDA margin by 2.7 percentage points.

30

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Ocean

Ocean profitability improved compared to 2023, driven by the substantial increase in freight rates, due to the capacity pressure associated with the Red Sea situation. The strong result was supported by solid volume growth. However, the Red Sea situation resulted in elevated operational costs, particularly due to higher bunker consumption and container handling costs. Throughout the year, Ocean remained focused on designing the network of the future, which was proudly launched on 1 February 2025.

Revenue increased, directly impacted by the higher freight rates of 17%, coupled by a volume increase of 3.6%. Unit cost at fixed bunker increased by 1.7%, due to the higher costs associated with the Red Sea situation partly offset by higher volume delivery.

Utilisation was 96% and improved by 4.1 percentage points compared to 2023 (92%), following the structural capacity efforts. Schedule reliability was lower as it was heavily impacted by the Red Sea situation; however, it improved since the beginning of 2024, highlighting the targeted customer outcome efforts throughout the year.

Line of business

At the heart of the integrator strategy, Ocean ensures that goods keep moving across the world, providing customers with a unique offering, combining flexibility and stability to manage and simplify their end-toend supply chains.

While providing access to a competitive global network, Ocean offers resilient solutions and differentiated value propositions through its global network and digital products to fit the diverging customer needs and enhance long-term partnerships. Operating one of the largest container vessel fleets in the world, Ocean carries more than 12m FFE per annum serving over 500 ports worldwide.

Ocean highlights USD million
2024 2023
Freight revenue 32,684 28,421
Other revenue, including hubs 4,704 5,232
Revenue 37,388 33,653
Container handling costs 9,744 9,233
Bunker costs 7,067 6,064
Network costs, excluding bunker costs 6,811 6,917
Selling, General & Administration (SG&A) costs 2,626 2,921
Cost of goods sold and other operational costs 1,954 1,646
Total operating costs 28,202 26,781
Other income/costs, net - 68
Profit before depreciation, amortisation and
impairment losses, etc. (EBITDA)
9,186 6,940
EBITDA margin 24.6% 20.6%
Profit before financial items (EBIT) 4,743 2,227
EBIT margin 12.7% 6.6%
Invested capital 30,864 29,851
CAPEX 2,708 1,987
Operational and financial metrics
Loaded volumes (FFE in '000) 12,338 11,904
Loaded freight rate (USD per FFE) 2,698 2,313
Unit cost, fixed bunker
(USD per FFE incl. VSA income)
2,412 2,371
Bunker price, average (USD per tonne) 613 616
Bunker consumption (tonne in '000) 11,262 9,838
Average operated fleet capacity (TEU in '000) 4,307 4,162
Fleet owned (end of year) 308 310
Fleet chartered (end of year) 399 362

Decarbonisation focus

  • Network and asset efficiency
  • Shift to lower emission fuels
  • For more details, see climate change in the sustainability statement, pages 78-100.

Ocean

12.6

FFE ('000) 2024 2023 Change Change % East-West 5,610 5,510 100 1.8 North-South 4,034 3,900 134 3.4 Intra-regional 2,694 2,494 200 8.0 Total 12,338 11,904 434 3.6 2020

2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 0

USD/FFE 2024 2023 Change Change % East-West 2,956 2,221 735 33.1 North-South 3,321 3,064 257 8.4 Intra-regional 1,511 1,626 -115 -7.1 Total 2,698 2,313 385 16.7

The increase of 1.7% was driven by the higher cost associated with the Red Sea situation, slightly offset

2024 2023 2022 2021 2020
2,412 2,371 2,533 2,186 2,055

USDbn

USD/FFE

28.2bn

(USD 26.8bn)

Higher bunker consumption by 14% and higher container handling costs by 5.5% were attributable to the re-routing south of the Cape of Good Hope. Network cost excluding bunker decreased by 1.5%, mainly due to the lower port and canal cost associated with fewer Suez Canal crossings offsetting the increased transhipment, time charter equivalent and slot charter costs. SG&A decreased by 10% reflecting the continuous efforts to streamline the organisation.

32

Ocean

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

(USD 6.1bn)

USD

Bunker cost increased by 17% following the increase of bunker consumption by 14% due to the re-routing south of the Cape of Good Hope, while the average bunker price decreased mar ginally by 0.5% to 613 USD/tonne (616 USD/ tonne). Bunker cost was further affected by the introduction of the EU Emissions Trading System (ETS) in January 2024. Excluding the ETS effect (USD 161m), bunker cost increased by 14%. Bunker efficiency increased by 5.6% to 37.3 g/TEU*NM (39.5 g/ TEU*NM).

7.1bn 707 Vessels (year-end) 4,307k TEU (average)

The average operated capacity of 4,307k TEU (4,162k TEU) increased by 3.5%. The newbuilding programme order book for vessels capable of running on green fuels at the end of 2024 was 37. At the end of the year, the fleet consisted of 308 owned and 399 chartered vessels, of which 138k TEU or 3.2% of the fleet were idle (20 vessels), mainly due to repairs.

Fleet capacity, year-end

2024 2023 2024 2023
TEU
'000
TEU
'000
Vessels Vessels
Own
container vessels
0-4,699 458 476 135 141
4,700-7,999 277 277 45 45
8,000-14,999 678 707 71 74
> 15,000 1,027 903 57 50
Total 2,440 2,363 308 310
Chartered
container vessels
0-4,699 731 644 267 237
4,700-7,999 365 332 61 55
8,000-14,999 666 654 62 62
> 15,000 139 124 9 8
Total 1,901 1,754 399 362

Ocean highlights

In 2024, supply chains were impacted by the Red Sea situation and the subsequent re-routing south of the Cape of Good Hope. The re-routing led to higher operational costs, supply chain pressure, and thus higher freight rates. Throughout, Ocean continued its efforts in decarbonising, renewing its fleet and on designing the network of the future.

Network of the future

During Q1 2024, A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) and Hapag - Lloyd AG announced a long-term, operational collaboration, the Gemini Cooperation starting in February 2025 focus ing on East-West trades. The collaboration aims to establish a more predictable and efficient shipping experience, with a fast response to disruptions and demand changes. By reducing port calls on mainliners, enhancing shuttle services and leveraging state-of-the-art hubs, the ambition of Gemini is to generate industry leading reliability, above 90% for services under the Gemini scope of trades, once fully phased in.

Fleet renewal plan

In continuation of its fleet renewal programme initiated in 2021, Maersk announced the placement of orders and chartered contracts of 800k TEU of dual-fuel vessels until 2030. The new vessels will serve as replacements rather than adding capacity and will contribute to Ocean's decar bonisation agenda.

Ongoing emphasis on cost discipline

Ocean remains focused on cost containment with many cost initiatives being implemented across the organisation to reduce costs and increase efficiencies, while maintaining the focus on customer outcome.

33

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Logistics & Services

Logistics & Services has continued to solidify its ambition to be a reliable end-to-end logistics partner. Despite a setback in the first quarter, Logistics & Services demonstrated resilience in 2024 as momentum was built steadily each quarter, culminating in volume growth and improved revenue and EBIT margin compared to the previous year.

As 2024 advanced, the industry witnessed a phase of stabilisation, ultimately leading to full-year performance exceeding the previous year's. Throughout the year, Logistics & Services took proactive steps to reinforce profitable growth, including boosting asset utilisation in Warehousing, resolving implementation issues in Ground Freight in North America and route optimising in Air.

Additional efforts were directed towards ensuring customer satisfaction and expanding market presence, including the inauguration of A.P. Moller - Maersk's (Maersk) largest logistics park in the Middle East, the addition of two Boeing 777F aircraft as well as opening Maersk's first warehouse in France.

Truly integrating logistics solutions

Logistics & Services is a core growth element of the integrator strategy, fulfilling customer needs at every step of their supply chain through integrated logistics offerings enabled by digital platforms.

Managed by Maersk offers Customs brokerage services, Lead Logistics, Cold Chain Logistics and Project Logistics.

Fulfilled by Maersk offers Warehousing (consolidation, deconsolidation and fulfilment), Cold Storage, Ground Freight, Depot operations and e-commerce logistics solutions.

Transported by Maersk offers Landside Transportation, Air, Less than Container Load (LCL) and Cargo Risk Management products.

Logistics & Services highlights USD million

2024 2023
Revenue 14,920 13,916
Direct costs (third-party costs) 10,385 9,694
Gross profit 4,535 4,222
Direct operating expenses1 2,258 2,064
Selling, General & Administration (SG&A) costs1 830 907
Profit before depreciation, amortisation and
impairment losses, etc. (EBITDA)
1,447 1,251
EBITDA margin 9.7% 9.0%
Profit before financial items (EBIT) 538 446
EBIT margin 3.6% 3.2%
Invested capital 11,631 10,779
CAPEX 803 771
Operational and financial metrics
Managed by Maersk revenue1 2,167 2,182
Fulfilled by Maersk revenue1 5,735 5,238
Transported by Maersk revenue1 7,018 6,496
Supply chain management volumes (cbm in '000) 120,137 102,252
First Mile volumes (FFE in '000)1 6,773 6,092
Air freight volumes (tonne in '000) 327 295

1 2023 comparatives are restated as follows: Direct IT costs were reclassified into Direct operating expenses from SG&A, by Maersk revenue split to reflect changes within the Logistics & Services model definition and First Mile volumes (previously called Intermodal) to include volumes from newly integrated businesses.

pages 78-100.

Decarbonisation focus

  • Equipment electrification
  • Site energy efficiency
  • Integration of renewable electricity

Annual Report 2024

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

EBITDA

1.4bn

(USD 1.3bn) EBITDA increased by USD 196m with an EBITDA margin of 9.7% (9.0%), driven by Lead Logistics, Air and First Mile.

Revenue USDbn Gross profit USDbn
14.9
bn
4.5 bn
(USD 13.9bn) (USD 4.2bn)
Revenue increased by 7.2% or USD 1.0bn, alongside volume
growth across products.
2024
14.9
Increased by USD 313m, mainly from Ware
housing, Air and Lead Logistics. Gross profit
margin was steady at 30.4% (30.3%).
2023
2022
13.9
14.4
2021
2020
9.8
7.0
EBIT USDm
Managed by Maersk's revenue decreased by 0.7% to
USD 2.1bn (USD 2.2bn), despite higher volumes. Supply
Chain Management volumes in Lead Logistics increased
to 120,137k cbm (102,252k cbm), driven by favourable
market conditions. Customs services volumes increased
by 19% to 6,781k declarations (5,684k declarations).
Fulfilled by Maersk's revenue was up by 9.5% to USD
5.7bn (USD 5.2bn) due to solid growth in Warehousing.
Transported by Maersk's revenue was up by 8.0% to
USD 7.0bn (USD 6.5bn), driven by Air and First Mile. Air
volumes grew by 11% at 327k tonnes across most regions,
supported by capacity sales to third parties. First Mile
volumes rose by 11% to 6,773k FFE (6,092k FFE).
538
(USD 446m)
EBIT increased by USD 92m.
EBIT margin increased to 3.6% (3.2%) .
800
600
400
200
0
2020
2021
2022
m
16%
12%
8%
4%
0%
2023
2024
Managed by Maersk's margins increased,
mainly from Lead Logistics.

USDbn Fulfilled by Maersk's margins decreased, partly due to Warehousing ramp-up costs and operational challenges in Ground Freight.

Transported by Maersk's margins increased, driven by Air due to cost opti misation and improved customer mix.

Logistics & Services highlights

By continuously transforming its end-to-end logistics solutions, Logistics & Services is committed to becoming more optimised and to provide greater flexibility to our customers at every stage of their supply chain.

Managed by Maersk

Volumes increased across most products, fostering efficiency and enhancing performance, resulting in revenue increases in Project Logistics due to geographical expansion and customer growth, particularly for renewables and energystorage customers. Lead Logistics also improved the EBIT margin while helping to grow customers' businesses by offering self-service logistics execution solutions to strategic supply chain partnerships.

Fulfilled by Maersk

Strategic measures in Ground Freight aim to improve customer implementation and asset utilisation in North America, including a new end-to-end integrated e-com merce solution for parcels from Europe to the US with sorting, labelling, scanning, air transport, customs clear ance and final mile delivery to consumers across the United States. Additionally, Fulfilled by Maersk is taking further actions to improve utilisation in Warehousing.

Transported by Maersk

Volume growth in Air was bolstered by the addition of two Boeing 777Fs. These modern aircraft are crucial for sus tainable aviation, enabling the integration of sustainable aviation fuels derived from waste biomass, reducing carbon emissions. The Less than Container Load (LCL) value proposi tion continued to strengthen as volumes and rates increased and the LCL network expanded with over 795 own direct consolidation lanes (600 lanes).

35

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Terminals

Terminals delivered its best-ever financial results in 2024 with EBITDA and EBIT reaching record highs. This was driven by significant top line growth based on strong volume and a significant increase in revenue per move. Inflation-offsetting tariff increases and congestion-related storage in the Americas were key contributors and led to a significant margin expansion with a record high EBIT of USD 1.3bn and a ROIC LTM of 13.5%.

Margins improved steadily each quarter year-over-year with the EBITDA margin reaching 35.9% in 2024. Volume adjusted for exits increased by 8.2%, mainly driven by North America. Utilisation increased by 5.2 percentage points to 78%, with the additional capacity added during the year absorbing some of the volume increase. Revenue per move increased by 7.4%, driven by higher tariffs, better product and customer mix and an increase in congestion-related storage revenue. Cost per move increased below inflation at 2.4% as adverse product mix and labour inflation was offset by improved utilisation and efficiency. The yard modernisation in Los Angeles, USA, was completed, and the quay side will be completed in early 2025. Expansion projects in Lazaro Cardenas, Mexico, Callao, Peru, and Pipavav, India, are continuing. The construction of new terminals in Rijeka, Croatia, and Suape, Brazil, are ongoing and are expected to be operational in 2025 and 2026, respectively.

54 gateway terminals across 29 countries

The terminals are operated either exclusively by Terminals under the APM Terminals brand or together with a joint venture partner. The performance of seven hub terminals also operated by Terminals is reported under the Ocean segment.

Terminals is uniquely positioned to help both shipping line and landside customers, with ~75%/25% of revenue, respectively, to grow their business and achieve better supply chain efficiency, flexibility and dependability.

Terminals highlights USD million
2024 2023
Revenue 4,465 3,844
Concession fees 347 308
Labour cost (blue collar) 1,290 1,121
Other operational costs 658 618
Selling, General & Administration (SG&A)
and other costs, etc.
569 519
Total operating costs 2,864 2,566
Profit before depreciation, amortisation and
impairment losses, etc. (EBITDA)
1,601 1,278
EBITDA margin 35.9% 33.2%
Profit before financial items (EBIT) 1,329 980
EBIT margin 29.8% 25.5%
Invested capital 7,930 7,813
CAPEX 580 541
Operational and financial metrics
Terminal volumes
– financially consolidated (moves in '000)
13,095 12,204
Ocean segment 4,200 4,245
External customers 8,895 7,959
Terminal revenue per move
– financially consolidated (USD)
337 313
Terminal cost per move
– financially consolidated (USD)
258 252
Result from joint ventures and associated
companies (USDm)
327 282

Decarbonisation focus

  • Equipment electrification
  • Integration of renewable electricity
  • For more details, see climate change in the sustainability statement, pages 78-100.

Revenue

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

4.5bn

USDbn

Revenue increased by USD 621m, driven by high volume in North America, combined with inflation-offsetting tariff increases, a positive customer and product mix and higher storage revenue from localised congestion. Overall, revenue increased by 16% compared to 2023.

Volume improved in all quarters year-over-year and ended 7.3% above 2023. Adjusted for exits (Mauritania and Castellon, Spain), volume increased by 8.2%. The main contributors were Los Angeles, USA, Mumbai, India, Port Elizabeth, USA, and Barcelona, Spain, offsetting lower volume in Pipavav, India, Buenos Aires, Argentina, and Aqaba, Jordan. Volume from Ocean decreased by 1.1% (increased by 0.3% like-for-like) and volume from external customers increased by 12% (12% like-for-like). Utilisation increased to 78% (73%) with the increase in volume being partially offset by an increase in capacity from the ongoing terminal modernisation programme in North America.

Revenue per move increased by 7.4% to USD 337 (USD 313), driven by inflation-offsetting tariff increases, a positive customer and product mix and higher congestion-related storage revenue, partly offset by negative rate of exchange impacts. Cost per move increased by 2.4% to USD 258 (USD 252), due to investment-driven depreciation and customer and product mix, partially offset by the impact of higher utilisation and a positive rate of exchange impact.

Adjusted for foreign exchange rates, volume mix and portfolio changes, revenue per move increased by 11% and cost per move increased by 2.6%.

2024 4.5
2023 3.8
2022 4.4
2021 4.0
2020 3.2

1.6bn

EBITDA

  • EBITDA increased by USD 323m, due to higher utilisation and a significant increase in revenue per move which outgrew cost per move by 5 percentage points.
  • The EBITDA margin improved by 2.7 percentage points to 35.9% (33.2%).

EBIT USDm
1.3
bn
(USD 980m)

EBIT increased by USD 349m, driven by the significantly higher EBITDA and higher results from joint ventures and associated companies. EBIT margin improved by 4.3 percentage points to 29.8% (25.5%).

2024 2023 2022 2021 2020
1,329 980 832 1,173 687

Results from joint ventures and associated companies 327m USDm 38% Labour costs (blue collar) 17% Selling, general and administration (SG&A) and other costs, etc. Other operational

(USD 282m)

The share of profit in joint ventures and associated companies improved by 16%, mainly driven by strong volume in Brazil and West Africa.

37

In North America, volume increased by 20%, driven by significant growth in Los Angeles and Port Elizabeth, USA, as well as growth across all terminals. Utilisation increased by 6.4 percentage points to 77% (70%) as the increase in volume was partly offset by an increase in capacity.

In Latin America, volume increased by 2.1%, driven by Pecem, Brazil, and Buenaventura, Colombia, partly offset by weaker volume in Buenos Aires, Argentina. Utilisation increased by 9.1 percentage points to 83% (74%), due to a reduction in capacity.

In Europe, volume increased by 2.3% due to strong volume in Barcelona, Spain, and Vado, Italy, offsetting the impact of the divestment of Castellón, Spain. Adjusted for the exit, volume increased by 3.9% and utilisation increased by 1.5 percentage points to 73% (72%).

In Africa, volume decreased by 9.5%, due to the divestment of two terminals in Mauritania and lower volume in Onne, Nigeria, and San-Pedro, Côte d'Ivoire. Adjusted for the exits, volume decreased by 2.4%.

Regional volume

Total 13,095 12,204 7.3%
Asia 3,576 3,321 7.7%
Africa 721 796 -9.5%
Europe 2,784 2,722 2.3%
Latin America 2,396 2,346 2.1%
North America 3,618 3,019 19.8%
Moves ('000) 2024 2023 Growth (%)

Utilisation increased by 3.5 percentage points to 64% (61%) as the reduced capacity from exits more than offset the decrease in volume.

In Asia, volume increased by 7.7%, driven by Mumbai, India, where one berth was closed in 2023 due to construction, partly offsetting the negative impact that the Red Sea situation had in Aqaba, Jordan, and Pipavav, India. Utilisation increased by 4.7 percentage points to 83% (79%).

Volumes Terminals highlights

In addition to modernising and increasing capacity at existing facilities, Terminals is engaged in the development of three new terminals. This strategy, along with enhanced sustainability measures and portfolio optimisation, positions the company well for future growth.

Growth & Modernisation

The facility acquisition in Suape, Brazil, was completed and the construction of a fully electrified terminal with state-of-theart technology ensuring high efficiency and safety is taking place, with go-live planned for 2026. The Rijeka, Croatia, terminal is progressing with go-live in 2025. The US terminal modernisation programme is also progressing well with Los Angeles and Elizabeth nearing completion, already boosting capacity in 2024, while the phase 4 Mobile expansion is ramping up.

Portfolio optimisation

Terminals secured a 15-year extension of its Aqaba, Jordan, concession, following approval by the Amman cabinet in September 2024. Consequently, the concession period now extends until 2046. The portfolio has been further optimised as the terminal increased its ownership stake in APM Terminals Monrovia, Liberia, to 100% through a share swap, while divesting its holdings in the terminal in Conakry, Guinea.

Sustainability

The construction of Rijeka Gateway in Croatia has secured electricity supply from renewable energy sources, reducing CO2 and other greenhouse gas emissions. It is set to become the most advanced terminal in the Adriatic region, with most of the equipment being electrified and remotely operated. The Mumbai, India, terminal has signed a memorandum of understanding to pilot new technology with port authorities, aiming to reduce carbon emissions from vessels during their port stay.

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Quarterly summary

2024 2023
Income statement Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1 Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1
Revenue 14,594 15,762 12,771 12,355 11,741 12,129 12,988 14,207
Profit before depreciation,
amortisation and impairment
losses, etc. (EBITDA)
3,597 4,797 2,144 1,590 839 1,878 2,905 3,969
Depreciation, amortisation and
impairment losses, net
1,651 1,570 1,481 1,518 1,580 1,584 1,571 1,880
Gain on sale of non-current
assets, etc., net
-9 16 208 7 84 136 163 140
Share of profit/loss in joint ventures
and associated companies
113 66 92 98 120 108 110 97
Profit/loss before financial items
(EBIT)
Financial items, net
2,050
204
3,309
-51
963
13
177
151
-537
101
538
153
1,607
-16
2,326
190
Profit/loss before tax
Tax
2,254
144
3,258
177
976
143
328
120
-436
20
691
137
1,591
104
2,516
193
Profit/loss for the period
A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' share
2,110
2,085
3,081
3,049
833
798
208
177
-456
-436
554
521
1,487
1,453
2,323
2,284
Underlying profit/loss1 2,165 3,097 623 210 -442 489 1,346 2,561
Balance sheet
Total assets
Total equity
Invested capital
Net interest-bearing debt
87,697
57,947
50,564
-7,373
84,942
56,497
50,846
-5,634
80,745
53,126
49,563
-3,563
81,598
53,373
50,430
-3,092
82,5782 83,459
55,090
50,430
-4,658
55,973
49,080
-6,844
83,500
56,427
49,343
-7,090
85,490
55,833
50,322
-7,002
Cash flow statement
Profit/loss before financial items
Non-cash items, etc.
Change in working capital
Cash flow from operating activities
before tax
Taxes paid
2,050
1,725
837
4,612
-197
3,309
1,535
-414
4,430
-158
963
1,112
-260
1,815
-189
177
1,506
-474
1,209
-114
-537
1,370
-513
320
-154
538
1,437
-435
1,540
-155
1,607
1,240
145
2,992
-234
2,326
1,926
1,220
5,472
-138
Cash flow from operating activities 4,415 4,272 1,626 1,095 166 1,385 2,758 5,334
2024 2023
Cash flow statement, continued Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1 Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1
CAPEX -1,650 -941 -904 -706 -1,251 -819 -738 -838
Cash flow from investing activities -3,037 -4,964 -605 681 536 -2,909 -631 7,081
Repayments of lease liabilities -784 -776 -742 -749 -763 -816 -822 -825
Cash flow from financing activities -1,043 -1,031 -368 -1,058 -1,545 -1,200 -3,334 -10,726
Free cash flow 2,163 2,705 397 -151 -1,714 -124 1,581 4,224
Financial ratios
Revenue growth 24.3% 30.0% -1.7% -13.0% -34.1% -46.7% -40.0% -26.4%
EBITDA margin 24.6% 30.4% 16.8% 12.9% 7.1% 15.5% 22.4% 27.9%
EBIT margin 14.0% 21.0% 7.5% 1.4% -4.6% 4.4% 12.4% 16.4%
Cash conversion 123% 89% 76% 69% 20% 74% 95% 134%
Return on invested capital after tax
(ROIC) (last 12 months)
12.3% 7.4% 2.0% 3.2% 7.4% 17.7% 34.3% 49.1%
Equity ratio 66.1% 66.5% 65.8% 65.4% 67.1% 67.1% 67.6% 65.3%
Underlying ROIC1 (last 12 months) 12.0% 7.0% 1.5% 2.8% 7.5% 17.5% 34.1% 49.0%
Underlying EBITDA1 3,595 4,798 2,143 1,597 911 1,907 2,916 4,037
Underlying EBITDA margin1 24.6% 30.4% 16.8% 12.9% 7.8% 15.7% 22.5% 28.4%
Underlying EBIT1 2,104 3,322 756 174 -520 450 1,469 2,563
Underlying EBIT margin1 14.4% 21.1% 5.9% 1.4% -4.4% 3.7% 11.3% 18.0%
Stock market ratios
Earnings per share, USD 133 193 51 11 -27 31 85 131
Diluted earnings per share, USD 132 193 51 11 -27 31 85 131
Cash flow from operating
activities per share, USD
280 271 103 69 16 87 163 306
Share price (B share),
end of period, DKK
11,905 11,260 12,105 8,994 12,140 12,735 11,975 12,445
Share price (B share),
end of period, USD
1,668 1,691 1,736 1,305 1,800 1,809 1,745 1,816
Total market capitalisation,
end of period, USD
25,698 26,027 26,992 20,349 28,541 29,490 29,273 30,957

For definition of terms, see page 203.

1 Underlying items are computed as the relevant performance measure adjusted for the net gains/losses from the sale of non-current assets, etc. and net impairment losses as well as transaction, restructuring and integration costs related to major transactions. The adjustments include A.P. Moller - Maersk's share of mentioned items in joint ventures and associated companies and, when applicable, the adjustments are net of tax. 2 Restated in 2024. Refer to note 1.1 general accounting policies of the consolidated financial statements for details.

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Q4 2024 results

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) continued to deliver robust results in the fourth quarter. Supported by strong market demand and better-than-expected freight rates, Ocean profitability increased significantly year-over-year, although revenue decreased sequentially following a normalisation in freight rates. Logistics & Services tracked positively and generated volume and revenue growth, while Terminals closed the year with a record-strong fourth quarter.

In Ocean, results were positively impacted by the continued high freight rates supported with stable volumes. While freight rates reached a peak in Q3, the Red Sea situation continued and market demand remained solid into the fourth quarter. A strong top line, combined with effective cost controls and strong asset utilisation, returned an EBIT of USD 1.6bn and an EBIT margin of 16.2%.

Logistics & Services demonstrated volume growth across most products, with significant improvement in results compared to the prior year. Progress was made in improving operational performance, with an EBIT of USD 158m and an EBIT margin of 4.1%.

Terminals delivered its highest-ever quarterly revenue and another strong quarter of profitability, driven by a significant increase in revenue per move, coupled with higher storage revenue and volume increases, with an EBIT of USD 338m and an EBIT margin of 28.3%.

Highlights Q4 USD million
Revenue EBITDA EBIT CAPEX
2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023
Ocean 9,902 7,180 2,821 196 1,600 -920 1,244 692
Logistics & Services 3,891 3,542 402 285 158 60 232 224
Terminals 1,194 1,019 421 303 338 234 158 220
Unallocated activities, eliminations, etc. -393 - -47 55 -46 89 16 115
A.P. Moller - Maersk consolidated 14,594 11,741 3,597 839 2,050 -537 1,650 1,251

Financial review Q4 2024

Ocean, USDbn

Revenue for Q4 increased by USD 2.9bn to USD 14.6bn (USD 11.7bn), led by a USD 2.7bn increase in Ocean, as well as increases of USD 349m and USD 175m in Logistics & Services and Terminals, respectively.

Ocean, USDbn (Q4 2023: 7.2bn) 9.9 Logistics & Services, USDbn (Q4 2023: 3.5bn) 3.9 Terminals, USDbn (Q4 2023: 1.0bn) 1.2

EBITDA increased to USD 3.6bn (USD 839m) due to higher revenue, with an increase in Ocean of USD 2.6bn due to higher freight rates, partly offset by higher operating costs due to the continued re-routing around the Cape of Good Hope, as well as an increase in Logistics & Services by USD 117m and in Terminals by USD 118m.

(Q4 2023: 285m) 402 Terminals, USDm

(Q4 2023: 303m) 421

EBIT increased to USD 2.1bn (negative USD 537m), with an EBIT margin of 14.0% (negative 4.6%), driven by all segments from the increased revenue, specifically in Ocean. In Logistics & Services, the EBIT margin of 4.1% (1.7%) was positively impacted by Air, First Mile and Customs. In Terminals, EBIT increased by USD 104m

Ocean, USDbn 1.6 Logistics & Services, USDm 158 Terminals, USDm 338
(Q4 2023: -920m) (Q4 2023: 60m) (Q4 2023: 234m)

Financial items, net, was a gain of USD 204m (gain of USD 101m), mainly impacted by the positive foreign exchange rate impact on working capital and continued interest income.

Tax increased to USD 144m (USD 20m), primarily due to higher profit before tax.

(Q4 2023: 196m) 2.8 Logistics & Services, USDm

from higher storage revenue and volumes.

The underlying profit of USD 2.2bn (negative USD 442m) was adjusted for impairment losses, net of USD 47m.

Cash flow from operating activities of USD 4.4bn (USD 166m) was driven by EBITDA of USD 3.6bn and a positive change in net working capital of USD 837m, translating into a cash conversion of 123% (20%).

Gross capital expenditure (CAPEX) of USD 1.7bn (USD 1.3bn) was primarily driven by higher investments in Ocean.

Free cash flow was USD 2.2bn (negative USD 1.7bn), mainly due to increased cash flow from operating activities by USD 4.4bn, slightly offset by higher capital expenditures by USD 399m.

For equity, capital structure, net interest-bearing debt, liquidity reserve and dividend, see page 27.

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Ocean

Q4

Ocean increased profitability with an EBIT of USD 1.6bn (negative USD 920m), driven by increased freight rates by 38%, linked to the continuing Red Sea situation, supported by the higher volume of 0.8%. Profitability was lower compared to Q3 2024, mainly due to the freight rate decline following the peak reached in Q3. Operating costs remained consistent with Q4 2023 as the higher costs associated with the re-routing south of the Cape of Good Hope were mainly offset by the lower average bunker price and fewer Suez Canal crossings.

Ocean highlights USD million
Q4 2024 Q4 2023
Freight revenue 8,756 5,889
Other revenue, including hubs 1,146 1,291
Revenue 9,902 7,180
Container handling costs 2,435 2,353
Bunker costs 1,637 1,647
Network costs, excluding bunker costs 1,758 1,737
Selling, General & Administration (SG&A) costs 697 686
Cost of goods sold and other operational costs 535 633
Total operating costs 7,062 7,056
Other income/costs, net -19 72
EBITDA 2,821 196
EBITDA margin 28.5% 2.7%
Profit before financial items (EBIT) 1,600 -920
EBIT margin 16.2% -12.8%
Invested capital 30,864 29,851
CAPEX 1,244 692
Operational and financial metrics
Loaded volumes (FFE in '000) 3,134 3,108
Loaded freight rate (USD per FFE) 2,659 1,925
Unit cost, fixed bunker (USD per FFE incl. VSA income) 2,431 2,280
Bunker price, average (USD per tonne) 576 655
Bunker consumption (tonne in '000) 2,784 2,513
Average operated fleet capacity (TEU in '000) 4,395 4,131

Revenue

volume increase of 0.8%.

9.9bn

(USD 7.2bn)

Revenue increased by USD 2.7bn to USD 9.9bn (USD 7.2bn), driven by the higher freight revenue of 49% attributed to the increased freight rates by 38%, mainly due to the Red Sea situation, supported by the

2.8bn

(USD 196m)

EBITDA increased by USD 2.6bn to USD 2.8bn (USD 196m), driven by the higher revenue following the increased freight rates. EBIT increased by USD 2.5bn to USD 1.6bn (negative USD 920m). The EBITDA margin increased by 25.8 percentage points to 28.5% (2.7%). The EBIT margin increased by 29.0 percentage points to 16.2% (negative 12.8%).

EBITDA

Q4 2023

5.0 4.0 USDbn

Q4 2024

80% 100%

Q3 2024

Q2 2024

0 0%

3.0 60%

2.0 40% 1.0 20%

Q1 2024

Average loaded freight rate

The average loaded freight rate increased by 38% to 2,659 USD/FFE (1,925 USD/FFE) across all trades. The average freight rate experienced a decrease of 18% from its peak level in Q3 2024 (3,236 USD/FFE).

USD/FFE Q4 2024 Q4 2023 Change Change %
East-West 2,755 1,818 937 51.5%
North-South 3,475 2,702 773 28.6%
Intra-regional 1,586 1,405 181 12.9%
Total 2,659 1,925 734 38.1%

Loaded volumes

Loaded volumes increased by 0.8% to 3,134k FFE (3,108k FFE), driven by the stronger demand in Asia-Europe, Intra-Asia, Latin America and Oceania trades. The increase was partly offset by lower volume in India-Middle East, North America and Africa trades.

FFE ('000) Q4 2024 Q4 2023 Change Change %
East-West 1,417 1,462 -45 -3.1%
North-South 1,032 1,001 31 3.1%
Intra-regional 685 645 40 6.2%
Total 3,134 3,108 26 0.8%

Unit cost USD/FFE

2,431 (2,280 USD/FFE)

Unit cost at fixed bunker increased by 6.6% to 2,431 USD/FFE (2,280 USD/ FFE), driven by the higher cost at fixed bunker associated with the Red Sea situation, slightly offset by the higher volumes of 0.8%.

Total operating costs remained stable at USD 7.1bn (USD 7.1bn) as higher costs attributed to re-routing south of the Cape of Good Hope were mostly offset by the lower port and canal costs linked to fewer Suez Canal crossings and the decreased bunker price by 12%.

k FFE

Bunker costs USDbn

USD/FFE

(USD 1.6bn)

Bunker costs decreased marginally by 0.6%. The vessel re-routing south of the Cape of Good Hope led to an increased bunker consumption of 11%, the effect of which was offset by the lower average bunker price of 12% at 576 USD/tonne (655 USD/tonne). Costs relating to the EU Emissions Trading System amounted to USD 34m. Bunker efficiency increased by 8.4% to 35.8 g/TEU*NM (39.1 g/ TEU*NM).

41

Q4

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Logistics & Services

The Logistics & Services segment ended the last quarter of 2024 with a year-over-year revenue growth of 9.9%, and the EBIT margin increased by 2.4 percentage points to 4.1%, significantly better than last year. The improved financial performance was mainly driven by increased margins for Air and First Mile in Transported by Maersk and, to a lesser extent, offset by lower margins in Fulfilled by Maersk.

Managed by Maersk delivered year-over-year revenue growth for all products. In Fulfilled by Maersk, revenue saw solid year-over-year growth in Warehousing, primarily in North America. Transported by Maersk continued to transcend with solid revenue increases across all products.

Logistics & Services highlights USD million
Q4 2024 Q4 2023
Revenue 3,891 3,542
Direct costs (third-party costs) 2,665 2,492
Gross profit 1,226 1,050
Direct operating expenses1 597 493
Selling, General & Administration (SG&A) costs1 227 272
EBITDA 402 285
EBITDA margin 10.3% 8.0%
Profit before financial items (EBIT) 158 60
EBIT margin 4.1% 1.7%
Invested capital 11,631 10,779
CAPEX 232 224
Operational and financial metrics
Managed by Maersk revenue1 584 485
Fulfilled by Maersk revenue1 1,488 1,387
Transported by Maersk revenue1 1,819 1,670
Supply chain management
volumes (CBM in '000)
29,816 26,114
First Mile volumes (FFE in '000)1 1,670 1,630
Air freight volumes (tonne in '000) 78 85

Revenue USDbn

3.9bn

(USD 3.5bn)

Revenue increased by USD 349m or 9.9%, driven by volume improvements across most products. Revenue was on par with Q3 2024.

Managed by Maersk's revenue increased by 20% or USD 99m to USD 584m (USD 485m), mainly driven by strong performance in Project Logistics due to customer growth and expansion within the Asia Pacific region, however, decreased sequentially by 6.4% as Lead Logistics volumes had been pulled forward into Q3. Supply Chain Management volumes increased by 14% to 29,816k cbm (26,114k cbm) and Customs volumes increased by 18% to 1,734k declarations (1,474k declarations).

Fulfilled by Maersk's revenue increased by 7.3% or USD 101m to USD 1.5bn (USD 1.4bn), primarily driven by Warehousing growth in North America.

Transported by Maersk's revenue increased by 8.9% USD 149m to USD 1.8bn (USD 1.7bn) with solid volume growth in most products as well as rate increases especially in Air and Less than Container Load. Although Air freight volumes decreased by 8.2% to 78k tonnes (85k tonnes) due to an improved customer mix, this was more than offset by direct capacity sales to third parties. First Mile volumes increased by 2.5% to 1,670k FFE (1,630k FFE).

Gross profit USDbn

(USD 1.1bn)

Gross profit increased by USD 176m to USD 1.2bn (USD 1.1bn), driven by Warehousing, Air and First Mile, resulting in a gross profit margin of 31.5% (29.6%). Gross profit remained stable with Q3 2024.

Q4 2024 1.2
Q3 2024 1.2
Q2 2024 1.1
Q1 2024 1.0
Q4 2023 1.1

EBITDA USDm 402m

(USD 285m)

EBITDA increased by USD 117m to USD 402m (USD 285m) but decreased by USD 29m sequentially partly due to volumes that pulled forward into Q3 and operational challenges in Fulfilled by Maersk. EBITDA margin was 10.3% (8.0%).

EBIT USDm 158m (USD 60m)

  • EBIT increased by USD 98m to USD 158m (USD 60m), due to solid performance in First Mile and improved performance in Air, coupled with cost control.
  • The EBIT margin increased to 4.1% (1.7%), however, decreased 1.0 percentage point from Q3 2024, mainly due to a different business mix.

Managed by Maersk's margins increased moderately, mainly driven by Customs.

Fulfilled by Maersk's margins had an overall year-over-year decrease in Q4, mainly driven by operational one-off costs in Last Mile, slightly offset by improved margins in Warehousing.

Transported by Maersk's margins grew with Air and First Mile, mainly driving the increase due to a refocus on customer profitability and unit cost savings from route optimisation and procurement initiatives for Air.

42

1 2023 comparatives have been restated. See footnote 1 on page 34.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Q4

Terminals continued to deliver strong top line-driven results in Q4 2024 with revenue increasing 17% due to a significant increase in revenue per move and strong volume in North America. Volume increased by 6.7% (like-for-like) and utilisation increased to 84% (77%). Revenue per move (like-for-like) increased by 10%, driven by tariff increases, improved product mix and higher storage revenue due to localised congestion. Cost per move (like-for-like) increased by 3.4%, with the impact of inflation and product mix partly offset by the positive impact from higher utilisation. As a result, the EBITDA margin improved 5.5 percentage points to 35.3% (29.7%).

Terminals highlights USD million
Q4 2024 Q4 2023
Revenue 1,194 1,019
Concession fees (excl. capitalised lease expenses) 82 77
Labour costs (blue collar) 343 299
Other operational costs 179 213
Selling, General & Administration (SG&A) and
other costs, etc. 169 127
Total operating costs 773 716
EBITDA 421 303
EBITDA margin 35.3% 29.7%
Profit/loss before financial items (EBIT) 338 234
EBIT margin 28.3% 23.0%
Invested capital 7,930 7,813
CAPEX 158 220
Operational and financial metrics
Volumes – financially consolidated (moves in '000) 3,359 3,168
Ocean segment 1,057 1,090
External customers 2,302 2,078
Revenue per move – financially consolidated (USD) 349 321
Cost per move – financially consolidated (USD) 270 267
Result from joint ventures and associated
companies (USDm)
102 91

Revenue

(USD 1.0bn)

Revenue increased by 17% to USD 1.2bn (USD 1.0bn), driven by inflation-offsetting tariff increases, higher volume and higher storage revenue from localised congestion. Storage per move increased by 11% compared to Q4 2023. Volume increased by 6.0% (6.7% like-for-like excluding exits), driven by strong growth in North America particularly in Los Angeles, USA. Volume from Ocean decreased by 3.1% (1.9% like-for-like) and volume from external customers increased by 11% (11% like-for-like). Utilisation increased by 7 percentage points to 84% (77%).

Revenue per move increased by 9.0% to USD 349 (USD 321), driven by tariff increases, higher storage revenue and favourable terminal mix impact, partially offset by unfavourable foreign exchange rate impact. Cost per move increased by 1.1% to USD 270 (USD 267), driven by inflation and product mix, partially offset by the higher utilisation and positive foreign exchange rate impact.

Mumbai, India, in Q4 2023.

EBITDA USDm

EBIT

421m

(USD 303m)

EBITDA improved by 39% to USD 421m (USD 303m), driven by the strong top line and continued cost focus. EBITDA margin increased to 35.3% (29.7%).

USDm 338m (USD 234m)

EBIT increased by 44% to USD 338m (USD 234m), driven by the higher EBITDA and strong results from joint ventures and associated companies, partially offset by higher depreciation. The EBIT margin improved by 5.3 percentage points to 28.3% (23.0%).

Volumes USDbn

North America volume increased by 15%, driven by significant growth in Los Angeles, USA and Lazaro Cardenas, Mexico. Utilisation increased to 83% (74%). Latin America volume increased by 6.5%, driven by Buenaventura, Colombia, and Quetzal, Guatemala. Utilisation increased to 95% (81%).

Europe volume increased by 2.3% due to significant growth in Barcelona, Spain, partially offset by lower volume in Valencia, Spain, and the divestment of Castellon, Spain. Adjusted for the exit, volume increased by 3.3%. Utilisation increased to 72% (67%).

Africa volume decreased by 3.3% due to divestment of two terminals in Mauritania and lower volume in San Pedro, Ivory Coast. Adjusted for the exits, volume increased by 2.9%. Utilisation increased to 76% (71%).

Asia volume increased by 3.0% driven by Mumbai, India, and Yokohama, Japan, partially offset by lower volume in Pipavav, India. Utilisation increased to 89% (88%).

Regional volume1 Moves ('000)
Q4
2024
Q4
2023
Growth
%
North America 905 789 14.6%
Latin America 642 603 6.5%
Europe 683 667 2.3%
Africa 198 205 -3.3%
Asia 931 904 3.0%
Total 3,359 3,168 6.0%

1 Financially consolidated.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Corporate governance

Jeddah, Saudi Arabia

Renewable electricity for logistics

The Maersk Logistics Park in Jeddah, Saudi Arabia, the Middle East's most expansive integrated logistics park, opened its doors in 2024. The 225,000 m2 greenfield site includes storage and distribution zones, a hub for tranship ment and air freight and an e-commerce fulfilment centre.

The site features a 64,000 m 2 solarpanelled rooftop, which will produce up to 15 MW of power, covering twothirds of the site's energy requirements. Supporting youth and gender diversity in Saudi Logistics, the park pioneered a Female Logistics and Services Academy, empowering women with training, mentorship and career development. 44

Annual Report 2024

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Shareholder information

capital in A.P. Møller - Maersk A/S before the cancellation of shares. Share price performance in 2024 was defined by increasing freight rates driven by the Red Sea situation combined with continued strong volumes. As a result, the share price was subject to volatility from shifting expectations regarding the duration of the Red Sea situation and geopolitical factors, including the risk of worker strikes and potential tariff increases.

The Maersk B share closed 2023 at DKK 12,140, having increased significantly in the last month of the year due to the onset of the Red Sea situation and its impact on global freight rates. In the latter half of the first quarter of 2024, the share price declined, reflecting market reactions to the suspension of the share buy-back programme, the post-dividend and post-Svitzer balance sheets, and a downward trend in freight rates. However, the share price rebounded following an increase in our guidance in the first quarter earnings release in May, as freight rates began to rise again. Further guidance upgrades in June and August, coupled with increasing freight rates, spurred strong share price performance through the mid-year period. Although the share price experienced some volatility in the third quarter due to shifting expectations around the Red Sea situation and US-based macroeconomic impacts, it remained stable overall. The share price then increased throughout the fourth quarter, driven by another guidance upgrade in October and stabilising freight rates. The Maersk B share closed 2024 at DKK 11,905, representing a 1.9% decline for the year. Assuming reinvestment of the dividend paid in March 2024, the total shareholder return for the year was 8%.

The Board of Directors of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S proposes a dividend of DKK 1,120 per share based on a pay-out ratio of 40%, corresponding to a dividend yield of 9.4%.

Total shareholder return

2024 2023 2022 2021 2020
8% 6% -26% 77% 45%

The Maersk B share price decreased by 1.9% to DKK 11,905 from its closing price at the end of 2023 of DKK 12,140. By comparison, the benchmark indices MSCI Europe Transportation and OMXC25 decreased by 11% and 2.4%, respectively. The Maersk B share price reached its highest price of DKK 13,295 on 4 July 2024, and its lowest price of DKK 8,412 on 26 March 2024. The total market value of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S was USD 25.7bn or DKK 183.5bn at the end of 2024.

In 2024, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S distributed ordinary dividends of USD 1.2bn and executed share buy-backs of approximately USD 415m. The demerger and spin-off of Svitzer returned USD 1.1bn to shareholders through a dividend in-kind as per the 1 May 2024 closing price of Svitzer Group A/S. Collectively, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S returned USD 1.6bn to shareholders during 2024 through dividends and share buy-backs, or USD 2.7bn including the value returned through the Svitzer demerger.

Share capital

On 24 May 2024, the cancellation of 350,555 A shares and 1,390,218 B shares was completed, corresponding to 9.91% of the total share

Share information

Ticker Maersk A Maersk B Total
Votes per share 2 0
Nominal value per share, DKK 1,000 1,000
Number of issued shares1 9,756,491 6,072,451 15,828,942
Number of treasury shares1 - 120,307 120,307

1 For details on the number of issued shares and treasury shares as of 31 December 2024 at a nominal value of DKK 1,000, refer to note 4.1 in the consolidated financial statements.

Source: S&P Cap IQ; data rebased from the

Maersk B share price at the end of December 2024.

Share price development Price change, %

Maersk B MSCI Europe Transportation Index OMXC25

45

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Key figures 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020
Year-end share price
(DKK, B share)
11,905 12,140 15,620 23,450 13,595
Market capitalisation at year
end (USDbn, A and B share)
25.7 28.5 39.1 64.1 42.0
Earnings per share (USD) 387 227 1,600 941 145
Dividend per share
(DKK, A and B shares)1
1,120 515 4,300 2,500 330
Dividend yield (B share)1 9.4% 4.2% 27.5% 10.7% 2.4%
Total dividends (USDm)1 2,437 1,169 10,888 7,117 1,092
Share buy-back programme
(DKKbn)2
3.6 21.1 19.8 12.3 5.4
Share buy-back programme
(USDm)2
528 3,070 2,785 1,956 806

1 Based on the proposed dividend for the year.

2 Based on executed share buy-back during the year and including shares bought back for the long-term incentive programme.

Shareholders with > 5% of share capital or votes

Shareholders according to section 55
of the Danish Companies Act
Share
capital
Votes
A.P. Møller Holding A/S, Copenhagen, Denmark 41.5% 51.5%
A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers
Familiefond, Copenhagen, Denmark
9.8% 14.5%
Den A.P. Møllerske Støttefond, Copenhagen, Denmark 4.1% 6.6%

Financial calendar 2025

Annual General Meeting — virtual event 18 March
Interim Report Q1 08 May
Interim Report Q2 07 August
Interim Report Q3 06 November

Ownership

The total number of registered shareholders increased by 2,000 to around 109,000 by the end of 2024. Shareholders with more than 5% of share capital or votes held 55.4% of the share capital, while the 20 largest institutional shareholders together owned around 13.3% of the total share capital and around 30.1% adjusted for the free-float. Retail investor holdings were around 14.2% of the total share capital.

Shareholder return

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' dividend policy stipulates an annual pay-out ratio of 30-50% of the underlying net result adjusted for gains, impairments and restructurings. For 2024, the Board of Directors proposes a dividend to shareholders of DKK 1,120 per share of DKK 1,000, which represents a dividend yield of 9.4% and 40% of the underlying net profit. Payment is expected to take place on 21 March 2025.

Of the share buy-back programme which targeted around USD 12bn over the years 2022-2025, Maersk bought back a total of USD 6.7bn worth of shares. The share buy-back programme was suspended on 7 February 2024, with a re-initiation to be reviewed once market conditions in Ocean are settled.

The Board of Directors has decided to initiate a share buy-back programme of up to DKK 14.4bn (around USD 2bn), to be executed over a period of 12 months, with the first phase of DKK 7.2bn (around USD 1bn) to run from 7 February up to 6 August 2025.

The share buy-back programme is carried out with the purpose of adjusting the capital structure of Maersk. Shares which are not used for hedging purposes for the long-term incentive programmes are proposed to be cancelled at the Annual General Meeting. The Annual General Meeting has authorised the Board of Directors to allow the company to acquire treasury shares to the extent that the nominal value of the company's total holding of treasury shares at no time exceeds 15% of the company's share capital at the market price applicable at the time of acquisition with a deviation of up to 10%.

Terms for the first phase: No shares may be bought back at a price exceeding the higher of i) the share price of the latest independent trade and ii) the highest current independent offer price on the trading venue where the purchase is carried out. The maximum number of A and B shares that may be purchased on each trading day may not exceed 22.50% of the average daily trading volume

of A and B shares, respectively, on Nasdaq Copenhagen, on which the purchase is carried out, over the last 20 trading days prior to the date of purchase. A and B shares will be acquired in a 15/85 split reflecting the current trading volumes of the two share classes. The company will fulfil its reporting obligations by announcing no later than every seventh trading day the purchases made under the share buy-back programme.

Capital allocation

The capital allocation strategy ensures that Maersk has sufficient financial flexibility to meet the strategic growth objectives while maximising return to Maersk's shareholders. The hierarchy of capital allocation priorities was reiterated during the year and include, in order, to i) maintain balance sheet strength to weather volatility in the Ocean business, ii) continue to renew the fleet and pursue organic growth in Logistics & Services and Terminals while also considering selective inorganic opportunities and iii) remain committed to the dividend policy while returning excess cash to shareholders through share buy-back programmes. Additionally, Maersk is committed to maintaining an investment-grade credit rating.

Investor Relations

In 2024, Investor Relations (IR) worked to ensure that the global investment community were kept updated on the latest financial performance and corporate developments. Together with the Executive Leadership Team, Investor Relations engaged with institutional investors, financial analysts and individual investors, discussing our strategy and business transformation. Maintaining a global presence, the Executive Board and IR team met with investors in key financial centres across multiple continents, including in Copenhagen, Stockholm, London, Paris, Frankfurt, New York, Los Angeles, Singapore and more. A field trip was hosted in October in New Jersey where investors toured the APM Terminals Port Elizabeth terminal and a state-of-the-art contract logistics warehouse, showcasing how Maersk is connecting and simplifying customers' supply chains through global end-to-end logistics solutions. The investor website, investor.maersk.com, underwent a redesign during 2024 and remains an important communication channel where investors can find the latest financial reports, investor presentations as well as share and bond information.

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Corporate governance

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S must comply with or explain deviations from the 'Recommendations for Corporate Governance' implemented by Nasdaq Copenhagen in the Rules for issuers of shares and section 107b of the Danish Financial Statements Act.

The Board of Directors has prepared a statement on corporate governance for the financial year 2024, which can be found on investor.maersk.com/governance/corporate-governance.

Out of the 40 Recommendations for Corporate Governance, the company complies with 33 and complies partly with seven of the recommendations.

Governance structure

The shareholders exercise their rights at the Annual General Meeting, which is the supreme governing body of the company. The Annual General Meeting, inter alia, elects the Board of Directors and appoints the auditors, approves the annual report and adopts the company's Articles of Association.

The company has two share classes: A shares carrying voting rights and B shares without voting rights. A and B shares carry equal economic rights and are traded publicly at Nasdaq Copenhagen.

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S has a management structure consisting of the Board of Directors and the Executive Board. The governance structure and rules are further described in the Articles of Association, the Corporate Governance Statement and the Rules of Procedure for the Board, all of which are available at investor.maersk.com.

The Board of Directors appoints the Executive Board to conduct the day-to-day management of the company. The Executive Board consists of Vincent Clerc (CEO) and Patrick Jany (CFO). The Executive Board is supported by the Executive Leadership Team which consists GOV-1 §21d Percentage of men % 70 47

of 12 members (in addition to the CEO and CFO) who are responsible for specific parts of the business.

The governance structure promotes close coordination between the Board of Directors, the Executive Board and leaders across the organisation. The structure promotes the objectives of:

  • Early identification of opportunities, challenges and risks.
  • Efficient processes for informed decision-making.
  • Continuous learning.
  • Proactive planning and agile execution.
  • Sound controls, checks and balances and compliance.
  • Clear allocation of authorities and responsibilities.
  • Safe operations and oversight of ESG-related matters.

Board competences and diversity

The Board has identified several key competences needed within the Board to fulfil its responsibilities: shipping, transport, logistics, IT and digital/business transformation, innovation, asset heavy industries, ESG, finance and accounting, risk management, global leadership and board service in stock listed companies.

Currently, the Board consists of three women and seven men, none of which are members of the registered management of the company. The current 30/70 split is not considered to be equal gender representation on the Board, and the Board has made a target for reaching such.

Composition and diversity of the Board of Directors

Ref. Indicator Unit 2024
GOV-1 §21a Number of executive members # 0
GOV-1 §21a Number of non-executive members # 10
GOV-1 §21b Number of employees in the company # 2
GOV-1 §21e Percentage of independent Board members % 50
GOV-1 §21d Percentage of women % 30

Skills and expertise within ESG-related matters

When considering Board candidates, the Nomination Committee takes into account the competences of both the potential candidates and the current Board members with regards to ESG-related matters to ensure that the Board as a whole has a relevant level of expertise. GOV-1 §23a,b

To leverage knowledge on ESG matters, the Board established an ESG Committee in 2023 to focus on strategic ESG-related topics aligned with the overall ESG strategy, including climate change, safety, diversity, equity and inclusion and business conduct. GOV-1 §23a,b G1.GOV-1 §5b GOV-2 §26c

In addition, the Audit Committee oversees sustainability reportingrelated matters related to external reporting e.g. in connection with the discussion of A.P. Moller - Maersk's CSRD double materiality assessment, which increases the Committee members' expertise with regards to material impacts, risks and opportunities related to sustainability. GOV-1 §17

The Board has around four teach-in sessions per year, which are educational sessions on company-relevant matters, including ESG matters. In 2024, the Board had a dedicated session on the CSRD and the double materiality assessment with input from an external company and an independent audit firm.

Board evaluation

In 2024, a Board evaluation was conducted, covering topics such as diversity on the Board, content of the committee work and the competences needed to support the company's strategy in the best way. All Board members participated in the survey. The results were discussed in a plenary Board session, and agreed actions for improvement will be implemented.

The Board evaluation 2024 confirmed the composition of the Board with regards to diversity, competences and alignment within the Board on the strategic priorities. In 2024, an assessment of Board members competences within ESG-related matters as well as available education within this area was made.

Board Committees

The Rules of Procedure for the Board Committees are available on the company's website.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Audit Committee Board members: 3 Independent: 3/3

Matters managed in 2024, among others:

  • Review of annual and interim financial reports.
  • Monitor financial and integrated reporting processes, including financial reporting risks, reporting process integrity and accounting estimates, judgements and policies.
  • Monitor CSRD reporting including double materiality assessment.
  • Review of tax report
  • Monitor effectiveness of internal control systems, fraud risks and fraud prevention.
  • Discuss key audit matters, monitor services, audit plans, reports and independence of external auditors and recommend statutory auditor for appointment.
  • Monitor Group Internal Audit, its independence, scope, performance, resources and reporting, and resolution of audit findings.
  • Oversee company's enterprise risk management framework and review key enterprise risks and related mitigation plans.

Nomination Committee Board members: 3 Independent: 1/3

Matters managed in 2024, among others:

  • Review and assess the Board's composition, succession planning, competences including skills and expertise within ESG-relevant matters and diversity.
  • Identify new candidates for the Board of Directors.
  • Assess Board member independence criteria.

Remuneration Committee Board members: 3 Independent: 1/3

Matters managed in 2024, among others:

  • Define and review benchmarks for executive remuneration.
  • Review, monitor and present proposal to the Board of the 2024 and 2025 scorecards (including KPIs and targets).
  • Review and present 2024 Executive Board remuneration packages to the Board.
  • Prepare Remuneration Report.
  • Propose fees for members of the Board of Directors.

ESG Committee Board members: 4 Independent: 2/4

Matters managed in 2024, among others:

  • Review the company's ESG commitments, including future legislation and reporting requirements.
  • Review energy transition in shipping, including the green fuel strategy.
  • Review safety and security in Logistics & Services.
  • Review human rights and labour standards.
  • Review ESG KPIs and targets for the 2024 and 2025 scorecards for executive remuneration and present the same for the Board's approval. • Review fleet cultural transformation programme.

Internal control and risk management systems

The company's risk management and internal controls in connection with its financial and sustainability (integrated) reporting are planned to reduce the risk of errors and omissions in the reporting.

Control environment

The Board of Directors, the Audit Committee and the Executive Board regularly assess material risks and internal controls associated with the company's integrated reporting process. This includes sustainability reporting, where work to mature our ESG KPIs was undertaken during 2024 with a focus on improving and implementing controls to support completeness and accuracy of reported ESG data. As 2024 is the first year of CSRD reporting, the control environment is less mature than for our financial reporting. GOV-5 §36a,b

Attendance rate

Board
meeting
Audit
Committee
Nomination
Committee
Remuneration
Committee
ESG
Committee1
Robert Mærsk Uggla 10/10 (Chair) 4/4 (Chair) 6/6 5/5
Marc Engel 10/10 4/4 6/6 (Chair) 4/5
Bernard L. Bot 10/10 7/7
Marika Fredriksson 10/10 7/7 (Chair) 6/6
Arne Karlsson 10/10 1/13
Thomas
Lindegaard Madsen
10/10
Amparo Moraleda 10/10 6/7 5/5 (Chair)
Kasper Rørsted 10/10 4/4 5/5
Allan Thygesen2 8/8
Julija Voitiekute 10/10
Overall
attendance rate
100% 95.5% 100% 100% 95%

1 The ESG Chair is also an Audit Committee member, ensuring alignment of roles and responsibilities, particularly for CSRD reporting.

  • 2 Allan Thygesen joined the Board in March 2024.
  • 3 Marika Frederiksson succeeded Arne Karlsson as the Chair of the Audit Committee in March 2024.

The Audit Committee has a supervisory responsibility on behalf of the Board of Directors. The Executive Board is responsible for the maintaining an efficient integrated reporting control environment. The Board of Directors and the Executive Board prepare and approve policies, procedures and controls over the company's significant integrated reporting areas.

Risk assessment and management

At least once a year, the Board of Directors and the Executive Board undertake a general identification and assessment of enterprise risks, including fraud risks, and consider mitigation measures to be implemented, based on an assessment of the risk severity. This process also includes sustainability reporting risks, including addressing risks of incompleteness and inaccuracy of reported ESG data by ensuring that clear definitions and procedures are in place and that process maps, risks assessments and internal controls have been implemented. GOV-5 §36c

Control activities

Specific control activities related to integrated reporting risks have been defined and implemented for each business segment, including internal controls that are performed by relevant functions in relation to ESG KPIs. GOV-5 §36d

Monitoring

The monitoring of risk management and control systems associated with integrated reporting includes ongoing assessments and control at different levels within the company. Material weaknesses, omissions and violations are reported to the Executive Board. The Board of Directors and Audit Committee receive reports from the Executive Board and Group Internal Audit on compliance with the guidelines, including in relation to ESG reporting. GOV-5 §36e

Group Internal Audit

Group Internal Audit provides assurance to the Board of Directors and the Audit Committee and acts independently of the Executive Board. Group Internal Audit's focus is to review the internal control effectiveness, procedures and systems to prevent and detect irregularities. The Head of Group Internal Audit reports to the Chair of the Board of Directors and to the Audit Committee.

Remuneration

The remuneration of the Executive Board members for 2024 reflects a year of resilience and achievement in which A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) navigated a landscape of evershifting global circumstances and significant challenges posed by the Red Sea situation. Despite these complexities, Maersk delivered strong financial results and made solid progress towards our strategic transformation journey.

Performance

Corporate governance

Executive summary

The integrator

Sustainability

In 2024, the core elements of the Executive Board's remuneration remained consistent, with variable components fully linked to business results, ensuring alignment between executive remuneration and shareholders' interest over the short and long term. Underlining the importance of sustainability alongside financial performance, our longterm incentive plan continues to include ESG targets within the overall performance scorecard, reinforcing our commitment to creating sustainable value.

The following sections set out key elements of the Remuneration Policy ('Policy') and the total remuneration awarded to the members of the Board of Directors and the Executive Board for 2024.

Remuneration Policy at a glance

The Policy supports the business needs by enabling an appropriate total remuneration package that has a clear link to the business strategy and aligns with shareholder interests.

The objectives of the Policy are to:

  • Ensure appropriate total remuneration: The remuneration design and decisions are guided by market practice, reflected in the remuneration components offered and the total remuneration value provided.
  • Link to business strategy:

The Policy supports the business plan and the need for executive leaders to focus on delivering ongoing progress to achieve the company's strategic goals, reflected in a combination of short and long-term incentive components.

Align with shareholder interest:

The Policy is designed to support the delivery of strong financial and operational results over time, which ultimately grows shareholder value.

The current Policy applies to members of the Executive Board and the Board of Directors and was adopted at the company's Annual General Meeting in 2023.

Board of Directors

The members of the Board of Directors receive a fixed annual fee which is differentiated based on the role:

• Ordinary Board members receive a fixed amount, and the Chair and Vice Chair receive fixed multiples thereof.

Board of Directors members serving on the Board committees or performing ad hoc work beyond the normal responsibilities receive an additional fee.

Executive Board

The remuneration of the Executive Board members consists of a fixed base salary, a benefit allowance, short-term incentives as well as longterm incentive components.

The remuneration structure is intended to drive a 'reward for performance' culture by aligning individual reward to company performance and shareholder value creation. The individual remuneration level is set and reviewed based on peer companies of similar size and complexity to ensure they remain comparable and fit for the business.

Total remuneration 2024

The below table shows the total remuneration awarded to members of the Board of Directors and the Executive Board in aggregate from 2020 to 2024, as set out in note 2.2 of the consolidated financial statements.

Further information regarding the share-based incentives is detailed in note 5.2 of the consolidated financial statements as calculated according to IFRS 2.

Long-term share-based incentives are different in both reporting and methodology in the company's Remuneration Report 2024, which is available at the company's website: investor.maersk.com/governance/policies-and-charters

2020-2024 Remuneration USD million
Remuneration awarded 2024 2023 2022 2021 2020
Board of Directors
Fixed annual fee 2 2 2 3 3
Total 2 2 2 3 3
Executive Board
Fixed pay 3 3 8 9 8
Short-term cash incentive 4 2 6 8 6
Long-term share-based
incentives
31 2 8 3 2
Remuneration in connection
with redundancy, resignations
and release from duty to work
- -1 82 - -
Total 10 63 30 20 16
  • 1 In 2024, following the demerger of Svitzer, the outstanding stock options, restricted share units and performance shares were modified, resulting in immediate recognition of a beneficial modification expense for the already vested grants in 2024. The beneficial modifications to unvested programmes will be recognised over the remaining vesting period.
  • 2 During 2022, it was announced that Morten Engelstoft would leave A.P. Moller Maersk effective at the end of June 2022 and Søren Skou effective at the end December 2022. In accordance with the terms and conditions of the restricted share plan and the stock option plan, any remaining expenses related to previous years' plans were accelerated and recognised in 2022 for plans that were kept, and previously recognised expenses are reversed for cancelled plans. This resulted in an increase in the long-term share-based incentives remuneration in 2022.
  • 3 In 2023, the Executive Board was reduced from five to two members.

Board of Directors

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

  • Agata ApS (CEO) • Estemco XII ApS (CEO)
    • IMD (Director of the foundation Board)

Robert Mærsk Uggla

Chair, Chair of the Nomination Committee, member of the ESG Committee and the Remuneration Committee. CEO, A.P. Møller Holding A/S. • Swedish nationality • Male, born 1978 • Joined the Board in 2014 • Current election period: 2024-2026 Other management duties, etc. • A.P. Moller Capital P/S (Chair) • Svitzer Group A/S1

  • International Business Leaders' Advisory Council, IBLAC (member)
  • Board positions in a number of subsidiaries controlled by A.P. Møller Holding A/S

(Vice Chair)

Education

• MSc in Business Administration, Stockholm School of Economics, including studies at Università Commerciale Luigi Bocconi • Executive education at The Wharton School of the University of Pennsylvania, Stanford Business School, Harvard Business School, and IMD.

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Leadership experience within transportation, infrastructure and investment-related activities.

Not considered independent due to position as CEO of A.P. Møller Holding A/S.

Marc Engel

Vice Chair, Chair of the Remuneration Committee and member of the Nomination Committee and the ESG Committee.

  • Dutch nationality
  • Male, born 1966
  • Joined the Board in 2019
  • Current election period: 2023-2025

Other management duties, etc.

• ACT commodities (Supervisory board member)

Education

• MSc, Applied Physics, University of Groningen, Groningen, Netherlands

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

International experience in general management, sustainability, procurement and supply chain. Insight from a customer's perspective in both shipping and broader logistics space.

Not considered independent due to his recent position in Unilabs, an A.P. Møller Holding A/S company.

Bernard L. Bot

Member of the Audit Committee.

  • Dutch nationality
  • Male, born 1966
  • Joined the Board in 2019
  • Current election period: 2023-2025

Other management duties, etc.

• None

Education

  • MSc in Economics, Erasmus University Rotterdam, Netherlands
  • MBA, University of Chicago Booth School of Business, Chicago, USA

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Considered independent.

Experience within the transport and logistics sector and listed companies. Technical financial skills, knowledge of global business-to-business technology and customer markets.

Marika Fredriksson

Chair of the Audit Committee and member of the Remuneration Committee.

  • Female, born 1963
  • Joined the Board in 2022
  • Current election period: 2024-2026

Other management duties, etc.

  • AB Industrivärden1 (Board member)
  • Sandvik AB1 (Board member)
  • Emagine Consulting (Chair)
  • Ecolean AB (Board member)
  • Master's degree from the Swedish School of Economics, Helsinki, Finland

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Considered independent.

International experience as CFO and member of the board of directors of listed companies within construction.

Arne Karlsson

• Swedish nationality

  • Male, born 1958
  • Joined the Board in 2010
  • Current election period: 2023-2025

Other management duties, etc.

  • Einar Mattsson (Chair)
  • FPI Group AB (Chair)
  • FAPM Fastighets AB (Chair)
  • Fastighets AB Stadshus (Chair)
  • KANA I Ramundberget AB (Chair)
  • Ramisverket AB (Deputy board member)
  • Swedish Securities Council (Board member) • Advisory Board for The ESS (European
  • Spallation Source) (member)
  • Origover AB (Board member)

Education

• Bachelor's degree in Business and Economics, Stockholm School of Economics, 1982

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Experience as CEO and board member of private equity and industrial companies and with managing and developing a diverse portfolio of businesses operating in different markets.

Not considered independent due to being member of the Board for more than 12 years.

- Swedish nationality

-

(Board member)

  • Kone Oy1
  • Education

Board of Directors

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Navigations Skole

• None Education

Madsen

Captain, Maersk Line. • Danish nationality • Male, born 1972 • Joined the Board in 2018 • Current election period: 2024-2026 Other management duties, etc.

Captain in Maersk Line since 2011 and Chief Officer in Maersk Line from 2004-2011. Technical, maritime and operational knowledge.

• Graduated Master, 1996, Svendborg

Thomas Lindegaard

Amparo Moraleda

Chair of the ESG Committee and member of the Audit Committee.

  • Spanish nationality
  • Female, born 1964
  • Joined the Board in 2021
    • Current election period: 2023-2025

Other management duties, etc.

  • Caixabank1 (Board member) • Airbus SE1 (Board member)
  • Vodafone Group1 (Board member)
  • Education
  • Industrial Engineer by ICAI, Universidad Pontificia de Comillas, 1988 • Advance Management programme (PDG) by IESE Business School, Universidad

de Navarra, 1995

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c Board experience from international listed technology, chemical, aerospace, transportation, automotive and innovation companies and from the financial sector. Management experience from global, listed IT and electric utility companies. Digital transformation and strategy experience.

Kasper Rørsted

Member of the Nomination Committee and the ESG Committee.

  • Danish nationality
  • Male, born 1962
  • Joined the Board in 2023 • Current election period: 2023-2025

  • Other management duties, etc. • Siemens AG1 , Germany (Board member, member of the Innovation and Finance Committee)

  • Lenovo Group Limited1 (Board member, member of the Audit Committee and Compensation Committee)

• Woom, Austria (Chair)

• IISS, Think Tank, Board of trustees (member)

Education

  • International Business Studies, Copenhagen
  • Business College, Denmark
  • Executive Program, Harvard Business School, USA

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Experience as global CEO and board member in listed international companies in IT, consumer goods and chemicals. Strong competencies in digital transformation, leadership development, sustainability and global business trends.

Allan Thygesen

CEO and board member of DocuSign, Inc.1

  • Danish nationality
  • Male, born 1962
  • Joined the Board in 2024
  • Election period: 2024-2026

Other management duties, etc.

  • Advisory board of Stanford's Institute for Research in the Social Sciences (Vice Chair)
  • Stanford's Institute for Economic Policy Research (Advisory board member)

Education

  • Master's degree in Economics from the University of Copenhagen
  • MBA from the Stanford Graduate School of Business, graduating as an Arjay Miller scholar

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Experience as global CEO and board member in listed international companies in several IT sectors, at the senior level in a global leader in digital information and entertainment services and as a partner in a global private equity firm. Strong competencies in digital transformation, leadership development, sustainability and global business trends.

Julija Voitiekute

Energy transition academy lead, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S.

  • Lithuanian nationality
  • Female, born 1981
  • Joined the Board in 2022
  • Current election period: 2024-2026

Other management duties, etc.

• Innovation Committee of Danish Shipping (member)

Education

  • Master's degree in International Strategy, Copenhagen Business School
  • Bachelor's degree in Finance and Banking from St. Petersburg University of Economics and Finance
  • Board education from Copenhagen Business School in cooperation with Børsen

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Knowledge in ship operation, technical management, future trends and innovation.

Considered independent.

Considered independent.

Considered independent.

Not considered independent due to employment in A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

  • Bachelor in Political Science, Lausanne, Switzerland
  • MBA, Columbia Business School, New York, and London Business School

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Vincent has held various roles in North America and Copenhagen. In December 2015, Vincent was appointed Chief Commercial Officer in Maersk Line before being appointed as member of the Executive Board as Chief Commercial Officer of Maersk in 2017. In December 2019, Vincent Clerc was appointed CEO of Ocean & Logistics at Maersk.

Patrick Jany

Registered as CFO, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S Chief Financial Officer (CFO) since May 2020.

  • German and Swiss nationality
  • Male, born 1968
  • Joined the Executive Leadership Team in 2020
  • Joined Maersk in 2020

Other management duties, etc.

• Comet AG, Switzerland (Board member)

Education

• Master in Business Administration, Finance, ESCP (École Supérieure de Commerce de Paris)

Qualifications GOV-1 §21c

Before joining Maersk, Patrick was CFO and member of the Executive Committee in Clariant AG, Switzerland. Prior to his role as CFO, Patrick held several leadership positions within finance, general management and corporate development in Clariant in Germany, Mexico, Singapore, Indonesia and Spain.

Executive Leadership Team

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk)'s Executive Leadership Team includes leaders with a long tenure within Maersk and leaders with experience from outside the company, bringing increased diversity of thought, age, gender and nationality.

The organisational structure is shaped around 13 roles and areas of responsibility. The Executive Leadership Team jointly owns the execution of Maersk's Integrator strategy and is composed to create strong alignment across the enterprise as well as clear ownership and accountability for key aspects of the next phase of Maersk's strategy.

The Executive Leadership Team's responsibilities

Vincent Clerc1 Chief Executive Officer Patrick Jany1 Chief Financial Officer Karsten Kildahl CCO & LAM & IMEA

Aymeric Chandavoine President Europe

Charles van der Steene President North America

Katharina Poehlmann Head of Strategy

Susana Elvira Chief People Officer

Navneet Kapoor

Caroline Pontoppidan Chief Corporate Affairs Officer

Chief Technology & IS Officer

Ditlev Blicher President Asia Pacific

Johan Sigsgaard Chief Product Officer – Ocean

Narin Phol Chief Product Officer – Logistics & Services

Rabab Boulos Chief Operating Officer

Keith Svendsen CEO APM Terminals

1 Executive Board

Annual Report 2024

Vincent Clerc

• Male, born 1972

Education

  • Joined the Executive Leadership Team in 2017
  • Joined Maersk in 1998
  • Other management duties, etc.

• European Round Table of Industrialists

Executive Board

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Sustainability statement

General disclosures Environmental disclosures Social disclosures Governance disclosures 53

Methanol-capable vessels and the fuels to sail them

Aarhus, Denmark

In 2024, Maersk took delivery of seven new large dual-fuel methanol vessels, including Antonia Mærsk, shown here in Aarhus, Denmark. She was christened by our customer Vestas, a Danish sustainable energy solution producer.

While the vessel technology to decarbonise ocean transport is readily available, the biggest challenge is securing the green fuels for these ships. Maersk signed additional offtake agreements in 2024 and has secured more than half of the projected 2027 demand for its new vessels.

Annual Report 2024

ESRS 2

In 2024, for the first time, A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) has prepared the sustainability statement in accordance with the EU Corporate Sustainability Reporting Directive (CSRD) and its underlying European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS).

Maersk's reporting on sustainability and ESG focuses on material sustainability matters and activities and encompasses areas where Maersk may have the largest impact on people and planet through our activities, or where Maersk is exposed to the most significant financial risks or opportunities. The materiality of sustainability matters and topics is determined based on the application of a double materiality assessment (DMA) principle. The results of the DMA have shaped the content of the sustainability statement.

Scope and consolidation

Unless otherwise stated, the ESG performance data and information included in the sustainability statement are reported based on the same consolidation principles as the financial statements. Thus, the ESG performance data include consolidated data from the parent company, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S, and subsidiaries controlled by A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S. Similarly, unless otherwise stated, our policies apply to all Maersk entities, employees and everyone

working under Maersk's control. Data is collected per legal entity and per activity, and the figures are consolidated line-by-line. Consolidation of ESG performance data using financial scope implies that data from the following assets are included:

  • Owned assets that Maersk financially owns and that are operated by Maersk
  • Long-term leased-in assets that Maersk treats as capital assets and that are treated as such on Maersk's balance sheet in accordance with IFRS 16
  • Leased-out assets that Maersk treats as wholly owned assets in financial accounting and that are treated as such on Maersk's balance sheet (i.e. short-term leased-out assets to third parties).

For entities and assets that are under Maersk's operational control but not consolidated under the parent company and its subsidiaries, the above financial consolidation principles differ.

Operational control is defined as the situation where Maersk or one of its subsidiaries has full authority to introduce and implement its operating policies at the entity (i.e. operationally controlled investees in e.g. associates, joint ventures or unconsolidated subsidiaries). Operational control is determined by looking at the contractual arrangements to determine whether Maersk has full authority to introduce and implement its operating policies.

Data from divestments is included until the divestment date. Data from Svitzer, which was demerged during 2024, is included up until the demerger date of 26 April 2024.

This report covers the full upstream and downstream value chain based on the outcome of the DMA.

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Uncertainties and estimates

Preparation of ESG performance data requires Management to make estimates in some areas, which affect the reported data. Management forms its estimates based on historical experience, independent advice, external data points, in-house specialists and other information believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Read more about uncertainties and estimates in the accounting policies relating to the ESG performance data. To minimise risks of reporting errors in relation to ESG performance data, including areas with uncertainty, internal controls and validation processes are established.

Page Key accounting estimates
and judgements
Estimate /
Judgement
Impact
91 Categorisation of emissions
from short-term leases between
scope 1 and scope 3
Judgement
90 GHG emissions from upstream
transportation and distribution
activity estimates
Estimate
108 Waste estimates Estimate
124 Average working hours estimate used
to calculate gender pay gap
Estimate
124 Annual total remuneration
estimates
Estimate
125 Exposure hours estimates used
when preparing the lost time
incident frequency
Estimate

Level of potential impact to the reported data:

  • Low
  • Medium
  • High

Changes affecting the ESG performance data in 2024

In 2024, Maersk reports for the first time in accordance with the CSRD and the disclosure requirements outlined in the ESRS. Thus, for 2024, we have, in addition to previously reported KPIs, included new ESRSrelated datapoints that have been deemed material as part of Maersk's DMA in the relevant ESG performance data sections of the sustainability statement. This includes:

Environment

  • Percentage of scope 1 greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions from regulated emissions trading schemes
  • Renewable energy production
  • Maersk top 5 sites at material risk of physical climate change
  • Operating expenditures (OPEX) in conjunction with major incidents and deposits
  • Total weight of procured steel

Social

  • Average number of employees
  • Number of employees by gender
  • Number of employees by contract type by gender
  • Number of employees by contract type by region
  • Number of employees by country
  • Number of employees who left the company
  • Total employee turnover
  • Employees by age group
  • Gender pay gap
  • Annual total remuneration ratio (CEO pay ratio)
  • Employees paid below the applicable adequate wage benchmark
  • Number of lost time incidents

Governance

  • Number of convictions for violation of anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws
  • Amount of fines for violation of anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws
  • Number of legal proceedings outstanding for late payments

Throughout the sustainability statement, the references used in ESG performance data tables are based on the EFRAG data point list ID's.

In 2024, we report our progress towards validated science-based targets, which are our main climate KPIs and targets towards 2030 and 2040. Consequently, we have discontinued reporting on segment-specific climate targets, including for Terminals, reduction of absolute scope 1 and 2 emissions by 2030 (2020 baseline), and for Ocean, share of freight transported on green fuels.

In 2024, we have revised our definition of operationally controlled entities and joint ventures. With the introduction of a clear definition for operational control in ESRS, which is based on whether a company has full authority to introduce and implement its operating policies at the entity as stated in the contractual agreement, Maersk has aligned its definition accordingly, which has resulted in an insignificant adjustment.

We have made a number of other restatements to the 2023 numbers owing to improvement of reporting processes and data quality. Most notably, we made a correction to scope 1 emissions, as refrigerant emissions had been overstated in 2023. The correction has led to a restatement of scope 1 emissions of 1.7m tonnes CO2e or approximately a 5% reduction of total scope 1 emissions for 2023.

summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

ESRS 2

Incorporation by reference

The table below provides an overview of where information can be found relating to ESRS disclosures that have been incorporated by reference and stated outside of the sustainability statement as part of other sections of this Annual Report or in the Remuneration Report .

Disclosure requirements incorporated by reference

Disclosure
requirement
Data
point(s)
Paragraph Page
GOV-1 §21a Number of executive and non-executive members
of the Board of Directors
Corporate governance 47
GOV-1 §21b Employee representatives on the Board of Directors Corporate governance 47
GOV-1 §21d,
§23a-b
Diversity of the Board of Directors Corporate governance 47
GOV-1 §21e Percentage of independent Board of Directors members Corporate governance 47
GOV-1
G1.GOV-1
§23a-b,
§5b,
§21c, §17
Information on Board competences,
skills and relevant experience
Corporate governance 47
50-51
GOV-2 §26c Material impacts, risks and opportunities addressed
by the Board of Directors
Corporate governance 47
GOV-5 §36a-e Information on risk management and controls Corporate governance 48
GOV-3
E1.GOV-3
§27,
§29a-e
§13
Information on sustainability-linked remuneration Remuneration report
S1-16 §97b The annual total remuneration ratio (the CEO pay ratio) Remuneration report
SBM-1 §42,
§42a-b
Business model and value chain Business model 13
SBM-1 §40a i-ii,
40e-g
Business strategy and products/services linkage
to sustainability matters
Strategy 19
SBM-1 §40b Total revenue by significant sectors Consolidated financial
statements, note 2.1
147
SBM-1 §40d-i Revenue derived from fossil fuel activities Consolidated financial
statements, note 2.1
147

integrator

The

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Disclosure requirements covered by Maersk's Annual Report 2024

The table below provides an overview ESRS datapoints that derive from other EU legislation and where this information can be found if deemed material.

General disclosures

ESRS disclosure requirement Section/report Page
General disclosures
BP-1 General basis for preparation of the sustainability statement Basis of preparation 54
BP-2 Disclosures in relation to specific circumstances Basis of preparation 55
GOV-1 The role of the administrative, management and
supervisory bodies
Corporate governance 47
ESG governance model 64-65
GOV-2 Information provided to and sustainability matters addressed
by the undertaking's administrative, management and
supervisory bodies
Corporate governance 47
ESG governance model 64-65
GOV-3 Integration of sustainability-related performance
in incentive schemes
Remuneration report
GOV-4 Statement on due diligence Approach to due diligence 69
GOV-5 Risk management and internal controls over sustainability
reporting
Corporate governance 48
Business model 13
Strategy, business model and value chain Strategy 19
SBM-1 Consolidated financial
statements, note 2.1
147
Social performance data 119
Double materiality assessment:
value chain mapping
68
SBM-2 Interests and views of stakeholders Stakeholder engagement 70-74
SBM-3 Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their interac
tion with strategy and business model
ESG strategy 62-63
Double materiality assessment 66-67
77
110
127
IRO-1 Description of the process to identify and assess material
impacts, risks and opportunities
Double materiality assessment
methodology
68
IRO-2 Disclosure requirements in ESRS covered by the undertaking's
sustainability statement
Double materiality assessment
methodology
68
Index tables 57-59

Environment

ESRS disclosure requirement Section/report Page
Climate change
E1.GOV-3 Integration of sustainability-related performance
in incentive schemes
Remuneration report
E1-1 Transition plan for climate change mitigation Climate change 79
Climate change 77-88
E1.SBM-3 Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their
interaction with strategy and business model
Double materiality assessment 66-67
77
E1.IRO-1 Description of the processes to identify and assess material
climate-related impacts, risks and opportunities
Double materiality assessment
methodology
68
E1-2 Policies related to climate change mitigation and adaptation Climate change 78-88
E1-3 Actions and resources in relation to climate change policies Climate change 78-88
E1-4 Targets related to climate change mitigation and adaptation Climate change 79
E1-5 Energy consumption and mix Climate change performance data 89-100
E1-6 Gross scopes 1, 2, 3 and Total GHG emissions Climate change performance data 89-100
E1-8 Internal carbon pricing Embedding the transition
plan into business strategy
and financial planning
81-82
E1-9 Anticipated financial effects from material physical and
transition risks and potential climate-related opportunities
Climate change 88
Pollution
E2.IRO-1 Description of the processes to identify and assess material
pollution-related impacts, risks and opportunities
Double materiality assessment
methodology
68
Stakeholder engagement 70-74
E2-1 Policies related to pollution Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E2-2 Actions and resources related to pollution Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E2-3 Targets related to pollution Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E2-4 Pollution of air, water and soil Environmental performance data 107-108
E2-6 Anticipated financial effects from pollution-related impacts,
risks and opportunities
Environment and ecosystems 107

Corporate

Financials

ESRS disclosure requirement Section/report Page
Biodiversity and ecosystems
E4.IRO-1 Description of processes to identify and assess material
biodiversity and ecosystem-related impacts, risks and
Double materiality assessment
methodology
68
opportunities Stakeholder engagement 70-74
E4.SBM-3 Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their
interaction with strategy and business model
Environment and ecosystems 77
101-106
Double materiality assessment 66-67
E4-1 Transition plan and consideration of biodiversity
and ecosystems in strategy and business model
Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E4-2 Policies related to biodiversity and ecosystems Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E4-3 Actions and resources related to biodiversity and ecosystems Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E4-4 Targets related to biodiversity and ecosystems Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E4-5 Impact metrics related to biodiversity and ecosystems
change
Environment and ecosystems 101-106

Resource use and circular economy

E5.IRO-1 Description of the processes to identify and assess material
resource use and circular economy-related impacts, risks and
Double materiality assessment
methodology
68
Stakeholder engagement 70-74
E5-1 Policies related to resource use and circular economy Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E5-2 Actions and resources related to resource use and circular
economy
Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E5-3 Targets related to resource use and circular economy Environment and ecosystems 101-106
E5-4 Resource inflows Environmental performance data 107-108
E5-5 Resource outflows Environmental performance data 107-108

Social

ESRS disclosure requirement Section/report Page
Own workforce
S1.SBM-2 Interests and views of stakeholders Stakeholder engagement 70-74
Our workforce 110-113
S1.SBM-3 Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their
interaction with strategy and business model
Double materiality assessment 66-67
110
127
Policies related to own workforce Our workforce 111-118
S1-1 Grievance and remedy 73-74
S1-2 Processes for engaging with own workforce and workers'
representatives about impacts
Stakeholder engagement 70-74
S1-3 Processes to remediate negative impacts and channels
for own workforce to raise concerns
Grievance and remedy 70-74
Taking action on material impacts on own workforce, and
approaches to managing material risks and pursuing material
opportunities related to own workforce and effectiveness
of those actions
Our workforce 111-118
S1-4 Grievance and remedy 70-74
S1-5 Targets related to managing material negative impacts,
advancing positive impacts and managing material risks
and opportunities
Our workforce 111-118
S1-6 Characteristics of the undertaking's employees Social performance data 119-125
S1-9 Diversity metrics Social performance data 119-125
S1-10 Adequate wages Social performance data 119-125
S1-14 Health and safety metrics Social performance data 119-125
S1-16 Remuneration metrics (pay gap and total remuneration) Social performance data 119-125
S1-17 Incidents, complaints and severe human rights impacts Grievance and remedy 73-74
Executive
summary
ESRS disclosure requirement Section/report Page
Workers in the value chain
S2.SBM-2 Interests and views of stakeholders Stakeholder engagement 70-74
Our workforce 110-113
S2.SBM-3 Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their
interaction with strategy and business model
Double materiality assessment 66-67
110
127
Sustainable procurement 130-131
S2-1 Policies related to value chain workers Grievance and remedy 73-74
S2-2 Processes for engaging with value chain workers about impacts Stakeholder engagement 70-74
S2-3 Processes to remediate negative impacts and channels
Grievance and remedy
for value chain workers to raise concerns
73-74
Taking action on material impacts on value chain workers, Sustainable procurement 130-131
S2-4 and approaches to managing material risks and pursuing
material opportunities related to value chain workers,
and effectiveness of those actions
Grievance and remedy 73-74
S2-5 Targets related to managing material negative impacts,
advancing positive impacts and managing material risks
and opportunities
Sustainable procurement 130-131
Affected communities
S3.SBM-2 Interests and views of stakeholders Stakeholder engagement 70-74

interaction with strategy and business model Double materiality assessment

Governance

66-67 77 127

Grievance and remedy 73-74 Approach to human rights 112-113 Climate change 78-88 Environment and ecosystems 101-106 Business ethics 129

ESRS disclosure requirement Section/report Page
Business conduct
The role of the administrative, supervisory and ESG governance model 64-65
G1.GOV-1 management bodies Corporate governance 47
G1.IRO-1 Description of the processes to identify and assess
material impacts, risks and opportunities
Double materiality assessment
methodology
68
Responsible business conduct 128-132
G1-1 Business conduct policies and corporate culture Grievance and remedy 73-74
G1-2 Management of relationships with suppliers Sustainable procurement
G1-3 Prevention and detection of corruption and bribery Business ethics 129
G1-4 Incidents of corruption or bribery Governance performance data 134
G1-5 Political influence and lobbying activities Political engagement 71-72
G1-6 Payment practices Sustainable procurement 130-131

S3-1 Policies related to affected communities Grievance and remedy 73-74 Approach to human rights 112-113 Climate change 78-88 Environment and ecosystems 101-106 Business ethics 129 S3-2 Processes for engaging with affected communities about impacts Stakeholder engagement 70-74 S3-3 Processes to remediate negative impacts and channels for affected communities to raise concerns Grievance and remedy 73-74

S3-4 Taking action on material impacts on affected communities, and approaches to managing material risks and pursuing material opportunities related to affected communities, and effectiveness of those actions

S3.SBM-3 Material impacts, risks and opportunities and their

59

Disclosure requirements that derive from other EU legislation

The table below provides an overview ESRS data points that derive from other EU legislation, cf. ESRS 2 Appendix B and where this information can be found if deemed material.

General disclosures

ESRS data point Information Regulation Page
General disclosures
GOV-1 21 (d) Board's gender diversity ratio SFDR 47
GOV-1 21 (e) Percentage of independent Board members SFDR 47
GOV-4 30 Statement on due diligence SFDR 69
SBM-1 40 (d) i Activity in fossil fuel sector SFDR 147
SBM-1 40 (d) ii - 40 (d) iv Activity in chemical, controversial weapons
and/or tobacco industry
SFDR N/A
Climate change
E1-1
E1-1
14
16 (f)
Transition plan for climate change mitigation
Exclusion from EU Paris-aligned Benchmarks
EU Climate Law
Pillar 3,
Benchmark
regulation
E1-4 34 (a) - 34 (b) Emission reduction targets SFDR, Pillar
3, Benchmark
regulation
E1-5 37 (a) (c) Energy consumption from fossil and renewable sources SFDR 79
N/A
79
94
E1-5 37 (b) Energy consumption from nuclear sources SFDR N/A

E1-5 38 (c) (d) Fuel consumption from natural gas and other fuel sources SFDR 94

heat, steam or cooling from fossil sources SFDR 94

in high-climate-impact sectors SFDR 94

E1-5 38 (e) Consumption of purchased or acquired electricity,

E1-5 40-43 Energy consumption and intensity from activities

ESRS data point Information Regulation Page
E1-6 48-52 Scope 1, scope 2 and scope 3 emissions SFDR, Pillar 3,
Benchmark
89
E1-6 53, 55 GHG emission intensity SFDR, Pillar
3, Benchmark
regulation
92
E1-7 56 GHG removals and stage EU Climate Law N/A
E1-9 66 Assets at material financial risk Pillar 3 88
E1-9 67 (c) Carrying amount of real estate assets by energy
efficiency classes
Pillar 3 Phased in
E1-9 69 Financial opportunities (cost savings, market size and
changes to net revenue) from climate change actions
Benchmark
regulation
Phased in
Pollution
E2-4 28 (a) Emissions to air, water and soil SFDR 107
Water and marine resources
E3-1
E3-4
11, 13, 14, 28(c)
(e), 29
All disclosures SFDR N/A
Biodiversity and ecosystems
E4.SBM-3 16 (a) (b) (c) Activities in biodiversity-sensitive areas, impacts related
to land degradation, desertification and soil sealing,
and operations affecting threatened species
SFDR 101-106
E4-2 24 (b) (c) (d) Policies on sustainable land or agriculture practices,
sustainable oceans and sea practices, and deforestation
practices
SFDR 101-106
Resources use and circularity
E5-5 11, 13, 14 Non-recycled waste SFDR N/A
E5-5 28 (c) (e) Hazardous waste SFDR 108
E5-5 29 Radioactive waste SFDR N/A

The

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Annual Report 2024

Material Not material

Social

ESRS data point Information Regulation Page
Our workforce
11 (b) Geographies or commodities with risk of forced labour SFDR 110
S1.SBM-3 11 (b) Geographies or commodities with risk of child labour SFDR N/A
S1-1 20 (a) General approach to human rights SFDR 112-113
S1-1 20 (b) General approach to engagement with own workforce SFDR 70-74
S1-1, S1-3 20 (c), 32 (c) Approach and availability of grievance and remedy
in regards to own workforce
SFDR 73-74
S1-1 21 Policies are aligned with internationally recognised
instruments
SFDR 111-118
S1-1 22 Policies addressing human trafficking, forced labour
and child labour
SFDR 112-113
118
S1-1 23 Policies on accident prevention SFDR 116-117
S1-16 97 (a) - 97 (b) Gender pay gap, annual total remuneration SFDR,
Benchmark
regulation
124
S1-17 103 (a) Incidents of discrimination SFDR 74
S1-17 104 (a) Severe human rights issues and incidents SFDR,
Benchmark
regulation
74
Workers in the value chain
11 (b) Geographies or commodities with risk of forced labour SFDR 110
S2.SBM-3 11 (b) Geographies or commodities with risk of child labour SFDR N/A
S2-1 17 (a), 19 Human rights policy commitments and approach related
to value chain workers, aligned with internationally
recognised standards
SFDR 112-113
S2-1 17 (b) General approach to engagement with value chain workers SFDR 70-74
S2-1 17 (c) Approach to remedy for human rights impacts SFDR 73-74
S2-1 18, 19 Policies explicitly addressing forced labour and child
labour, aligned with internationally recognised standards
SFDR 112-113
118
S2-1 18 Undertaking has a supplier code of conduct SFDR 130-131
SFDR,

S2-4 19, 36 Severe human rights issues and incidents connected to value chain workers

ESRS data point Information Regulation Page
Affected communities
S3-1 16, 17 Human rights policy commitment to affected
communities, whether policies are aligned with
internationally recognised instruments, and general
approach to human rights of communities
SFDR,
Benchmark
regulation
112-113
S3-1 16 (b) Approach to engagement with affected communities SFDR 70-74
S3-1 16 (c) Approach to remedy in regard to human rights impacts
for affected communities
SFDR 73-74
S3-4 36 Severe human rights issues and incidents connected
to affected communities
SFDR 74
Consumers and end-users
S4-1
S4-4
16 (a) (b) (c),
17, 35
All disclosures SFDR,
Benchmark
regulation
N/A
-------------- --------------------------- ----------------- ---------------------------------- -----

Governance

Benchmark regulation

74

ESRS data point Information Regulation Page
G1-1 10 (b) (d) Statement if no policies exist in regard to anti-corruption
and bribery and to protection of whistleblowers
SFDR N/A
G1-4 24 (a) Number of convictions and amount of fines for violations
of anti-corruption and bribery laws
SFDR 134

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

61

ESRS 2, ESRS - G1

ESG strategy and governance

Geopolitical tensions, a heightened focus on social issues and impacts of climate-related weather events were among the key external trends 2024. In response to increasing regulatory require ments and further maturing of its strategy, A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) has reviewed and streamlined its ESG priorities.

ESG in the light of emerging global trends

Geopolitical tensions continued to reshape trade and logistics in 2024 as the majority of the world's shipping lines diverted traffic on Asia-Europe trade routes around the Cape of Good Hope in Africa to avoid attacks in the Red Sea. In addition to longer voyages, which directly increase greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, this situation led to port congestion, cargo delays and a greater reliance on higher-emission transport modes. As geopolitical tension is slowing down the green transition, inflationary pressures and the continued price differential between fossil and green fuels continue to create challenges to our customers' commitments and their capacity to decarbonise.

A notable climate change impact in 2024, continuing a pattern from previous years, is the sharp increase in the frequency and severity of extreme weather events including record floods, droughts, heatwaves and wildfires. This also poses disruption risks to global supply chains. It is likely that these events will continue in 2025, and therefore climate change remains both a risk and a strategic topic for Maersk. Severe weather has also created a greater need for Maersk to support commu nities with critical humanitarian aid during 2024.

The increase of geopolitical tensions and armed conflict is also driving a greater focus on societal issues for Maersk and its customers. This has increased the need for a heightened focus on the due diligence processes for human rights, trade controls, sanctions screening and export com pliance to identify and manage risks when operating in conflict zones.

Corporate

Sustainability

governance

Financials

Maersk ESG strategy

a safe and inspiring workplace
Governance We operate based on
responsible business practices

Three levels of priority

Strategic
categories
Climate change
Safety
Diversity, equity and inclusion
Prioritised
categories
Human capital
Business ethics
Sustainable procurement
Data ethics
Foundational
categories
Environment and ecosystems
Human rights
Employee relations and labour rights
Citizenship
Responsible tax

Supply chain digitalisation and increased automation is both a risk and a prerequisite for the integrated logistics strategy. Generative AI is also transforming the industry, highlighting the importance of an ethical use of data and artificial intelligence, where we are trusted in the use of our customers' and other stakeholders' data while automating internal processes.

In addition, it is crucial that we keep our workforce in mind in the automation of warehouses and terminals. While increasing accessibility of automation technologies creates opportunities for decarbonising our Logistics & Services and Terminals segments, we also need to invest in upskilling our workforce to maintain and attract critical talents and to ensure safe operations with new technologies.

Worker rights were particularly highlighted in 2024, as dockworker strikes in the US, Canada and the UK, some lasting only a few days, caused knock-on supply chain ripples. Maersk actively works to ensure good and fair working conditions for our workforce and focuses on engaging with our employees or their representatives on complex topics such as automation and fair wages.

The current geopolitical tensions and challenges are expected to continue into 2025. Against this complex and uncertain backdrop, Maersk will continue progressing all three of the core commitments of its ESG strategy in 2025.

ESG strategy

Building on over a decade of commitment to sustainability progress, Maersk's ESG strategy charts an ambitious course and establishes ESG as core to our Purpose and Values, critical to the success of our integrated logistics strategy, and a differentiator in the value we create for our customers.

The strategy encompasses the material sustainability impacts, risks and opportunities for Maersk and is centred around three core commitments, each with supporting governance, KPIs and targets. These commitments represent issues where Maersk's position, scale and reach can create the most significant impact, which in turn defines our ambition level in specific ESG categories.

In 2024, we reviewed our ESG priorities to better reflect market and business changes since the 2021 launch of our ESG strategy.

The updated strategy with a finetuning of our priorities is informed by the double materiality assessment (DMA) aligned with the EU Corporate Sustainability Reporting Directive (CSRD), our understanding of stakeholder expectations and taking inspiration from globally recognised reporting frameworks and ESG benchmarks.

As part of the review and streamlining of our ESG strategy framework and priorities, the categories relating to Governance and Sustainable and Inclusive Trade have been recategorised as an enabler and an outcome, respectively, of our ESG strategy.

The 2024 strategy update sets out a prioritisation of our material ESG categories into three levels, strategic with the highest level of focus, followed by prioritised and foundational.

For strategic categories, we set the highest ambition for Maersk's performance being a differentiator and impact driver. These topics are also tied to executive remuneration as part of the long-term incentive programme. Read more in the Remuneration Report.

Our prioritised ESG categories represent areas which are also closely connected to the impact we have on society, the risks to our business and where we have identified a higher degree of responsibility for acting. Together, the strategic and prioritised categories correspond to our strategic ESG targets. Both have high levels of internal governance and reporting processes, with progress on targets tracked and reported to Executive Leadership Team quarterly.

Our foundational ESG categories represent topics which are essential to our business and are a license to operate. Progress is governed through the wider corporate governance framework, Commit, and accountability resides with functional teams and executive sponsors.

As external measures of progress on our ESG strategy, we engage with select ESG rating providers to help us improve and track performance across the most material ESG aspects. ESG ratings are also a source of insight on stakeholder expectations, and our submissions are valued by customers and investors. We have prioritised those that are most material to our stakeholders and aligned them with our priorities, including EcoVadis, CDP, MSCI and Sustainalytics.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

ESG governance model

Responsibility for ESG and sustainability is anchored with Maersk's Board of Directors, who endorse the overall ESG strategy.

At the Board level, three committees are responsible for ESG-related aspects as reflected in the committee charters:

The ESG Committee's primary purpose is to oversee our strategic ESG direction, acting as a sounding board for the Executive Leadership Teams (ELT) and supporting the Board of Directors with strategy insights into specific ESG matters. The committee meets quarterly to discuss selected ESG topics throughout the year. The ESG Committee also approves the ESG KPIs that are part of the executive remuneration long-term incentive programme.

The Audit Committee oversees external ESG reporting, data quality and internal controls.

The Remuneration Committee reviews the sustainability-linked targets, proposed by the ESG Committee as part of the long-term incentive programme for the Executive Leadership Team. Read more in the Remuneration Report.

At the executive level, dedicated sponsors are allocated to Maersk's material ESG categories. This sponsorship includes driving initiatives forward and accountability to the full ELT and the Board of Directors for the development of and delivering on targets and policies. Responsibility for executing on the ESG strategy resides with the dedicated teams within relevant functional areas reporting to the respective ELT sponsors.

Risk and Compliance Committee

The Risk and Compliance Committee (RCC) is the main executive governance forum for ESG as well as other key risk and compliance processes and topics across Maersk, including our internal Commit governance framework (description below) and the enterprise risk management (ERM) process. The RCC charter was updated during 2024 with a view to strengthening central governance across the strategic ESG categories (climate, safety and DE&I), anchored with the RCC. To facilitate oversight and support decision making for strategic dilemmas and risks through the year, ESG progress updates are compiled quarterly for strategic and prioritised targets and KPIs and biannually across all ESG categories.

ESG governance in A.P. Moller - Maersk in 2024

64 A.P. Moller - Maersk

Annual Report 2024

Performance

governance

Sustainability

Corporate

Financials

These updates, as well as deep dives into strategic ESG categories and regulatory developments are overseen at the quarterly meetings of the RCC and subsequently, if relevant, discussed with the full ELT.

On an operational level, cross-functional steering committees and working groups facilitate coordination, ensuring that relevant functional and business areas are included in strategic decisions and supporting implementation across business areas.

ESG integration in governance and risk frameworks

In addition to the dedicated ESG governance model outlined above, ESG topics are also integrated into other internal governance processes, including Commit, Maersk's governance framework (see box on the right).

Maersk's Employee Code of Conduct and Supplier Code of Conduct outline the standards for our employees and our suppliers.

ESG is integrated into Commit through the Code of Conduct and specific Commit rules in relation to health, safety, security and environment (HSSE), global employee relations, anti-corruption, sustainable procurement as well as data privacy and data ethics. Each rule has a designated owner in the organisation who is responsible for compliance. Progress oversight on implementation and compliance is performed on an ongoing basis through impact and risk assessment such as selfassessment performed for the Global Employee Relations Rule, compliance checks for the Anti-corruption Rule and site inspections for the HSSE Rule. Executive oversight of compliance with Commit is managed through the annual internal assurance process, anchored with the RCC. In addition, the ERM process also incorporates ESG-related risks as part of the annual risk assessment covering the entire business and overseen by the RCC and the Audit Committee.

Managing inorganic changes to the organisation

Acquisitions are important to Maersk's integrated logistics strategy, especially as we look to add capacity and expertise in areas like project logistics and e-commerce to our global portfolio and local coverage. Although we did not make any acquisitions in 2024, ESG considerations remained an active part of our due diligence processes in evaluating potential opportunities during the year.

To ensure that all inorganic growth targets are aligned with our ESG strategy and commitments, we continue strengthening due diligence processes by incorporating ESG risk assessments more systematically into our mergers and acquisitions (M&A) process. We regularly engage with and perform specific trainings for the M&A teams with a view to further embed ESG priorities and climate change impact assessments into the due diligence and investment decision processes.

In 2024, Maersk completed the demerger of Svitzer. In alignment with our accounting policies, ESG data from Svitzer for 2024 is included until the date of demerger.

The three core elements of Commit

Maersk's internal governance framework

Our Commit governance framework sets the foundation for how we work in Maersk to ensure compliance with relevant laws, regulations and responsible business conduct, as well as having adequate risk mitigation. The framework is structured around three core elements:

Our guiding Core Values

have been shaped and strengthened since our foundation in 1904. These were updated in 2022 to ensure that they are consistently interpreted, easy to apply and have a strong connection to our Purpose. Read more on Maersk.com.

Our Code of Conduct

sets global standards for how we engage with colleagues, customers, suppliers, communities, authorities and other stakeholders. The Code of Conduct was updated in 2022 to align with our Purpose and ESG strategy.

21 rules of business ethics, governance and authority

are included in the governance framework, providing detailed internal instructions for all employees covering high-risk areas. These are subject to internal controls and an annual internal assurance process.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

ESRS 2, ESRS - S1, S2, S3

Double materiality assessment

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk)'s ESG strategy and reporting is grounded in a double materiality assessment (DMA) aligned with the ESRS requirements.

In 2024, we updated our corporate-level DMA. The assessment is approved by the ELT sponsors and endorsed by the Audit Committee. In the coming years, we will continue working towards further maturing and refining our assessment in line with best practices and new guidance across our ESG topics.

The impacts, risks and opportunities (IROs) identified as material to Maersk's operations and value chain have been mapped against the disclosure requirements listed in the topical European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS) to identify material information for 2024 reporting. For material IROs already covered by a topical standard, we disclose information listed in the ESRS. For additional entity-specific topics, we have applied the minimum disclosure requirements as a foundation for reporting on policies, actions, targets and metrics. For the index of information covered by this sustainability statement, see pages 57-59.

Maersk's material topics

The updated DMA assessment has not led to any significant change to our overall ESG categories but did result in changes to the material topics that are part of the ESG categories. For example, where we have previously been tracking and externally reporting on water use in our operations, the more in-depth assessment performed in the DMA showed that water use is important but not material to Maersk.

Our material ESG topics comprise further sub-topics driven by the impacts, risks and opportunities identified. The IROs under each of the topics are unfolded in the Environmental, Social and Governance sections of this report. This includes 29 individual IROs.

Climate change remains a key material category to Maersk from an impact and financial perspective. We have identified two major climate-related risks: transitional and physical. Climate transition risk has been part of our enterprise risks for several years. For the assessment physical impact of climate change to our assets, our double materiality assessment has been informed by an in-depth assessment of the physical impact of climate change to our assets across multiple time horizons.

For environment and ecosystems, in 2024 we conducted an assessment of nature-related issues using the Taskforce on Nature-related Financial Disclosures (TNFD) LEAP assessment approach, resulting in a number of changes from our 2023 assessment including a more granular overview of IROs across our operation and value chain (read more on page 77). Based on the LEAP assessment, we have identified IROs related to five material sub-topics: pollution, ecosystem health and biodiversity, waste management, responsible ship recycling and the sourcing of critical resources.

Environmental topics that are financially material to Maersk are mainly driven by a risk of non-compliance to environmental regulations or related to remediation costs towards environmental incidents. Costs related to such environmental incidents are disclosed in the Environment performance data section.

For social topics, the assessment has confirmed that human capital, diversity, equity and inclusion, employee relations and labour rights and safety and security are material categories to Maersk. Most material topics under these categories are material from an impact perspective, however, remediation costs and reputational damage is assessed as also being a material risk to Maersk. Additionally, attraction and retention of critical talents have been deemed financially material as a key enabler to delivering on our business strategy.

While human rights are included as a category in our ESG strategy, they are not called out as standalone IROs in the DMA. This is because human rights issues are integrated across the existing environmental, social and governance topics. The same is the case for impact to affected communities, where impacts on people in local communities can occur across our operations and activities. As an example,

greenhouse gases can impact people's livelihood and wellbeing, and corruption can exacerbate inequalities in societies where we operate. On governance, the assessment also reconfirmed our existing categories on business ethics, sustainable procurement, data and AI ethics and responsible tax. The last two categories are not currently covered by the topical ESRS and are therefore entity-specific. Of the material topics, several risks related to costs of non-compliance to regulations have been deemed material to Maersk, including related to corruption laws, sanctions and transportation of illegal goods. In addition, risks related to data and AI ethics and supplier non-compliance have been assessed as material to our overall strategy.

Of the material risks, none are expected to cause material adjustments to carrying amounts of liabilities reported in the financial statements in the next annual reporting period.

Recognising our global presence and the nature of our business as an integrator of global supply chains, this is not an exhaustive list, however, it shows where Maersk may have the largest impacts on people and planet through our activities, or where Maersk is exposed to the most significant financial risks or opportunities. Many of the topics below the threshold for external reporting are still actively monitored and managed as part of internal processes. As an example, while water use was deemed below the materiality threshold and not covered by our sustainability statement, we continue to actively monitor and work to reduce consumption of water globally, particularly in water-stressed areas. The same is the case for impacts to communities in areas where we operate, where we continue to monitor potential negative impacts and regularly engage with communities as part of e.g. Environmental and Social Impact Assessments (ESIAs), and through local Corporate Social Responsibility (CSR) initiatives under our citizenship programme.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Climate change adaption

Climate change Impact Climate change mitigation Overview of our material categories and topics related to Environment

Environment and ecosystems
Pollution
Ecosystem health and biodiversity
Waste management
Responsible ship recycling
Sourcing of critical resources

Overview of our material categories and topics related to Social

Human capital Impact
Attracting and retaining critical talent

Diversity, equity and inclusion

Harassment of vulnerable groups
Discrimination in the workforce

Safety and security

Safety of our workforce
Exposure to global/local security risks

Employee relations and labour rights

Forced labour
Working hours and adequate wages
Adequate housing and sanitation

Environment Social Governance

Overview of our material categories and topics related to Governance

Business ethics Impact
Legal and regulatory compliance
Grievance and remedy

Sustainable procurement

Supplier relationship management
Payment practices

Data and AI ethics

Ethical use of data and AI
---------------------------- --

Responsible tax

Tax governance
---------------- --

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Double materiality assessment methodology

Value chain mapping

As part of the DMA, we assessed material impacts across all operations and the value chain. Outlined in our integrator strategy, Maersk's business model spans activities within ocean transportation, terminals and logistics and services to connect and simplify customers' supply chains. In our upstream value chain, shipyards, fuel suppliers and equipment manufacturers, commercial partners such as freight forwarders and third-party logistics providers, as well as manning agencies provide essential resources and add extended workforce for our operations. Our downstream value chain includes entities and stakeholders involved in ensuring the final delivery of goods and services to end customers, including retailers and manufacturers, freight forwarders and thirdparty logistics providers, customs and regulatory authorities and port operators, terminals and distribution providers not owned by Maersk. The assessment also extends to the communities that we impact through our operations and workers who are part of our value chain, including our suppliers' workforces, who are not part of Maersk's own or contracted workforce, and workers of joint ventures and associates. To assess impacts in our value chain where visibility and data is limited, we use industry-specific analysis, articles, scientific research and shared knowledge from stakeholders etc., as input to identify high risk areas or operations and vulnerable groups.

No IROs were identified for consumers and end-users due to our business model of providing logistics services to customers (business to business) who are not consumers/end-users as defined in the ESRS.

Time horizons

In the assessment of IROs, we apply the time horizons as per ESRS 1 – short-term being the reporting year and medium-term covering 1-5 years. We have also identified long-term emerging impacts and risks (beyond 5 years). For emerging risks please see Risk management on page 24. In addition, we have identified emerging impacts such as the increased use of water needed for production of biofuels in our value chain.

None of the emerging impacts or risks were deemed material as of this assessment. Acknowledging that materiality is a dynamic process, these emerging impacts or risks are being monitored and tracked as the landscape evolves. Thus, the list of material IROs outlined in the topical sections encompass impacts and risks assessed to have an impact already in the short or medium term. Some of these, such as physical risks of climate change, are also material in the longer term, but since impacts are already apparent, these have been included as either short or medium term IROs.

Identification and assessment of material impacts

To assess impact materiality of ESG topics, a specific scoring sheet has been developed and validated by internal subject-matter experts for each of the 10 topical standards in the ESRS. The scoring of impacts is performed for each identified impact and across our value chain, taking into consideration particular stakeholder groups, areas or operations at higher risk of negative impact, informed by our human rights impact assessment. For example, scoring of social impacts has been performed separately for own employees, non-employee workers and workers in the value chain to best capture impact occurrence for different affected stakeholders in our operations and value chain.

Where available, the scoring utilises existing methodologies and assessments such as Maersk's most recent human rights impact assessments and relevant internal management systems. For environmental impacts, the DMA is informed by a LEAP assessment performed in 2024. As part of this assessment, we identified impacts and dependencies across our business activities, using various databases and scientific studies. Read more on pages 101-102.

Severity (based on scale, scope and the irremediable character) is assessed for each IRO using a scale of 1 to 5. For topics where Maersk has potential impacts, the likelihood of such impacts is also assessed with severity and likelihood each being assigned a 50/50 weighting. For human rights-related topics, severity has an assigned higher weighting (75%) compared to likelihood (25%) when determining impact materiality. A threshold of 3 (out of 5) is applied to capture areas where Maersk has a very significant or critical impact to the environment or people, above which the topic is included in our external reporting.

Identification and assessment of material risks and opportunities

As part of the DMA, we also assess potential sustainability-related risks that can trigger negative financial or reputational impacts to

our business. This includes a consideration of whether the identified impacts and dependencies can also trigger financial risks to Maersk, e.g. reputational damage from impacts on people, or risks from dependencies on access to environmental or human resources.

For climate-related risks, we have assessed our current and future climate-related exposure of assets across different time horizons and climate scenarios. Read more on page 88.

The assessment of risks to Maersk is aligned with our ERM framework and is based on an assessment of magnitude (financial and/or reputational costs) and likelihood. This year, we continued the work initiated in 2023 to quantify ESG risks using scenario-based modelling, where feasible. This includes modelling of both inherent and residual risks, where the inherent risk scores are used as part of the DMA. Application of scenario-based modelling has allowed us to understand the financial risk profile in different scenarios under different assumptions. The risk scores have been assigned based on the scenario, which results in the highest monetary impact. Work to quantify ESG risks will continue as we mature and obtain more solid data as a foundation for the assessment. In addition, we will work towards including modelling of financial opportunities as part of this process going forward.

A quantitative threshold has been set to capture and report on the risks and opportunities with the highest monetary risk exposure. This threshold is lower than that of our ERM process to capture a broader range of potential ESG-related risks to our business.

Engaging with key external stakeholders

The assessment considers the perspectives of key internal and external stakeholders, as well as external experts on for example climate, nature, governance and human rights. This year, we mapped our external stakeholders considering both affected stakeholders and those who are users of the information we publish. Through various engagement channels, we continuously collect valuable insights on topics that are important to stakeholders, which inform our assessment of material impacts and risks and underpin the development of solutions and initiatives in delivering on our ESG commitments and KPIs. During 2025, we will work towards further strengthening our processes for documenting and incorporating external stakeholder perspectives into the double materiality process to ensure that stakeholder perspectives are continuously reflected in our ESG priorities. Read more on pages 70-74.

ESRS 2

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Approach to due diligence

Increasing regulatory requirements are broadening the scope of corporate responsibility, extending beyond a company's own operations to include due diligence and greater transparency across the value chain.

The increasing complexity of regulatory requirements is challenging for many companies with global supply chains, and it will be a journey for A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) to further mature our own processes over the coming years to ensure that human rights and environmental considerations are fully integrated into our due diligence processes and ESG governance mechanisms. We also recognise the opportunities of further embedding due diligence and transparency to support customers across their logistics supply chains and strengthening stakeholders' trust in our brand.

To continue navigating increased expectations, we support regulatory measures that strengthen requirements for responsible business conduct and contribute to a level playing field globally.

Due diligence in Maersk is integrated into multiple internal processes and programmes to identify, prevent and mitigate negative impacts arising from our operations and value chain. Examples of our human rights and environmental due diligence processes include our supplier management approach, mergers and acquisitions (M&A) processes and requirements embedded in the Commit governance framework.

Our long-standing human rights due diligence approach is founded in our Purpose and Core Values and based on the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights, which serve as a north star in navigating global trade's often complex impacts on people. Human rights impacts may occur in different business areas, and we take a risk-based approach to our activities and work to strengthen key due diligence processes that allow us to identify and act upon actual and potential human rights risks for rightsholders.

Please see the illustration for more information on specific parts of our processes related to due diligence.

5

Communicate how impacts are addressed

1 Embed responsible business conduct in operations Our guiding documents - the Employee Code of Conduct and Supplier Code of Conduct, outline our Core Values and policies. See ESG governance

We communicate progress across ESG categories as part of the Annual Report, on our website, and through participation in selected ESG ratings.

4

Track implementation and results

Across ESG categories, we measure progress and track performance against our strategic targets. See relevant ESG chapters Internally, we track progress as part of e.g. quarterly

ESG updates to the Executive Leadership Team, and annual compliance assessment for Commit rules. See ESG governance

2

Identify and assess adverse impacts

Material impacts are identified through the DMA, informed by, e.g. our corporate human rights assessment, and engagement with external stakeholders. See double materiality assessment See stakeholder engagement

6

Providing for remediation when appropriate

We are committed to ensuring our stakeholders have access to grievance and remedy. Access to remedy is a salient human rights issue and focus area for Maersk. See grievance and remedy

3

Cease, prevent or mitigate impact

Material impacts are managed through our ESG categories, and through various cross-topical processes and programmes such as supplier management, the Commit governance framework, and M&A processes. See relevant ESG chapters See ESG governance

69

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

ESRS 2, ESRS S1, S2, S3, E2, E3, E4, E5, G1

Stakeholder engagement

Engagement with key stakeholders provides valuable insights into their perspectives, both from those who might be directly impacted by our activities and those who are users of the information that A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) publishes.

Stakeholder engagement supports us in identifying existing or emerging impacts or risks as part of the double materiality assessment (DMA). Their insights provide valuable input to our ESG programmes, helping us to shape our strategy, targets and decisions towards delivering on ESG commitments and KPIs.

The table on the right shows seven prioritised stakeholder groups. Colleagues and teams across Maersk regularly engage with stakeholder groups through various channels, gathering valuable insights on topics that are important to them. Stakeholder engagement with key external stakeholders such as own workforce and value chain workers is anchored with the relevant business functions across Maersk, depending on the stakeholder group or topic: labour-rights focused engagement is anchored with the Employee Relations and Labour Rights team headed by the Chief People Officer, whereas engagement related to safety is anchored with the Safety and Resilience team headed by the Chief Operating Officer. Management receives regular updates on topics raised by stakeholders and their perspectives. As an example, perspectives raised by e.g. investors and customers are presented to the Executive Leadership Team.

We proactively seek stakeholder opinions through, for example, annual employee and supplier surveys, and with customers through a voice-of-customer process and our annual Strategic Customer Council, as well as dialogues with civil society organisations and unions to gain insights on key industry risks and impacts to workers and communities.

Key external stakeholders and how we engage with them

Stakeholder expectations of Maersk Key engagement channels How stakeholder input is used
Employees,
contingent
workers and
value chain
workers
Meaningful work, fair treatment
and wages, safe working conditions,
a sense of belonging for all, and good
development opportunities.

Daily manager/colleague interactions

Engagement and inclusion surveys

Grievance mechanisms

Engagement with unions and interest groups

Supplier audits
Provide valuable input to ESG programmes and
shape actions and improvement plans to address
any issues.
Customers Solutions that can ensure responsible
business practices and lower supply
chain emissions.

Regular business interactions and ongoing
supplier assessment

Strategic Customer Council and customer
satisfaction surveys

Partnerships and collective action alliances
Informs product development and shapes
solutions. Customer feedback on providing greater
value is directly linked to our integrator strategy.
Authorities,
regulators
and standard
setters
Compliance with regulation and
industry leadership on the trans
formation to net-zero.

Engagement with local, national and
international agencies and authorities

Standard-setter collaboration on topic-specific
research, pilots and implementations

Industry associations, collective action alliances
and strategic partnerships
Ensure we adhere to regulations. Help us identify
opportunities for collaboration and initiatives
across the ESG agenda and to push for regulations
towards industry-wide decarbonisation.
Suppliers
and business
partners
Fair and transparent business
opportunities and partnerships
on strategic issues.

Contract management

Supplier relationship management framework

Supplier surveys, workshops and capability
building programmes

Industry forums and associations
Build understanding of the effectiveness of
supplier practices and engagement. Enhance value
chain visibility, including fair working conditions
and supplier ethical business conduct.
Investors
and analysts
Strategies, plans and actions to
mitigate short and long-term risk
to the business model.

Regular engagement through e.g. earnings calls,
conferences, events, roadshows and meetings,
including the Annual General Meeting

Investor surveys and ESG ratings

Collective action alliances
Helps us understand how the company is perceived
in comparison to other investment opportunities.
ESG ratings additionally help identify gaps in ESG
management and emerging trends.
Local
communities
and nature
Responsibility and accountability
towards material issues in areas
of highest impact.

Environmental and Social Impact Assessments,
Corporate Social Responsibility initiatives

Engagement with community representatives
and employees

Collective action alliances and partnerships

Scientific studies
Local communities help us better understand the
needs and constraints of nature where we operate,
informing decisions to invest and procure resources
and to mitigate negative impacts in operations and
the value chain.
Civil society
organisations
Responsibility and accountability
towards material issues and positive
contributions in areas of highest
impact and leverage.

Bilateral engagement with local, national
and international agencies

Collective action alliances
Access to valuable insights, expertise and best
practices which help us identify potential risks or
opportunities and shape ambitions and actions.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

ESG ratings are also a source of stakeholder expectation insights, and our submissions are valued by customers and investors. We prioritise those that are most material to our stakeholders and align with our priorities, including EcoVadis, CDP, MSCI and Sustainalytics. We actively use these questionnaires to identify gaps in current processes or ambitions and thus inform action plans across ESG topics.

We proactively engage in cross-industry partnerships and coalitions to set standards, develop solutions and drive common agendas across the ESG agenda such as the UN Global Compact, Smart Freight Centre, SteelZero initiative, the World Business Council for Sustainable Development, and the Zero Emission Port Alliance. Such proactive engagement is core to our ESG strategy, and in recent years we have seen significant growth in engagement requests.

We welcome perspectives raised by stakeholders, and have regular dialogues on topics raised by customers, civil society organisations and investors, etc. These perspectives provide valuable insight into how our ambitions and decisions are received, and enable us to engage in constructive dialogue with our stakeholders.

During 2024, we worked to strengthen the format for directly collecting and incorporating external stakeholder perspectives into the double materiality process, ensuring that these perspectives are continuously reflected in our ESG priorities. This work began with an in-depth mapping of the current approach to engagement, to assess whether it effectively captures our stakeholders' perspectives. Based on this mapping, we identified a need for a more structured approach to the collection and documentation of the input received from our stakeholders, ensuring that we leverage existing channels to raise the right questions and document the inputs received.

We regularly perform more targeted engagement towards specific groups or on specific topics. For example, we conducted an Inclusion Survey in 2024 to gain perspectives from vulnerable or underrepresented groups in our workforce on potential negative impacts related to diversity, equity and inclusion. In 2025, we will continue this work with the aim of conducting more in-depth engagements on specific ESG topics to help shape future ambitions. In 2024, we also held highlevel talks with the International Transport Workers' Federation, to discuss collaboration opportunities for 2025, focused on contracted labour. The collaboration will focus on two key topics: future of work and diversity, equity and inclusion.

Engagement with local communities

Our operations can impact people in local communities and their natural surroundings, highlighting a responsibility to proactively engage with communities or their representatives. This engagement is crucial as a license to operate and to understand the needs and conditions in the areas, informing decisions to invest and make meaningful contributions to the societies where we operate.

As part of new infrastructure projects, landside projects are reviewed under the Environmental and Social Impact Assessment (ESIA) screening process to understand the environmental and social sensitivities of new projects and existing operations. The ESIA process is based on legal requirements and international standards around conducting such assessments. It provides location-specific context on environmental and social impacts and is the first step towards managing the impacts of our operations and growth projects. For each ESIA screening, the scope of the project is reviewed against ten environmental criteria using global and regional data sources.

Local and indigenous knowledge, as well as nature-based solutions and restoration initiatives, have yet to be widely incorporated into broader commitments and actions addressing biodiversity and ecosystems. Currently, they are confined to specific local projects. For example, APM Terminals supports a local conservation initiative in the Monarch Butterfly Biosphere Reserve in Mexico, where scientists observed a significant decrease in the eastern migratory populations in 2024, as habitat loss remains a significant threat. Local and indigenous knowledge is essential for this project as it provides practical insights into local ecosystems and effective conservation methods used by local communities.

Political engagement and responsible lobbying

Maersk is actively involved in shaping policy and regulatory discussions at both global and regional levels to accelerate the decarbonisation of the maritime and logistics industries. Decarbonising our operations is a core ESG commitment and to achieve our targets, we are dependent on the implementation of supporting regulation. We work actively with political engagement and lobbying as opportunities to support our climate ambitions and to positively impact the industry's transition to net-zero.

Maersk's climate policy outreach is conducted in line with the goals of the Paris Agreement. At the International Maritime Organization (IMO) level, Maersk is actively working for the adoption of ambitious, proportional and enforceable mid-term measures, including a greenhouse gas (GHG) price and a global fuel standard or a combination hereof. Moreover, Maersk calls for any IMO measure to take into consideration just and equitable transition and secure that the collection of revenue benefits developing nations in their energy transition.

2025 marks a crucial milestone for the IMO, as a global carbon pricing mechanism and a global fuel standard are expected to be approved. These initiatives are essential for closing the cost gap between fossil and green fuels, to drive the shipping industry's energy transition and to align with Maersk's broader goal of achieving netzero emissions by 2040.

Maersk actively participated in key global meetings during the year, including for example the New York Climate Week and COP29, emphasising the need for stronger global commitments to maritime decarbonisation. Maersk's CEO, Vincent Clerc, was one of over 100 CEOs and senior executives to call on world leaders ahead of COP29 to enact policies that support the scaling-up of green fuel production and renewable energy infrastructure, while ensuring a just and equitable transition.

At the EU level, Maersk has called for the full implementation of the 'Fit for 55' legislative package, which includes the EU Emissions Trading System (ETS) and the FuelEU Maritime Regulation. Maersk has pushed for the inclusion of container terminals in the ETS and advocated for an end-date for fossil fuel-only newbuild vessels. These measures aim to bridge the cost gap between green and fossil fuels and accelerate the energy transition across the shipping sector.

On landside transportation, Maersk is working for robust EU regulation to promote electrification of road transportation.

Maersk adheres to policies and procedures to ensure responsible lobbying. The company is part of the EU Transparency Register (registration number 680443918500-51), in relation to policies on climate, tax, customs, competition, trade, company law and corporate governance and general industry-related policies.

"We have bold, ambitious targets for decarbonising our value chain and know that we can't do it alone. We need the right partners to help us get there. Maersk shares Nike's commitment to building a responsible supply chain and recognises the importance of long-term partnerships for driving scale and true global impact."

Venkatesh Alagirisamy Chief Supply Chain Officer, NIKE

We perform risk-based management integrity screenings of thirdparties who interact with government officials on Maersk's behalf or procure business for Maersk. Additionally, hiring managers may not offer employment, directorships or internships to anyone employed or formerly employed (in the last three years) by the government or being a close relative to such a person without approval from Compliance. This is outlined in our Commit Business Ethics Rule.

In general, Maersk does not provide any financial or in-kind dona tions to politicians, regulators or political parties. In Denmark, Maersk is a member of large trade associations such as Danish Shipping and Danish Industry, which may allocate political contributions on behalf of their member organisations and sectors. These contributions are determined and distributed directly by the associations. In the US, Maersk has established a Political Action Committee (PAC) where dona tions are voluntary contributions made by individuals, corporations or unions to support candidates, parties or issues, and are subject to strict limits and reporting requirements to ensure full compliance with federal and state regulations. In 2024, the amount donated through the PAC was USD 15k, and no other financial or in-kind political donations were provided by Maersk.

Engaging with customers

Customers are at the centre of our business and ESG strategy, and we actively collaborate with them also on sustainability and ESG issues to shape solutions, enhance our practices and achieve shared goals. The core focus of our engagement with customers relates to decarbonisa tion. Adapting our solutions to meet the unique decarbonisation needs of different customer segments is key to our customer engagement. For example, customer feedback has led to the development of a blended green and fossil fuel product in ECO Delivery Ocean, through the use of different levels of lower-emission and fossil fuel-based fuels, to meet different customer needs and price sensitivities while still supporting decarbonisation.

Across many segments, customers have an appetite for logistics partners that are at least as ambitious on decarbonisation as them selves and offer credible solutions to make those ambitions a reality. As an example, Primark ships most of its products by ocean, and through our partnership, Maersk is now moving some of Primark's ocean cargo on lower-emission fuels such as biodiesel and biomethanol. In addition, the first large dual-fuel methanol vessels joined our fleet in 2024, and our customers Nissan, Vestas, Nike and Primark joined us as godparents for vessel-naming events, emphasising the importance of partnerships.

Customers' demand for end-to-end decarbonised logistics has prompted Maersk to develop more inland solutions, including electric trucks and rail options in multiple countries. For example, in the US, Maersk is collaborating with Microsoft and Pepsi, the Smart Freight Centre and other partners to launch a shipper-carrier coalition to accelerate heavy-duty EV deployment, including a long-haul EV testing corridor between California and Texas.

The majority of logistics GHG emissions in some industries (i.e. automotive and chemical companies) come from ocean transporta tion, whereas others have emission hotspots from their air and inland logistics, i.e. fashion, consumer goods and tech companies. Never theless, we see a trend of fashion and fast-moving consumer goods leading the engagement of ocean decarbonisation, highlighting their maturity in this field. These segments are closer to end consumers, and their logistics are more visible and therefore more attractive to decarbonise.

Performance

Corporate governance Cutting air freight GHG emissions is one of the most challenging tasks in decarbonising logistics. Air freight is also a vital and integrated part of many automotive, technology and lifestyle supply chains. Customers in these segments have partnered with us on ECO Delivery Air, using sustainable aviation fuel to reduce emissions for their air freight shipments.

Like Maersk, many customers are looking at emissions in their value chains and aim to incorporate ESG metrics as part of their procurement processes and science-based target setting. To support these needs, Maersk has developed an emissions dashboard solution.

Maersk's annual Strategic Customer Council is a key engagement channel and platform for collaborating with our customers' executive leadership, taking a joint problem-solving approach to decarbonisation at a systemic level, including joint lobbying towards IMO member states to balance the price gap of lower-emission and fossil fuels.

We see a positive trend in the maturity of our customers' sustainability approach – moving from a transactional procurement activity, towards partnerships and collaboration with strategic suppliers. Customer dialogues in 2024 spanned across several topics of interest for future collaborations, including regulatory engagements, circularity, simplifying the complexity of decarbonisation data visibility and comparability, challenges to the execution of decarbonisation strategies and the overall resilience of supply chains.

Citizenship

Maersk's corporate citizenship is rooted in meaningful engagement with our partners and communities, and aligned with our Purpose, Core Values and stakeholder expectations. We assume an active responsibility to support the societies where we operate by partnering with local communities, non-profit organisations and customers on social and environmental causes. Leveraging our global reach, expertise and resources, we aim to co-deliver impactful solutions and achieve shared goals effectively.

Donations and social investments

Maersk supports select stakeholder initiatives through donations and investments in social and environmental well-being, guided by corporate guidelines. Our in-kind and financial support aims to address

critical needs connected to five priority causes: disaster relief and preparedness, empowering people to trade, protecting the natural environment and oceans, education and health and safety.

Maersk collaborated with a diverse range of organisations in 2024, supporting local initiatives in over 30 countries. Our efforts are designed to create sustainable and positive change, enhancing community well-being and contributing to better futures.

2024 was marked by record flooding across many regions. During the year, Maersk supported flood relief efforts in Vietnam, Guatemala, Brazil, Kenya and the US through a mix of delivering water and relief supplies, and by donating essential supplies and relief item storage containers.

Our support of education and training programmes in 2024 included improving educational infrastructure and supporting skills development and capacity-building activities, from providing technical learning scholarships in Peru to a container library project in Vietnam.

Corporate partnerships

Maersk engages in strategic partnerships that demonstrate effective multi-stakeholder cooperation between the private and public sectors. These leverage our expertise and resources to address global challenges connected to our industry, but also enhance our knowledge, capabilities and stakeholder relationships. Partnerships further support our prioritised causes of disaster response and trade empowerment. Maersk is a member of the United Nations-led Logistics Emergency Teams (LET) along with logistics peers, who join forces to provide pro bono support and consultation services during humanitarian crises and natural disasters. Working under UN auspices and in collaboration with other key stakeholders allows us to put our experience, network and assets to the best use and reach those in need in a coordinated and efficient way.

In 2024, the LET actively coordinated regional aid and relief efforts in response to the ongoing conflict and resulting humanitarian emergency in Gaza. Maersk established a 5,000 m² logistics hub in Amman, Jordan, which serves as a consolidation centre to assist over 50 UN partner and humanitarian NGOs and governments delivering cargo to Gaza. This in-kind donation is ongoing and will extend through 2025.

Since 2018, Maersk has partnered with the International Trade Centre's SheTrades initiative to advance women's economic empowerment through trade. This year's collaboration focused on fostering sustainable and inclusive trade practices and advocating for public-private

partnerships to promote gender inclusivity. For example, Maersk participated in a panel at a World Trade Organization - International Trade Centre event aimed at inspiring governments and the private sector to take bolder actions in supporting women's economic empowerment, particularly around issues impacting the supply chains of women-led businesses in developing countries. We also took part in a webinar series to support women- and youth-led micro, small, and mediumsized enterprises (MSMEs) in building resilient supply chains. This involved sharing knowledge on sustainable business practices, including human rights considerations and managing increasingly complex ESG due diligence and trade.

Engaging our own workforce

Our annual internal Go Green campaign was maintained in 2024. It aims to engage colleagues on environmental stewardship topics, raise awareness and create a platform for collective action across Maersk and with the communities where we operate. This year's theme, 'Nothing goes to waste', focused on waste management best practices and how they tie into our ESG goals. Employees in over 35 locations participated in local learning events on waste, recycling and other sustainability topics, and a number of local on- and off-site volunteer events took place including trash clean-ups and recycling competitions.

Grievance and remedy

Maersk fosters a 'speak up' up culture where anyone is encouraged to voice concerns. This is enshrined in our Code of Conduct along with a zero-tolerance, non-retaliation policy. Multiple channels are available for employees and other stakeholders to raise concerns. As a key process anchored in the Commit framework, the whistleblower programme has been available for decades and aims to create a safe and secure environment for anyone to speak up and report violations without fear of retaliation. Whistleblower reporting is independently managed on a third-party platform, and complete confidentiality is maintained along with the option of anonymous reporting. This is supported by effective investigations led by independent, objective and impartial investigators and by ensuring appropriate follow-up action to address violations and implement controls to avoid repetition of undesirable behaviour.

Performance Corporate

governance

The investigators follow a standard investigation procedure, outlined in our misconduct reports and investigation process. This includes complying with local laws and data privacy considerations.

Considering the global nature of our business, the whistleblower site is accessible in all countries where Maersk operates, and phone lines are available in 75 languages. The channel is publicly available on Maersk.com and integral in both our Employee Code of Conduct and Supplier Code of Conduct. It is open to everyone, including employees, suppliers and other external affected stakeholders.

In addition to the whistleblower channel, other internal channels are available for our employees to ask questions or raise concerns – such as direct management or leaders, our Compliance, People or Ombuds functions and an employee assistance programme.

Maersk's internal Ombuds function acts as a neutral, independent, informal and confidential function providing another voice for employees who do not feel comfortable with other channels. The Ombuds function offers a voluntary safe place for employees to seek guidance, voice concerns or discuss options for any work-related matter.

Speaking up

We actively monitor the number of cases raised across stakeholder groups, including from our workforce, workers in the value chain, affected communities and consumers as this gives us an indication of the level of awareness and trust of our whistleblower channel and the strength of our speak up culture. In addition, our 2024 inclusion survey included questions around employees' trust in the grievance mechanisms available. Several improvement areas were identified and are being addressed through initiatives by the Compliance function.

Periodic campaigns like Speak Up are carried out for all Maersk employees, and training projects are rolled out for investigators. Considering the distinct nature of our seafaring workforce, awareness programmes are ongoing as part of the larger cultural transformation for our crews and prevention of unique risks at sea. In 2024, the Speak Up campaign also focused on warehouse and terminal workers and covered 300 entities.

In 2024, Maersk saw a significant rise in whistleblower reports, receiving 1,387 cases – a 20% increase from the 1,154 cases in 2023. This surge reflects the success of our awareness initiatives and underscores the critical role of reporting in maintaining transparency and

accountability. By encouraging and facilitating whistleblower reports, we ensure that issues are promptly addressed, fostering a culture of integrity and trust within our organisation. 84% of the cases received in 2024 have been closed. In particular, we have seen an increase in cases related to HR-related matters. As part of this category, two cases of discrimination on protected grounds were substantiated and resulted in respectively disciplinary action and policy/process review, respectively. In 2024, we also started tracking human rights incidents which are inherently severe, including cases related to e.g. forced labour, human trafficking or child labour. No such cases were recorded for 2024.

Ensuring access to remedy

Maersk is committed to providing remedy in cases that have caused or contributed to an adverse negative impact, including related to human rights. We continue working towards strengthening processes for providing remedy to affected stakeholders, including our own workforce, workers in the value chain and affected communities.

We collaborate with both judicial and non-judicial mechanisms to provide access to remedy if allegations are reported externally. Where Maersk is directly linked to impacts through our business relationships, we are committed to using our leverage to provide remedy.

Issues raised are addressed and documented and feedback is shared with key stakeholders, including the annual submission of a comprehensive whistleblower report to the Audit Committee and the Risk and Compliance Committee. This includes key performance measures such as the number of cases reported, number of cases closed, type of cases, case outcome, actions taken and benchmark analysis. For own employees, Maersk ensures a 24-hour availability to the employee assistance programme which offers psychological, legal and financial support to employees.

Percentage Closed whistleblower reports

ESG COMMITMENTS

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

A.P. Moller - Maersk is taking a leading role in decarbonising logistics and in providing green solutions to assist our customers reach their climate goals.

A.P. Moller - Maersk strives to provide a safe and inspiring environment for our people to grow, develop and thrive as a diverse and global team.

Environment Social Governance

At A.P. Moller - Maersk, high standards of responsible business practices are foundational for the services we deliver to customers and the value we create for the communities where we operate.

GO TO ENVIRONMENT GO TO SOCIAL GO TO GOVERNANCE

GO TO SOCIAL
-------------- --

75

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Environment

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) is taking a leading role in decarbonising logistics and in providing solutions to assist our customers reach their climate goals. Learn more about our progress, including newly validated science-based targets for 2030 and 2040, and how we minimise our impact on the natural environment.

CLIMATE CHANGE

  • Targets by 2030
    • 35% absolute reduction in total scope 1 emissions
    • 100% renewable electricity sourcing
    • 22% absolute reduction in total scope 3 emissions
  • Net-zero targets by 2040
    • 96% absolute reduction in total scope 1 and 2 emissions
    • 90% absolute reduction in total scope 3 emissions

ENVIRONMENT AND ECOSYSTEMS

Ongoing ambition Maersk takes constant care to ensure our operations and value chain minimise and pre vent impacts to the environment and to people, and we align our operations with local laws and regulations to ensure compliance with environ mental requirements. Our overall objective is to do as little harm as possible while safeguarding the environment, including protecting the eco systems and habitats where we operate.

PERFORMANCE DATA

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Environment Climate change adaptation

Overview of our material impacts, risks and opportunities related to Environment.

Negative impact

Financial risk

Financial opportunity

Climate change

Climate change mitigation

Greenhouse gases emitted from our operations, suppliers and business partners in the value chain

Our operations and value chain activities result in direct and indirect emissions of greenhouse gases (GHG) impacting the environment. Climate change caused by emission of GHGs may also have adverse negative impacts on people's livelihoods and well-being and on nature/biodiversity. Value chain Time Short term

Transition risks related to policies and market demand for decarbonisation of the shipping industry

Lack of political and market support for decarbonisation of the shipping industry present a reputational risk to Maersk of not being able to transition fast enough to meet our sciencebased targets.

Climate advocacy/lobbying for policy interventions on energy transition in shipping and logistics

Financial opportunity related to stricter and more ambitious regulation towards industry-wide decarbonisation and a just and equitable transition to support our decarbonisation commitments. Value chain Time Medium term

Financial risks due to physical impacts of climate change to assets and operations

Financial exposure of our assets towards climate-related physical risks/hazards and disruption of operations and networks.

Environment and ecosystems

Pollution

Air pollutants from vessels and landside/air transportation Adverse impacts on air quality due to emissions of NOx, SOx, PM, BC, CO and NMVOCs, primarily from our vessels.

Pollution from hydrocarbon spills from vessels and landside operations and from containers lost at sea

Adverse impacts to the environment and people related to hydrocarbon spills to the ocean, aquifers and soil from vessels and at our land-based facilities, and impacts from the loss of containers at sea, resulting in the release of pollutants into the ocean and accompanying costs for Maersk to clean up polluting materials.

Discharged wastewater to the sea (e.g. scrubber, bilge, sewage and grey water)

Adverse impacts arising from the discharge of wastewater from vessels, including scrubber water, bilge water, cargo bilge water, wash water, grey water, treated and untreated sewage and boiler water.

Ecosystem health and biodiversity

Disturbance of species due to vessel traffic and underwater radiated noise

Vessel speed, underwater noise and disturbances from concentrated ship traffic can disrupt ecosystems and species, negatively affecting the development and reproduction of marine species. These impacts may lead to biodiversity loss and direct harm to species, such as whales.

Where

Own operation Time Short term

Where Own operation Value chain Time Short term

Where Own operation Value chain Time Short term

Where Own operation Value chain Time Short term

Where Own operation Value chain Time Short term

Ecosystem degradation and biodiversity loss caused by land use and habitat disruption resulting from construction and operation of land-based assets The construction and operations of warehouses and

terminals can harm biodiversity and ecosystems, particularly when these are located in biodiversity-sensitive areas.

Spread of invasive species

Adverse impact of vessels transporting organisms (via biofouling) spread across large areas. The spread of invasive alien species can lead to the disruption of coastal ecosystems and contribute to the spread of disease.

Where Own operation Value chain

Time Short term

Where Own operation Value chain

Where Own operation Value chain Time Short term

Where Value chain Time Short term

Time Short term

Waste management

Waste generation during operations

Adverse impact related to waste generation and disposal from operations, particularly in locations with inadequate waste management infrastructure.

Responsible ship recycling

Environmental impacts during decommissioning of vessels

Adverse impacts related to breaking and recycling of own vessels, including waste generation and pollution as well as worker safety. Inability to recycle ships due to regulatory changes or increased number of vessels in the pipeline can also pose a financial risk to Maersk through increased cost of recycling.

Sourcing of critical resources

Environmental impacts resulting from the steel value chain

Actual and potential adverse impact from the procurement of non-recycled steel for production of containers and vessels. The impacts are related to pollution, water use, ecosystem degradation, disturbance of species and potential biodiversity loss.

Environmental impacts resulting from the fossil fuel and biofuel value chain

Actual and potential adverse impact from the procurement of fossil-based fuels and biofuels. The impacts are related to pollution, water use, ecosystem degradation, disturbance of species and potential biodiversity loss.

Where

Value chain Time Short term

Where Value chain

Time Short term

Own operation Value chain Time Medium term

Where Own operation

78

The

Climate change

ESRS – E1, S3

In early 2024, A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) reached an important milestone with validated science-based targets. A major focus this year has been on further refine the transition plan and driving the investments and actions needed to take us from where we are today to where we need to be in 2030 and 2040 to meet those targets.

Much like the preceding year, 2024 brought ample evidence that the world is facing a climate emergency, impacting not only the environment and broader nature, but also people's health and economic prosperity. As an industry leader, we consider it our obligation to take decisive action to reach net-zero greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions across our operations, to the benefit of our customers and society at large, and to our shareholders and our business by mitigating transition risks. This is the core of our environmental commit ment, 'we will take leadership in the decarbonisation of logistics'.

2024 was a year marked by headwinds from externalities that had a significant impact on the entire trans portation and logistics sector including Maersk and our ability to reduce GHG emissions during the year. We remain optimistic about our ability to decarbonise and the path ahead, but we are also realistic that we will face many hurdles along the way in meeting our science-based targets.

-

Commercial shipping attacks in the Red Sea and Gulf of Aden continued re-routing Asia-Europe trade around the Cape of Good Hope to ensure the safety of people, vessels and cargo. This led to longer voyages, capacity shortages and port congestion, all of which contributed to higher fuel consumption and GHG emissions.

In addition, the year's overall geopolitical climate – including increased protectionism and election cycles in countries with high GHG emissions – created uncertainty and, in some cases, headwinds for climate action. Rising raw material costs, higher shipping expenses and increasing interest rates further challenged our customers' decarbonisation action in 2024.

Regulatory debates also continue to impact our sector, as consensus and action on several topics critical to the energy transition remain elusive. While there has been promising regional progress such as Fuel EU Maritime starting in 2025 and the US Inflation Reduction Act, more ambitious and impactful policies are urgently needed at a global level, with the support of the International Maritime Organization (IMO) and its member states. 2025 is a pivotal year for IMO policy setting, and the outcomes of IMO Marine Environment Protection Committee meetings in April and October will have a significant impact on the decarbonisation progress of Maersk, our customers and the industry as a whole in the coming years.

In 2024, we made progress in the areas of our operations that to a greater extent are within our control, while focusing on stakeholder engagement and advocacy for areas with greater external dependencies. These are unfolded in detail in our transition plan.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

  • Scope 3 emissions
  • Scope 1 emissions
  • GHG removals

Scope 2 emissions Climate transition plan towards 2030

GHG emissions, m tonnes CO2e/year

A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024 1 Maersk's transition plan from 2030 to 2040 will include a continued focus on energy efficiency and fuel shifts and the impacts of dependencies such as regulation, technology and market growth. The plan will be unfolded further in the coming years.

2 Residual emissions will be neutralised in accordance with the net-zero criteria of the Science Based Targets initiative.

Performance

Corporate governance

Climate transition plan

Maersk's climate transition plan outlines the key levers and scenarios to reach our science-based commitments for 2030 taking into consideration key uncertainties and complexities. The plan encompasses GHG emissions from our own operations and value chain, covering our end-to-end logistics customer offerings across ocean, land and air. Our approach is focused on business integration and investments in levers where we have higher control, and stakeholder engagement and lobbying for levers more dependent on externalities, including regulatory progress and our customers' willingness to buy, as well as local standards, technology and infrastructure.

Our transition plan, illustrated on the previous page, encompasses two fundamental decarbonisation drivers – efficiency measures and energy shifts. The first two levers relate to the energy efficiency of our network and assets, which combined represent our biggest reduction potential and areas where we have higher degree of control over actions needed to decarbonise. As we mature on our journey and enhance our assessments, we have seen that the efficiency of our network and assets can play a much more prominent role in meeting our near-term targets towards 2030. Our focus in the coming years will therefore include a higher emphasis on efficiency measures that can deliver tangible reductions towards our 2030 targets. Efficiency, however, will not in itself take us all the way to our net-zero greenhouse gas target, and fuel shifts will play an important role, in particular from 2030 to 2040. Looking beyond 2030, Maersk will continue to apply key levers related to efficiency measures and energy shifts to deliver our 2040 long-term targets. However, uncertainty remains in regard to e.g. further developments of international policies and standards, developments in the fuel market, and advancement of new technologies, all of which are key dependencies for Maersk to deliver on its long-term targets.

Network efficiency relates to Maersk's Ocean network including the Gemini network, and asset efficiency includes our owned and timechartered vessels and our ongoing fleet renewal plan.

The three energy shift-related levers focus on the transition from fossil fuels to lower emissions energy solutions such as alternative marine fuels or electrified solutions.

Aligning our roadmap to the Science Based Targets initiative pathway

The Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi) is a widely adopted framework for setting corporate climate targets in line with the 2015 Paris Agreement's pathway limiting global temperature rising to 1.5°C. In 2024, Maersk announced the validation of our climate targets by the SBTi as the first in the shipping industry in alignment with a 1.5°C pathway for 2030 and the 2040 net-zero standard.

For the first time, we are this year reporting progress against these targets consisting of absolute reduction targets for scope 1, 2 and 3 emissions across Maersk, with required sub-targets for certain operations and GHG sources – in particular related to ocean activities as we follow the maritime sector framework. The sub-targets for maritime operations cover well-to-wake emissions, including emissions relating to the entire process from fuel production and delivery to the actual combustion onboard the vessels.

We continue to internally track and externally report on strategic KPIs on efficiency in our Ocean business and the commercial uptake of the ECO Delivery Ocean product, as these metrics are indicators towards our intended outcomes and closely tied to operational and financial planning.

The SBTi framework poses some challenges which Maersk is raising in external dialogues, including directly with the SBTi, in particular relating to accounting for growth and applying Book & Claim mechanisms.

The current methodology allows for recalculation of the baseline if a company grows as a result of acquisitions, but this is not allowed when growth happens organically as a result of growing market share. Maersk's view is that further nuances should be introduced in the treatment of organic growth in methodologies by distinguishing between increased market activity owing to market growth versus the capture of market share with no increase in market activity. This is because the capture of market share by a company will result in the decrease in market share for another if market activity is unchanged, leading to marginal effects on GHG emissions emitted into the atmosphere for the same activity depending on individual efficiencies of companies.

SBTi currently lacks recognition for Book and Claim/market-based mechanisms. In a rapidly evolving market with exponential demand for green fuels, we see a need to rapidly address the lack of guidance and consideration of such mechanisms. Regulatory frameworks already use this to operationalise fuel policy (e.g. the Renewable Fuel Standard in the US), and it is widely used and accepted in regulated and voluntary electricity markets, such as the EU, US and India. SBTi has started a call for evidence in 2023/2024 and we look forward to more clear guidance on this topic in 2025.

To meet our net-zero target by 2040, we plan to neutralise unabated emissions. According to our transition plan, we expect to have 6.2m tonnes of residual GHG emissions annually by 2040 that we will need to neutralise in accordance with SBTi Net-Zero criteria. The SBTi Corporate Net-Zero Standard is currently undergoing revision. While we await clearer guidance on beyond value chain mitigation and the neutralisation of residual emissions, we continue to evaluate opportunities for the use of carbon credits and Natural Climate Solutions (NCS).

While electrification of owned assets has a relatively lower contri bution to the transition plan, it is the core lever to reducing scope 1 emissions in our logistics and terminal operations, as well as scope 2 emissions when renewable electricity is available from local grids. In Logistics & Services and APM Terminals businesses, we have direct control over the electrification of sites and owned assets; however, we need to work across a fragmented landscape with different tech nologies, infrastructure, partners and policies that often require site or country-specific roadmaps.

The electrification of non-owned assets includes all of our landside transportation solutions, but in particular vehicles of third-party truck ing partners. Our ability to decarbonise is highly dependent on the readiness of local grids to support increased electrification demand and their degree of renewable integration.

Lastly, the fuel shift lever has a prime focus on reducing scope 1 emissions from our vessels. The shift to alternative marine fuels like biodiesel, green methanol and biomethane is especially dependent on externalities which are currently slowing the scaling of infrastructure and capacity. Most notably, global regulations are needed through the IMO for green fuel standards, fossil fuel phase-out timelines and the implementation of effective mid-term measures to close the signifi cant cost gap between fossil fuels and green fuels.

In 2025, the IMO aims to reach agreements on these topics. The outcomes of those decisions will significantly impact the industry,

Incorporating social impacts into the transition plan

Maersk's transition plan is underpinned by policies and govern ance to address the social implications of our decarbonisation activities. These include, for example, the impact of electrifi cation on our workforce, and the risks of adverse effects from green fuel market development on local communities. Our sus tainability due diligence focuses on environmental and social impacts, including human rights and social safeguards, and Maersk has reserved rights for independent audits as part of offtake agreements during construction and production of methanol facilities.

our customers' ability to pay for decarbonisation and the pace of the energy transition. Our transition plan considers three possible scenarios of ascending ambition, pessimistic, base case and optimistic, each with different implications for green fuel scaling and demand and therefore a corresponding need to adapt our transition plan.

The levers and the current actions supporting our progress are unfolded in the respective sections of this chapter, with greater details on our impacts, risks and opportunities.

Unallocated opportunities pertain to emission reduction measures that rely on consensus in international policies and standards such as SBTi for their successful implementation. Maersk endeavours to con tinue engaging with policymakers and standard setters in 2025 to unlock unallocated opportunities for our climate transition plan.

Embedding the transition plan into business strategy and financial planning

Reaching our climate ambitions is core to our ESG strategy and part of the annual business planning process. As such, the required capital and operational expenditures (CAPEX and OPEX) to pursue our climate targets and roadmap is allocated as part of the business strategy and financial planning for the relevant business segments, e.g. the financ ing of our new fleet of green methanol dual-fuel vessels, ongoing fleet renewal activities and investments in battery-electric container handling equipment. For more information about CAPEX and OPEX allocated to the transition plan, please see the respective sections on the decar bonisation levers.

Progress towards our strategic KPIs is reviewed quarterly by the Executive Leadership Team (ELT) and the Board of Directors. Respon sibility for the transition plan and execution resides with the Chief Operating Officer as outlined in our ESG governance model. The ELT and the Board of Directors are involved in discussions around current and upcoming key trends and market developments, progress against our science-based targets and the potential impact of different IMO agreement scenarios to further integrate our energy transition into business planning.

Since 2021, Maersk has had in place an internal shadow price of USD 75 per tonne of GHG for investment decisions. The price was deter mined in 2021 based on an analysis of the existing abatement costs and expectations towards future carbon taxes. This internal price is not

81

Performance

Corporate governance applied to actual emissions but is used for projections to ensure that future regulations and carbon costs are considered in all investment committee decisions.

Our Green Finance Framework is essential to ensuring that our transition plan is properly funded. The Framework allows Maersk to use a variety of financial instruments to fund projects that deliver positive impact to the environment and progress towards our targets. The Framework aligns closely with the EU Taxonomy, covering categories such as new build vessels, retrofitted vessels, warehouses, terminals and electrified equipment, and it includes both CAPEX and OPEX. Read more on the 2024 Green Finance Framework. In addition to supporting our transition and business plans, the Framework also builds investor trust through its alignment with recognised criteria by showing our commitment to sustainable investments.

EU Taxonomy reporting

The EU Taxonomy is a classification system for which economic activities can be considered environmentally sustainable. It is a cornerstone of the EU's sustainable finance framework and an important market transparency tool, defining criteria for economic activities that are aligned with a trajectory of net-zero GHG emissions by 2050 and broader environmental goals beyond climate. Since 2021, Maersk has provided EU Taxonomy reporting, and from 2024, Maersk is required to disclose its EU Taxonomy reporting as part of CSRD reporting in relation to our climate transition plan. As a transport and logistics company, we are engaged in the activities under the EU Taxonomy that are listed on this page.

The full overview of the results of Maersk's taxonomy screening for 2024, which can be found on pages 96-100, confirms that the company has a significant opportunity to substantially contribute towards climate change mitigation. Although taxonomy-aligned activities continue to increase, Maersk is still in the early stages of its journey to decarbonise the end-to-end value chain. We therefore, see a high share of eligible revenue, CAPEX and OPEX, but a significantly lower share of revenue, CAPEX and OPEX, related to taxonomyaligned activities. As aligned assets come into operation, we see a modest, gradual increase of taxonomy-aligned revenue and a continued, steady increase in the taxonomy-aligned CAPEX in line with our decarbonisation strategy and transition plan going forward.

Activities included in Maersk's EU Taxonomy reporting Revenue CAPEX OPEX
Ocean
6.10 Sea and coastal freight water transport
Aligned revenue in the Ocean segment is related to 40 conventional vessels as
well as our first eight dual-fuel vessels that meet the technical screening
criteria. Aligned CAPEX relates to 1) capital expenses in relation to existing vessels;
and 2) milestone payments for the ordered dual-fuel vessels incurred during
the year. Aligned OPEX is the repair and maintenance expenditures in relation
to aligned vessels incurred during the year.
6.12 Retrofitting of sea and coastal freight and passenger water transport
Aligned CAPEX represents efforts to improve our existing fleet with regards
to efficiency and dual-fuel capabilities.
Logistics & Services
6.2 Freight rail transport
6.6 Freight transport services by road
6.19 Passenger and freight air transport
Freight transport by rail, road and air are anchored within Maersk's Logistics &
Services segment. Only freight done by electrified assets is considered aligned
in relation to rail and road transport. Non-eligible activities within the Logistics
& Services segment relate to supply chain management and e-commerce.
Terminals
6.16 Infrastructure enabling low-carbon water transport
Aligned revenue, CAPEX and OPEX in the Terminals segment represents efforts to
decarbonise port infrastructure, supporting ocean-based transportation, and are
linked to electrical equipment used to operate the terminals, including cranes, trucks
and lifts, charging stations as well as onsite renewable electricity installations.
Non-eligible activities relate to terminal concession rights and operational software.
Cross segments
7.7 Acquisition and ownership of buildings
7.6 Installation, maintenance and repair of renewable energy technologies
Aligned CAPEX represents investments into on-site renewable electricity
installations across all business segments
7.4 Installation, maintenance and repair of charging stations
Aligned CAPEX represents investments into charging stations across
all business segments

EU Taxonomy reporting 2024

  • Taxonomy-aligned
  • Taxonomy-eligible but not aligned
  • Non-eligible

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Efficiency-driven decarbonisation

The first and most impactful component of our transition plan towards 2030 is the efficiency of our Ocean network and assets, which directly reduces fuel consumption. Efficiency of the network addresses the operational excellence of our Ocean network including our new Gemini network in 2025. Efficiency of assets in the network relates to the design, technology and composition of the global fleet of 700+ owned and timechartered vessels.

In an industry first, the Maersk Halifax was retrofitted as a dual-fuel methanol vessel at the Zhoushan Xinya Shipyard, China in 2024.

The Energy Efficiency Operational Indicator (EEOI) is a key measure of efficiency in Ocean operations. The EEOI is an expression of emissions of CO2e per unit of transport work (tonne cargo times nautical mile). In 2024, we improved the EEOI to 11.1 gCO2e/t nm, compared to 11.7 in 2023, marking a record low for the second consecutive year.

In 2024, the EEOI benefited from increased transport volumes due to the Red Sea situation, as higher capacity utilisation enhanced the energy efficiency of our vessel operations. Our science-based target commitments, however, focus on reducing our absolute scope 1 emissions, not on energy efficiency per transported container, and longer voyages and faster sailings in 2024 resulted in a net increase of absolute greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions of 8%, compared to 2023.

Maersk's Fleet Management and Technology policy statement, anchored in our Code of Conduct, outlines our commitments to reduce negative impacts to the environment and society from our fleet, including environmental commitments such as improving energy efficiency and preserving ecological balance and biodioverisy as well as commitments around health and safety, fair employment practices and human rights and business ethics.

Network efficiency

Optimising sailing speed and routing, while taking factors such as vessel safety and environmental protection into consideration, allows us to meet customer delivery promises while optimising fuel consumption and thereby reducing GHG emissions. In addition, network efficiency will have the largest contribution to scope 1 emission reductions in our transition plan towards 2030.

Network efficiency is supported by StarConnect, Maersk's AI-powered fleet energy efficiency platform that processes 2.5bn data points annually from more than 700 vessels. This advanced system uses machine learning to forecast and optimise fuel consumption and safety, taking into account environmental conditions including ocean currents and weather.

Along with optimising our current network efficiency, significant planning efforts in 2024 went into the Gemini Cooperation with Hapag- -Lloyd, which went live on 1 February 2025. The new East-West trade network is built on a fundamentally different design and includes 29 ocean mainliner services and an extensive network of interregional

shuttle services making transhipments to strategically selected hubs (ports). Gemini will use leaner, single operator mainliner loops and have almost half the number of port calls per service rotation compared to today. This means that the average number of stops a container makes between origin and final destination

will decrease significantly.

In addition to increased reliability and speed, Gemini will also improve network utilisation and fuel efficiencies. Gemini opened for bookings in December 2024; we will deepen our understanding of how the network supports our science-based targets and customers' decarbonisation journeys under actual operating conditions starting in 2025.

Asset efficiency

Asset efficiency includes the overall design, technology and composition of our fleet, including a mix of owned and time-chartered vessels, and the operational flexibility this provides in reducing GHG emissions while also meeting network demand. Our fleet renewal strategy is also a key factor as Maersk works at a pace of roughly 160k TEU a year to ensure a gradual and continuous upgrade of our shipping capacity to new fuels.

In 2024, Maersk made significant progress in decarbonising its fleet by deploying seven large dual-fuel green methanol vessels, with additional orders in the pipeline (see figure on page 85). These investments reinforce Maersk's commitment to advancing sustainable shipping and driving the maritime industry's energy transition.

Alongside the fleet renewal, Maersk continued implementing new and improved propellers and bulbous bows as well as retrofits and is also working with shore power enablement to reduce the need for vessels to consume fuels while in port. The establishment of a robust global regulatory framework this year by the International Maritime Organization (IMO) remains critical to a successful energy transition.

To increase asset efficiency in terms of investing in new, dual-fuel vessels as well as retrofitting our existing fleet, Maersk has invested USD 1.2bn in 2024, out of which USD 1.2bn is EU Taxonomy aligned under activity 6.10 and 6.12 (read more on page 97). Until 2030, we expect to invest an additional USD 10.9bn into new and existing assets.

Annual Report 2024

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Energy shift-driven decarbonisation

The second fundamental part of our transition plan is a shift to powering our business activities using energy with a lower climate impact. In our Ocean business, this includes switching to new fuels like biodiesel, green methanol and liquefied biomethane, and our approach to securing these fuels, as the market mature and scale across multiple pathways. In Logistics & Services and Terminals, it includes the electrification of previously fossil fuel-powered trucks, warehouse vehicles and terminal container handling equipment. It also includes the use of renewable electricity to reduce scope 2 emissions.

Fuel shifts

Our shift away from fossil fuels, contributing to reducing Ocean emissions across 700 owned and time-chartered vessels, is particularly influenced by externalities. This includes customers' willingness to cover part of the cost gap between conventional and green fuels, which in turn is dependent on regulators setting industry standards and creating supportive policies. In addition, we are dependent on innovation and external investments to scale green fuel production, infrastructure and renewable electricity to responsibly produce green fuel. As our transition plan matures, we see network and asset efficiency levers playing a greater role in reaching our science-based targets, as outlined on the previous pages. A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) therefore now anticipates a need for between 10-20% green fuels by 2030 to reach our Ocean targets (depending on growth), which de-risks our plan compared to the 25% green fuels expectation communicated in 2021.

Maersk's actions relating to shifting to green fuels are twofold: In areas where we have higher control and influence, such as our fleet renewal and green fuel offtake agreements, we have a strong executional focus. For areas with significant external dependencies, such as customer willingness and industry-level policy, we take a strong engagement and advocacy focus.

Shifting to green fuels is a balancing act between various, sometimes conflicting demands, including market viability, customer requirements, current and emerging regulations and our own science-based targets. We follow a diversified, fuel-agnostic portfolio strategy to ensure we can cut emissions now and over the mid-term as multiple pathways to netzero emissions mature and, in the case of fossil fuels, start to wind down.

Securing green fuels for current and future operations

Maersk's long-term commitments to green fuels, including methanol, biomethane and the biodiesel, currently used in our ECO Delivery Ocean offering, help us to reduce greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions and to meet customer demands today. They also send important demand signals to the industry, which incentivises more production scaling. We also continue exploring promising future green energy sources such as ammonia.

Successfully transitioning to green fuels is not, however, limited to securing fuel supplies and investing in vessels that can sail on them. It also requires increasing the industry's knowledge on how to safely operate low-emissions transport, establishing the needed policies, procedures and permitting, and developing the infrastructure required for a global transformation to net-zero supply chains.

Maersk progressed along its methanol fuel pathway with the launch of seven large dual-fuel methanol vessels during 2024. This included six name-giving events in various strategic cities, including Aarhus, Singapore and Los Angeles. These name-giving events are important opportunities to engage with our customers, regulators, employees and business partners in welcoming the additions to our fleet and celebrating progress in the industry's green transition.

Maersk has 11 large (16,000-17,000 TEU capacity) dual-fuel vessels scheduled for delivery in 2025 as well as six smaller (9,000 TEU) dualfuel vessels coming in 2026-2027. In November, we successfully took delivery of the Maersk Halifax – the world's first retrofitted dual-fuel methanol vessel.

To secure green methanol for these vessels, we have made important offtake agreements, including an October 2024 long-term biomethanol offtake agreement with LONGi Green Energy Technology Co., Ltd.

Maersk's requirements for green fuels

Our approach to green fuels is guided by requirements across three pillars.

1) All green fuels must be certified by a third party to ensure credibility and have a proof of sustainability.

2) We look at lifecycle GHG savings; all fuels must meet the minimum reductions of the EU Renewable Energy Directive which is 65% for biofuels and 70% for e-fuels compared to referenced fossil fuel.

3) Maersk only accepts second-generation feedstocks such as wastes and residues, i.e. we do not accept any first-generation food and feed crops.

In addition to climate impacts, when assessing the lifecycle impact of new fuels, we consider a broad range of environmental indicators such as biodiversity, ecosystems, resources and materials depletion, human health and ecotoxicity, air and water quality. We use lifecycle assessment and also consider indirect effects of fuel use such as indirect land use and other marginal effects to avoid shifting the burden of GHG emissions and impacts from one stakeholder to another.

Our lifecycle analysis of prioritised current and possible future green fuels for ocean shipping is governed by three policies, which are available online:

Maersk green fuel requirements Maersk biofuel sustainability requirements Maersk methanol sustainability requirements

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Maersk's combined methanol offtake agreements now meet more than 50% of the expected dual-fuel methanol fleet demand in 2027.

In 2024, Maersk sourced green fuels valued at above USD 250m towards our ECO Delivery solutions sold to customers. Until 2030, we anticipate spendings in the range of USD 2-8bn on green fuels depend ing on growth, outcomes of the IMO and other uncertainties that will impact our transition plan towards 2030. As OPEX for fuels is not included in the scope of the OPEX KPI under the EU Taxonomy, these expenses are not included in Maersk's EU Taxonomy reporting.

Maersk is taking steps to diversify its fuel pathways, with our energy transition plan and fleet renewal strategy built around an expectation for a multi-fuel future. In August 2024, we announced our intention to add 50-60 newbuild dual-fuel vessels to our fleet as part of our on going fleet renewal programme. In December, Maersk executed on the fleet renewal plan, with the ordering of 20 owned vessels for our fleet. With these orders, Maersk concluded the intended owned newbuilding orders announced in the August update of the fleet renewal plan. In addition to these new dual fuel vessels, our fleet renewal plan also includes retrofitting existing vessels. This year, Halifax became the industry's first retrofitted dual-fuel methanol vessel.

Time-chartered vessels represent approx. half our fleet of 700+ vessels and are also part of these renewal orders to support scope 1 emissions reduction targets from subcontracted ocean shipping. These vessels will be a combination of dual-fuel methanol and dualfuel liquified methane vessels.

Bio and e-methanol are likely to be the most competitive and scalable pathways to decarbonisation in this decade. Liquefied bio and e-methane also meet Maersk's green fuel requirements for emission reductions, and we are now engaging the market to seek a scalable sup ply of these fuels. At the same time, there is a risk of methane slippage linked to the production of methane that impacts upstream scope 3 value chain GHG emissions. Therefore, more focus is needed on feedstock pro curement and upstream processing. Methane slip is also a risk on vessels, and Maersk is committed to using engine types with the lowest methane slip. We also continue to explore other promising fuel pathways like ammonia, which is scalable but poses safety concerns due to its toxicity.

Maersk is further engaging with ports in many regions to establish safe methanol bunkering procedures and permitting, building on pro gress in 2023 from early adopters such as Singapore and Rotterdam.

85

In 2025, Maersk will continue defining a roadmap for the right asset mix to move, store, blend and bunker new fuels like methanol, and the right policy support to get those fuels onto our vessels.

Fuels for air transportation

Customer demand for integrated supply chains that include air freight remains high, especially for cargo of high value or with demanding delivery schedules. Yet reducing airfreight GHG emissions is one of the most challenging tasks in decarbonising logistics due to the high abatement costs of sustainable aviation fuel (SAF) and the lack of production or distribution scalability.

Whereas there are effective short-term solutions to decarbonise ocean and landside operations, air cargo presents a long-term challenge due to its significant dependency on technology developments and industry and government-level regulation.

In 2024, we added two new Boeing 777Fs to our fleet, one of the most fuel-efficient freighters available today, especially for longhaul operations.

Regulatory and customer impacts on our fuel transition

The regulatory landscape and its impact on our customers' transport choices has a profound importance for our ability to shift to green fuels. 2024 saw the inclusion of shipping in the EU Emissions Trading System (ETS), a market-based mechanism designed to reduce European Economic Area emissions. An even stronger driver in the coming years will be the new FuelEU Maritime legislation, which comes into force in January 2025 and introduces increasingly stricter limits on GHG intensity for ships calling on European ports. It favourably includes a wellto-wake approach which Maersk already uses and advocates for, as well as looking beyond carbon to include other GHG such as methane and nitrous oxide.

At the same time, FuelEU Maritime is complex, with numerous unresolved issues around definitions, compliance and financial mechanisms that require resolution. Implementing a regional standard for fuels which are purchased and consumed in international trade creates challenges and inconsistencies. Maersk therefore advocates for a global industry standard through the IMO to create a level playing field for all nations.

The IMO Carbon Intensity Indicator (CII) is to be reviewed by 2026. Depending on the outcome of this review, the CII could also have an impact on the energy transition towards 2030.

Closing the price gap between fossil fuels and green fuels is one of the most critical IMO policy needs. The IMO's Marine Environment Protection Committee MEPC 83 meeting in April 2025 will be crucial for refining and approving mid-term measures, including marine fuel standards and a pricing mechanism, which will be formally adopted at an extraordinary MEPC session in October 2025. Maersk actively supports effective mid-term measures and works towards measures that secure a multi-fuel future for shipping, and a just and equitable transition for all countries.

The ambition level and regulatory clarity of these agreements will have an impact on the pace and scale of the global shipping industry's energy transition, as well as Maersk's fuel strategy. In a pessimistic scenario, a low ambition level of IMO regulations would result in a patchwork of regional and country regulations that would make decarbonisation compliance more complex, maintain the cost gap between green and fossil fuels and decrease financial investments needed for scaling due to their higher risk.

In a more optimistic scenario for an IMO agreement with high ambition and regulatory clarity, effective finance mechanisms would be enacted that result in green and fossil fuels reaching price parity. This would make green fuels the obvious choice for shipping customers and the need for additional funding of the green fuel transition would go down. This would also derisk and further catalyse further capacity and infrastructure investments to accelerate the green energy transition.

Between these two extremes is a 'base case' scenario which would secure some supportive measures but with less ambition and clarity of the optimistic scenario. This could create the need for shipping customers to cover additional costs in the medium term, so the industry's transition speed would be affected by a lower willingness to pay in the market . The biggest question under this scenario therefore is whether it will be sufficient to drive the industry to commit and act on reducing GHG emissions in time.

The outcomes of the eventual IMO agreement will naturally have a significant impact on our customers' capacity to act on commitments for decarbonisation.

Many Maersk customers, including almost 60% of our top 200 customers, share our recognition of the urgency of acting on climate change and have set or committed to science-based targets. At the same time, they had to navigate higher raw materials, fuel and freight costs and higher interest rates, all in 2024, as well as prioritising resilience in the face of many global supply chain disruptions and uncertainties.

As the affordability of decarbonisation is challenged, this may lead some companies to pull back on their SBTi commitments. Under pessimistic or base case IMO scenarios, the business case for companies to increase the maturity of their decarbonisation commitments will be more difficult.

In 2024, absolute volume rate increases for Maersk ECO Delivery product offerings were lower than previous years, under high fuel price pressures. However, we optimistically see continued customer interest in building long-term volume commitments in ECO Delivery Ocean, the most mature of our ECO Delivery products.

Electrification of owned assets

Electrification of owned assets, while being a relatively low contributor to the transition plan, is a vital decarbonisation lever for APM Terminals and Logistics & Services. It includes replacing diesel terminal container handling equipment with electric versions, connecting existing and newbuild warehouses and terminals with renewable electricity and adding supportive infrastructure to these sites such as EV charging stations for electric equipment and vehicles.

These ambitions are highly dependent on local renewable electricity capacity, grid reliability and market, for example, our ability to enter into power purchasing agreements with state-owned utilities. Therefore, in less mature renewable electricity markets, our approach focuses on advocacy and engagement with local officials to drive policy change and infrastructure investments, as well as joint planning with governments and utility companies to upgrade grids.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Electrification of terminals

For APM Terminals, shifting from fossil-fuelled equipment in our ports to battery-electric container handling equipment is the main lever for reducing scope 1 GHG emissions. During 2024, we rolled out such equipment in Egypt, Jordan and Spain as part of our USD 60m electrification pilot programme.

In 2023, APM Terminals and DP World jointly announced the Zero Emission Port Alliance (ZEPA), an industry-wide strategic coalition aiming to accelerate the adoption of battery-electric container handling equipment in ports. In December 2024, ZEPA published its first annual findings. It expects demand to rapidly accelerate in the coming years but notes the need for standardisation to ensure widespread adoption as well as the importance of grid and infrastructure updates to support increased terminal power demand.

While some electric equipment prices have fallen and reached cost parity with fossil fuel alternatives from a total cost of ownership perspective, many electric container handling equipment categories still have a large price gap to diesel-powered alternatives. This is largely driven by a lack of scale or standardisation – for example the wide divergence in battery sizes, charging infrastructure and software for battery-electric equipment.

To meet science-based scope 1 targets, APM Terminals is committed to electrifying assets at the time of their scheduled replacement. This transition is expected to require an overall CAPEX of USD 1.1bn to 1.2bn until 2030, which includes investments in battery-electric container handling equipment and infrastructure needed for electrification. Investments into the electrification of Terminals is included in Maersk's EU Taxonomy reporting of CAPEX, amounting to USD 513m in 2024. Read more on page 97.

Despite higher initial investments, the long-term operational benefits from electrification are expected to offset a portion of the cost. These savings come from reduced diesel consumption and the positive financial impact of long-term power purchase agreements (PPAs) and onsite solar projects. Ultimately, the investment in the electrification of our assets will support both sustainability objectives and financial performance.

For scope 2 emissions, the ambition is to transition to 100% renewable energy by 2030. In 2024, approx. 45% of APM Terminals' electricity was powered through renewable sources. These initiatives have resulted in more than 8% reduction in absolute scope 1 and 2 emissions in our Terminals in 2024 compared to our 2022 baseline.

Our USD 2bn investments in two newbuild terminals in Suape, Brazil, and Rijeka, Croatia, and the expansion of the MV II terminal in the Netherlands include all the infrastructure that is needed for electrified operations, which will run on renewable electricity. The investment includes infrastructure for charging of battery-electric equipment and solar panels.

In addition to the improvements in air quality that electrified container handling equipment provides for local communities, APM Terminals also focuses on the social impact to our workforce and communities. This includes upskilling opportunities for our workforce to operate battery electric equipment, and a more pleasant work environment with reduced noise and odours, and lower equipment vibrations.

Electrification of our warehouses

In warehouse operations, we focused in 2024 on energy efficiency retrofits, upskilling our frontline teams in energy management at our 500+ facilities and on building a data foundation to provide emission visibility to customers at a warehouse level. We also continue to ensure that all newbuild facilities are green building certified to the highest efficiency standards. In June 2024, Maersk opened a BREEAM Excellent certified warehouse in Taulov Dry Port, Denmark. The warehouse has zero direct emissions from operations and all indoor and outdoor equipment is electrified.

Certified buildings and electrification of equipment in our warehouses are important levers to Maersk and part of our Green Finance Framework, which also saw allocation to green bonds issued earlier in 2024.

landside network such as rail. Our aim is to provide emission visibility while offering lower emission solutions across inland modes.

Maersk owns some landside transport assets, such as our fleet of 100+ Volvo VNR electric trucks in North America. However, most of our landside logistics services are delivered through third party partnerships with trucking companies across our operational footprint. Therefore, our ability to decarbonise landside logistics depends on their willingness and ability to invest in replacing fossil fuel powered road vehicles such as heavy and light delivery trucks with EVs. It also depends on local energy providers and infrastructure to ensure sufficient power grid capacity, reliability and charging station availability.

Maersk's ECO Delivery Inland product is our main offering for truck, rail and barge logistics decarbonisation, together with the Emissions Studio product, which offers increased visibility over transportation emissions. Improving ECO Delivery Inland availability and scalability are key focus areas for 2025, as both are key customer value drivers.

We have already started EV-powered truck operations with partners in Spain, China, Sweden, Denmark, UK, Thailand and Brazil, with more in development. We are also working on ECO Delivery Inland for rail, with pilots for barges underway.

To address investment barriers for our suppliers, our focus is on cost reduction through scaling and demand certainty for both EV manufacturers and grid owners, encouraging them to invest and scale, which will further drive down costs for our customers.

Energy shifts of business partners

Landside logistics are often the largest source of GHG emissions in our customers' supply chains, and there is strong demand for both landside decarbonisation solutions and integrated logistics solutions across ocean, land and air. In addition, it represents a large share of scope 3 emission reductions in our transition plan. Our emission reduction solutions currently rely on a mix of EVs and transitional fuels like biofuels, as well as modal shift to more efficient transport modes within our

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Physical climate risks exposure

The past decade has been the warmest on record globally with 2024 becoming the first year to exceed 1.5°C above pre-industrial levels, coupled with increased frequency and intensity of extreme weather events.

In 2022, in collaboration with external consultants, we performed an in-depth assessment of the physical impact of climate change on Maersk's business. 107 assets were selected for analysis, including terminals, warehouses, data centres and third-party operated property. The assets were mapped against prevailing climate hazards such as heatwaves, flooding, windstorms, water stress etc, and modelled across multiple time horizons and climate scenarios. Estimated loss values were determined based on losses to impacted assets (property damage and disruption costs) but excludes the resulting effect on the network.

The illustration to the right shows our top five assets at risk by 2050 in a "middle of the road" SSP2-4.5 scenario (+2.5°C by 2100), representing a future based on stated policies. In the assessment, we have also considered risks under SSP5-8.5 (+3.0°C by 2100) and SSP1-1.9 (+2°C by 2100) scenarios, with the former showing a higher level of extreme climate impacts, and the latter where risks are mitigated. Most of the financial impact from weather disruption and damage is concentrated around the five terminals presented to the right. The financial impact is driven by their exposure to temperate windstorms, coastal flood, drought/water stress, heatwave, and hurricane and storm.

As a response to the physical risk to our assets, all our majority owned terminals and large warehouse locations are part of a loss prevention programme entailing an assessment of climate change related exposure. In addition, we conduct risk engineering reports for selected exposed assets that inform mitigative actions at site level. For example, in APM Terminals Maasvlakte we have implemented actions such as elevating critical electrical infrastructure above ground level to mitigate impacts of flooding and tying down equipment to be able to withstand storms and floods. We have currently not developed a corporate policy or overall measurable targets, but we continue to assess the need for mitigative actions at site level.

SSP2-4.5 SCENARIO BY 2050

Top 5 assets exposed to physical climate risks

88

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Performance data

Gross scopes 1, 2, 3 and total GHG emissions

EFRAG ID Retrospective Milestones and target years
E1-6_01 E1-6_02 E1-6_04 E1-6_07
E1-6_08 E1-6_09 E1-6_10 E1-6_11
E1-6_12 E1-6_13 E1-6_14 E1-6_27
MDR-T_13
Base
year
(2022)
Com
parative
(2023)1
2024 % 2024
/2023
2025 2030 2040 Annual %
target/
Base year
Scope 1 GHG emissions
Gross scope 1 GHG emissions
(1,000 tonnes CO2e)
Percentage of scope 1 GHG emissions from
regulated emission trading schemes (%)
- 34,4162 32,4042 33,939
-
16% 5%
-
N/A
N/A
35%
N/A
96%
(S1 & S2)
N/A
4%
-
Scope 2 GHG emissions
Gross location-based scope 2
GHG emissions (1,000 tonnes CO2e)
4412 3752 431 15% N/A
Gross market-based scope 2
GHG emissions (1,000 tonnes CO2e)
4212 3352 356 6% N/A 100% 96%
(S1 & S2)
13%
Significant scope 3 GHG emissions
Total gross indirect (scope 3)
GHG emissions (1,000 tonnes CO2e)
47,980 44,938 49,232 10% N/A 22% 90% 3%
1)
Purchased goods and services
3,248 5,728 5,383 -6% N/A N/A N/A N/A
2)
Capital goods
1,502 1,065 2,520 137% N/A N/A N/A N/A
3)
Fuel and energy-related activities
(not included in scope 1 or scope 2)
5,949 5,653 6,036 7% N/A N/A N/A N/A
4)
Upstream transportation and
distribution
26,574 20,465 23,759 16% N/A N/A N/A N/A
5)
Waste generated in operations
9 4 3 -25% N/A N/A N/A N/A
6)
Business traveling
156 141 134 -5% N/A N/A N/A N/A
7)
Employee commuting
21 25 20 -20% N/A N/A N/A N/A
8)
Upstream leased assets
121 130 624 380% N/A N/A N/A N/A
11)
Use of sold products
8,799 10,428 9,699 -7% N/A N/A N/A N/A
12)
End-of-life treatment of sold products
313 391 298 -24% N/A N/A N/A N/A
13)
Downstream leased assets
531 155 178 15% N/A N/A N/A N/A
15)
Investments
757 753 578 -23% N/A N/A N/A N/A
Total GHG emissions (1,000 tonnes CO2e)
Total GHG emissions (location-based) 82,8372 77,7172 83,602 8% N/A N/A N/A N/A
Total GHG emissions (market-based) 82,8172 77,6772 83,528 8% N/A N/A N/A N/A

For 2024, Maersk's total emissions increased by 8% compared to 2023. This was mainly driven by an increase of 5% in scope 1 emissions and an increase of 10% in scope 3 emissions. The increases in both scope 1 and scope 3 to a large extend relate to increased emissions from the additional fuel consumption needed for the extended re-routing around the Cape of Good Hope, caused by the Red Sea situation, from both our own vessels and chartered vessels, and from vessel-sharing agreements and supply chain partners.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Scope and consolidation

The consolidation of greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions data is based on the financial consolidation approach and stated in accordance with the GHG Protocol: direct emissions from owned and long-term leased-in assets as defined by IFRS 16 (scope 1), indirect emissions from purchased electricity and district heating (scope 2), and value chain emissions (scope 3), which also includes emissions related to leased out assets as defined by IFRS 16. For more information, see the sustainability statement basis of preparation.

Emissions reporting for entities under operations

In 2024, it has been assessed that Maersk does not have operationally controlled investees in e.g. associates, joint ventures, or unconsolidated subsidiaries. This implies that the scope and treatment of entities under financial control and operation control do not differ for 2024. Thus, no separate disclosures are provided for Maersk's GHG emissions, including operationally controlled investees in e.g. associates, joint ventures, or unconsolidated subsidiaries. Maersk is annually reviewing its contractual arrangements in line with CSRD requirements.

Emission conversions and calculations

GHG emissions are calculated using conversion factors for energy consumption and other GHG gases. Primary

schemes used for activity-based calculations are Sixth Assessment Report (AR6, 2022), European Monitoring and Evaluation Programme/European Economic Area (EMEP/EEA air pollutants database, 2023), International Energy Agency (IEA, 2024), Global Logistics Emissions Council (GLEC) framework, (updated 2023), and Department for Environment, Food and Rural Affairs (UK) (2024). The Comprehensive Environmental Data Archive 6 (CEDA 6) (2022) is used for spend-based estimates. Relevant spend is adjusted to 2018 levels using the latest data from Oxford Economics (Q3 2024) to ensure comparability with the base year of the spend-based emissions factors. The principles for choosing among the schemes for default conversion factors are:

  • The most recent and internationally recognised schemes are preferred
  • Specific industry schemes can be included when not in conflict with the above.

Gross scope 1 GHG emissions

Gross scope 1 GHG emissions is the sum of all UNFCCC/ Kyoto gases converted to CO₂ equivalents. UNFCCC/Kyoto gases comprise: CO₂, CH₄ and N₂O, which are calculated based on amount of direct energy (i.e. the fuels stated under 'Energy consumption') that are consumed/combusted, and HFCs, PFCs, SF₆ and NF₃, which are based on direct consumption at entities/vessels controlled by Maersk.

89 A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024

2 Numbers restated due to improved reporting processes.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Percentage of scope 1 GHG emissions from regulated emission trading schemes

Percentage of scope 1 GHG emissions from regulated emission trading schemes is the share of Maersk's gross scope 1 GHG emissions covered by the EU ETS.

Gross location-based scope 2 GHG emissions

Gross location-based scope 2 GHG emissions is the CO₂ equivalents' converted sum of CO₂, CH₄ and N₂O, calculated based on consumed electricity and district heating bought from a third party and using location-based IEA emission factors.

Gross market-based scope 2 emissions

Gross market-based scope 2 GHG emissions is the CO₂ equivalents' converted sum of CO₂, CH₄ and N₂O, calculated based on consumed electricity and district heating bought from a third party and using country-specific market-based factors for EU countries and the US and IEA factors for other countries. In markets where Maersk procures renewable electricity, this is used as part calculating the gross market-based scope GHG emissions, provided appropriate EAC documentation is available.

Significant scope 3 GHG emissions

Value chain GHG emissions (scope 3 GHG) are the CO₂ equivalents' converted sum of CO₂, CH₄ and N₂O from Maersk's value chain activities. Of the 15 scope 3 categories in the GHG Protocol, 12 categories are currently determined as applicable to Maersk's business model and activities. The excluded categories are:

  • Category 9 downstream transportation and distribution, since we do not produce products that we need transportation for.
  • Category 10 processing of sold products, since our business model is transport and logistics services for our customers' goods.
  • Category 14 franchises, since we do not have franchises.

Thus, value chain GHG emissions comprise of emissions relating to:

• Category 1 – purchased goods and services, which are reported based on financial data and includes goods for our operations.

  • Category 2 capital goods, which is reported based on life cycle assessments and reported capital expenditure. This category covers capital investments such as new asset purchases, retrofit of vessels and dry docking. We include the full scope 3 impact in the year of investment.
  • Category 3 fuel and energy-related activities, which is reported based on actual fuel procured and consumed.
  • Category 4 upstream transportation and distribution, which is reported based on transportation data recorded in operational systems. The resulting emissions are estimated following the Global Logistics Emissions Council (GLEC) methodology per transport type. For supporting logistics-related activities like towage services, financial data is multiplied by relevant emission factors.
  • Category 5 waste generated in operations, which is reported based on amounts and types of waste.
  • Category 6 business travel, which is reported based on activity-data for our direct air travel and procurement data for other business travel related activities.
  • Category 7 employee commuting, which is reported based on employee headcounts per location, estimated commuting distance and transportation modes.
  • Category 8 upstream leased assets, which is a spendbased estimate of emissions from leased assets that is not reported in scope 1 and 2.
  • Category 11 use of sold products, is based on activity data for fossil fuels distributed by Maersk to third parties, estimated fuel use of liners calling APM Terminals, and estimated emissions from the use of refrigerated containers produced by Maersk Container Industry.
  • Category 12 end-of-life treatment of sold products, which is reported based on activity data for end of life and retreatment of sold new and second-hand reefers.
  • Category 13 downstream leased assets, which is reported based on fuel consumption from vessels, tugs and planes leased to third parties.
  • Category 15 investments, emissions are calculated to the extent of the equity share in non-controlled joint ventures and associates using financial data and corresponding factors. Total gross scope 3 emissions is the emissions related to the 12 significant scope 3 categories outlined above.

Total GHG emissions

Total GHG emissions have been stated as both the sum of scope 1, scope 2 – location-based and scope 3 emissions as well as scope 1, scope 2 – market-based and scope 3 emissions.

Annual % target /base year

The annual % target/base year is the percent average annual emission reduction per year required to meet Maersk's 2030 target. The annual % target/base year is calculated using the following formula:

Uncertainties and estimates

GHG emissions from upstream transportation and distribution activities are modelled using the EcoTransIT World (ETW) online tool. In cases, where Maersk does not have access to information of the actual fuel consumption and/or route information of third-party transportation activities, we use the ETW and its worldwide transportation route network and vehicle model data set to estimate the emissions from such activities. Maersk uses actual activity data from its transport management systems for the GHG modelling in ETW. The actual data from Maersk's systems that are used for the modelling are:

  • Origin and destination details.
  • Carrier mode to be considered for segregation of transport mode. Presently it can contain ocean, air, trucks, rail and vans.
  • Carrier actual weight.

The share of Maersk's total scope 3 emissions for 2024 that have been modelled using the ETW tool is 28.44%.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Progress towards Maersk's 2030 and 2040 targets

Retrospective Milestones and target years
EFRAG ID
MDR-T_13
Base
year
(2022)
(1,000
tonnes
CO2e)
2023
(1,000
tonnes
CO2e)1
2024
(1,000
tonnes
CO2e)
% 2024/
2023
% 2024/
Base year
2030 2040 Annual %
target/
Base year
Scope 1
Absolute reduction in total
scope 1 emissions
34,416 32,4042 33,939 5% -1% 35% 96% 4%
Scope 2
Renewable electricity sourcing
421 3352 356 6% -15% 100% 100% 13%
Scope 3
Absolute reduction in total
scope 3 emissions
47,980 44,938 49,232 10% 3% 22% 90% 3%
Maritime operations
Absolute reduction in scope 1 and
scope 3 well-to-wake emissions from
own container shipping operations
38,134 35,884 38,079 6% 0% 35% 96% N/A
Absolute reduction in scope 3 well-to
wake emissions from subcontracted
container shipping operations
11,725 8,531 10,921 28% -7% 17% 97% N/A
Other operations
Absolute reduction in scope 1
and scope 2 emissions from all
other sources
1,937 1,697 1,667 -2% -14% 42%
Absolute reduction in scope 3 Fuel
and energy-related activities and
Upstream transportation
15,143 12,983 13,069 1% -14% 25% 90%3 N/A
Absolute reduction in scope 3 emissions
from Use of sold products covering
distributed fossil fuels
6,450 7,932 8,105 2% 26% 42%
Absolute reduction in scope 3 emissions
from all other sources
9,006 10,314 11,331 10% 26% -4

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

2 Numbers restated due to improved reporting processes.

  • 3 Maersk has validated targets to reduce emissions from other operations than maritime operations by 90% in 2040. In addition, Maersk has near-term (2030) sub-targets in relation to other operations than maritime operations that relate to significant emissions categories, which support the delivery of the overall 90% reduction target for 2040. This is in line with the SBTi Net-Zero Standard, accounting for the ongoing updates in global frameworks regarding the applicability of market instruments in meeting net-zero emissions targets.
  • 4 Outside the near-term (2030) target boundary. Work to reduce the scope 3 emissions from all other sources in other operations will be performed in the 2030 to 2040 time period.

For 2024, our absolute scope 1, scope 2 and scope 3 emissions increased by 5%, 6%, and 10%, respectively, compared to 2023, and thus trending in the wrong direction. The absolute emissions were significantly negatively impacted by the re-routing of vessels around the Cape of Good Hope, which resulted in longer distances and increased fuel consumption throughout 2024. Compared to Maersk's baseline in 2022, we have reduced our absolute scope 1 emissions by 1% and scope 2 emissions by 15%. Our scope 3 emissions have increased by 3% in the same period. In addition to the impacts of the re-routing, we took delivery of more dual-fuel vessels during 2024 compared to previous years. This has also increased our scope 3 emissions.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Main targets

Absolute reduction in total scope 1 emissions

The absolute reduction in total scope 1 emissions is stated as a percentage reduction of scope 1 in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Absolute reduction in scope 2 emissions

The absolute reduction in scope 2 emissions is stated as the percentage reduction of scope 2 (market-based) in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Absolute reduction in total scope 3 emissions

The absolute reduction in total scope 3 emissions is stated as a percentage reduction of scope 3 in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Uncertainties and estimates

When preparing the reporting of emissions related to short-term charter vessels, Management applies judgement in the categorisation of such emissions as to whether they should be categorised as own (scope 1) or value chain (scope 3 category 4 upstream transportation and distribution) emissions. For 2024, we have included emissions from short-term charter vessels in scope 3. This is a change compared to previous years, where emissions from shortterm charter vessels have been included in scope 1. Recategorisation of emissions between scopes for comparison years before application of ESRS has not been done. Total emissions reported for all years are complete. Had we restated comparative numbers to align with the approach for classification of emissions from short-term charters applied for 2024, Maersk's scope 1 emissions would have increased by 11% in 2024, while Maersk's scope 3 emissions would have increased by 6% compared to 2023.

Equally, Maersk's absolute reduction in scope 1 and scope 3 well-to-wake emissions from own container shipping operations, would have increased to 11% in 2024 compared to 2023.

Sub-targets – Marine operations

Absolute reduction in scope 1 and scope 3 well-to-wake emissions from own container shipping operations

The absolute reduction in scope 1 and scope 3 well-towake emissions from own container shipping operations is stated as the percentage reduction of scope 1 and scope 3 well-to-wake emissions from own container shipping operations in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Absolute reduction in scope 3 well-to-wake emissions from subcontracted container shipping operations

The absolute reduction in scope 3 well-to-wake emissions from subcontracted container shipping operations is stated as the percentage reduction of scope 3 well-towake emissions from subcontracted container shipping operations in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Sub-targets – Other operations

Absolute reduction in scope 1 and scope 2 emissions from all other sources

The absolute reduction in scope 1 and scope 2 emissions from all other sources is stated as the percentage reduction of scope 1 and scope 2 emissions for all other (non-maritime) operations, including emissions from terminals, landside logistics and air freight operations in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022).

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Absolute reduction in scope 3 Fuel and energyrelated activities and upstream transportation The absolute reduction in scope 3 Fuel and energy-

related activities and Upstream transportation emissions is stated as the percentage reduction of scope 3 Fuel and energy related activities (Category 3) and Upstream transportation (Category 4) for all other (non-maritime) operations in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Absolute reduction in scope 3 emissions from the use of sold products covering distributed fossil fuels

The absolute reduction in scope 3 Use of sold products covering distributed fossil fuels is stated as the percentage reduction of scope 3 Use of sold products (Category 11) relating to distributed fossil fuels in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Absolute reduction in scope 3 emissions from all other sources

Absolute reduction in scope 3 emissions from all other sources is stated as the percentage reduction of scope 3 emissions for all other (non-maritime) operations in the reporting year (2024) compared to the base year (2022) and previous year.

Annual % target/base year

The annual % target/base year is the percent average annual emission reduction per year required to meet Maersk's 2030 target. The annual % target/base year is calculated using the following formula:

1 - emissions in target year emissions in target base year target year – base year

How Maersk ensures consistency of GHG emission reduction targets with GHG inventory boundaries

Maersk has validated near-term and net-zero climate targets by Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi), a widely recognised global standard for corporate target setting. Maersk's climate inventory follows the requirements of the Greenhouse Gas Protocol, covering all greenhouse gas emissions.

Maersk's climate inventory follows the financial control approach for target setting, which translates to a 100% inclusion of emissions from activities by subsidiaries and an equity share of emissions for joint ventures and associates included under scope 3.15 Investments.

Maersk currently has near-term and net-zero climate targets for scope 1, 2, and 3, and complementary sub targets in line with the requirements of SBTi's maritime sector decarbonisation guidance. Maersk's near-term target covers >95% of scope 1 and 2 and >66% of scope 3; the net-zero coverage is >95% and >90% respectively. These thresholds are in line with SBTi requirements. The emissions reduction targets are gross targets, meaning that GHG removals, carbon credits or avoided emissions are not currently considered as means of achieving the GHG emission reductions.

Maersk ensures its climate targets are relevant and follow the latest climate standards by means of a recalculation policy of climate inventories and targets. The recalculation policy is publicly available and follows the latest requirements of the Greenhouse Gas Protocol and Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi), outlining the types of changes and thresholds that trigger a recalculation and restatement of previously reported greenhouse gas emissions. Please see the Maersk recalculation policy. Maersk endeavours to ensure consistency, accuracy, completeness and comparability in public reporting of emissions and externally committed greenhouse gas reduction targets.

GHG emission intensity

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024
E1-6_30 GHG emission intensity (location-based) 1,000 tonnes CO₂e/USDm 1.51
E1-6_31 GHG emission intensity (market-based) 1,000 tonnes CO₂e/USDm 1.51

The GHG emission intensity for 2024 is 1.51k CO2e/USDm both when calculating based on location- and market-based scope 2 emissions.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

GHG emission intensity

GHG emission intensity is the GHG emissions expressed per unit of revenue (million) – based on total GHG emissions (sum of reported scope 1, scope 2 – location-based and scope 3 emissions) and revenue as stated in the income statement of the consolidated financial statements.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Efficiency in Ocean

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 20201
Entity
specific
Energy efficiency operational indicator (EEOI) Intensity 11.1 11.7 13.0 13.0 12.2

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

In 2024, Maersk continued increasing the energy efficiency of our fleet, despite the negative impact on fuel consumption of the network diversion around the Cape of Good Hope. The Red Sea situation has resulted in longer routes and increased fuel consumption. To address these challenges, Maersk has continuously focused on network optimisation and maintained a relentless focus on vessel utilisation within our operations, resulting in year-on-year improvement in our efficiency in CO2 emitted per tonne mile. Maersk has also continued to invest in and expand proven initiatives, increasing the adaption of Star-Connect and successfully rolling out new features. Efficiency retrofits in both owned and time-chartered vessels have also continued, with shore power enablement and the first large container vessel conversion to the dual-fuel methanol engine of Maersk Halifax.

The use of second-generation biodiesel remains an important lever and has been complemented by the steady increase in biomethanol, with the delivery of seven dual-fuel methanol vessels.

These initiatives have delivered efficiencies at a scale to significantly reduce the impact of increased fuel consumption caused by longer routes and has enabled us to continue driving down the EEOI, achieving a record of 11.1, down from 11.7 in 2023.

Biogenic emissions

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024
E1-6_17 Biogenic emissions not included in scope 1 1,000 tonnes CO2e 828

For 2024, Maersk recorded 828k tonnes CO2e biogenic emissions not included in its scope 1 inventory. Biogenic emissions are primarily related to the combustion of biofuels in Maersk's Ocean operations.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Biogenic emissions not included in scope 1

Biogenic CO2 emissions result from the combustion or biodegradation of biomass. Biomass is defined as any material or fuel produced by biological processes of living organisms, including organic non-fossil material of biological origin (such as plant material), biofuels (such as liquid fuels produced from biomass feedstocks), biogenic gas (such as landfill gas) and biogenic waste (such as municipal solid waste from biogenic sources).

In Maersk's current inventory, the calculation of biogenic CO2 is limited to the combustion of fuels based on biogenic feedstock in Maersk's scope 1 GHG emissions. This may expand based on evolving international standards detailing the treatment of biogenic emissions in corporate inventories.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Energy efficiency operational indicator (EEOI)

The energy efficiency operational indicator (EEOI) covers container vessels under Maersk's operation. EEOI is defined by IMO in MEPC.1/Circ.684 and is calculated as gCO₂/(Tonne cargo x Nm). In practice, we calculate EEOI on voyage level and aggregate it in the following way:

(g CO2 voy 'n' + g CO2 voy 'n' + g CO2 voy 'n') ((Tonne cargo x Nm)voy 'n' + (Tonne cargo x Nm)voy 'n' + (Tonne cargo x Nm)voy 'n')

The data sources are:

  • g CO₂ Based on fuel consumption, from departure voyage 1, to departure voyage 2, multiplied with relevant CO₂ factor (3.114 for HFO, 3.206 for MDO and 0 for biofuels).
  • Tonne cargo Calculated via draft and displacement tables, subtracting vessel weight and ballast water and fuel stock.
  • Nm GPS distance from departure voyage 'n', to departure voyage 'n'.

Energy consumption

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221
E1-5_01
E1-5_19
Total energy consumption GWh 121,008 116,272 2 124,0702
E1-5_02 Fossil energy consumption GWh 117,664 113,831 2 121,7342
E1-5_11 Fuel oils GWh 116,789 112,9712 120,7612
E1-5_12 Gas fuels GWh 101 1062 752
E1-5_13 Other fuels GWh 14 14 62
E1-5_14 Electricity and heating from fossil fuel sources GWh 760 7402 8932
E1-5_05 Renewable energy consumption GWh 3,344 2,4412 2,3362
E1-5_07 Renewable electricity GWh 303 231 2302
E1-5_06 Green fuels GWh 3,034 2,2043 2,1063
E1-5_08 Self-generated non-fuel renewable energy GWh 7 6 0

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

2 Numbers restated due to improved reporting processes.

3 Previously reported numbers for green fuels have been restated as a result of an improved reporting practice. In previous years, the amount of green fuels was based on invoiced amounts. With the roll-out of StarConnect to the entire fleet, the actual amount of green fuels consumed on the vessels are now collected and used for reporting. The numbers for consumption of green fuels have been restated accordingly.

For 2024, the total energy consumption increased by 4% compared to 2023. The increase was mainly related to an increase in fuel oils consumption related to the Red Sea situation and re-routing of vessels around the Cape of Good Hope. While relatively smaller, the consumption of renewable energy increased by 37% in 2024 compared to 2023. The increase was mainly driven by an increase in green fuels consumption and more terminals procuring renewable electricity.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Scope and consolidation

Energy consumption data is collected per legal entity per energy type, and the figures are consolidated line by line. To ensure completeness in reported data from our offices within legal entities, office standards have been developed, which can be used for offices with no production or warehouses. The office standards define average consumption values per FTE and are only used if other more accurate information is not available.

Total energy consumption

Total energy consumption is the sum of fossil energy consumption and renewable energy consumption.

Fossil energy consumption

Fossil energy consumption encompasses all fossil-based energy consumption that is consumed/combusted at Maersk controlled entities/vessels. Fossil energy consumption includes the following:

  • Fuel oil, including heavy fuel oil, marine diesel oil, gasoline, diesel and kerosene
  • Gas fuels, including liquified petroleum gas (LPG), liquefied natural gas (LNG) and natural gas
  • Other fuels, including heating oil and cylinder oil
  • Electricity and heating

Renewable energy consumption

Renewable energy consumption encompasses all renewable energy consumption, including renewable electricity, heating and green fuels that are consumed at Maersk-controlled entities/vessels. Renewable electricity includes electricity from solar panels, wind turbines and batteries, covering on-site self-generated and purchased renewable electricity from the grid. Green fuels include biofuels and green methanol. Thus, renewable energy consumption is reported as:

  • Renewable electricity
  • Green fuels
  • Self-generated non-fuel renewable energy

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Energy intensity and mix

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221
E1-5_18 Energy intensity GWh/USDm 2.18 2.28 1.52
E1-5_09 Share of renewable energy consumption % 3 2 2
E1-5_15 Share of fossil fuel sources in energy consumption % 97 98 98

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

For 2024, the energy intensity was 2.18 GWh/USDm, a decrease from 2.28 compared to 2023. This was driven by a relatively higher increase in revenue compared to energy consumption for the year. We recorded a minor increase in the share of renewable energy consumption from 2023 to 2024, however 97% of Maersk's total energy consumption was derived from fossil fuel sources in 2024.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Energy intensity (based on revenue)

Energy intensity is the total energy consumption in high climate impacts sectors per unit of revenue (USDm), as stated in the income statement of the consolidated financial statements. All of Maersk's energy consumption is considered as related to high climate impact sectors.

Share of renewable energy consumption

The share of renewable energy is the percentage of total energy consumption that is derived from renewable energy sources.

Share of fossil fuel sources in energy consumption

The share of fossil fuel sources in energy consumption is the percentage of total energy consumption that is derived from fossil-based energy sources

Renewable energy production

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024
E1-5_17 Renewable energy production GWh 9

Maersk's renewable energy production is related to on-site solar installations that produce electricity and/ or heating, which is used on-site. Electrification of assets and investments in on-site renewable energy installations are part of Maersk's transitions.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Renewable energy production

Renewable energy production is the total amount of renewable energy produced in Maersk's operations during the reporting year. The total reported production comprises of the consumption, storage and sale of renewable electricity to the grid.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Proportion of revenue from products or services associated with Taxonomy-aligned economic activities 20241

Financial year 2024 2024 Substantial contribution DNSH
Economic activities Code Absolute
revenue
(USDm)
Proportion
of revenue
(%)
Climate
change
mitigation
(Y; N; N/EL)
Climate
change
adaptation
(Y; N; N/EL)
Water and
marine
resources
(Y; N; N/EL)
Circular
economy
(Y; N; N/EL)
Pollution
(Y; N; N/EL)
Biodiversity
and eco
systems
(Y; N; N/EL)
Climate
change
mitigation
(Y/N)
Climate
change
adaptation
(Y/N)
Water and
marine
resources
(Y/N)
Circular
economy
(Y/N)
Pollution
(Y/N)
Biodiversity
and eco
systems
(Y/N)
Minimum
safeguards
(Y/N)
Proportion of
Taxonomy-aligned
or eligible revenue
2023 (%)
Enabling
activity
(E)
Transitional
activity
(T)
A. Taxonomy-eligible activities
A.1. Environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned)
Freight rail transport CCM 6.2 15 0.03% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.05% E
Freight transport services by road CCM 6.6 3 0.00% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.00% E
Sea and coastal freight water transport CCM 6.10 2,241 4.04% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 3.08% T
Infrastructure enabling low-carbon water
transport
CCM 6.16 1,719 3.10% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 2.84% E
Revenue of environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned) 3,978 7.17% 7.17% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 5.97%
Of which Enabling 1,737 3.13% 3.13% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 2.89% E
Of which Transitional 2,241 4.04% 4.04% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 3.08% T
A.2. Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities)
(EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL)
Freight rail transport CCM 6.2 50 0.09% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 0.06%
Freight transport services by road CCM 6.6 6,556 11.82% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 10.21%
Sea and coastal freight water transport CCM 6.10 31,700 57.13% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 58.50%
Infrastructure enabling low-carbon water
transport
CCM 6.16 1,834 3.31% EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 2.95%
Passenger and freight air transport CCM 6.19 1,449 2.61% EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 2.39%
Revenue of Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable
activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (A.2)
41,589 74.96% 74.96% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% 74.11%
A. Revenue of Taxonomy-eligible activities (A.1+A.2) 45,567 82.13% 82.13% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% 80.08%
B. Taxonomy-non-eligible activities
Revenue of Taxonomy-non-eligible activities 9,915 17.87%

1 Eight of the vessels – Laura, Ane, Astrid, Antonia, Alette, Alexandra, Angelica, and A.P. Møller – contributing USD 460m to the aligned revenue under section 6.10, have been partially financed (54%) via green bonds.

Total 55,482 100%

The total aligned revenue under section 6.10, excluding the revenue from the vessels partially financed via green bonds, would therefore be adjusted by USD 248m to USD 1,993m (3.59%). Consequently, the adjusted share of aligned revenue would decrease to 6.72%.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Proportion of CAPEX from products or services associated with Taxonomy-aligned economic activities 20241

Financial year 2024 2024 Substantial contribution DNSH
Economic activities Code Absolute
CAPEX
(USDm)
Proportion
of CAPEX
(%)
Climate
change
mitigation
(Y; N; N/EL)
Climate
change
adaptation
(Y; N; N/EL)
Water and
marine
resources
(Y; N; N/EL)
Circular
economy
(Y; N; N/EL)
Pollution
(Y; N; N/EL)
Biodiversity
and eco
systems
(Y; N; N/EL)
Climate
change
mitigation
(Y/N)
Climate
change
adaptation
(Y/N)
Water and
marine
resources
(Y/N)
Circular
economy
(Y/N)
Pollution
(Y/N)
Biodiversity
and eco
systems
(Y/N)
Minimum
safeguards
(Y/N)
Proportion of
Taxonomy-aligned
or eligible CAPEX
2023 (%)
Enabling
activity
(E)
Transitional
activity
(T)
A. Taxonomy-eligible activities
A.1. Environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned)
Freight transport services by road CCM 6.6 4 0.05% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.02% E
Sea and coastal freight water transport CCM 6.10 1,149 13.15% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 10.57% T
Retrofitting of sea and coastal freight and
passenger water transport
CCM 6.12 65 0.74% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.38% T
Infrastructure enabling low-carbon
water transport
CCM 6.16 513 5.87% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 6.07% E
Installation, maintenance and repair of
charging stations
CCM 7.4 1 0.01% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.03% E
Installation, maintenance and repair
of renewable energy technologies
CCM 7.6 15 0.17% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.50% E
CAPEX of environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned) (A.1) 1,747 19.99% 19.99% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 17.57%
Of which Enabling 533 6.10% 6.10% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 6.62% E
Of which Transitional 1,214 13.89% 13.89% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 10.95% T
A.2. Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL)
Freight transport services by road CCM 6.6 33 0.38% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 0.63%
Sea and coastal freight water transport CCM 6.10 3,241 37.09% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 25.39%
Retrofitting of sea and coastal freight and
passenger water transport
CCM 6.12 124 1.42% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 4.72%
Infrastructure enabling low-carbon
water transport
CCM 6.16 753 8.62% EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 10.10%
Passenger and freight air transport CCM 6.19 129 1.48% EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 2.61%
Installation, maintenance and repair of
charging stations
CCM 7.4 0 0.00% EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 0.00%
Installation, maintenance and repair
of renewable energy technologies
CCM 7.6 0 0.00% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 0.00%
Acquisition and ownership of buildings CCM 7.7 750 8.58% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 15.06%
CAPEX of Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable
activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (A.2)
5,030 57.57% 57.57% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% 58.51%
A. CAPEX of Taxonomy-eligible activities (A.1+A.2) 6,777 77.56% 77.56% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% 76.08%
B. Taxonomy-non-eligible activities
CAPEX of Taxonomy-non-eligible activities 1,961 22.44%
Total 8,738 100%

1 The CAPEX of the following activities are affected by financing via the issuance of green bonds under Maersk's Green Finance Framework:

Taxonomy-aligned 6.10 Capex allocation in 2024 was USD 340m. Adjusted aligned CAPEX for transitional 6.10 would result in USD 809m (9.27%); Taxonomy-aligned 6.12 CAPEX allocation in 2024 was USD 4.1m. Adjusted aligned CAPEX for transitional 6.12 would result in USD 60.9m (0.70%); Taxonomy-aligned 6.16 CAPEX allocation in 2024 was USD 196m. Adjusted aligned CAPEX for enabling 6.16 would result in USD 317m (3.63%); Taxonomy-aligned 7.6 CAPEX allocation in 2024 was USD 7m. Adjusted aligned CAPEX for enabling 7.6 would result in USD 8m (0.09%). For more details on our green bonds allocation, please refer to the allocation reports for 2021-2024 which can be found here: investor.maersk.com

97

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

98

A.P. Moller - Maersk
Annual Report 2024

Proportion of OPEX from products or services associated with Taxonomy-aligned economic activities 2024

Financial year 2024 2024 Substantial contribution DNSH
Economic activities Code Absolute
OPEX
(USDm)
Proportion
of OPEX
(%)
Climate
change
mitigation
(Y; N; N/EL)
Climate
change
adaptation
(Y; N; N/EL)
Water and
marine
resources
(Y; N; N/EL)
Circular
economy
(Y; N; N/EL)
Pollution
(Y; N; N/EL)
Biodiversity
and eco
systems
(Y; N; N/EL)
Climate
change
mitigation
(Y/N)
Climate
change
adaptation
(Y/N)
Water and
marine
resources
(Y/N)
Circular
economy
(Y/N)
Pollution
(Y/N)
Biodiversity
and eco
systems
(Y/N)
Minimum
safeguards
(Y/N)
Proportion of
Taxonomy-aligned
or eligible OPEX
2023 (%)
Enabling
activity
(E)
Transitional
activity
(T)
A. Taxonomy-eligible activities
A.1. Environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned)
Freight transport services by road CCM 6.6 0 0.00% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.00% E
Sea and coastal freight water transport CCM 6.10 22 2.38% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 2.31% T
Infrastructure enabling low-carbon
water transport
CCM 6.16 80 8.65% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 5.66% E
Acquisition and ownership of buildings CCM 7.7 0 0.00% Y N N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 0.00% E
OPEX of environmentally sustainable activities (Taxonomy-aligned) (A.1) 102 11.03% 11.03% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 7.97%
Of which Enabling 80 8.65% 8.65% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 5.66% E
Of which Transitional 22 2.38% 2.38% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% Y Y Y Y Y Y Y 2.31% T
A.2. Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities)
(EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL) (EL; N/EL)
Freight transport services by road CCM 6.6 14 1.51% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 0.63%
Sea and coastal freight water transport CCM 6.10 263 28.43% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 31.76%
Infrastructure enabling low-carbon
water transport
CCM 6.16 182 19.68% EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 17.61%
Passenger and freight air transport CCM 6.19 58 6.27% EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 6.92%
Acquisition and ownership of buildings CCM 7.7 49 5.30% EL EL N/EL N/EL N/EL N/EL 7.44%
OPEX of Taxonomy-eligible but not environmentally sustainable
activities (not Taxonomy-aligned activities) (A.2)
566 61.19% 61.19% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% 64.36%
A. OPEX of Taxonomy-eligible activities (A.1+A.2) 668 72.22% 72.22% 0% 0% 0% 0% 0% 72.33%
B. Taxonomy-non-eligible activities
OPEX from non-eligible activities 257 27.78%

Total 925 100%

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Nuclear and fossil gas-related activities for revenue, CAPEX and OPEX

Nuclear energy-related activities Yes/No

The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to research, development, demonstration and deployment of innovative electricity generation facilities that produce energy from nuclear processes with minimal waste from the fuel cycle.

No

No

No

The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construction and safe operation of new nuclear installations to produce electricity or process heat, including for the purposes of district heating or industrial processes such as hydrogen production, as well as their safety upgrades, using best available technologies.

The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to safe operation of existing nuclear installations that produce electricity or process heat, including for the purposes of district heating or industrial processes such as hydrogen production from nuclear energy, as well as their safety upgrades.

Fossil gas-related activities No
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construc
tion or operation of electricity generation facilities that produce
electricity using fossil gaseous fuels.
No
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construc
tion, refurbishment and operation of combined heat/cool and
power generation facilities using fossil gaseous fuels.
No
The undertaking carries out, funds or has exposures to construc
tion, refurbishment and operation of heat generation facilities
that produce heat/cool using fossil gaseous fuels.
No

EU Taxonomy accounting policies

Maersk has in 2024 continued to apply the climate change mitigation (CCM) technical screening criteria as our primary screening lens when assessing our economic activities. This is because our assessment shows that Maersk does not currently have eligible or aligned activities relating to the remaining five environmental objectives. As the EU Taxonomy regulation matures and evolves, we will change and expand our reporting accordingly, which may also impact the taxonomy KPIs previously reported. Key changes from 2023 are mainly rooted in the improvement of data availability and quality as well as refinement of our approach of how to evaluate KPIs. Main changes include:

  • The addition of eligible and aligned activities CCM 7.4 Installation, Maintenance and Repair of Charging Stations as well as CCM 7.6 Installation, Maintenance and Repair of renewable energy technologies, especially applicable to our land-based business segments.
  • The expansion of eligible activity CCM 7.7 Acquisition and ownership of buildings across all segments.
  • The inclusion of more aligned vessels in Ocean due to data quality improvements.
  • Change in allocation key for revenue in Terminals, as we have excluded assets under construction from the base of assets generating revenue.

Where changes affect the numbers we have reported in 2023, these numbers have been restated.

The taxonomy-eligible KPIs have been calculated as:

  • Taxonomy-eligible revenue KPI = eligible revenue/total revenue
  • Taxonomy-eligible CAPEX KPI (additions) = eligible CAPEX/total CAPEX
  • Taxonomy-eligible OPEX KPI (repair and maintenance) = eligible OPEX/total OPEX

Maersk's process for determining taxonomy-eligible activities (the numerator of the taxonomy-eligibility KPIs) has followed a three-step approach:

    1. Defining the economic activities that Maersk is engaged in within each of the segments across the Group
    1. Assessing whether said activities are covered by the economic activity descriptions included in the EU Taxonomy Climate Delegated Act
    1. Allocating revenue, CAPEX (additions) and OPEX (repair and maintenance) according to the company's overall assessment of whether an economic activity is eligible or not.

First, determination of the share of economic activities in Maersk that are taxonomy eligible is based on activity codes in the financial consolidation system, which also forms the basis for Maersk's external financial reporting. As such, activity codes have been defined as an economic activity.

Second, based on the descriptions of what is registered on Maersk's activity codes, an assessment has been made of whether these activities are covered by the activity descriptions that are included in the EU Taxonomy Climate Delegated Act.

Third, depending on whether the registrations are related to assets or processes associated with taxonomy-eligible economic activities, the revenue, CAPEX and OPEX registered on these activity codes are assessed to be eligible or non-eligible and allocated accordingly.

The denominator for the eligibility KPIs has been defined as:

  • Total revenue as stated in note 2.1 segment information of the consolidated financial statements.
  • Total CAPEX (additions) as stated in note 3.1 intangible assets, note 3.2 property, plant and equipment and note 3.3 right-of-use assets of the consolidated financial statements. Additions related to goodwill, customer relationship, concessions rights and concession leases are excluded from total CAPEX.
  • Total OPEX related to repair and maintenance of eligible and non-eligible assets.

The taxonomy-aligned KPIs have been calculated as:

  • Taxonomy-aligned revenue KPI = aligned revenue/total revenue
  • Taxonomy-aligned CAPEX KPI (additions) = aligned CAPEX/total CAPEX
  • Taxonomy-aligned OPEX KPI (repair and maintenance) = aligned OPEX/ total OPEX

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Maersk's process for determining taxonomy-aligned activities (the numerator of the taxonomy KPIs) has been based on screening the identified eligible activities within each of the segments against the technical screening criteria for climate change mitigation.

For Ocean, revenue from aligned vessels has been prepared by applying an allocation key to total Ocean revenue. The allocation key is based on transport work from aligned vessels out of the total transport work during the year. CAPEX additions in relation to existing aligned vessels; 2) expenditures for existing vessels undergone retrofitting that meet the technical screening criteria and 3) milestone payments for ordered dual-fuel vessels incurred during the year. Aligned OPEX is the repair and maintenance expenditures in relation to aligned vessels incurred during the year.

For Terminals, revenue from aligned electrified equipment has been prepared by applying an allocation key to total terminal revenue. The allocation key is based on the carrying amount of aligned electrified equipment out of the total carrying amount of terminal assets (excluding assets under construction). Aligned CAPEX (additions) is the CAPEX additions in relation to electrified equipment, solar panels and charging stations incurred during the year. Aligned OPEX is the repair and maintenance expenditures in relation to aligned electrified terminal equipment incurred during the year.

For Logistics & Services, revenue from aligned activities, which includes electrical trucking and rail freight, has been prepared based on the following approaches:

  • Trains: Maersk does not currently own or lease trains, which means that there is no related CAPEX or OPEX. The allocation of revenue is based on the revenue generated on electrified corridors and operated by vendors that have documented alignment with the EU Taxonomy criteria.
  • Trucks: The preparation of the revenue, CAPEX and OPEX KPIs are based on the separate accounting that is kept for the electric trucks.
  • Solar panels: CAPEX is identified based on regional accounting registrations. This activity is not relevant for revenue or OPEX.

For Svitzer, there are no aligned activities. Svitzer data is included until the day of divestment in 2024.

Do no significant harm (DNSH)

We have assessed and documented compliance with the DNSH criteria relating to the eligible activities in scope for Maersk's Taxonomy reporting. Since we only screen for substantial contribution for 'Climate change mitigation', we have screened our eligible activities for DNSH compliance with 'Climate change adaptation', 'Sustainable use and protection of water and marine resources', 'Transition to a circular economy', 'Pollution prevention and control' and 'Protection and restoration of biodiversity and ecosystems'. Only when we have been able to document compliance with all applicable DNSH criteria, we have assessed an activity to be aligned. Consequently, if an activity fails to meet one or more of the DNSH criteria, we have assessed that activity to be eligible but not aligned.

Minimum safeguards

Maersk and its subsidiaries are committed to conducting business in a responsible and upright manner and to respect human rights across our activities, in line with the Maersk Values. We endorse the principles of the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights (UNGPs) and the OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises. We commit to respect all internationally recognised human rights referenced in the International Bill of Human Rights and the ILO Declaration on Fundamental Principles and Rights at Work. These rights include core labour rights such as the rights of freedom of association and collective bargaining, the rights to not be subjected to forced labour, child labour or discrimination in respect of employment and occupation and standards on working hours and the safety and health of workers. We implement our commitment to these via our Code of Conduct and other internal policies and procedures. Maersk's compliance with the Minimum Safeguards as outlined in the EU Taxonomy regulation has been performed at a Group level and is based on the following assessment:

Human rights: The company is committed to conducting human rights due diligence (HRDD) as outlined in the UN Guiding Principles (UNGPs) and OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises (MNEs). Please refer to Maersk's Human Rights Policy. Maersk continuously identifies and assesses human rights risks via relevant due diligence processes. In 2021, the company conducted a corporate-wide human rights assessment, please refer to the 2021 Sustainability Report and the human rights information in this report for more. Further, there

is no indication that Maersk does not adequately implement HRDD resulting in human rights abuses, as the company has not been finally convicted in court cases on labour law or on human rights. Moreover, Maersk is committed to engaging with stakeholders through the mechanisms stated in the EU Taxonomy regulation, including OECD National Contact Points or the Business and Human Rights Resource Centre (BHRRC) and there are no signals that Maersk does not engage.

Corruption: Maersk has in place an anti-corruption policy and adequate internal controls, ethics and compliance programmes and measures for preventing and detecting bribery. Please refer to the governance and business ethics sections of this report. In addition, none of Maersk's senior management, including the senior management of its subsidiaries, have been convicted in a court of corruption.

Taxation: Tax is treated as an important topic of oversight, anchored with the highest governing bodies in Maersk, and the company has put in place adequate tax risk management strategies and processes as outlined in OECD MNE Guidelines covering tax. Furthermore, the company has not been found guilty of tax evasion.

Fair competition: The company promotes employee awareness of the importance of compliance with all applicable competition laws and regulations and trains senior management in relation to competition issues. Compliance with competition laws and regulations is a core part of Maersk's Code of Conduct, which Maersk employees are training in every year. Moreover, none of Maersk's senior management, including the senior management of its subsidiaries, have been found in breach of competition laws.

Environment and ecosystems

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) is committed to carrying out its business activities safely and securely with minimal impact to the environment. This includes the responsible use of natural resources such as land, water and natural materials for our operations, and managing risks to biodiversity and ecosystems as well as specific activities in our value chain, namely responsible ship recycling and sourcing of critical resources.

Since the adoption of the United Nations Kunming-Montreal Global Biodiversity Framework, we have seen new standards and initiatives emerging to guide corporate actions and disclosures related to nature and biodiversity. In 2024, Maersk performed an initial assessment using the LEAP (Locate, Evaluate, Assess and Prepare) framework created by the Taskforce on Nature-related Financial Disclosures (TNFD) to identify and assess our main nature-related issues, aiming to strengthen the foundation for environmental initiatives across our global operations and align commitments and actions with global standards.

Environmental and ecosystem management spans a range of topics handled by different functions and business segments, each supported by dedicated teams responsible for regulatory compliance and initia tives of varying scope. These efforts include initiatives such as the newly established landside environmental roadmap (see page 103), global standards such as our environmental and social impact assessment proce dure, and other health, safety, security and environment (HSSE) procedures across our landside, terminal and ocean operations, often addressing multiple interconnected environmental topics. There are further significant synergies between our activities to drive energy transition, ensure social responsibility and mitigating nature-related impacts, not least related to responsible ship recycling and the sourcing of critical resources, including steel and fuels.

The LEAP assessment helped inform our double materiality assessment (DMA) (see page 66), enabling us to identify and understand key impacts to the environment, both actual and potential. As part of the DMA, we also identified material financial risks to our business related to hydrocarbon spills, lost containers and challenges associated with ship recycling. When it comes to physical and transition risks, more broadly related to nature and systemic risks of ecosystem collapse, an emerging risk looking beyond five years is an increased dependency on water in our supply chain for production of e-fuels. Additionally, we foresee transition risks driven by increased regulatory focus on ocean health, particularly in biodiversity-sensitive areas, and stricter regulations concerning for example, the use of scrubbers. Such emerging risks are being monitored and tracked as the landscape evolves.

The material environmental and ecosystem impacts, risks and opportunities in our own operations, identified as part of the 2024 DMA, centre around pollution, ecosystem health and biodiversity and waste management. We have further identified specific material activities in our value chain, including responsible ship recycling and the sourcing of critical resources, including steel and fuels.

These topics are explained in the sections below with regard to policies and approaches, actions and targets, with pollution, waste and ecosystem health and biodiversity combined in one section as these issues share a common approach and policies across Maersk operations. Maersk's environment and ecosystems policy architecture document outlines all key commitments and principles as a comprehensive overview to employees and other stakeholders of efforts to avoid and minimise nature-related impacts, dependencies and risks across all five topics. The document is supported by internal business and issue-specific standards, requirements and policies, and is made available to relevant stakeholders via our intranet.

Suppliers are required to adhere to the environmental standards outlined in our Supplier Code of Conduct. This includes demonstrating a commitment towards environmental protection by striving to minimise environmental impacts and, where material, proactively contribute positively to shared environmental ambitions.

102

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

ESRS – E2, E4, E5, S3

Environmental impacts from our operations

As a global logistics company operating across ocean, land and air, we recognise our responsibility to manage impacts from our daily activities in terms of pollution, ecosystem health and biodiversity and waste management.

We are committed to avoiding and reducing pollution to air, land and sea across our operations. Maersk also strives to protect habitats and biodiversity, and actively participates in restoring ocean and land health in critical habitats. Waste management focuses on the need to reduce our waste footprint across our operations and to contribute to a circular economy. Across these topics, Maersk takes constant care to ensure our operations minimise and prevent impacts to the environment and people, and we align our operations with local laws and regulations to ensure compliance with environmental requirements.

Approach and policies

Maersk's Environment & Ecosystems Policy Architecture is a crosstopic document that guides our employees on minimising our material impacts by adhering to the principles set out by our environmental management systems and global policies, including on pollution, ecosystems health and biodiversity and waste management.

Approach to pollution

Maersk continues to address pollution impacts by adhering to our management framework and guidelines for preventing and responding to pollution across our daily land and sea operations. This includes air quality management measures, chemical handling protocols, spill prevention standards and detailed emergency response manuals.

Maersk collaborates with key industry stakeholders to tackle air pollution impacts, such as the Alliance for Clean Air. Through this partnership, we aim to reduce air pollution across the value chain by looking into innovative solutions, increasing transparency in reporting, and investigating target setting methodologies.

In our Ocean business, pollution is regulated through the International Convention for the Prevention of Pollution from Ships (MARPOL) and International Maritime Organization (IMO) regulations. Maersk uses a combination of low sulfur fuel oil and open-loop scrubbers to comply with mandatory IMO 2020 sulfur emission regulations. Open-loop scrubbers reduce sulfur oxide (SOx) emissions into the air, however, they transfer effluents to the marine environment, which may increase seawater acidity. Maersk recognises the ongoing environmental challenges that open-loop scrubbers present, and we continue working together with the World Shipping Council and the IMO to find industry-level solutions to this complex challenge.

Pollution risks from container losses at sea are directly attributed to severe weather and sea conditions. Maersk takes a technology-based approach to managing this risk through innovative new container lashing techniques, the installation of larger bilge keels to enhance stability and advanced weather and rolling monitoring solutions.

Approach to ecosystem health and biodiversity

Environmental and social impact assessments are performed for all new Logistics & Services and APM Terminals projects, to proactively identify environmental risks and impacts, extending beyond biodiversity and ecosystem concerns. We use defined screening criteria, including global and regional data sources, to predict and mitigate biodiversity and ecosystems risks and assess community impacts. Our work going forward will include integrating a more structured approach to consult with affected communities as part of environment and social screenings and assessments.

In marine contexts, we adhere to relevant standards and regulations, strive to minimise disturbances to marine wildlife, and continue to enhance our understanding of impacts and risks to ocean health through research projects and collaborative engagements with civil society and academics. Maersk does not currently use biodiversity offsets as a way to address our impacts.

We have a zero-tolerance policy towards transporting illegal wildlife and timber (available on Maersk.com), zero tolerance for transporting any products of shark and whale origin, and we are committed to enforcing stringent internal controls to prevent the misdeclaration and unauthorised transboundary movement of hazardous waste including plastic scrap, battery waste and industrial waste.

Approach to waste management

Maersk's waste management requirements establish critical controls to reduce risks associated with waste generation and disposal, and guidance to fulfil these requirements to minimise environmental impact. We ensure compliance with environmental requirements by aligning our practices with local laws and regulations.

In our Ocean operations, Maersk fully complies with MARPOL Annex V regulations for waste and garbage management and maintains a strict zero-dumping policy. In line with these regulations, we are dedicated to reducing overall waste generation and have set a clear goal to minimise plastic waste across our fleet.

Targets and progress

In relation to pollution, Maersk does not have measurable targets in place. However, we strive to prevent spills through operational controls and monitor and respond immediately to mitigate impacts of spills. In 2024, Maersk had no significant (above 10 m3 ) hydrocarbon spills. We also strive to avoid the loss of any containers at sea. In 2024, five containers were lost overboard from the time-chartered vessel Celsius Brickell near the port of Mombasa, Kenya. The containers were all empty and the incident resulted in no pollution or injuries.

At present, Maersk also does not have group-wide targets specifically addressing waste management or ecosystem health and biodiversity. However, we continuously monitor our performance across both landside and ocean operations to gain a clearer understanding of our impacts. With regard to waste, we are currently working to enhance the granularity of data on waste generation and disposal across both land and sea, including establishing accurate baselines. This groundwork will position us to set meaningful commitments for the future.

Key actions

In 2024, Maersk finalised a landside environmental roadmap to define a strategy and critical focus areas for 2024-2026. This includes developing a stronger set of digital tools for tracking compliance and increasing incident and spills reporting, which will drive future transparency and target-setting. Updated environmental and social screening guidance will align our growth opportunities with corporate policy and ambitions.

Maersk also made a significant USD 2m investment to improve HSSE performance, as part of our final integration process across

Annual Report 2024

220+ warehouse sites. These projects include installation of spill kits, updated waste containers and signage, water infrastructure improve ments, refrigerant retrofits and environmental site assessments.

Actions addressing pollution impacts

  • To mitigate the risk of lost containers at sea and improve safety on our vessels, in 2024, Maersk introduced a heavy weather monitoring and alert technology solution that allows shore-based support teams to provide real-time notifications to vessels at risk of encountering extreme weather. Maersk also introduced a parametric roll risk man agement solution that enables crews to optimise route planning by incorporating real-time weather forecasts, thereby avoiding adverse seas that could cause dangerous rolling conditions.
  • Maersk actively engages with the TopTier Joint Industry Project to scientifically address lost containers at sea and conducted our own technical research and model testing to identify the key contributing factors for container loss. We shared these findings through the IMO.

Actions addressing ecosystem health and biodiversity impacts

• As part of the LEAP assessment, in 2024, we identified critical busi ness segments across our operations and value chain, analysing impact drivers and dependencies in relation to specific business activities and their potential effect on nature and ecosystem ser vices. To evaluate our presence in biodiversity-sensitive areas, we utilised data from the World Databases of Protected Areas and Key Biodiversity Areas. Initial findings based on the geolocations of our sites per 31 October 2024, indicate that 48 terminals, 471 inland logistics facilities, and 269 offices are in potential biodiversity-sen sitive sites. Further analysis in coming years will confirm whether these sites and assets negatively impact such areas or significantly depend on local ecosystem services. Our objective for the coming 1-2 years is to further refine our understanding of these links, ena bling prioritisation, target-setting and action plans as well as over all transition planning and resilience analysis. Ocean transporta tion was excluded from the 2024 analysis, as our vessel navigation platforms do not currently include sensitivity layers enabling the assessment. We expect to be able to include impacts from vessels into the analysis in the coming years.

  • Maersk complies with international conventions to perform pest control and as of 2024, we reached the target of 100% of our vessels having ballast water treatment systems installed, well in line with the deadline set by the Ballast Water Management Convention.
  • We are improving our StarConnect AI-powered fleet energy efficiency platform to include capabilities to monitor our presence in marine protected areas and particularly sensitive sea areas, as well as adding additional whale zones based on updates to the World Shipping Council (WSC) Whale Chart. Implementation of this data will take place in 2025.
  • Maersk actively engaged with regulators, state entities, shipping asso ciations and NGOs in the development of revised guidelines on Under water Radiated Noise (URN) Management, in line with IMO guidelines. This includes participation in awareness campaigns and workshops across the industry, URN measurements of fleet vessels to develop a baseline and conduct data analysis, and development of an action plan based on the guidelines.

Actions addressing waste impacts

  • In 2024, Maersk started a pilot for a fleet-wide solution to create better visibility into different waste categories and landing and dis posal requirements. When fully implemented, it will provide full tracking of garbage landed at end destinations and enable precise reporting for waste regulatory requirements.
  • A global waste assessment was completed across Logistics & Services and APM Terminals in 2024, developing a baseline understanding of waste generation and management across our organisation. In Logistics & Services, an updated global waste standard, paired with compliance tools and updated training, will enable the setting of future targets around waste management and landfill diversion.
  • Maersk continued its employee and community engagement around offshore and landside waste management through its annual Go Green Week in June 2024. The week included virtual and onsite events in all operational regions to raise environmental awareness and intro duce colleagues and external stakeholders to waste management best practices.
  • Maersk continued its recycled mooring rope pilot with C-Loop. In 2024 we had the first landing of recycled ropes in Europe, and exploration continues on several promising repurposing or recycling solutions with the hope of scaling more in 2025.

104

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Responsible ship recycling

As a responsible ship owner, Maersk's ambition is to ensure safe and responsible recycling of our vessels at end-of-life, benefiting workers, the environment, responsible yards and shipowners. Globally, there is an urgent need for financially viable, responsible recycling practices to meet the growing demand for large vessel recycling. By leveraging these retiring assets, the shipping industry can also contribute to decarbonising the global steel value chain. As an industry leader and a significant owner of steel assets, we recognise our responsibility to drive positive impact.

Approach and policies

ESRS – E5

Maersk's responsible ship recycling standards outline stringent requirements to ensure that ship recycling processes are conducted safely and responsibly. These standards are established to prevent, reduce, minimise and, to the extent practicable, eliminate accidents, injuries and other adverse impacts on human health and the environment caused by ship recycling operations.

Maersk actively collaborates with stakeholders to foster a supportive regulatory environment, addressing the critical capacity challenges required to meet growing demands for responsible ship recycling. Advocating for effective policies to accelerate responsible ship recycling remains a key priority for Maersk, and we are positive about new 2024 regulations, which should clear the way for more EU-flagged vessels to be recycled at approved facilities outside of the EU.

We also work to create global opportunities for responsible post-Panamax ship recycling, where recycling capacity shortfalls can only be addressed through global consensus on the approval of more yards with appropriate safety and environmental standards. This global consensus should be based on the rules of the IMO's Hong Kong Convention for the Safe and Environmentally Sound Recycling of Ships.

Our CSR projects in the Alang, India area continue to make a meaningful contributions in the lives of the ship recycling workers. The mobile health unit (MHU) project provides complementary health care access, addressing skin and muscular-skeletal ailments, diabetes and oral cancer screening and providing health training.

Targets and progress

Maersk actively monitors the effectiveness of its policies and actions towards our qualitative target to increase global capacity for the responsible recycling of post-Panamax vessels.

Key actions

  • Maersk successfully completed the recycling of Maersk Patras in May 2024 at Alang, India, and Jeppesen Maersk and Alexander Maersk at Aliaga, Turkey, in October 2024 with zero safety or environmental incidents.
  • To create further global opportunities for recycling post-Panamax vessels, Maersk signed a memorandum of understanding in July 2024 with Kingdom of Bahrain ministries that aims to develop local post-Panamax recycling capacity and lower steel ecosystem GHG emissions through government and industry collaboration.
  • As part of our commitment to the broader development of the Alang area, the mobile health unit in Alang provided 15,000 out-patient department services in 2024.

Alang impact assessment

We continue monitoring the impact of Maersk's ship recycling activities in Alang, India. The data below covers the period 2017-2024, during which 17 vessels were responsibly recycled at six yards, engaging more than 1,200 workers. Please see the full assessment on maersk.com

OUR ENGAGEMENT

Audits performed, including 45+ Lloyd's Register audits, 40+ environmental tests and 40+ Maersk Sustainable Procurement audits

3,250+ 5,440+ Man days of supervision Health and safety trainings

THE IMPACT

Spills and hazardous materials incidents

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Sourcing of critical resources

Effective resource management and reducing the impact of our sourcing activities across the value chain are foundational to our ESG priorities. We strive to use resources efficiently across the company, with a focus on avoiding and reducing impacts throughout the upstream supply chain, particularly for critical resources which Maersk is dependent on such as steel and fuels.

Approach and policies

ESRS – E5

Maersk's policies relevant for sourcing of steel and green fuel are outlined in the Environment & Ecosystems Policy Architecture. They include our specific green fuel sustainability requirements and our approach to deepening our understanding of the steel value chain and mitigating its negative impacts.

Shipbuilding and large infrastructure projects across our operations rely heavily on steel, a material associated with significant environmental impacts. Maersk is committed to increasing the use of lower GHG emissions steel by collaborating with key industry stakeholders. One particular challenge in developing an ecosystem around lower emissions steel is the lack of standards across the value chain. Maersk is working with the Climate Group (under the SteelZero initiative) and industry partners to develop criteria for responsible steel sourcing practices and to create alignment around low GHG emissions steel standards and certifications.

As part of our energy transition, we are shifting from fossil fuels towards the use of green fuels. To ensure these fuels are sourced and assessed responsibly, Maersk has established environmental sourcing requirements for biofuels and methanol across all company operations. Read more under climate change.

Targets and progress

Beyond GHG emissions, we do not currently have targets to address the wider environmental impacts from the steel and fuel value chains.

Key actions

  • As part of our commitment through the SteelZero initiative to transition to using 50% lower emission steel by 2030 and setting a clear pathway to using 100% net-zero steel by 2040, in 2024, Maersk continued the collaboration with the Climate Group to define environmental standards for lower emission steel.
  • As part of our science-based climate targets, we are committed to adhering to our green fuel standards to ensure responsible sourcing throughout the transition. In new offtake agreements with Goldwind and LONGi, we are in continued dialogue with production partners to ensure alignment with our green fuel requirements in the development and production phases of the agreements.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Hydrocarbon spills > 10 m3

Environmental incidents

and deposits

Operating expenditures (OPEX) in conjunction with major incidents

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

During 2024, we recorded no oil spills above 10 m3

E2-6_04

Spills are reported as the number of uncontained hydrocarbon liquids spills greater than 10 m3 , resulting from any unintended, irreversible release associated with current operations.

Performance data

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 20201 E2-4_03 Hydrocarbon spills > 10 m3 Number 0 0 0 2 2 E2-4_03 Containers lost at sea Number 5 52 118 - -

a significant oil spill from our operations. In February 2024, we lost five empty containers following a vessel collision near Mombasa, Kenya. No pollution or people injuries were caused from the incident but both vessels suffered damage. The number of containers lost at sea has decreased over the last three years, indicating that our efforts to improve the handling of containers are working. The operational expenditures incurred during 2024 in relation to major environmental incidents are linked to the clean-up and salvage operation undertaken following the loss of 46 containers in the North Sea in December 2023.

The operational expenditures relate to the additional costs that are not covered by insurance.

Containers lost at sea

Containers lost at sea is based on the recorded number of containers (independent of size) lost at sea during the year. This includes containers lost at sea from own and time-chartered vessels, but does not include containers falling overboard in ports and other cases where containers will be picked up.

Operating expenditures (OPEX) in conjunction with major incidents and deposits

USDm 2 - - - -

, making 2024 the third consecutive year without

The operational expenditures (OPEX) related to major environmental incidents include the clean-up and salvage operation costs that are not covered by insurance in conjunction with significant oil spills (> 10 m3) and containers lost at sea from Maersk-owned vessels incurred during the financial year.

Air pollutants

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 20201
E2-4_02 SOx 1,000 tonnes 97 90 100 107 102
E2-4_02 NOx 1,000 tonnes 704 672 611 887 825
E2-4_02 NMVOCs 1,000 tonnes 16 16 27 - -
E2-4_02 CO 1,000 tonnes 80 77 55 - -
E2-4_02 PM10 1,000 tonnes 58 49 51 - -
E2-4_02 PM2.5 1,000 tonnes 40 38 43 - -
E2-4_02 Black Carbon 1,000 tonnes 3 3 3 - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

For 2024, Maersk's air pollutant emissions increased as a result of and generally in line with the increased fuel oils consumption caused by the extended distance linked to the Red Sea situation and re-routing of vessels around the Cape of Good Hope throughout 2024. Black Carbon emissions remained on par with 2023, which was a result of a general higher engine load contributing to more efficient combustion.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Air pollution

Air pollution is the amount of air pollutants emitted in relation to Maersk's operations, besides GHG emissions. The air pollutants included are SOx, NOx, Non-Methane Volatile Organic Compounds (NMVOCs), carbon monoxide (CO), Particulate Matter (PM10 and PM2.5, and Black Carbon (BC)). By default, PM10 also includes smaller particles (hereunder PM2.5 and BC), which are also reported separately because these fractions of particulate matters have differing impacts on environment and health than the coarser fractions.

Air pollutants have been prepared and stated based on the first version of the Stockholm Environment Institute's (SEI) reporting guide, except for BC and PM10 reporting from the fleet of Maersk, which is based on the methods outlined by IMO in MEPC 75/7/15 as our data availability allows for IMO's more accurate assessment. In case of scrubber use, SOx pollutants are reported based on Clean Cargo guidelines, where SOx output is assumed to be maximum for the operating area in which the vessel spends 80% of time.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 20201
E5-5_07 Waste 1,000 tonnes 556 5172 553 357 289
E5-5_15 – Hazardous waste 1,000 tonnes 236 218 229 216 188
E5-5_10 – Non-hazardous waste 1,000 tonnes 320 2992 324 141 101

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

2 Restated from 533k tonnes and 315k tonnes for 'waste', and 'non-hazardous waste', respectively, due to the application of an incorrect unit conversion from a reporting entity in 2023.

For 2024, Maersk recorded an increase of approximately 8% in total waste generated across its operations compared to 2023. The increase is mainly driven by an increased number of vessels in Maersk's operations.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Waste

Waste is reported as the sum of all waste types generated, with further bifurcation in hazardous and non-hazardous waste types. Non-hazardous waste primarily consists of municipal and industrial waste, such as food waste, pallets, cardboard, general trash and metal and wood scrap.

Uncertainties and estimates

Waste data is reported by entities and is based on a combination of actual numbers and estimates.

For land-based operations, waste data is sourced from billing and accounting systems or from the procurement/ supply management department. For some offices and minor sites, where it is challenging to obtain actual waste data, estimates based on FTE counts are used to ensure completeness in waste reporting.

For waste from vessel, conversion factors for all MAR-POL Annex V garbage categories have been developed and used on the actual waste generated by 10 vessels within three different vessel size groups (sample of 30 vessels in total). The average waste generated by vessels within each of vessel size groups has been used to extrapolate waste numbers for the entire fleet.

Resource inflows

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024
E5-4_02 Total weight of steel consumed Tonnes 73,394

Maersk procures and uses steel for manufacturing containers. In addition, significant amounts of steel are used by suppliers and partners in the value chain to produce vessels, cranes and other heavy assets that Maersk uses in its operation. We only report on the weight of the steel we directly procure and use to manufacture containers.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Total weight of steel consumed

Total weight of steel consumed is the weight of steel used for producing containers during the year. The weight is calculated based on the number of containers produced and the bill of materials related to those containers.

Social

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) strives to provide a safe and inspiring environment for our people to grow, develop and thrive as a diverse and global team. Our actions are guided by our Purpose and Core Values, international standards and the expectations of our key stakeholders.

HUMAN CAPITAL
Target by 2025 Employee engagement survey score
in the 75th percentile of global norm
SAFETY AND SECURITY
Target by 2024
(recurring)
100% of learning teams completed
following high potential incidents
DIVERSITY, EQUITY AND INCLUSION
Targets by 2025
>40% women in management

>30% diverse nationality (non-OECD)
of executives
EMPLOYEE RELATIONS AND LABOUR RIGHTS
Target by 2024
(recurring)
100% of employees (in scope) trained
in employee relations and labour rights

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Social Human capital

Overview of Maersk's material impacts, risks and opportunities related to Social

Negative impact

Financial risk

Financial opportunity

Attracting and retaining critical talent Where
Inability to retain and attract the right workforce for key Employees
Time
Medium term
critical capabilities
Inability to retain and attract key critical capabilities could
impact the ambition to deliver on the integrator strategy.

Where Employees Non-employee workers Time Short term

Where Employees Non-employee workers Time Short term

Where Employees Non-employee workers Value chain workers Time Short term

Diversity, equity and inclusion

Harassment of vulnerable groups

Risk of harassment creating an unsafe working environment for underrepresented or vulnerable groups in our workforce Underrepresented and vulnerable groups are at increased risk of harassment and violence. This can take place in office environments, warehouses or on ships, the risk being higher for frontline workers and in highly male-dominated environments. This can pose a financial risk to Maersk in terms of

Discrimination in the workforce

Risk of discrimination based on ethnicity, gender, nationality or disabilities

costs of remediation and reputational damage.

Potential discrimination within our workforce, based on ethnicity and nationality given a large global workforce and the variety of office environments, and on the basis of gender in traditionally male-dominated parts of the business. Underrepresented and vulnerable groups (such as persons with disabilities) may also be at increased risk of discrimination.

Safety and security

Safety of our workforce

Risks of work-related injuries, life-altering incidents and fatalities

Risks of work-related injuries, life-altering incidents and fatalities for workers given the nature of the transport and logistics sectors. This can pose a financial risk to Maersk in terms of costs of remediation and reputational damage.

Exposure to global/local security risks

Exposure to global/local security risks

Forced labour

of passports

workforce.

Global and local geopolitical instability and conflicts result in security risks where criminals, terrorists and/or others with ill intent expose our employees to health and safety risks, e.g. piracy and terrorism. Financially, this can cause disruptions to our operations, which may also impact our ability to decarbonise, and costs related to safety incidents. Where

Employees Non-employee workers Value chain workers

Time Short term

Employee relations and labour rights

Forced labour such as debt bondage and withholding Risk of debt bondage and withholding of passports for contracted workforce and value chain workers. This risk is higher for large infrastructure projects with a migrant Non-employee workers Value chain workers Time Short term Working hours and adequate wages Excessive hours worked for contracted frontline workers Impacts related to working hours and overtime for contracted frontline workers, such as truck drivers, seafarers and migrant workers. Where Non-employee workers Time Short term Ensuring that workers are paid an adequate wage In some supplier categories, there is a potential risk of inadequate wages being paid for contracted labour. Where Non-employee workers Time Short term Adequate housing and sanitation Where

Adequate housing and sanitation facilities for own and contracted workforce

For contracted workers and in the broader value chain, on-site housing is provided to workers at e.g. terminal constructions, warehousing, shipyards and shipbreaking yards. These spaces can potentially be substandard, crowded and not adequately hygienic – aggravated in some contexts by the lack of gender segregation.

Non-employee workers

Value chain workers Time

Short term

Our workforce

The people of A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) are the foundation of our success and the ones who deliver on our customer promises, including Environmental, Social and Governance commitments. Our ambition is to ensure that our people thrive at work by providing a safe and inspiring workplace. This is driven by efforts within human capital, diversity, equity and inclusion (DE&I), safety and security and employee relations and labour rights, and underpinned by a commitment to respecting human rights.

We employ 100,000+ people across almost 130 countries in the world. Our team includes office-based professionals and technology experts who develop and bring Ocean, Logistics & Services and Terminals offerings to life. We also employ frontline workers who fulfil our customers' logistics needs, such as ware house staff, truck drivers, terminal operators and aircraft maintenance teams, as well as the 12,000+ dedicated seafaring colleagues sailing our vessels.

In addition to own employees, we also rely on a large extended workforce of third-party contracted labour (non-employee workers) who are not directly employed by Maersk, but work on our premises with us and for us in our customers' value chain, especially in Logistics & Services and Terminals. Our business model also includes impacts and risks to workers in our value chain. These include workers on chartered/ leased assets and workers of our suppliers that are not part of our contracted workforce.

The complexity of our operations and workforce, combined with diverse local labour regulations, stand ards and practices across our global footprint, creates potential people-related impacts and risks. Whether our people have office-based or frontline roles, or whether they are employees or contracted labour in the value chain, we strive to safeguard fair and safe working conditions and the ability to make meaningful con tributions through growth and learning. Doing this requires active management of several impacts and risks.

An inability to retain and attract employees could impact Maersk's ambition to deliver on our integrated logistics business model, especially for specialised experts in technology and logistics.

Given the nature of the transport and logistics sectors, Maersk employees and non-employee workers under our duty of care are exposed to health and safety risks, including work-related injuries, life-altering incidents and fatalities. Maersk's broad footprint also exposes our assets and employees to security risks, especially with the current increase in geopolitical instability such as the Red Sea situation.

Our workforce may be exposed to the risk of harassment, discrimination or violence that could create a physically or psychologically unsafe working environment. This risk is especially higher for underrepresented or vulnerable groups in our workforce.

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

EMPLOYEES BY REGION

Europe

Our people

  • Asia Pacific
  • Indian subcontinent, Middle East & Africa
  • Latin America
  • North America

TOP 6 EMPLOYEE NATIONALITIES

We actively manage the risks and impacts of our operations on labour rights. Frontline employees and contracted workers face risks related to excessive working hours and overtime. Contracted workers might also face demands to work excessive hours, or risks of forced labour where workers may face restrictions on their freedom of movement due to the retention of their passports. Ensuring that workers are paid an adequate wage is also a labour rights risk, as is securing adequate housing and sanitation facilities for own and contracted workers. Both risks are gen erally higher for contracted workers and are present in all high-risk supplier categories. Across all of Maersk's workforce risk categories, there is also a risk of limited visibility across the value chain, especially tier 2 or 3 suppliers and parts of the downstream value chain.

Maersk's People strategy

Our People strategy outlines the people principles which are our north star for all people practices and policies. It includes employee attrac tion, development and engagement activities to ensure workforce con tinuity and stability, while unleashing employees' energy, focus and commitment to executing our strategy.

The priorities of Maersk's People strategy for 2024, a multi-year effort launched in 2021, are:

  • Enable teams that collaborate, to deliver with passion towards goals, maximise individual and team results and pursue continuous learning and growth.
  • Lead with intent, embodying our leadership commitments.
  • Scale frontline capability to drive growth, create competitive advantage and great workplaces for all.
  • Drive a culture of empathy, care and compassion which empowers everyone to perform, lead and deliver.

Every year, the people priorities, with specific focus areas, are set and communicated to the entire organisation. Employees and Constant Care are both Core Values to Maersk and fully aligned with our People strategy. We carefully monitor and analyse the impact of our People strategy through the biannual employee engagement survey (EES), which helps us shape our programmes and targets. In 2024, we performed a second organisation-wide inclusion survey to gain valuable insights from employees and lessons for improvement on DE&I performance.

ESRS S1, ESRS S2, ESRS S3

Maersk's approach to human rights

Many aspects of our business touch on human rights, including employees' working conditions, health and safety, how vessels are recycled, how we use digital data and tech nologies and suppliers' business practices. Our conduct within our own business and through business relationships can have a significant impact on people, communities and society, both positive and negative. Human rights perspectives inform and guide several categories in our ESG strategy and governance approach.

Approach to human rights

Recognising the potential for global trade and supply chains to make positive contributions to society and socio-economic development, Maersk is committed to respecting human rights in its own operations and entire value chain. Maersk's approach to human rights is founded in our Purpose and Core Values and based on a long standing commitment to the UN Guiding Principles (UNGPs) on Business and Human Rights and the OECD Guidelines for Responsible Business Conduct, helping us navigate the often complex impacts of global trade on people. These commitments and this approach are formalised in Maersk's Human Rights Policy Statement, available on Maersk.com.

Human rights are anchored in Corporate Sustainability, headed by the Chief Corporate Affairs Officer. The department collaborates with several key functions such as Legal, Compliance, Employee Rela tions, Safety and Resilience, the People function and Sustainable Pro curement to ensure that human rights considerations are integrated throughout the business and value chain. Maersk's ambition is to con tinue aligning our business practices with the UNGP and ensure that human rights considerations are integrated into due diligence pro cesses and ESG governance mechanisms.

In 2024, a key focus has been to initiate preparations for compli ance with the EU's Corporate Sustainability Due Diligence Directive (CSDDD), which will be mandatory for Maersk from 2027. As part of this, we continued engaging and training key functions and human rights

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

issue owners to support and equip them with the knowledge and tools to handle dilemmas in a manner sensitive to potential human rights impacts.

We engage regularly with key stakeholders, such as customers and investors, as well as external experts on human rights topics, as we see increasing regulation and growing expectations from stakeholders. We continued to mature key internal due diligence processes, and we are also addressing emerging risks from new business activities, such as the development of the green fuel supply chain and the continued expansion of logistics operations. As a consequence of increasing geopolitical tensions across the world, we recognise the need for enhancing our approach to human rights risk assessments when operating in conflict-affected areas.

As a global company with a footprint all over the world, we serve all types of customers, both companies and states. In line with our commitment to ensuring responsible business practices aligned with international standards, we perform risk assessments and heightened due diligence on certain transactions, including in relation to armed conflicts and military cargo. This is also to ensure we comply with arms embargoes.

In May 2024, NCP Denmark (the Danish Mediation and Complaints Handling Institution for Responsible Business Conduct) concluded on a case raised against Maersk relating to the operations of the joint venture Douala International Terminal in Cameroon, following a two-and-a-half year investigation process. While the vast majority of raised complaints were dismissed, including complaints related to the specific joint venture, we acknowledge the recommendations by NCP Denmark related to our joint venture framework and promoting responsible business conduct in entities where we do not have full control, as well as exercising due diligence with regards to documentation and follow-up on policy implementation. We have already undertaken updating our joint venture framework, as well as expanded our training for APM Terminals-nominated board members and representatives for joint venture entities.

We actively engaged with NCP Denmark throughout the course of the investigation over two-and-a-half years, with the intent to demonstrate and explain how we implement our commitment to respecting the OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises. We valued the opportunity to reflect upon and review how we implement and document

our respect for international standards and have taken a variety of learnings from the process, including codifying initiatives that we had underway into our governance frameworks and due diligence processes, ensuring our commitment and approach to respecting the OECD Guidelines are unequivocally documented.

Maersk's salient human rights issues

In 2021, we conducted a corporate-level human rights impact assessment founded in the OECD guidelines. The result of this exercise was five prioritised salient human rights issues that we continuously address. This assessment has also informed the 2024 double materiality assessment (DMA), reconfirming the materiality of the human rights issues.

These include health and safety in the supply chain, violence and harassment at work, impacts of climate change and decarbonisation (just transition), access to remedy and working conditions in the supply chain. Read more about these issues in the relevant topical sections of this report.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Human capital

ESRS S1

Maersk's ability to deliver on customer needs and our business strategy ambitions depends on highly engaged employees and internal capabilities in critical areas. To ensure that we attract and retain the right talent, our aspiration is to create an engaging environment for all colleagues and to be a company where employees can develop and have thriving careers.

Policies and approach

Our People strategy outlines our vision, core principles and capabilities. It includes engagement as an outcome of excellent leadership, clear direction and workspaces that are inclusive. Therefore, engagement is included in all people practices.

Maersk's approach to human capital as an ESG priority includes three focus areas: employee engagement, employee attrition and talent development. These speak to our continuous efforts to attract, engage and retain employees and ensure continuity and stability of, and for our workforce.

We work towards minimising negative impacts arising from our operations through careful monitoring and analysis of employee engagement and attrition. In particular, our employee engagement survey (EES) provides valuable insights into performance and helps us pinpoint areas of improvement. Both functional and operational leaders receive the results of the EES and are responsible for developing action plans to address survey findings, with the support of dedicated resources in the People function. In response to the survey results, we conduct listening sessions, refine processes and policies as needed and invest continuously in leadership and overall capabilities.

Biannual progress updates take place, supplemented by internal campaigns on performance management tools and training programmes, as part of the People strategy. Multiple training and development resources are available to employees through our internal talent development (MPACT) framework to maximise talent performance and ensure alignment and career growth.

Targets and progress

In support of our ambition to attract and retain the right talent and create an engaging environment for all colleagues to develop and thrive, we evaluate progress against our strategic target to achieve an EES score in the 75th percentile of Gallup's global norm. The EES is performed twice a year.

The result of the second EES of 2024 showed an increase in engagement to the 65th percentile compared to a 60th percentile score at the end of 2023. Another noteworthy positive trend is that 92% of colleagues consistently participated in both of the 2024 surveys compared to 85% in 2023. The survey also highlighted consistent strengths and opportunities compared to the previous two surveys, notably in the areas of recognition and development, attributed to the continued adoption of MPACT and the embedding of a performance culture. These improvements suggest that more leaders are dedicating time to review performance, recognise good work and encourage development.

Along with the EES, we track employee turnover with the aim to sustain a healthy attrition rate aligned with the industry performers. In October 2024, the employee turnover rate was 11%.

Key actions

In 2024, we progressed across our People strategy's main focus areas:

  • The MPACT framework continued to strengthen our performance culture by driving objective setting and performance conversations, with adoption rates reaching 87% and 82% across Maersk, respectively.
  • Employee development solutions were strengthened with the launch of the Maersk Academy framework attracting over 750,000 visits, an expanded mentoring solution with 2,400 participants and the introduction of a coaching programme.
  • Leadership solutions were consistently promoted to support leaders in empowering employees in their daily work. Each people leader is expected to create an action plan based on the EES results and leverage the MPACT talent and development framework alongside other targeted leadership initiatives, including specialised programmes and leadership development solutions. Additionally, we elevated the succession management process to a global level, enhancing visibility for leaders and fostering the growth and development of talent.

Employee engagement Percentile

(60th percentile)

The result of the second employee engagement survey of 2024 showed an increase in engagement to the 65th percentile compared to a 60th percentile score at the end of 2023. While this is a solid result, more work is needed to reach the 75th percentile target by 2025.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

35%

% headcount

Women in management

on par with 2023.

(35%) In 2024, the share of women in management1 remained

Target nationalities in executive leadership Percentage 21% (20%) Through focused efforts, our target nationalities

ESRS S1

Diversity, equity and inclusion

At Maersk, we aspire to facilitate diversity of thought and create a more diverse, equitable and inclusive workplace, where our employees feel able to bring their whole selves to work and contribute to their fullest. This is a Core Value of Maersk and essential to supporting our customers' evolving logistics needs and growing our business. By facilitating a culture where everyone feels respected and is treated fairly, we gain access to a larger, more diverse pool of talent.

Policies and approach

Two main policies anchor our diversity, equity and inclusion (DE&I) approach: a diversity, equity and inclusion policy and an anti-discrimination, harassment, bullying and violence policy. These policies are publicly available on Maersk.com and accessible on our internal intranet site along with training materials.

Our diversity, equity and inclusion policy outlines our holistic view on diversity, grounded in our Core Values, as well as our targets and approach to underrepresented groups in our workforce. In 2023, we introduced a diverse abilities policy to provide even stronger support for this specific, underrepresented group. We call disabilities 'diverse abilities' to focus on our colleagues' skills and capabilities, rather than their perceived limitations.

Maersk's anti-discrimination, harassment, bullying and violence policy articulates that discrimination, harassment, and bullying of employees are not tolerated in any country where we operate. This is further codified in our Commit governance rules, through our Code of Conduct, and in our commitment to the UNGP Global Compact and UNGP on Business and Human Rights. These policies are developed with an inclusion perspective, going beyond minimising harm.

As a core strategic topic for Maersk, DE&I is anchored in the Executive Leadership Team and is driven by a dedicated global diversity, equity and inclusion team as well as by employees across the organisation.

Beyond diversity targets, we prioritise inclusion as a catalyst for behavioural change, shifting mindsets from passive allyship to active advocates. To foster an inclusive culture, we conduct an organisation-wide inclusion survey to guide functional team action plans so we can take a targeted approach to embed equity, bring inclusion to life and continuously measure progress. In addition, we gain valuable insights from our employees and lessons for improvement from feedback during our annual global diversity, equity and inclusion week, diverse abilities week, pride celebration, black history month and other campaigns.

A new employee resource network (ERN) in Oceania brings the total to 42 ERNs, all dedicated to integrating our Global DE&I strategy across regions. Twice a year, the ERNs join forces with the Global DE&I Team to discuss best practices and collaborate to strengthen collective efforts.

Targets and progress

To create a more diverse, equitable and inclusive workplace, we have set a range of strategic targets:

We set a gender diversity target of above 40% women in management by the end of 2025. In 2024, the number remained on par with 2023 at 35% with continued impact from the 2023 reorganisations. With slower progress due to reorganisations and new hire restrictions, we took steps to maintain representation – especially at leadership levels – and to improve gender balances in hiring in 2024. These included adding a DE&I statement to all job advertisements, hiring manager trainings, launching a social media advocacy programme and mandating the use of gender language tools.

Taking into account broader diversity aspects, we also set a target of having above 30% of diverse nationalities (non-OECD) of executives. In 2024, the number increased by 1 percentage point, slightly reducing the gap towards our 2025 target. In 2024, we expanded the original scope of our talent sponsorship programme for women in leadership to also include talent of underrepresented racial and ethnic groups.

To address some of the remaining challenges in our diversity targets and the inherent limitations of count-based targets, we introduced a new 'diversity in teams' metric, which looks at gender and nationality in our leadership pipeline. In 2024, our score was 58% on gender and 85% on nationality. Measured at the team level, diversity in teams builds systemic equal opportunity across different roles at leadership levels.

115

116

Executive summary

The integrator

Corporate governance

Financials

Following a successful 2024 test, we will roll out team-wide tailored plans in 2025, with targeted actions intended to have greater impact than generic diversity programmes and trainings.

Key actions

Maersk progressed in many DE&I engagement initiatives during 2024:

  • Our second inclusion survey was launched across 126 countries. The results showed a shared pride in working at Maersk and its overall culture of inclusion. 88% of respondents agreed that Maersk hires from a variety of backgrounds. The results also highlighted equal opportunity as a focus area for improvement in 2025.
  • Over 5,000 colleagues were identified as having diverse abilities in the inclusion survey and recorded a positive inclusion experi ence. A dedicated programme was developed in 2024 to support our colleagues' and wider teams on hiring and onboarding, in line with our diverse ability policy introduced in 2023.
  • Targeted efforts in developing and hiring underrepresented genders included expanding our talent sponsorship programme to North America and improving gender balance in our hiring process through e.g. social media advocacy, inclusive language, DE&I statement in job ads and training of hiring managers.
  • In 2024, Maersk reached the important milestone of employing almost 6% of female seafarers across the fleet. According to the International Maritime Organization (IMO), the industry average is 2%. We actively promote gender diversity at sea through special training programmes for young women in select markets, position ing Maersk as a maritime employer with career opportunities, and collaborating with schools and universities.
  • A series of initiatives under our One team together programme to transform the working culture at sea continued to progress in 2024, including actively attracting, onboarding, training and developing colleagues at all levels, with a strong focus on exten sive leadership development for senior officers.

ESRS S1

Safety and security

Safety and security at work is a basic human right, and Maersk has a duty of care to ensure the health, safety and security of everyone who works with us.

Policies and approach

Our commitment towards health, safety, security and environment (HSSE) is anchored in our company values and codified in Maersk's HSSE Policy. The policy, publicly available on Maersk.com, clearly sets our obligation , clearly sets our obligation for healthy, safe, secure and environmentally responsible business practices and applies globally to all Maersk entities, employees and everyone working under Maersk's supervision. This means that all workers on our sites, including both own employees and contracted workers that work under Maersk's supervision, are covered by Maersk's safety management systems. The HSSE Policy is supported by and unfolded in detail in our HSSE Commit Rule and the Maersk HSSE Management Framework. Our Supplier Code of Conduct further set expectations for our suppliers to uphold respon sible business practices including on safety (see Sustainable Procure ment pages 130-131).

These commitments are well reflected in our legacy operations. Since embarking on our integrated logistics strategy, Maersk has added hundreds of warehouses and thousands of new logistics colleagues to complement ocean and terminal operations. The speed of this growth, as well as expansion into new locations with diverse practices and safety cultures, has transformed and expanded our HSSE risk profile. To meet this challenge, we are working fast on a global scale to bring the landside asset portfolio up to our global HSSE standards and to build the capacity, capabilities and work culture required to work safely and securely everywhere that we operate. In these efforts, we draw on and benefit from the experience and solid safety culture we have developed over decades in our Ocean and Terminals businesses.

Our efforts are guided by four principles equally anchored in safety theory and operational experience. First, 'we lead with care' – leaders engage, listen and respond to what frontline colleagues need to do their work safely. Second, 'we learn and adapt' by building capacities

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

to manage serious risks through controls and safeguards that protect people while improving business efficiency, using innovation and safetyby-design principles. Third, we insist that 'our people are the experts' – inspiring a culture of learning and engagement by promoting employee voices, elevating engagement and sharing learning across our business. Fourth, we make sure 'we are resilient' by planning for and monitoring supply chain disruptions and ensuring we have the backup capabilities for key resources to keep customer cargo moving.

We continuously monitor and manage evolving safety and security risks. For example, the introduction of new dual-fuel capable vessels as part of our energy transition brings new technologies, equipment and fuels that have different safety characteristics. Maersk has robust procedures and training in place to ensure that the crew on these vessels are well equipped for safe operations. In our Terminals business, we are ensuring that the electrification of container-handling equipment is safe and inclusive to frontline terminal colleagues with upskilling and specialised training and procedures in topics like electric battery maintenance and fire prevention.

As part of our security and business resilience (continuity planning and crisis management) framework, we focus on protecting people, assets, cargo and the Maersk brand. Our threat intelligence team (forecasting) collects, analyses and prioritises security or continuity risks, which are then presented for discussion with the regional security and business resilience managers. This supports informed risk decision-making and mitigation strategies on topics such as people-related risks, cargo theft and severe weather disruptions. Our approach is to leverage technology and data to understand customer and legislative expectations and the local environment, and to standardise controls and risk management.

Targets and progress

To support capacity building to manage critical risks and identify improvement areas, we have set strategic targets of ensuring that 100% of learning teams are completed following a high potential incident. In 2024, we conducted focused training towards learning teams across our portfolio, aiming to address all high potential incidents, ending the year at 99% completion. Following a Terminals high potential incident review, Terminals identified traffic management as a key risk and conducted a Kaizen activity to drive improvements and standardise practices across terminals.

100% of learning teams completed following a high potential incident (by 2024) (2023: 99%)

Key actions

2024 was marked by heightened geopolitical threats, conflicts and instability. Protecting cargo from security-related disruptions, while ensuring reliable and resilient supply chains is critical to our growth and reputation. We are also moving with speed and resolve to bring every logistics site up to Maersk's global standards and provide everyone with HSSE responsibilities with the tools, training and support needed to fulfil their roles. In 2024, this included:

  • 15,000 safety and security Gemba walks conducted across Ocean, Logistics & Services and Terminals operations.
  • Completion of a one-time HSSE assessment of 354 logistics sites, closing 95% of the HSSE and business resilience improvement actions, including new safeguards, security equipment and training. The findings also laid the foundation for a capability study to build an HSSE learning academy to upskill our workforce in 2025.
  • Launch of a three-year global campaign to help every Maersk warehouse and depot implement our HSSE management framework.
  • A new global HSSE assurance team to provide regular validation of our HSSE performance and improvement journey.
  • Successfully managed more than 19 crisis management teams across a variety of crises from the Red Sea situation to vessel fires.
  • Reviewed resilience maturity for third-party terminals (+20) linking to the Gemini network. In 2025, we will continue supplier resilience evaluations and assessments with procurement to understand vulnerabilities and develop improvement plans.
  • Development of a global resilience intelligence tool to standardise and better enable site-level business continuity planning.
  • Training of 191 employees as business resilience coordinators at the site level, enabling them to develop and implement business continuity plans.
  • New in-house capability to identify security and resilience-related threats, enabling pre-emptive risk mitigation. This included refining our data landscape to ensure internal metrics and external threats are properly identified and assessed as well as improved data aggregation across Security and Resilience functions.

99%

Lost time incident frequency rate LTIf

(1.14 LTIf)

The rise of our lost time incident frequency (LTIf) rate was driven by increases in lost time incidents (LTIs) in our Logistics & Services and APM Terminals businesses, as well as an improved reporting culture.

1 2023 restated from 1.11.

Fatalities in 2024 1 Number

(4)

Regrettably, we had one fatal incident involving a contracted colleague in a warehouse in the Philippines on 26 December 2024. While we have seen a significant reduction in the number of fatalities since 2022, the loss of a colleague underscores that we still have much work to do on understanding and staying ahead of our risks and on building the right safety culture. In addition to the fatalities recorded for employees and contractors under Maersk's responsibility, we recorded one fatality involving a value chain worker on a construction site within our premises. This individual was employed by the construction company and not working under Maersk's responsibility.

117

Performance

Employee relations and labour rights

The way we treat employees and their representatives is fundamental to responsible business practices and grounded in respect for internationally recognised labour rights in all of our workplaces. Respect for fundamental labour rights is an essential part of Maersk's social commitments, which include offering decent, fair and equitable working conditions for all employees. We assess potential risks affecting both own employees and contracted/third-party labour and take proactive and corrective measures to ensure our operations and growth align with our commitments on social responsibility.

Policies and approach

ESRS S1

Maersk has two main employee relations and labour rights policies. The Commit Rule on Global Employees and Labour Relations is applicable to own employees, while the Maersk global standards on thirdparty labour applies to contract/third-party labour.

The Commit Rule, which is part of the broader Maersk Commit governance framework, describes the fundamental rights of employees and colleagues as foundational to a positive working environment. When it comes to workers of our suppliers, starting with our Supplier Code of Conduct as a base, we further clarify labour expectations with the global third-party labour standards (please see Sustainable Procurement page 130-131).

These policies are aligned with international standards such as the UN International Labour Organisation core conventions and the UN Global Compact and cover all fundamental labour rights, including guidelines on forced and child labour, adequate housing and sanitation, wages and working hours. They are further supported by internal guidelines for flexible working, a global principle of rewards policy, a global employee benefits and rewards policy and other topic-specific policies on e.g. safety and DE&I, which all apply to the working conditions for employees of Maersk.

Maersk has three main employee relations and labour rights focus areas. The first is how we manage the risks of violation of employee

rights for third-party labour. This is particularly material to our strategic business focus of driving growth in the Logistic & Services segment, which depends on third-party relationships, and where we operate in regions with higher risk of violations of employee rights.

The second is technology and business growth – how we secure the ethical use of technologies in our operations to ensure labour standards are respected and implemented as we grow our business. The final focus is on wages – employees should as a minimum be paid an adequate wage. A 2024 assessment of adequate wages across own employees, based on the guidance from the CSRD and available benchmarks, showed that no employees are paid below the applicable adequate wage benchmark. We are currently developing a framework for assessing local adequate wage levels for contracted employees.

As part of our human rights due diligence processes, potential negative impacts and risks are monitored on an ongoing basis via joint business reviews, site audits and a biannual self-assessment for compliance with the Commit Rule. These processes allow us to identify emerging risks within our operations and develop targeted action plans to mitigate such risks.

Targets and progress

Key actions

We have set the strategic target of training 100% of our in-scope employees on employee relations and labour rights. At the end of 2024, 94% of Maersk employees have completed the mandatory employee and labour relations e-learning. While this is an improvement compared to 2023, more work is needed to address challenges in reaching all employee groups. We maintain the rigour of a 100% target also for 2025, with a particular focus on ensuring that all new employees are trained as part of their onboarding process.

• During 2024, we broadened the rollout of the global standards on third-party labour through targeted training for leaders, addressing unique risks across APM Terminals and Logistics & Services. APM Terminals achieved 85% compliance, while Logistics & Services

100% of employees (in scope) trained in employee relations and labour rights (by 2024) (2023: 90%)

94%

reached 42%. To further close identified gaps and achieve full compliance in 2025, we have identified a need to further strengthen internal capabilities within employee and labour relations. As a result, APM Terminals created a labour excellence organisation and regional focus leads were appointed in Maersk's frontline Logistics & Services.

  • We launched a tracking app in 2024 to monitor training progress, supplier performance and compliance risks, providing a consolidated dashboard across the People function, procurement and operations. This effort is supported by steering committees consisting of senior executive management for APM Terminals and Logistics & Services, to oversee progress and to ensure full compliance. In 2025, we plan to expand the tracking app use across the business as a single source of truth for documenting compliance.
  • In 2024, our Supplier Code of Conduct and Commit Rule were updated to align with the new global standards on third-party labour.
  • Maersk's global labour rights council completed a company-wide labour rights assessment as part of our due diligence, with action plans for 2025 focusing on areas such as working hours and overtime payment.
  • We performed an assessment of adequate wages across own employees in 2024, based on the guidance from European Sustainability Reporting Standards and available benchmarks. The results showed that none of our employees are paid below the applicable adequate wage benchmark.

118 A.P. Moller - Maersk

Annual Report 2024

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Performance data

Number of employees

EFRAG ID
S1-06_01
Number of employees
in 2024 (headcount)
SBM-1_03
SBM-1_04
S1-6_09
S1-6_10
S1-6_03 Total number of employees 108,160
S1-6_03 Average number of employees 106,6261

1 Refer also to the most representative average number of employees (FTEs) number in note 2.2 operating costs of the consolidated financial statements. Average number of employees (headcount) is the average number of individual employees during the year while FTEs (as stated in note 2.2 operating costs of the consolidated financial statements) is calculated based on working hours and reported as an average for the full-year.

At year-end 2024, Maersk employed 108,160 employees, and the average number of employees during the year was 106,626.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Total number of employees

Total number of employees is the headcount of employees with an employment contract with Maersk, who are on payroll regardless of the type of contract at year end. Excluded are employees on garden leave and unpaid leave, contractors and third-party workers. The number of employees is based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems.

Average number of employees

The average number of employees is calculated as average number of employees (headcount) per month during the year.

Number of employees by gender

EFRAG ID
S1-06_01
Gender Number of employees
in 2024 (headcount)
S1-06_01 Male 70,100
S1-06_01 Female 37,459
S1-06_01 Other 3
S1-06_01 Not disclosed 598

At year-end 2024, of the 108,160 employees employed by Maersk, 70,100 were recorded as male, 37,459 were recorded as female, 3 were recorded as other and 598 were recorded as not disclosed.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Number of employees by gender

The number of employees by gender is the number of males, females, other and not disclosed in the total number of employees at 31 December in the reporting year. The gender categorisation is based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Number of employees by contract type by gender

2024
EFRAG ID Female Male Other Not
disclosed
Total
S1-6_07 Number of employees (headcount) 37,459 70,100 3 598 108,160
S1-6_07 Number of permanent employees (headcount) 31,039 56,301 3 563 87,906
S1-6_07 Number of temporary employees (headcount) 6,420 13,799 0 35 20,254
S1-6_07 Number of non-guaranteed hours employees (headcount) 0 0 0 0 0

Maersk does not employ any employees on non-guaranteed hours contracts, and the majority of Maersk's workforce is on permanent contracts.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Number of employees (headcount) by contract type

The number of employees (headcount) by contract type by gender is the number of permanent, temporary and non-guaranteed hours employees in the total number of employees at 31 December in the reporting year. The contract type and gender categorisation are based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems.

Number of employees by country

EFRAG ID Country Number of employees
in 2024 (headcount)
S1-6_04
S1-6_05
India 16,159
S1-6_04
S1-6_05
Denmark 15,820
S1-6_04
S1-6_05
China 11,908
S1-6_04
S1-6_05
USA 11,126

For 2024, Maersk had more than 10% of its total workforce employed in each of the countries of India, China and the USA. Denmark has been included in the list as Maersk's seafarer population is employed by a Danish legal entity and thus has been allocated to Denmark. The seafarer population totals more than 12,000 employees.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Number of employees by country

The number of employees by country is the number of employees in countries where Maersk has more than 50 employees, representing at least 10% of the total number of employees at 31 December in the reporting year. The employees by country specification is based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems.

Performance

Financials

Number of employees by contract type by region

2024
EFRAG ID Asia
Pacific
Europe Indian subcontinent,
Middle East, Africa
Latin
America
North
America
S1-6_07
S1-6_08
Number of employees
(headcount)
27,015 32,781 23,770 10,526 14,068
S1-6_07
S1-6_08
Number of permanent employees
(headcount)
19,138 21,959 23,400 9,448 13,961
S1-6_07
S1-6_08
Number of temporary employees
(headcount)
7,877 10,822 370 1,078 107
S1-6_07
S1-6_08
Number of non-guaranteed
hours employees (headcount)
0 0 0 0 0

At year-end 2024, the share of employees in Maersk's regions of Asia Pacific, Europe and the Indian subcontinent - Middle East and Africa were 25%, 30% and 22%, respectively, with the Latin America and North America regions combined accounting for 22% of the employees in Maersk.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Number of employees (headcount) by contract type by region

The number of employees (headcount) by contract type by region is the number of employees by contract type by region at 31 December in the reporting year. The employee contract type and region specifications are based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems.

Employee attraction and retention

EFRAG ID Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 20201
Entity
specific
Employee engagement
survey score
Percentile rank 65 60 67 59 54
S1-6_11 Number of employees
who left the company
Number 11,835 - - - -
S1-6_12 Total employee turnover rate % 11 - - - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

In 2024, our employee engagement survey (EES) results improved as engagement scored at the 65th percentile. We have narrowed the gap to our 2025 target (75th percentile). The progress recorded for 2024 is driven by an improvement across all questions included in the EES. For 2024, the employee turnover rate was 11%.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Employee engagement survey score

The employee engagement survey score is calculated as Maersk's aggregated ranking of employee engagement relative to Maersk's survey vendors' global organisational employee engagement norm.

Total employee turnover rate

The total employee turnover is calculated based on the average number of employees and the number of employees who left the company during the year.

Number of employees who left the company

The number of employees who left the company is the number of employees who left the organisation voluntarily or due to dismissal, retirement or death while employed by Maersk during the year. The number of employees who left during the year is based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Diversity of our workforce

EFRAG ID Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 20201
S1-9_01 Women in leadership
(job level 6+)
# 340 359 331 233 189
S1-9_02 % 27 27 26 22 21
Entity Women in management
(job level 4+)
# 6,405 6,170 5,459 4,228 3,224
specific % 35 35 33 33 31
Entity
specific
Target nationalities in executive
leadership (job levels 8 and 9)
% (headcount) 21 20 16 15 12
Entity
specific
Diversity in teams (gender) % 58 - - - -
Entity
specific
Diversity in teams (nationality) % 85 - - - -
S1-9_03 Employees under 30 years old # 23,909 - - - -
% 22 - - - -
S1-9_04 Employees between 30-50
years old
# 71,946 - - - -
% 67 - - - -
S1-9_05 Employee over 50 years old # 12,305 - - - -
% 11 - - - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

For 2024, the share of women in leadership and the share of women in management are on par with 2023. This is the result of efforts made in 2024 to continue the progress in the face of significant and necessary reorganisations that impacted Maersk's workforce in late 2023. We also recorded a relatively higher level of gender diversity in teams of leaders in CEO -1 and CEO -2 layers. Through focused efforts, our target nationalities in executive leadership saw an overall improvement. Concerted efforts are required in 2025 to reach the targets of 30% and 40% for women in leadership and management, respectively, and to meet the target of 30% target nationalities.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Women in leadership

Women in leadership is the percentage of women at job levels 6, 7, 8 and 9, corresponding to leaders, senior leaders and executives, compared to the total headcount at the same levels. Seafarers are not included in the calculation of women in leadership since seafarers do not have the same job level categories as our other employee groups.

Women in management

Women in management is the percentage of women at job levels 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 and 9, corresponding to managers, senior managers, leaders, senior leaders and executives, compared to the total headcount at the same levels. Seafarers are not included in the calculation of women in management since seafarers do not have the same job level categories as our other employee groups.

Target nationalities in executive leadership

Target nationalities in leadership is the percentage of leaders with non-OECD country nationalities at job levels 8 and 9, corresponding to executives, compared to the total headcount at the same levels.

Diversity in teams

Diversity in teams expresses the percentage of leaders with diverse teams based on 1) gender and 2) nationality at year-end. A team is defined as the direct reports to the leader (hierarchical view), excluding executive assistants and other administrative staff. The scope of diversity in teams is leaders at the CEO-1 and CEO-2 layers.

Team diversity is assessed and calculated per leader based on two parameters: gender and nationality. The assessments are binary: either the team is diverse or non-diverse for that parameter. For a team to be considered gender diverse, the percentage of one gender must not surpass 70% of the team headcount, excluding executive assistants and other administrative staff. Similarly, for a team to be considered nationality diverse, the percentage of one nationality must not surpass 70% of the team headcount, excluding executive assistants and other administrative staff.

Employee age diversity

The employee age diversity is the number and share of employees that are under 30 years old, between 30 and 50 years old (30 and 50 included), and over 50 years old. Age is defined as the chronological age, i.e. the total period in years a person/employee has existed. Age distribution of employees is based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems.

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Gender diversity of our seafarers 2024

EFRAG ID Female Male Other Not
disclosed
% of
females
Entity
specific
Total 719 11,449 0 0 6
Entity
specific
Senior officers 29 2,373 0 0 1
Entity
specific
Junior officers 89 2,727 0 0 3
Entity
specific
Cadets 372 1,372 0 0 21
Entity
specific
Rating 229 4,977 0 0 4

In 2024, Maersk reached an important milestone by employing almost 6% of female seafarers across the fleet. According to the IMO, the industry average is 2%. Attracting more female colleagues remains a priority across our key sourcing areas where we continue to build, grow and promote career paths for women. Key initiatives include special training programmes for young women in select markets, proactively positioning Maersk as maritime employer with career opportunities, and collaborating with schools and universities.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Gender diversity of our seafarers

Gender diversity of our seafarers is the number and share of females within Maersk's seafarer population at year-end. The gender diversity of seafarers is based on registrations in Maersk's HR systems. For 2024, we have applied the gender categories of male and female, which is currently in our HR system for seafarers, and all seafarers have a gender category according to this. In 2025, we will work towards including all four gender categories.

Employee relations and labour rights training

EFRAG ID Unit 2024 20231 20221 2021 2020
Entity
specific
Employee relations and labour
rights training
Completion
rate
94 90 83 - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

For 2024, we recorded a 4 percentage point improvement in the completion rate for the employee relations and labour rights training compared to 2023. We continue to strive for an 100% completion rate for the employees in scope for the employee relations and labour rights training.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Employee relations and labour rights training

Employee relations and labour rights training is the completion rate of employees in scope for the employee relations and labour rights e-learning out of the total employee population in scope. The employees in scope for the e-learning in 2024 are active office-based Maersk employees. This excludes office-based employees on long-term leave, consultants and employees that have joined Maersk after 31 October in the reporting year. The completion rate is based on registrations in Maersk's Learning Management system. The employees in scope of the training cover 58% of the total employees in Maersk during 2024.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Annual total remuneration ratio

Compensation metrics

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

The gender pay gap is calculated as the difference of average annual total remuneration between female and male employees, expressed as a percentage of the average annual total remuneration of male employees. The annual total remuneration for all own employees is calculated using the fully loaded cost index. Fully loaded cost is calculated per job level and country, and is an estimation of the benefits, guaranteed allowances, employer liabilities, on-target short-term incentives, on-target long-term incentives and recognition costs for 2024. The calculation is based on headcount and the estimated annual total remuneration at 31 December in the reporting year. Excluded from the calculation are learners, interns, graduates, students, cadets, long-term assignees and inactive employees on unpaid or garden leave.

Gender pay gap

The annual total remuneration ratio is calculated by comparing the annual total remuneration of the highest paid employee in Maersk with the annual median total remuneration of the rest of the own employees in Maersk. The annual total remuneration for all own employees is calculated using the fully loaded cost index. Fully loaded cost is calculated per job level and country, and is an estimation of the benefits, guaranteed allowances, employer liabilities, on-target short-term incentives, on-target long-term incentives and recognition costs for 2024.

The calculation is based on headcount and the estimated annual total remuneration at 31 December in the reporting year. Excluded from the calculation are learners, interns, graduates, students, cadets, long-term assignees and inactive employees on unpaid or garden leave.

Uncertainties and estimates

EFRAG ID Unit 2024 S1-16_01 Gender pay gap % 5 S1-16_02 Annual total remuneration ratio ratio 205

For 2024, our first company-wide gender pay gap analysis showed a 5% difference of average pay between female and male employees. The annual total remuneration ratio result for 2024 landed at 205. In the coming years, we will continue to refine our approach, which may also impact the outcome of the KPIs.

When preparing the gender pay gap, employees with annual salaries and part-time salaries are converted to full-time equivalents as part of the calculation methodology. In order to ensure cross-country comparability, we apply a standard formula to calculate the hourly rate for all employees. The calculation is based on a 40-hour work week or 2,080 hours per year for all employees. This is an estimate since actual and contractual working hours vary from country to country.

When preparing the annual total remuneration ratio and the gender pay gap, the fully loaded cost index is used as the basis of calculation. The fully loaded cost includes benefits, guaranteed allowances, employer liabilities, ontarget short-term incentives, on-target long-term incentives and recognition costs for Maersk's own employees for 2024. The on-target costs for short and long-term incentives/bonus are estimates as the actual costs are dependent on various factors not fully known at the time of reporting.

Employees paid below the applicable adequate wage benchmark for 2024

EFRAG ID Country % of employees
S1-10_03 N/A 0

For 2024, our assessment shows that we have no employees in any country that are paid below the applicable adequate wage benchmark.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Percentage of employees paid below the applicable adequate wage benchmark

The percentage of employees paid below the applicable adequate wage benchmark is prepared and reported as the percentage of employees in any country where not all Maersk employees are paid an adequate wage, and is based on the total number of employees at 31 December in the reporting year. Adequate wages is determined as:

In the European Economic Area (EEA):

The minimum wage set in accordance with Directive (EU) 2022/2041 of the European Parliament and of the Council on adequate minimum wages in the European Union. In the period until Directive (EU) 2022/2041 enters into force, where there is no applicable minimum wage determined by legislation or collective bargaining in an EEA country, Maersk uses an adequate wage benchmark from a neighbouring country with a similar socio-economic status or not lower than a commonly referenced international norm such as 60% of the country's median wage and 50% of the gross average wage.

Outside of the EEA:

  • i. The wage level established in any existing international, national or sub-national legislation, official norms or collective agreements, based on an assessment of a wage level needed for a decent standard of living;
  • ii. If none of the instruments identified in (i) exist, any national or sub-national minimum wage established by legislation or collective bargaining; or
  • iii. Living Wage benchmark (typical family law) as provided by Wage Indicator.

Excluded from the calculation are learners, interns, graduates, students, cadets, long-term assignees and inactive employees on unpaid or garden leave.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Safety and security

EFRAG ID Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 20201
S1-14_02 Fatalities Number 1 4 9 4 1
S1-14_04 Lost time incidents (LTIs)2 Number 493 376 282 270 327
S1-14_05 Lost time incident frequency (LTIf)2 Rate 1.53 1.143 0.93 0.93 1.22
Entity
specific
Learning teams completed
following a high potential incident
Completion
rate
99 99 83 - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

2 The Lost time incidents (LTIs) and Lost time incident frequency (LTIf) include both own- and non-employee workers (contracted workers) working under our responsibility.

3 Restated from previously reported figure of 1.11 to align with the updated operational control definition as outlined in the sustainability statement basis of preparation. Consequently, two terminals that were previously considered under operational control have been excluded from the reporting for 2023 and 2024. The reported numbers for 2021 and 2020 have not been restated.

Regrettably, we had one fatal incident involving a contracted colleague in a warehouse in the Philippines on 26 December 2024. While we have seen a significant reduction in the number of fatalities since 2022, the loss of a colleague underscores that we still have much work to do on understanding and staying ahead of our risks and building the right safety culture.

The lost time incident frequency (LTIf) increased to 1.53 compared to 1.14 in 2023. This is driven by increased lost time incidents (LTIs) in Logistics & Services and in APM Terminals. In Logistics & Services, an approximately 50% year-over-year increase in recorded LTIs reflected an improved safety reporting culture, which is expected to be further strengthened in the upcoming years. APM Terminals experienced more incidents during vessel lashing, prompting work on standardising best practices in close collaboration with stevedores. Fleet LTIs, mainly involving slips, trips, falls and pinching injuries among newcomers are being addressed through enhanced safety training.

For 2024, the share of learning teams completed following a high potential incident remained on par with 2023, standing at a 99% completion rate. We remain committed to reaching 100% of learning teams completed following a high potential incident.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Scope and consolidation:

The consolidation of safety data differs from the financial principles used across the sustainability statement.

Safety data is consolidated using an operational control approach. Operational control is defined as the situation where Maersk or one of its subsidiaries has full authority to introduce and implement its operating policies at the entity, i.e. an operationally controlled investee (such as associates, joint ventures or unconsolidated subsidiaries). In such cases, Maersk is responsible for the health, safety and environmental (HSE) management of the people, processes and facility and is liable to report 100% of the ESG data for the entity in question. Operational control is determined by looking at the contractual arrangements to determine whether Maersk has the full authority to introduce and implement its operating policies at the operation. In 2024, it has been assessed that Maersk does not have operationally controlled investees in e.g. associates, joint ventures, or unconsolidated subsidiaries. This implies that the scope and treatment of entities under financial control and operation control do not differ for 2024.

Mobile assets are included when operated by Maersk. For vessels, the International Safety Management Code Document of Compliance must be held by Maersk to be included in the safety data.

Fatalities

Fatalities is the headcount of work-related accidents leading to the death of the employee regardless of time between injury and death.

Lost time incidents (LTIs)

A lost time incident is a work-related injury, which results in an individual being unable to return to work and carry out any of his/her duties within 24 hours following the injury, unless caused by delays in getting medical treatment. Excluded from LTIs are suicide or attempted suicide, 'natural causes', incidents during the commute to and from the regular place of work and incidents which occur off the ship, but where the consequences appear onboard at a later point in time.

Lost time incident frequency (LTIf)

Lost time incident frequency is the number of lost time incidents per million exposure hours. LTIs used to calculate the LTIf follows the definition for LTIs. Exposure hours are the total number of work hours in which an employee is exposed to work-related hazards and risks. Leave and non-work-related sickness are excluded from exposure hours.

Uncertainties and estimates

When preparing the lost time incident frequency, the exposure hours performed by Maersk's own and nonemployees (contractors) are used as the basis for calculating the frequency. Since actual exposure hours are not registered for all employees across Maersk's operations, Maersk applies estimates where actual exposure hours are not available. The estimates are based on the type of work and employee contracts, e.g. certain number of exposure hours for seafarers aboard a vessel and certain number of exposure hours for office-based employees.

Learning teams completed following a high potential incident

Learning teams completed following a high potential incident is calculated as the share of learning teams completed following a high potential incident has been recorded. The number of high potential incidents and learning teams completed is based on reporting by brands and maintained and quality-assured by the Group Safety & Resilience team of Maersk. To give the organisation sufficient time to complete a learning team and maintain completeness in our reporting, the reporting period runs from 31 October in the previous year to 31 October in the reporting year, i.e. for 2024 the reporting period is 1 November 2023 to 31 October 2024.

A high potential incident may be exempted from conducting a learning team in cases where a full-scale investigation has been carried out by internal or external parties, or the involved parties are outside of Maersk's operational control, or legal circumstances does not allow us to engage due to a legal investigation, or due to a recurrence of an incident for which a learning team has been previously completed.

Governance

At A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk), high standards of respon sible business practices are foundational for the services we deliver to customers and the value we create for the communities where we operate.

BUSINESS ETHICS

Target by 2024 (recurring) 100% of employees (in scope) trained in business ethics

SUSTAINABLE PROCUREMENT

Targets by 2024
(recurring)

100% of suppliers (in scope) committed
to the Supplier Code of Conduct

>85% of strategic/high-risk suppliers
undergoing ESG assessments

>80% of high-risk category suppliers with
Improvement Plan successfully closed

100% procurement staff trained
in Sustainable Procurement
DATA AND AI ETHICS
Target by 2024
(recurring)
100% of employees (in scope) trained
on data ethics
RESPONSIBLE TAX

Ongoing ambition Ensure full compliance with tax regulations in all countries where we operate

PERFORMANCE DATA

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Governance Business ethics

Overview of Maersk's material impacts, risks and opportunities related to Governance

Negative impact Financial risk

Financial opportunity

Legal and regulatory compliance

Impact and risk of cases of noncompliance on anti-corruption laws, international sanctions or transport of illegal goods

The legal and regulatory landscape in which Maersk operates is complex, and Maersk could be subject to compliance cases in connection with violations of anti-corruption laws, international sanctions, transportation of illegal goods, competition law and/or data privacy. Corruption can negatively impact company culture and society, eroding trust and exacerbating inequality in societies.

Grievance and remedy

Access to grievance and remedy for affected stakeholders

Potential barriers to access grievance mechanisms for our stakeholders (e.g. language, fear of retaliation, psychological or physical barriers) could result in violations of rights and lack of access to remedy. The risk is heightened in the value chain.

Sustainable procurement

Supplier relationship management
Risks of noncompliance with Maersk's standards
by our suppliers
Risks of suppliers not complying with Maersk's standards,
including the Supplier Code of Conduct, could lead to Maersk
being subject to cases and incidents that negatively impact
Maersk's reputation and trust with customers and/or direct
financial costs.
Where
Value chain
Time
Short term
Payment practices
Ensuring timely and fair payment practices to suppliers
Where
Value chain
Time

Potential impact on suppliers' working capital and cash flow affecting their financial and operational stability. Especially with regard to late payments for small and medium-sized undertakings.

Where Value chain Short term

Where Own operation Value chain Time Short term

Where Own operation Value chain Time Short term

Data and AI ethics

Ethical use of data and AI

Ethical use of our stakeholders' data and protection of individuals' right to privacy

Potential risk of undue influence, mishandling and abuse of data and artificial intelligence can have negative implications to the customers and business partners whose data has been handled unethically. This erodes trust in Maersk as a business partner. Potential violation of employees' and consumers' right to privacy if their personal data is not handled responsibly.

Where Own operation

Time Short term

Responsible tax

Tax governance

Risk of different interpretations and tax controversy

Tax regulations are complex and differences in interpretation is considered a key risk, with impacts depending on the specific situation.

Where

Time Short term

Own operation

127

Responsible business conduct

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) is a purpose-driven company operating in a complex environment that relies on integrated global supply chains. "We operate based on responsible business practices" is a core commitment of our ESG strategy, underpinning efforts to ensure compliance with relevant laws, regulations and responsible business conduct, as well as having adequate risk mitigation.

As a global leader in logistics services, Maersk serves 100,000+ customers and operates in almost 130 countries with a complex footprint across our business segments and value chain. We work to ensure that we have the right corporate culture to live up to our Purpose and Core Values. Our approach to this commit ment is driven by our Commit governance framework and ESG categories on business ethics, sustainable procurement, data ethics and AI and responsible tax.

Corruption undermines social and economic development, destabilises the business environment and adds to the cost of doing business and participating in global trade. Sanctions and export controls have grown exponentially over the last three years, and with growing geopolitical tensions, they are impacting global trade more than ever. Anti-competitive behaviour distorts fair market conditions, impacting global supply chains.

In this dynamic business environment and complex legal and regulatory landscape, it is imperative for Maersk to continuously enhance our compliance programme to adapt to evolving regulatory requirements, market conditions and geopolitical events. Increasing regulation on value chain due diligence, including the EU Corporate Sustainability Due Diligence Directive is also raising the importance of ensuring that Maersk's suppliers meet our global standards and local laws around business ethics, human and labour rights, working conditions and employment practices and environmental responsibility.

Maersk also sees a sharp rise in contraband, from narcotics to illegal wildlife and timber trafficking, and stolen and counterfeit goods. These criminal activities continue to affect our supply chain and require ongoing, proactive management to mitigate the risks of threats to people, bribery attempts and opera tional disruptions that are often associated with contraband trafficking.

Finally, as the digitalisation of supply chains continues to accelerate, including the rapid adoption of generative AI, responsibly managing data from business partners and customers has never been more relevant to maintaining their trust in Maersk.

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Business ethics

Corruption, sanctions and export controls, competition law violations and data privacy and ethics are the most material business ethics risks of Maersk. Failing to live up to our business ethics commitment could subject Maersk to legal or reputational risks and negatively impact company culture and societies where we operate. Our policies, approach and governance of business ethics focus on high standards for responsible business practices everywhere we operate, aligned with international requirements and with a heightened focus in jurisdictions with greater exposure to these risks and human rights abuses.

Policies and approach

The Maersk Code of Conduct sets global standards for how we engage with colleagues, customers, suppliers, communities, authorities and other stakeholders. As a global company, we take an active responsibility for the society and environment where we operate and are guided by international standards such as the Universal Declaration of Human Rights and the principles of the UN Global Compact. The Code is publicly available on Maersk.com in 17 languages.

The standards in our Code are supported by and explained in more detail in the Commit Business Ethics Rules. These rules are to be adhered to by all employees regardless of business association or geographic location, including contracted staff who act on behalf of Maersk and employees in controlled joint ventures.

Employees are required to take Code of Conduct trainings (onboarding and yearly refreshers). We conduct ongoing campaigns and activities linked to international awareness events such as Business Ethics Day, Anti-Corruption Day and Illegal Wildlife Day. Other communication activities include our Speak-Up and No Retaliation campaign, Sanctions and Export Controls awareness, Dawn Raid Preparedness and Data Privacy Due Diligence Check campaign.

We are committed to investigating allegations of business misconduct promptly, independently and objectively. Depending on the type of case, investigations are carried out by independent and objective

investigators from relevant teams in Maersk or by external advisors. Protocols are in place for internal investigations and disciplinary actions to ensure a swift and effective response to compliance violations. Cases of non-compliance are reported to the Board of Directors and Executive Leadership Team through the Risk and Compliance Committee.

The Commit Rules covering anti-corruption, sanctions and export controls, competition law violations and data privacy set out the measures to identify, mitigate and manage compliance risks in jurisdictions where we operate. The efforts are carried out through dedicated teams of 70+ compliance professionals and a comprehensive Business Compliance Ambassadors' network. These experts, represented in all regional offices and many high-risk locations, partner with colleagues in the business to detect, assess and mitigate risks.

Maersk is an active and founding member of the Maritime Anti-Corruption Network (MACN), working to eliminate corruption in the maritime and port industries. In 2024, Maersk partnered with MACN and USAID for a two-year project under the headline "Doing Business with Integrity". This collaboration is part of USAID's Countering Transnational Corruption Grand Challenge for Development, which is set to strengthen the fight against transnational maritime sector corruption.

Targets and progress

We have set the strategic target that 100% of our employees in scope complete our Code of Conduct training each year. This year, 94% of Maersk employees in scope completed the mandatory Code of Conduct training. Challenges in reaching all employee groups remain, particularly due to organisational changes, however, we are working to close this gap to 100% completion in 2025.

94%

100% of employees (in scope) trained in the Maersk Code of Conduct (2023: 92%)

A risk assessment is performed at least every two years, with the most recent in 2023, to identify high risk areas, functions and business activities. This is tracked through the percentage of operations covered by a risk assessment on compliance and business ethics targeting 100%.

Key actions

As we continue to advance on our business ethics ambitions, we completed the following key actions in 2024:

  • Introduction of the 'Minerva' cargo screening platform, to automate compliance and adapt screening processes to evolving trade regulations, with an initial focus on sanctions screening.
  • Reporting of the bi-annual 2023 risk assessment to business leaders and functional heads and implementation of mitigating measures. A next-generation risk assessment is under development for 2025 deployment, with the goal of anchoring compliance risk ownership in the appropriate businesses and functions.
  • Working with sustainable procurement and vendor data management to integrate third-party management screening and assessment at the process level during vendor onboarding.
  • Digitalisation of key compliance approvals and processes to provide insights into operational and compliance risk trends and patterns within the business.
  • Completion of 87 compliance spot checks on selected entities and processes, covering critical risks within the areas of anti-corruption, sanctions compliance, competition law and data privacy.

ESRS G1, ESRS S1, ESRS S2

Sustainable procurement

Management of ESG risks in our supply chain network enhances stakeholder trust in our brand and equips us to meet current and upcoming supply chain due diligence regulations. Maersk's operations and procurement choices influence the social, envi ronmental and economic conditions within our industry, global supply chains and the communities we serve. We are continu ously enhancing the process of embedding ESG as a strategic priority throughout the supplier lifecycle. We promote supplier collaboration and engagement, driving co-development and innovation towards sustainable outcomes.

Policies and approach

Our updated 2024 Supplier Code of Conduct is aligned with the UN Guiding Principles and OECD Guidelines for Multinational Enterprises on Responsible Business Conduct. It reflects Maersk's values of ethical conduct, environmental stewardship and social responsibility.

Enforced through the Commit Sustainable Procurement Rule, the Code sets expectations for suppliers to uphold responsible practices in areas such as ethics, human rights, working conditions and environ mental standards, and in compliance with all applicable laws and reg ulations. The Code also outlines the expectation for our suppliers to implement the Code or similar requirements with their sub-suppliers. It is communicated through several internal channels and is publicly available on Maersk.com in 12 different languages.

Our approach to sustainable procurement is founded in our com mitment to proactively manage supply chain risks as our "licence to operate" and to comply with an evolving regulatory landscape, includ ing the upcoming Corporate Sustainability Due Diligence Directive (CSDDD). ESG due diligence is therefore an integral part of our sup plier selection process. We also focus on continuously building the capacity of our procurement team and business functions who inter act with suppliers to fully integrate ESG principles and ensure com -

Our approach to procurement emphasises ESG integration through three key priorities: value chain decarbonisation, human and labour rights and safety and resilience.

Supporting Maersk's science-based targets, we focus on reducing scope 3 emissions, targeting key hotspots using data-driven insights and initiatives like supplier maturity assessments and abatement models.

The Sustainable Procurement programme contributes to the effective development, deployment and monitoring of our global standards on third-party labour and safety across our supply chain, to promote fair working conditions. Human rights and labour rights are integrated into our due diligence processes for suppliers. To address emerging risks from new business activities such as the development of green fuel supply chains, we are developing a green fuel sourcing due diligence framework. Site visits and workshops are conducted to raise awareness, with the aim that suppliers adhere to Maersk's standards in all aspects of their operations. This is supported by dedicated safety superintendents who oversee and conduct periodic on-site safety training sessions.

We promote a speak-up culture and actively monitor whistleblower cases to ensure transparency and accountability on identified value chain issues. Suppliers are required to communicate the Whistleblower channel's existence, and to ensure that their employees and subcon tractors are made aware of it. Each reported issue is investigated and, where necessary, appropriate remedies are provided.

Furthermore, we are piloting business resilience requirements with selected suppliers to strengthen Maersk's business continuity manage ment framework, identifying learnings and scaling it for global applica tion across our supplier base.

We recognise that ensuring fair and timely compensation for suppli ers is part of responsible supplier engagement. Our standard payment terms vary based on the service/spend category. We strive to align pay ments with these terms and continuously monitor payment practices to ensure compliance and improve supplier's experience. We are build ing visibility on supplier-related payment impacts, especially regarding late payments to small and medium-sized businesses through internal processes and tools, minimising the impact of delayed payments by prioritising prompt and equitable payment processes, aligned with local and national requirements. We are also actively engaging with suppliers on effective arbitration on late-payment related issues.

Sustainable procurement targets Percent

100% of suppliers (in scope) committed to the Supplier Code of Conduct by 2024.

Target
2024 100%
2024 87%
2023 95%

85% of tier 1 high-risk category suppliers undergoing ESG assessment by 2024.

Target
2024
85%
2024 47%
2023 71%

>80% of high-risk category suppliers with Improvement Plan successfully closed by 2024.

Targets and progress

We have set an annual target for all of our suppliers in scope to sign and comply with our Supplier Code of Conduct, supported by a mandatory Sustainable Procurement Clause. Currently, 87% have signed the Code. The decrease from 2023 is a result of integration of additional supplier contracts into the compliance framework and improvements to our calculation methods for the KPI.

We evaluate supplier compliance towards our Code across key areas such as anti-corruption, health and safety, labour and human rights and environmental practices. Our evaluation process includes pre-screening, desktop assessments, on-site audits and improvement plans to address identified gaps. During 2024, we digitised our reporting structure, which resulted in an expanded addressable baseline for the supplier assessment metric, causing a 24 percentage point decrease compared to 2023. To close the gap to the target, we are refining our processes and deploying advanced digital tools. Throughout the year, our assessment focus remained on categories including terminals, outsourced labour, shipyards and drydocks, covering over USD 2.5bn of spend within high-risk suppliers. We are committed to assessing the vast majority of suppliers, including prospects, within high-risk areas against Supplier Code of Conduct.

We continue to work closely with our suppliers to address the gaps identified as part of the improvement plans, resulting from assessments. A majority of the improvement plans have successfully been completed, tracking above our target and showing year-onyear improvement. To build on this progress and further sustain performance, we are integrating ESG more deeply into our end-to-end supplier lifecycle processes. We enable this through the development of a digital ESG solution and are investing in capability-building across the procurement community. Our procurement team has now achieved 99% completion of the mandatory Sustainable Procurement training.

Key actions

In 2024, we continued working towards our Sustainable Procurement commitments through key actions including:

• Update of our Supplier Code of Conduct, in preparation for evolving regulatory and market expectations.

  • Prepare for embedding ESG considerations into Maersk's Sourceto-Pay process to ensure ESG criteria are fully integrated into procurement decisions and supplier evaluations.
  • Development of a risk-based framework that incorporates geographic and industry ESG risk lenses, combined with supplier ESG performance and business criticality to prioritise supplier ESG engagements. Deployment is planned for 2025.
  • Implementation of our Third-Party Labour Standards across the contracted labour supplier category, ensuring consistent adherence to its requirements.
  • Development of safety standards for suppliers and planned pilot programmes with select suppliers to test and implement these standards in 2025.
  • Establishing the supply chain emissions baseline for hotspot identification and setting targets for supply chain categories aligned with our science-based targets. This will enable development of category-specific emission roadmaps.

ENTITY SPECIFIC

Data and AI ethics

Responsibly managing data from customers, business partners and employees is a critical issue in today's society. AI has a transformational impact on logistics and requires effective governance in place to responsibly unlock future innovation. Through strong governance and ethical use of data and AI, we mitigate risks and position Maersk as a digital frontrunner in our industry, in alignment with our Purpose and Core Values. This is essential to our customers, partners and our business strategy.

Policies and approach

Maersk's data ethics policy articulates our leadership aspirations based on four key principles: transparency, respect, security and innovation. Our ability to offer innovative logistics services relies on optimising customers' supply chains with data-powered technology. We maintain

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

the trust of our customers, business partners and employees by continuously improving how we safeguard this data and respectfully use it in our innovations.

The policy is anchored within Maersk's Commit governance framework, which includes touchpoints from data privacy, competition law and cyber security related polices, and is supported by awareness campaigns, standard operating procedures and controls embedded in processes and technology. Maersk's data ethics strategy balances impacts, opportunities and risks as we develop new products and services while implementing proper compliance measures.

The Risk and Compliance Committee provides strategic alignment and execution oversight. In addition, subcategory committees operationally drive the outcomes and roadmaps supported by accountable teams across corporate and business functions, coordinated by a dedicated data ethics team. The policy is publicly available on Maersk.com and embedded in our Code of Conduct.

Targets and progress

To ensure that our employees are well-equipped to navigate risks related to data, we have set a strategic target of 100% of employees in scope being trained on data ethics by year end. By the end of 2024, 93% of Maersk employees in scope completed our mandatory data ethics e-learning.

100% of employees (in scope) trained on data and AI ethics (2023: 91%) 93%

While challenges in reaching all employee groups remain, we maintain the rigour of a 100% target for 2025, with a particular focus on ensuring that all new employees are trained.

Key actions

In 2024, Maersk further matured its approach to data and AI ethics, improving and anchoring technology processes with clear organisational accountability. Key activities included:

• Implementation of a modern data privacy tool for process and application mapping and risk assessment and mitigation.

  • Implementation of automated data access management to ensure commercially confidential data is accessed only by allowed employees.
  • Implementation of a standardised process and tool for risk identification and management.
  • Development of governance effectiveness, measuring and implementing standard tools (registries, risks, reporting and dashboards).

For 2025, the focus is on stabilising our implemented processes with continuous improvements and further leveraging technology to increase automation and accuracy of data and AI ethics governance. Second, we will scale our governance approach for AI in support of regulatory readiness and our AI strategy.

ENTITY SPECIFIC

Responsible tax

Maersk strives to act responsibly and with integrity in all tax matters. We work closely with tax authorities to ensure that we fully disclose relevant information and pay the correct amount of taxes while balancing obligations towards our shareholders.

Policies and approach

The Maersk Responsible Tax approach is incorporated in the Maersk Code of Conduct and applies to the entire group (entities and employees). The Maersk Tax Principles and Strategy are approved by the Audit Committee on behalf of the Board of Directors.

We conduct and manage tax affairs in accordance with our Tax Principles, outlined in our 2024 Tax Report. These principles are reviewed annually and closely align with our Core Values and business strategy. We strive to be a compliant and accountable taxpayer in all countries where we operate. This includes:

• Managing tax risk and reputation with a responsible and transparent tax practice, e.g. instructions on the timely involvement of the global tax team.

  • We do not engage in artificial structures or other tax-driven engagements.
  • Accurate data provision required per law or upon request from authorities.
  • Reporting of violations of group tax principles in line with internal procedures.

Our approach to tax risk management aligns with Maersk's enterprise risk management and internal control framework, which includes tax controls. We constantly identify and manage tax risks to ensure adherence to our tax principles, including compliance with the letter and the spirit of the law. A clear procedure is in place for the assessment, management and reporting of identified tax risks, including quarterly updates to the Executive Leadership Team on both tax risks and tax strategy.

Our tax conduct is an ongoing effort with an ever-moving target as business and legal requirements continue evolving. We allocate significant resources to secure our adaptation to continuously emerging compliance requirements and governance, including the digitalisation of work where feasible, thus ensuring a continued, robust and efficient in-house tax function.

Targets and progress

We have not set measurable targets in regard to responsible tax. We aspire to act responsibly and with integrity in all tax matters and strive to be compliant in every jurisdiction across the world, considering both the letter and the spirit of the law.

Our key actions

A high focus this year has been on preparing reporting for compliance with the Global Minimum Taxation rules due to the Danish implementation of the Council Directive (EU) 2022/2523 of 14 December 2022.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Performance data

Code of Conduct training

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221 2021 2020
G1-3_07 Code of Conduct training Completion rate 94 92 83 - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

For 2024, we recorded a 2 percentage point improvement in the completion rate for the Code of Conduct training compared to 2023. We continue to strive for a 100% completion rate for the employees in scope for the Code of Conduct training.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Code of Conduct training

Code of Conduct training is the completion rate of employees in scope for the Maersk Code of Conduct e-learning out of the total employee population in scope. The employees in scope for the e-learning are active office-based Maersk employees. This excludes office-based employees on long-term leave, consultants and employees that have joined Maersk after 31 October in the reporting year.

The employees in scope of the Code of Conduct training cover 58% of the total employees in Maersk during 2024. The completion rate is based on registrations in Maersk's learning management system.

Operations covered by a risk assessment on compliance and business ethics

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221 20211 2020
Entity
specific
% of operations covered by a risk assessment
on compliance and business ethics risks
% 96 96 95 95 -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

Maersk completes a group-wide risk assessment on compliance and business ethics risks every second year. The most recent assessment was completed in 2023. This result has been carried forward for 2024. In addition to the group-wide risk assessments, we also perform specific risk assessments throughout the year.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

% of operations covered by a risk assessment on compliance and business ethics risks

% of operations covered by a risk assessment on compliance and business ethics risks is the percentage of entities that have completed the risk assessment survey on compliance and business ethics risks during the year when the assessment is rolled out. The group-wide risk assessment is carried out every second year with the latest one completed in 2023.

Thus, the 2023 result is carried forward for 2024. The % of operations covered by a risk assessment on compliance and business ethics risks is based on the records from Maersk's Global Entity Management System, considering owned or controlled operational entities.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Incidents of corruption and bribery

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024
G1-4_01 Number of convictions for violation of anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws # Nil
G1-4_02 Amount of fines for violation of anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws USD Nil
G1-6_04 Number of legal proceedings outstanding for late payments # Nil

Maersk has not been convicted for violation of anti-corruption or anti-bribery laws during 2024 and thus no fines have been paid in relation to such cases. Likewise, no legal proceedings for late payments are outstanding per year-end 2024.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Number of convictions for violation of anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws

The number of convictions for violation of anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws includes all convictions as a result of legal proceedings against A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S and/or any of its subsidiaries in the reporting year.

Amount of fines for violation of anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws

The amount of fines paid for violation of anticorruption and anti-bribery laws includes fines paid as a result of legal proceedings on these matters against A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S and/or any of its subsidiaries in the reporting year.

Number of legal proceedings outstanding for late payments

The number of legal proceedings outstanding for late payments includes all legal proceedings against A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S and/or any of its subsidiaries relating to late payments of business partners that are outstanding at year end.

Data and AI ethics

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 2022 1 2021 2020
Entity
specific
Data and AI ethics training Completion rate 93 91 67 - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

For 2024, we recorded a 2 percentage point improvement in the completion rate for the Data and AI ethics training compared to 2023. In 2024, focused efforts to roll out the training to office-based new joiners took place to drive up completion for outstanding employees. We continue to strive for a 100% completion rate for the employees in scope for the Data and AI ethics training.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Data ethics training

Data ethics training is the completion rate of employees in scope for the data and AI ethics e-learning out of the total employee population in scope. Employees must complete the training once. The employees in scope for the e-learning are active office-based Maersk employees that were employed at the time of launch of the e-learning in November 2022 and employees that have

since joined. This excludes office-based employees on long-term leave, consultants and employees that have joined Maersk after 31 October in the reporting year. The employees in scope of the data and AI ethics training cover 57% of the total employees in Maersk during 2024. The completion rate is based on registrations in Maersk's learning management system.

Sustainable procurement

EFRAG ID Indicator Unit 2024 20231 20221 2021 2020
Entity
specific
Suppliers committed to Maersk's
Supplier Code of Conduct
% 87 95 96 - -
Entity
specific
Tier 1 high-risk category/
strategic suppliers undergoing
ESG assessments
% 47 71 77 - -
Entity
specific
High-risk category/strategic
suppliers assessed with improvement
plans successfully closed
% 87 79 69 - -
Entity
specific
Procurement staff trained in
Sustainable Procurement (SP)
Completion
rate
99 91 - - -

1 Not covered by the Independent Auditor's limited assurance report.

For 2024, we recorded a decrease of 8 percentage points in the share of suppliers in scope that have committed to Maersk's Supplier Code of Conduct compared to 2023. The decrease is a result of integration of additional supplier contracts from recently acquired entities into the compliance framework and improvements made in our KPI calculation methodology. Our goal remains to have all suppliers committed to the Supplier Code of Conduct.

Compared to 2023, we recorded a significant decrease of 24 percentage points in the share of tier 1 high-risk category/strategic suppliers undergoing ESG assessments. The decrease is a result of digitisation of our reporting structure leading to an expanded metric baseline. The gap to the target of 85% will be addressed through an improved process and deployment of digital tools going forward.

The share of high-risk category/strategic suppliers assessed with improvement plans successfully closed increased by 8 percentage points in 2024 compared to 2023, and exceeded Maersk's target of 80%. This reflects our ongoing commitment to address gaps identified during supplier assessments.

By the end of 2024, 99% of procurement employees have completed our mandatory Sustainable Procurement training. This is a significant improvement compared to 2023, and we remain committed to driving awareness on ESG topics within our procurement community.

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Suppliers committing to Maersk's Supplier Code of Conduct

Suppliers committing to Maersk's Supplier Code of Conduct (CoC) is the percentage of existing valid contracts with active suppliers which include a sustainable procurement clause, a reference to Supplier CoC in the contract or a CoC acknowledgment document out of the total number of valid active supplier contracts. The suppliers committing to Maersk's Supplier CoC is based on registrations in Maersk's sustainable procurement database, DocuSign Insights.

Tier 1 high-risk category/strategic suppliers undergoing ESG assessments

Tier 1 high-risk category/strategic suppliers undergoing ESG assessments is the share of Tier 1 high-risk and strategic suppliers that have undergone an ESG assessment out of the total number of tier 1 high-risk category and strategic suppliers with valid contracts. The suppliers undergoing ESG assessments is based on registrations in database maintained by the sustainable procurement team.

High-risk category/strategic suppliers assessed with Improvement Plan successfully closed

High-risk category/strategic suppliers assessed with improvement plans successfully closed is the percentage of active high-risk category/ strategic suppliers with valid contracts that have successfully closed gaps observed within the agreed timelines through an improvement plan implementation out of the total high-risk category/ strategic suppliers with improvement plans. The suppliers assessed with Improvement Plan successfully closed is based on registrations made in database maintained by the sustainable procurement team.

Procurement staff trained in Sustainable Procurement (SP)

Procurement staff trained in Sustainable Procurement is the completion rate of procurement employees in scope for the SP e-learning out of the total employee population in scope. The employees in scope for the e-learning in 2024 are procurement employees in Maersk. This excludes procurement employees on long-term leave and procurement employees that have joined Maersk after 31 October in the reporting year. The completion rate is based on registrations in Maersk's learning management system.

Performance

The

Financials

Annual Report 2024

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024

Financials

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements Management's statement

Independent Auditor's Reports

Independent Auditor's limited assurance report 136

An electric future for terminals

Rijeka, Croatia

In 2024, APM Terminals broke ground on the Rijeka Gateway in Croatia – one of Europe's most modern container terminals. The majority of the Rijeka Gateway terminal's equipment will be electric and powered entirely by renewable electricity sources. The terminal also includes advanced water, lighting and noise management systems to minimise environmental impacts.

The remotely controlled terminal will foster economic growth in the region through innovation and high efficiency. Once operational in 2025, the terminal is expected to create around 300 direct jobs within the terminal alone and have an annual capacity of over one million TEUs.

Corporate governance

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Consolidated financial statements

Consolidated income statement

Consolidated income statement

Revenue
Operating costs
Other income
Other costs
2024
55,482
43,375
42
21
2023
51,065
41,574
117
17
Profit before depreciation, amortisation and impairment
losses, etc. (EBITDA)
12,128 9,591
Depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, net 6,220 6,615
Gains on sale of non-current assets, etc., net 222 523
Share of profit/loss in joint ventures and associated companies 369 435
Profit/loss before financial items (EBIT) 6,499 3,934
Financial income 1,885 1,804
Financial expenses 1,568 1,376
Profit before tax 6,816 4,362
Tax 584 454
Profit for the year 6,232 3,908
Of which:
Non-controlling interests 123 86
A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' share 6,109 3,822
227
227
Earnings per share, USD
Diluted earnings per share, USD
387
387

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income

Note 2024 2023
Profit for the year 6,232 3,908
Translation from functional currency to presentation currency:
Translation impact arising during the year -447 -16
Reclassified to income statement, gain on sale of non-current
assets, etc., net
5 44
4.4 Cash flow hedges:
Value adjustment of hedges for the year -167 27
Reclassified to income statement
– revenue 4 8
– operating costs 50 -41
– financial expenses 31 22
5.1 Tax on other comprehensive income 24 -6
Share of other comprehensive income of joint ventures
and associated companies, net of tax -3 -1
Total items that have been or may be reclassified subsequently
to the income statement
-503 37
4.6 Other equity investments (FVOCI), fair value adjustments for the year -60 17
4.3 Actuarial gains/losses on defined benefit plans, etc. 19 9
5.1 Tax on other comprehensive income 1 3
Total items that will not be reclassified to the income statement -40 29
Other comprehensive income, net of tax -543 66
Total comprehensive income for the year 5,689 3,974
Of which:
Non-controlling interests 112 71
A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' share 5,577 3,903

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

138

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Consolidated balance sheet at 31 December

Assets
Note 2024 2023
3.1 Intangible assets 9,824 10,124
3.2 Property, plant and equipment 28,245 27,059
3.3 Right-of-use assets 10,605 9,670
Investments in joint ventures 780 751
Investments in associated companies 965 999
4.6 Other equity investments 359 398
4.5 Derivatives 2 11
4.3 Pensions, net assets 125 120
Loan receivables 119 112
3.5 Other receivables 2,236 1,491
Financial non-current assets, etc. 4,586 3,882
5.1 Deferred tax 365 343
Total non-current assets 53,625 51,078
Inventories 1,601 1,658
4.5 Trade receivables 5,849 5,359
Tax receivables 519 355
4.5 Derivatives 47 137
3.5 Loan receivables 15,880 12,844
3.5 Other receivables 1,452 1,387
Prepayments 566 1,269
Receivables, etc. 24,313 21,351
4.6 Securities, etc. 1,580 -
Cash and bank balances 6,575 6,701
3.6 Assets held for sale or distribution 3 1,790
Total current assets 34,072 31,500
Total assets 87,697 82,578
Equity and liabilities
Note 2024 2023
4.1 Share capital 2,870 3,186
Reserves 54,047 50,844
Equity attributable to A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S 56,917 54,030
Non-controlling interests 1,030 1,060
Total equity 57,947 55,090
4.2 Lease liabilities, non-current 8,728 7,798
4.2 Borrowings, non-current 4,539 4,169
4.3 Pensions and similar obligations 179 191
3.7 Provisions 946 897
4.5 Derivatives 333 323
5.1 Deferred tax 834 766
Tax payables 246 438
Other payables 22 37
Other non-current liabilities 2,560 2,652
Total non-current liabilities 15,827 14,619
4.2 Lease liabilities, current 2,684 2,650
4.2 Borrowings, current 526 197
3.7 Provisions 756 812
Trade payables 6,698 6,401
Tax payables 621 442
4.5 Derivatives 225 72
Other payables 1,665 1,479
Deferred income 748 568
Other current liabilities 10,713 9,774
3.6 Liabilities associated with assets held for sale or distribution - 248
Total current liabilities 13,923 12,869
Total liabilities 29,750 27,488
Total equity and liabilities 87,697 82,578

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Consolidated cash flow statement

Note 2024 2023
Profit before financial items 6,499 3,934
2.3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3 Depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, net 6,220 6,615
2.4 Gain on sale of non-current assets, etc., net -222 -523
Share of profit/loss in joint ventures and associated companies -369 -435
5.5 Change in working capital -311 417
Change in provisions and pension obligations, etc. -3 150
Other non-cash items 252 166
Cash flow from operating activities before tax 12,066 10,324
Taxes paid -658 -681
Cash flow from operating activities 11,408 9,643
5.5 Purchase of intangible assets and property, plant and equipment -4,201 -3,646
Sale of intangible assets and property, plant and equipment 466 601
3.4 Acquisition of subsidiaries and activities -8 -140
Sale of subsidiaries and activities 28 953
Acquisition of joint ventures and associated companies -21 -18
Sale of joint ventures and associated companies 51 356
Dividends received 371 305
Sale of other equity investments 3 22
3.5 Other financial investments, net -3,042 4,687
Purchase/sale of securities -1,572 957
Cash flow from investing activities -7,925 4,077
4.2 Repayment of borrowings -705 -660
4.2 Repayments of lease liabilities -3,051 -3,226
4.2, 4.4 Proceeds from borrowings 2,167 845
Purchase of treasury shares -556 -3,120
Financial income received 1,087 1,086
Financial expenses paid -355 -233
4.2, 4.4 Financial expenses paid on lease liabilities -611 -563
Sale of treasury shares 9 24
Dividends distributed -1,333 -10,876
Dividends distributed to non-controlling interests -110 -92
Sale of non-controlling interests 1 -
Acquisition of non-controlling interest -33 -16
Other equity transactions -10 26
Cash flow from financing activities -3,500 -16,805
Net cash flow for the year -17 -3,085
Note 2024 2023
Cash and cash equivalents 1
January
6,730 10,038
Currency translation effect on cash and cash equivalents -170 -223
Cash and cash equivalents 31 December 6,543 6,730
Of which classified as assets held for sale - -47
Cash and cash equivalents 31 December 6,543 6,683
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and bank balances 6,575 6,701
Overdrafts 32 18
Cash and cash equivalents 31 December 6,543 6,683

Cash and bank balances include USD 928m (USD 1.0bn) relating to cash and bank balances in countries with exchange control or other restrictions. These funds are not readily available for general use by the parent company or other subsidiaries.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

140

Consolidated statement of changes in equity

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S
Note Share
capital
Translation
reserve
Reserve for
other equity
investments
Reserve
for hedges
Retained
earnings
Total Non
controlling
interests
Total equity
Equity 1
January 2023
3,392 -1,232 212 -27 61,646 63,991 1,041 65,032
Other comprehensive income, net of tax - 84 -25 12 10 81 -15 66
Profit for the year - - - - 3,822 3,822 86 3,908
Total comprehensive income for the year - 84 -25 12 3,832 3,903 71 3,974
Dividends to shareholders - - - - -10,824 -10,824 -94 -10,918
5.2 Value of share-based payments - - - - 28 28 - 28
Acquisition of non-controlling interests - - - - -16 -16 15 -1
Sale of non-controlling interests - - - - - - 1 1
4.1 Purchase of treasury shares - - - - -3,072 -3,072 - -3,072
4.1 Sale of treasury shares - - - - 24 24 - 24
4.1 Capital increases and decreases -206 - - - 206 - 26 26
4.6 Transfer of gain/loss on disposal of equity investments to retained earnings - - 2 - -2 - - -
Transfer of cash flow hedge reserve to non-current assets - - - -4 - -4 - -4
Total transactions with shareholders -206 - 2 -4 -13,656 -13,864 -52 -13,916
Equity 31 December 2023 3,186 -1,148 189 -19 51,822 54,030 1,060 55,090
2024
Other comprehensive income, net of tax - -366 -61 -60 -45 -532 -11 -543
Profit for the year - - - - 6,109 6,109 123 6,232
Total comprehensive income for the year - -366 -61 -60 6,064 5,577 112 5,689
Dividends to shareholders - - - - -1,191 -1,191 -108 -1,299
5.2 Value of share-based payments - - - - 36 36 - 36
Acquisition of non-controlling interests - - - - -14 -14 -19 -33
4.1 Purchase of treasury shares - - - - -529 -529 - -529
4.1 Sale of treasury shares - - - - 9 9 - 9
4.1 Capital increases and decreases -316 - - - 316 - 12 12
Distribution of shares in Svitzer to shareholders of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S - 224 - - -1,216 -992 -27 -1,019
4.6 Transfer of gain/loss on disposal of equity investments to retained earnings - - -2 - 2 - - -
Other equity movements - - - - -9 -9 - -9
Total transactions with shareholders -316 224 -2 - -2,596 -2,690 -142 -2,832
Equity 31 December 2024 2,870 -1,290 126 -79 55,290 56,917 1,030 57,947

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

141

Notes

  1. Basis of preparation 1.1 General accounting policies .................... 143 1.2 Significant accounting estimates and judgements ........................................ 145

2. Operating profit

3. Invested capital

4. Capital and financing

5. Other disclosures

Note 1.1 General accounting policies

Basis of preparation

The consolidated financial statements for 2024 for A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) have been prepared on a going concern basis and in accordance with IFRS Account ing Standards as adopted by the EU and additional Danish disclosure requirements for listed companies. The con solidated financial statements of Maersk are included in the consolidated financial statements of A.P. Møller Hold ing A/S. The accounting policies are consistent with those applied in the consolidated financial statements for 2023, except for the changes to accounting standards that were effective from 1 January 2024 and were endorsed by the EU. The changes have not had a material impact on the financial statements.

ESEF/iXBRL reporting

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S is required to prepare and file the annual report in the European Single Electronic Format (ESEF), and the annual report for 2024 is there fore prepared in the XHTML format that can be displayed in a standard browser. The primary statements and the notes to the consolidated financial statements are tagged using inline eXtensible Business Reporting Language (iXBRL). The iXBRL tags comply with the ESEF taxonomy, which is included in the ESEF Regulation and developed based on the IFRS taxonomy published by the IFRS Foun dation. Where a financial statement line item or note is not defined in the ESEF taxonomy, an extension to the taxonomy has been created. Extensions are anchored to elements in the ESEF taxonomy, except for extensions which are subtotals. The Annual Report submitted to the Danish Financial Supervisory Authority consists of the XHTML document together with certain technical files, all included in a file named APMM-2024-12-31-en.zip.

Changes to reportable segments

As a result of the sale of Maersk Supply Service on 15 May 2023 and the demerger of Svitzer on 26 April 2024, changes to the segment structure were made. Accordingly, the Towage & Maritime Services segment is no longer separately reported. The remaining businesses in Towage & Maritime Services and the contribution from Maersk Supply Service and Svitzer until their sale and demerger, respectively, are reported under Unallocated items with

effect from 1 January 2024. Comparison figures for note 2.1 segment information have been restated as if the change had been implemented on 1 January 2023. The reportable segments are as follows:

Ocean Global container shipping activities,
including strategic transhipment hubs
Logistics
& Services
Integrated transportation, fulfilment
and management solutions, including
landside and air transportation as
well as warehousing and supply chain
management offerings
Terminals Gateway terminal activities

Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements comprise the parent company A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S, its subsidiaries and proportionate shares in joint arrangements classified as joint operations.

Subsidiaries are entities controlled by A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S. Control is based on the power to direct the relevant activities of an entity and the ex posure, or right, to variable returns arising from it. In that connection, relevant activities are those that significantly affect the investee's returns. Control is usually achieved by directly or indirectly owning or in other ways controlling more than 50% of the voting rights or by other rights, such as agreements on management control.

Joint arrangements are entities in which Maersk, according to contractual agreements with one or more other parties, has joint control. The arrangements are classified as joint ventures, if the contracting parties' rights are limited to net assets in the separate legal en tities, and as joint operations, if the parties have direct and unlimited rights to the assets and obligations for the liabilities of the arrangement.

Entities in which Maersk exercises a significant but non-controlling influence are considered associated companies. A significant influence is usually achieved by directly or indirectly owning or controlling 20-50% of the voting rights. Agreements and other circumstances are considered when assessing the degree of influence.

1. Basis of preparation

This section sets out the general accounting policies for the Group that relate to the financial statements as a whole. Where an accounting policy is generally applicable to a specific note to the financial statements, the policy is described within that note. In addition, this section describes the significant accounting estimates and judgements that Management has identified as having a potentially material impact on the Group's con solidated financial statements. Refer to the specific note in the financial statements which is impacted by the significant accounting estimates and judgements.

Further, details are provided on the new accounting pronouncements that the Group will adopt in the coming years and on the Group's current view of the impact such pronouncements will have on the financial reporting.

1.1 General accounting policies
143
1.2 Significant accounting estimates and judgements
145

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 1.1 General accounting policies – continued

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

accordance with Maersk's accounting policies. Intra-group income and expenses, shareholdings, dividends, intragroup balances and gains on intra-group transactions are eliminated. Unrealised gains on transactions with associated companies and joint arrangements are eliminated in proportion to Maersk's ownership share. Unrealised losses are eliminated in the same way unless they indicate impairment.

Non-controlling interests' share of profit/loss for the year and of equity in subsidiaries are included as part of Maersk's profit and equity, respectively, but shown as separate items.

Consolidation is performed by summarising the financial statements of the parent company and its subsidiaries in

Foreign currency translation

The consolidated financial statements are presented in USD, the functional currency of the parent company. In the translation to the presentation currency for subsidiaries, associates or joint arrangements with functional currencies other than USD, the total comprehensive income is translated into USD at average exchange rates, and the balance sheet is translated at the exchange rates as at the balance sheet date. Exchange rate differences arising from such translations are recognised directly in other comprehensive income and in a separate reserve of equity.

The functional currency varies from business area to business area. For Maersk's principal shipping activities, the functional currency is typically USD. This means, among other things, that the carrying amounts of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets and, hence, depreciation and amortisation, are maintained in USD from the date of acquisition. For other activities, including container terminal activities and land-based logistics activities, the functional currency is generally the local currency of the country in which such activities are performed, unless circumstances suggest a different currency is appropriate.

Transactions in currencies other than the functional currency are translated at the exchange rate prevailing at the date of the transaction. Monetary items in foreign currencies not settled at the balance sheet date are translated at the exchange rate as at the balance sheet date. Foreign exchange gains and losses are included in the income statement as financial income or expenses.

Share of profit/loss in associated companies and joint ventures is recognised net of tax and corrected for the share of unrealised intra-group gains and losses. The item also comprises any impairment losses for such investments and their reversal.

Statement of comprehensive income

Other comprehensive income consists of gains and losses not recognised in the income statement, including exchange rate adjustments arising from the translation from functional currency to presentation currency, fair value adjustments of other equity investments (at FVOCI), cash flow hedges, forward points and currency basis spread as well as actuarial gains/losses on defined benefit plans, etc. Maersk's share of other comprehensive income in associated companies and joint ventures is also included.

On disposal or discontinuation of an entity, Maersk's share of the accumulated exchange rate adjustments relating to the relevant entity with a functional currency other than USD, is reclassified to the income statement. Accumulated value adjustments of equity instruments classified as equity instruments at fair value through other comprehensive income will remain in equity upon disposal.

Other comprehensive income includes current and deferred income tax to the extent that the items recognised in other comprehensive income are taxable or deductible.

Balance sheet

Investments in associated companies and joint ventures are recognised as Maersk's share of the equity value inclusive of goodwill less any impairment losses. Goodwill is an integral part of the value of associated companies and joint ventures and is therefore subject to an impairment test together with the investment. Impairment losses are reversed to the extent the original value is considered recoverable.

Equity instruments, etc., including shares, bonds and similar securities, are recognised on the trading date at fair value, and subsequently measured at the quoted market price for listed securities and at estimated fair value for non-listed securities. Fair value adjustments from equity investments at fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI) remain in equity upon disposal. Dividends are recognised in the income statement.

Inventories mainly consist of bunker, spare parts not qualifying for property, plant and equipment and other consumables. Inventories are measured at the lower of cost and net realisable value, primarily according to the FIFO method. The cost of finished goods and work in progress includes direct and indirect production costs.

Loans and receivables are initially recognised at fair value, plus any direct transaction costs, and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method. For loans and other receivables, write-downs are made for expected losses based on specific individual or group assessments. For trade receivables, the loss allowance is measured by the simplified approach according to IFRS 9, applying a provision matrix to calculate the expected lifetime losses. The provision matrix includes an impairment for non-due receivables.

Climate-related risks

When preparing the consolidated financial statements, Management considers climate-related risks, where these could potentially impact reported amounts materially. The areas in which Maersk has assessed climate-related risks at the end of 2024 are included in the individual notes including note 2.2 – operating costs, note 3.1 intangible assets and note 3.2 – property, plant and equipment.

New financial reporting requirements

Maersk has adopted the amendments to IAS 1: Classification of liabilities as current or non-current and non-current liabilities with covenants for the first time in the current year. The amendments did not have any material impact on the amounts recognised in prior periods and are not expected to significantly affect the current or future periods.

Maersk has not yet adopted the following new or amended accounting standards and requirements that have not yet become effective.

  • Amendments to IAS 21 Lack of Exchangeability
    • IFRS 18 Presentation and Disclosures in Financial Statements
    • IFRS 19 Subsidiaries without Public Accountability: Disclosures

Amendments to IAS 21 are effective from 1 January 2025 and are endorsed by the EU. IFRS 19 is effective from 1 January 2027, but there is some uncertainty as to its EU endorsement date. Changes from IAS 21 and IFRS 19 are not expected to have any significant impact on recognition and measurement.

IFRS 18 is also effective from 1 January 2027 and is expected to be endorsed by the EU. IFRS 18 replaces IAS 1 and introduces new requirements for presentation within the income statement, including specified totals and subtotals. Furthermore, classification of all income and expenses within the income statement into one of five categories: operating, investing, financing, income taxes and discontinued operations, whereof the first three are new, is also required. Maersk is currently working to identify all impacts the amendments will have on the primary financial statements and notes to the financial statements.

Restatement to 2023 balance sheet figures

In 2024, the 2023 contract liabilities previously offset against trade receivables were restated and presented separately as liabilities. Accordingly, Trade receivables and Deferred income have been grossed up. Notes impacted include note 2.1 (contract assets and contract liabilities), note 4.5 (receivables not due), note 4.6 (trade receivables) and note 5.5 (other working capital movements). The impact on the balance sheet is as follows:

2023
Published in Restated in
2023 2024
Assets
Trade receivables 4,881 5,359
Receivables, etc. 20,873 21,351
Total current assets 31,022 31,500
Total assets 82,100 82,578
Equity and liabilities
Deferred income 90 568
Other current liabilities 9,296 9,774
Total current liabilities 12,391 12,869
Total liabilities 27,010 27,488
Total equity and liabilities 82,100 82,578

Note 1.2 Significant accounting estimates and judgements

The preparation of the consolidated financial statements requires Management to make estimates and judgements on an ongoing basis, and to form assumptions that affect the reported amounts. Management forms its estimates and judgements based on historical experience, independent advice, external data points as well as on in-house specialists and other factors believed to be reasonable under the circumstances.

In its assumption setting, Management deals with various aspects of uncertainty. One aspect of uncertainty is the assessment of control over investments classified as associates, joint ventures and subsidiaries, where the assessment forms the basis for classification. Another aspect is measurement uncertainty, where Management makes assumptions that derive the value of recognised assets and liabilities. These assumptions concern the timing and amount of future cash flows as well as the risks inherent in these.

In certain areas, the outcome of business plans, including ongoing negotiations with external parties to execute those plans or the outcome of negotiations to settle claims that are raised against Maersk, is highly uncertain. Therefore, assumptions may change, or the outcome may differ in the coming years, which could require a material upward or downward adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities.

The areas and their related impact in which Maersk is particularly exposed to material uncertainty over the carrying amounts as at the end of 2024 are included in the individual notes as outlined below:

Note Key accounting estimates and judgements Estimate /
Judgement
Impact
Note 2.2 Vessel sharing agreements (cost-sharing arrangements) estimates Estimate
Note 2.2 EU Emissions Trading System (ETS) classification determination Judgement
Note 3.1 Cash-generating unit determination Judgement
Note 3.1 Impairment testing key assumptions Estimate
Note 3.2 Useful life and residual value estimates Estimate
Note 3.7 Provisions for legal disputes assumptions Estimate
Note 5.1 Recognition and measurement of deferred tax assets and uncertain tax positions Estimate
Note 5.5 Operations in countries with limited access to repatriating surplus cash assumptions Judgement

Level of potential impact on the consolidated financial statements:

  • Low
  • Medium
  • High

2. Operating profit

The Group's businesses are managed from the perspective of the operating segments, and selected financial data is presented in this section on this basis. Further, detailed below are the key amounts recognised when arriving at the Group's operating profit.

2.1 Segment information
146
2.2 Operating costs
149
2.3 Depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, net
150
2.4 Gain on sale of non-current assets, etc., net
150

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Note 2.1 Segment information

2024

OPERATING PROFIT

Key metrics:

2024

Add back:

Profit before depreciation, amortisation and impairment

Share of profit/loss in joint ventures

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

1 Relates to the fair value of derivatives that hedge net interest-bearing debt, including interest rate and cross currency swaps.

Ocean Logistics & Services

External revenue 35,263 15,544 3,441 1,234 - 55,482 Inter-segment revenue 2,125 -624 1,024 307 -2,832 - Total revenue 37,388 14,920 4,465 1,541 -2,832 55,482 Operating costs 28,202 13,473 2,869 1,665 -2,834 43,375

losses, etc. (EBITDA) 9,186 1,447 1,601 -112 6 12,128 Depreciation and amortisation 4,677 921 564 24 -8 6,178

and associated companies 26 17 327 -1 - 369 Profit before financial items (EBIT) 4,743 538 1,329 -124 13 6,499

Invested capital 30,864 11,631 7,930 145 -6 50,564 CAPEX 2,708 803 580 109 1 4,201 1 Following the demerger of Svitzer in Q2 2024, the Towage & Maritime Services segment is no longer separately reported. The remaining businesses in Towage & Maritime Services and the contribution from Svitzer until its demerger are reported under Unallocated items.

Refer to the income statement for a reconciliation from EBIT to profit before tax. The segment assets, segment liabilities and

Segment invested capital 63,196 12,771 50,425

Consolidated invested capital 63,401 12,837 50,564

the sum of invested capital per segment can be reconciled to the assets and liabilities as per the balance sheet.

Unallocated items 1,789 1,644 Eliminations -1,584 -1,578

Cash and bank balances 6,575 - Interest-bearing receivables (current and non-current) 16,029 - Equity investments, etc. 1,580 - Lease liabilities and borrowings (current and non-current) - 16,477 Fair value of derivatives1 - 435 Other 112 1 Consolidated balance sheet at 31 December 87,697 29,750

Terminals Unallocated

items1

Eliminations Consoli-

Assets Liabilities Invested

capital

dated total

Ocean Logistics
& Services
Terminals Unallocated
items1
Eliminations Consoli
dated total
2023
External revenue 32,149 14,075 2,859 1,982 - 51,065
Inter-segment revenue 1,504 -159 985 316 -2,646 -
Total revenue 33,653 13,916 3,844 2,298 -2,646 51,065
Operating costs 26,781 12,665 2,566 2,194 -2,632 41,574
Profit before depreciation,
amortisation and impairment
losses, etc. (EBITDA) 6,940 1,251 1,278 128 -6 9,591
Depreciation and amortisation 4,746 817 520 172 -17 6,238
Share of profit/loss in joint ventures
and associated companies 24 14 282 115 - 435
Profit before financial items (EBIT) 2,227 446 980 270 11 3,934
Key metrics:
Invested capital 29,851 10,779 7,813 2,025 -38 50,430
CAPEX 1,987 771 541 360 -13 3,646

1 Following the demerger of Svitzer in Q2 2024, the Towage & Maritime Services segment is no longer separately reported. The remaining businesses in Towage & Maritime Services and the contribution from Maersk Supply Service and Svitzer until its divestment/demerger are reported under Unallocated items.

Assets Liabilities Invested
capital
2023
Segment invested capital 60,410 11,967 48,443
Unallocated items 3,578 1,553
Eliminations -1,292 -1,254
Consolidated invested capital 62,696 12,266 50,430
Add back:
Cash and bank balances 6,701 -
Interest-bearing receivables (current and non-current) 13,005 -
Lease liabilities and borrowings (current and non-current) - 14,814
Fair value of derivatives1 - 351
Other 176 57
Consolidated balance sheet at 31 December 82,578 27,488

1 Relates to the fair value of derivatives that hedge net interest-bearing debt, including interest rate and cross currency swaps.

The segment disclosures provided above reflect the information which the Executive Board receives monthly in its capacity as 'chief operating decision maker' as defined in IFRS 8. The allocation of resources and the segment performance are evaluated based on revenue and profitability measured on earnings before interest and taxes (EBIT).

Note 2.1 Segment information – continued

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) has organised segments in 'Ocean', 'Logistics & Services' and 'Terminals'. The Ocean segment with the activities of Maersk Liner Business includes Maersk Line, Aliança and business from the retired brands Sealand – A Maersk company and Hamburg Süd as well as strategic transhipment hubs under the APM Terminals brand. Inland activities related to Maersk Liner Business are included in the Logistics & Services segment.

The Logistics & Services segment includes the activities from Managed by Maersk, Fulfilled by Maersk and Transported by Maersk. The Terminals segment includes gateway terminals, involving landside activities such as port activities where the customers are mainly the carriers.

SBM-1 §40b Types of revenue 2024 2023
Ocean Freight revenue 32,684 28,421
Other revenue, including hubs1 4,704 5,232
Logistics & Services Managed by Maersk2 2,167 2,182
Fulfilled by Maersk2 5,735 5,238
Transported by Maersk2 7,018 6,496
Terminals Terminal services 4,465 3,844
Unallocated activities and eliminations Towage services3 304 839
Sale of containers and spare parts 490 496
Offshore supply services3 - 111
Other shipping activities3 113 263
Other services 537 451
Unallocated activities and eliminations -2,735 -2,508
Total revenue 55,482 51,065
Hereof recognised over time 52,308 47,569
Hereof recognised at a point in time 5,909 6,004
Unallocated activities and eliminations -2,735 -2,508

1 Of which USD 1.5bn (USD 1.5bn) relates to Maersk Energy Markets revenue from third-party customers. SBM-1 §40d-i

2 The 2023 'by Maersk' revenue figures have been restated in order to reflect changes within the Logistics & Services model definition.

3 Revenue from Svitzer, US Marine Management and Maersk Supply Service is included in Towage, Other shipping activities and Offshore supply services, respectively, until divestment/demerger.

2024
Revenue from contracts with customers
54,562
Revenue from other sources
Vessel-sharing and slot charter income
797
Lease income
16
Others
107
51,065
114
16
938
49,997
2023

Set out above is the reconciliation of the revenue from contracts with customers to the amounts disclosed as total revenue.

Contract balances 2024 2023
Trade receivables 5,497 5,183
Contract asset 352 176
Contract liability 748 568

Trade receivables in the balance sheet include accrued income and contract assets comprising unbilled amounts to customers representing the Group's right to consideration for services transferred to date. All deferred income is recognised in the income statement within 12 months.

Under the payment terms generally applicable to the Group's revenue-generating activities, prepayments are received only to a limited extent. Typically, payment is due upon or after completion of the services.

Part of the deferred income presented in the balance sheet constitutes contract liabilities which represent advance payments and billings in excess of revenue recognised.

In 2024, the 2023 contract liabilities previously offset against trade receivables were restated and presented separately as liabilities.

Impairment losses disclosed in note 4.5 financial instruments and risks relate to receivables arising from contracts with customers.

External revenue Non-current assets1
Geographical split 2024 2023 2024 2023
Denmark 630 869 25,776 23,592
Australia 1,019 1,284 91 68
Brazil 1,684 1,431 315 207
China and Hong Kong 2,745 2,796 1,466 1,643
Costa Rica 398 384 761 795
Germany 1,711 1,668 609 1,345
India 1,316 1,397 605 629
Mexico 1,541 1,364 608 613
Morocco 350 300 1,616 1,605
Netherlands 2,229 1,603 1,510 1,165
Singapore 1,016 992 3,461 3,853
Spain 1,514 1,337 1,016 1,068
UK 2,208 1,823 336 320
USA 12,173 11,457 6,371 6,210
Other 24,948 22,360 4,133 3,740
Total 55,482 51,065 48,674 46,853

1 Comprise intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets, excluding financial non-current assets relating to continuing operations.

Geographical information

Revenue on shipping activities is based on the port of discharge for all vessels operated by the Group, including leased vessels on time charter agreements. Revenue for leasing out the vessels on time charter agreement, where the Group acts as a lessor, is based on the customer location. For non-current assets (e.g. terminals), which cannot be easily moved, geographical location is where the assets are located. For all other assets, geographical location is based on the legal ownership. These assets consist mainly of vessels and containers registered in China, Denmark, Singapore and the USA.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 2.1 Segment information – continued

ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Segment information

The allocation of business activities into segments reflects Maersk's character as an integrated container logistics business and is in line with the internal management reporting. The reportable segments are as follows:

Ocean Global container shipping activities,
including strategic transhipment hubs
Logistics
& Services
Integrated transportation, fulfilment
and management solutions, including
landside and air transportation as
well as warehousing and supply chain
management offerings

Terminals Gateway terminal activities

Operating segments have not been aggregated. The reportable segments comprise:

Ocean

Ocean activities

Activities under Maersk Line and Aliança and the retired brands Hamburg Süd and Sealand – A Maersk company, with ocean container freight being the main revenue stream. Ocean container freight is defined as the costper-weight measure of transporting goods on board a container vessel across the ocean, including demurrage and detention, terminal handling, documentation services, container services as well as container storage.

Hub activities

Activities under the APM Terminals brand-generating revenue by providing port services only in major transhipment ports such as Maasvlakte-II, Algeciras, Tangier, Tangier-Med II, Port Said, and joint ventures in Salalah and Tanjung Pelepas. The respective terminals are included under the Ocean segment, as the primary purpose of those ports is to provide transhipment services to Maersk's Ocean business, whereas third-party volumes sold in those locations are considered secondary.

Maersk Energy Markets

Sourcing marine fuels for Maersk's fleet and third-party customers, in addition to operating a fuel infrastructure in key bunker ports.

Logistics & Services

Managed by Maersk

Includes Lead Logistics, Project Logistics, Cold Chain Logistics and Custom Services, enabling customers to control or outsource part or all of their supply chain.

Fulfilled by Maersk

Activities such as Warehousing (consolidated, deconsolidation and fulfilment), Cold Storage, Ground Freight, Depot operations and e-commerce supporting integrated fulfilment solutions, to improve customer consolidation.

Transported by Maersk

Integrated transportation solutions supported by Landside Transportation, Cargo Risk Management products, Air, Less than Container Load (LCL) and Full Container Load (FCL), to facilitate supply chain control across Maersk.

Terminals

Terminals activities

Activities in ports fully or partially controlled by the APM Terminals brand, with the main revenue stream being port activities not considered a hub activity as described above.

Unallocated items and inter-segment revenue Towage activities

Activities under the Svitzer brand, a provider of offshore towage and marine services. The company was demerged in April 2024.

Maersk Container Industry Manufacturer that produces reefer containers.

Maersk Supply Service

Provides marine services and integrated solutions to the energy sector worldwide with a large fleet of anchor handling tug supply vessels and subsea support vessels. The company was divested in May 2023.

Maersk's corporate functions Consists of group-related costs in Maersk.

Other businesses

Consists of Maersk Growth, Maersk Training and other services to the maritime industry.

Revenue between segments is limited, except for the Terminals segment, where a large part of the services is delivered to the Ocean segment as well as the sale of containers from Maersk Container Industry to the Ocean segment.

Income statement

Revenue for all businesses is recognised when the performance obligation has been satisfied, which happens upon transfer of control to the customer at an amount that reflects the consideration to which the Group expects to be entitled in exchange for the goods and services.

Revenue from shipping activities is recognised over time as the performance obligation is satisfied, including a share of revenue from incomplete voyages at the balance sheet date. Invoiced revenue related to an estimated proportion of remaining voyage time and activities at the destination port is deferred. Percentage of completion is calculated as the number of days of a voyage as a percentage of the total number of days a voyage is estimated to last. Detention and demurrage fees are recognised over time up until the time of the customer's late return or pick-up of containers.

Revenue from terminal operations and towing activities is recognised upon completion of the service. In container terminals operated under certain restrictive terms of pricing and service, etc., the value of tangible assets constructed on behalf of the concession grantor is recognised as revenue during the construction. Revenue from most freight forwarding activities is recognised over time.

Revenue from the sale of goods is recognised upon the transfer of control to the buyer.

No significant element of financing is deemed present as sales are made with a credit term of 20-45 days, which is consistent with market practice. Revenue from sales is recognised based on the price specified in the contract, net of the estimated volume discounts. Accumulated experience is used to estimate and provide for the discounts, using the expected value method, and revenue is only recognised to the extent that it is highly probable that a significant reversal will not occur.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

OPERATING PROFIT

Note 2.2 Operating costs

2024 2023
Costs of goods sold 2,016 1,999
Bunker costs 7,076 6,037
Terminal costs 6,999 6,381
Intermodal costs 4,108 4,094
Port costs 1,528 2,261
Rent and lease costs 1,676 1,380
Staff costs 7,535 7,361
Other 12,437 12,061
Total operating costs 43,375 41,574
Remuneration of employees
Wages and salaries 6,513 6,370
Severance payments 128 206
Pension costs, defined benefit plans 32 63
Pension costs, defined contribution plans 315 290
Other social security costs 630 587
Total remuneration 7,618 7,516
Of which:
Recognised in the cost of assets 10 7
Included in restructuring costs 73 148
Expensed as staff costs 7,535 7,361
Average number of employees 104,890 105,909

Customary agreements have been entered into with employees regarding compensation in connection with resignation with consideration for local legislation and collective agreements.

For information about share-based payments, refer to note 5.2 share-based payments.

Fees and remuneration to the Executive Board 2024 2023
Fixed pay 3 3
Short-term cash incentive 4 2
Long-term share-based incentives 31 2
Remuneration in connection with redundancy, resignation and release from duty to work - -1
Total remuneration to the Executive Board 10 6

1 In 2024, following the demerger of Svitzer, the outstanding stock options, restricted share units and performance shares were modified, resulting in immediate recognition of a beneficial modification expense for the already vested grants in 2024. The beneficial modifications to unvested programmes will be recognised over the remaining vesting period.

The contract of employment for the Executive Board contains terms customary in Danish listed companies, including termination notice and non-competition clauses. In connection with a possible takeover offer, neither the Executive Board nor the Board of Directors will receive special remuneration. Fees and remuneration do not include pension.

Key management comprises the Executive Board and the Board of Directors.

The Board of Directors has received fees of USD 2m (USD 2m).

For disclosure of remuneration to the Executive Board of the parent company, refer to note 2.1 operating costs of the parent company financial statements.

Fees to the statutory auditors 2024 2023
Statutory audit 16 16
Other assurance services 2 2
Tax, VAT and advisory services 1 1
Other services 1 1
Total fees 20 20

Fees for other services other than statutory audit of the financial statements provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers Statsautoriseret Revisionspartnerselskab to Maersk mainly consist of transaction advice, accounting and tax-related services.

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

Vessel-sharing agreements (cost-sharing arrangements) Vessel-sharing agreements in shipping require that some vessels are committed towards specific service routes. The committed vessel's capacity is then shared with one or more container shipping providers in proportion to each party's contribution to the joint service. In practice, it is not always possible to provide tonnage precisely as

agreed in the sharing arrangements, therefore financial settlement often takes place on the basis of relative capacity over/under-utilised on a monthly basis or other mutually agreed cycle. At Maersk, these capacity adjustments are settled as close to actual costs incurred as possible based on market rates applicable at that time.

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING JUDGEMENTS

EU Emissions Trading System (ETS) classification determination

From 1 January 2024 onwards, Maersk is subject to the new EU ETS, a cap-and-trade system to reduce emissions via a carbon market. Implementation of EU ETS requires Maersk to purchase EU allowances (EUAs) representing the right to emit a specific amount of greenhouse gases (GHG).

Maersk has purchased EUAs either as spot or future contracts. EUA futures are financial instruments with delivery in December of the same year, and they satisfy the conditions for the 'own use' exemption and are offbalance sheet items. EUA spot contracts are classified as other current assets upon delivery of certificates.

They are measured at cost of settlement and are not subject to remeasurement until surrender. The cost includes all costs of purchase, costs of conversion and other directly attributable costs such as transaction costs. For more information on the EUAs recognised refer to note 3.5 Term deposits and other receivables.

The accrual is recognised as fuel is burnt in Maersk's applicable shipping activities, measured at expected cost for the required EUAs, based on actual emissions and the price of the EUAs, which is calculated as a weighted average price of EUA spots and futures. The corresponding cost is presented as bunker cost.

Note 2.3 Depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, net

Depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, net 6,220 6,615
Total impairment, net 42 377
Total amortisation 395 382
Total depreciation 5,783 5,856
2024 2023

Depreciation is related to property, plant and equipment of USD 2.7bn (USD 2.6bn) and to right-of-use assets of USD 3.1bn (USD 3.3bn).

Total net impairments are primarily related to property, plant and equipment of USD 44m (USD 55m) and intangible assets of USD 1m (USD 322m). Refer to note 3.1 intangible assets and note 3.2 property, plant and equipment.

Note 2.4 Gains on sale of non-current assets, etc., net

2024 2023
Gains 305 565
Losses 83 42
Gains on sale of non-current assets, etc., net 222 523

Gains in 2024 are primarily related to the sale of containers of USD 77m (USD 127m), the sale of vessels of USD 192m (USD 181m) and gains on termination of leases of USD 10m (USD 29m). In 2023, the gains included the sale of US Marine Management Inc. of USD 92m, the sale of shares in Höegh Autoliners A/S of USD 57m and the sale of Maersk Supply Service of USD 15m.

Losses in 2024 are primarily related to the sale of containers USD 23m (USD 22m) and a change in the provision for indemnities related to sale of assets in previous years of USD 26m.

3. Invested capital

Invested capital is primarily made up of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets. The intangible assets mainly consist of goodwill, terminal and concession rights and customer relationships. Goodwill arises when A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) acquires a business and pays a higher amount than the fair value of its net assets, primarily due to the synergies the Group expects to create. Goodwill is not amortised, but is subject to annual impairment reviews.

For further details refer to 'significant accounting estimates and judgements' within note 3.1 to the consolidated financial statements.

3.1 Intangible assets
151
3.2 Property, plant and equipment
154
3.3 Right-of-use assets
156
3.4 Acquisition/sale of subsidiaries and activities
157
3.5 Term deposits
and other receivables
158
3.6 Assets held for sale or distribution
158
3.7 Provisions
159

Executive summary

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Note 3.1 Intangible assets

Goodwill Terminal
and service
concession
rights
Customer
relationships
Other incl.
IT software
Total
Cost
1
January 2024
5,230 3,031 2,659 1,323 12,243
Additions - 77 - 183 260
Disposals 14 - - 120 134
Exchange rate adjustments -30 -64 -22 -33 -149
31 December 2024 5,186 3,044 2,637 1,353 12,220
Amortisation and impairment losses
1
January 2024
69 937 542 571 2,119
Amortisation - 105 157 133 395
Impairment losses 1 - - - 1
Disposals 14 - - 57 71
Exchange rate adjustments - -28 -6 -14 -48
31 December 2024 56 1,014 693 633 2,396
Carrying amount:
31 December 2024 5,130 2,0301 1,944 7202 9,824
1 Of which USD 76m is under development. USD 32m is related to terminal rights with indefinite useful lives in Poti Sea Port Corp.
Service concession rights with a carrying amount of USD 71m have restricted title.

2 Of which USD 185m is related to ongoing development of software.

Goodwill Terminal
and service
concession
rights
Customer
relationships
Other incl.
IT software
Total
Cost
1
January 2023
5,554 2,985 3,043 1,371 12,953
Additions - 21 - 183 204
Additions from acquired companies1 - - 14 - 14
Disposals 6 - 402 234 642
Transfers, assets held for sale -332 - -11 -13 -356
Exchange rate adjustments 14 25 15 16 70
31 December 2023 5,230 3,031 2,659 1,323 12,243
Amortisation and impairment losses
1
January 2023
349 824 491 504 2,168
Amortisation - 103 158 121 382
Impairment losses - - 299 23 322
Disposals - - 402 79 481
Transfers, assets held for sale -279 - -9 -9 -297
Exchange rate adjustments -1 10 5 11 25
31 December 2023 69 937 542 571 2,119
Carrying amount:
31 December 2023 5,161 2,0942 2,117 7523 10,124

1 Acquisition of Martin Bencher and Grindrod.

2 Of which USD 49m is under development. USD 34m is related to terminal rights with indefinite useful lives in Poti Sea Port Corp. Service concession rights with a carrying amount of USD 70m have restricted title.

3 Of which USD 162m is related to ongoing development of software.

A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 3.1 Intangible assets – continued

Goodwill carrying amount
Operating segment Cash-generating unit 2024 2023
Ocean Ocean 316 316
Logistics & Services Logistics & Services 4,568 4,599
Terminals Multiple terminals 241 241
Unallocated items Others 5 5
Total 5,130 5,161
Impairment losses
Operating segment Cash-generating unit 2024 2023
Ocean Ocean - 319 1
Logistics & Services Logistics & Services - 2 1
Terminals Various terminals 1 -
Unallocated items Maersk Container Industry - 1
Total 1 322

1 On 27 January 2023, it was announced that the Group would move towards a singular and unified brand by integrating the Maersk brands. Existing brands were retired during Q1 2023, resulting in the recognition of impairment losses of the full carrying amount of each respective retired brand on the balance sheet. Total impairment losses related to the retirement of brands in 2023 recognised in the income statement is USD 299m, of which USD 297m is within Ocean and USD 2m is within Logistics & Services.

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGEMENTS

Significant accounting judgements

Determination of cash-generating units Judgement is applied in the determination of cashgenerating units to which goodwill is allocated for impairment testing and in the selection of methodologies and assumptions applied in impairment tests.

The determination of cash-generating units differs based on the business area. Ocean operates its fleet of container vessels and hub terminals in an integrated network. Consequently, the Ocean activities are tested for impairment as a single cash-generating unit.

Logistics & Services, including first-mile activities, is considered a single cash-generating unit. Management views the Logistics & Services products as an integrated network, with the activities tested for impairment as a single cash-generating unit. In Terminals, each terminal

is considered an individual cash-generating unit for impairment tests, except when the capacity is managed as a portfolio.

Unallocated items consists of several individual businesses, including Maersk Container Industry, which are each considered one cash-generating unit.

Significant accounting estimates

Impairment – assessment inputs

The recoverable amount of each cash-generating unit is determined based on the higher of its value in use and fair value less costs to sell. The estimated value in use is calculated using certain key assumptions for the expected future cash flows and applied discount factor. Current market values for vessels, etc., are estimated using acknowledged brokers.

The cash flow projections are based on financial budgets and business plans. In nature, these projections are subject to judgement and estimates that are uncertain, though based on experience and external sources where available. Centralised processes and involvement of corporate functions ensure that indices and data sources are selected consistently while observing differences in risks and other circumstances.

The discount rates applied reflect the time value of money as well as the specific risks related to the underlying cash flows, i.e. project and/or country-specific risk premium. Further, any uncertainties reflecting past performance and possible variations in the amount or timing of the projected cash flows are generally reflected in the discount rates.

Impairment – key assumptions applied

The outcome of impairment tests is subject to estimates of the future development of freight rates and volumes, oil prices and the discount rates applied. Management determines these key assumptions by considering past experience as well as market analysis and future expectations based on supply and demand trends.

Further, the value in use calculation is sensitive to the discount rate and the terminal growth rate. Value in use is determined based on the expected future economic growth rate and replacement CAPEX during the terminal period, which is based on Management's plans and expectations for the future.

The future development in freight rates is a significant factor impacting the Ocean segment in particular and is influenced by regional and global economic environments, trade patterns, and by industry-specific trends in respect of capacity supply and demand. Freight rates continued to increase throughout the first half of 2024 as a result of the Red Sea situation. The rates peaked in Q3 2024, then partially normalised and stabilised with supply catching up.

The future development of oil prices is also uncertain and is a significant factor impacting accounting estimates across Maersk, either directly on the bunker oil price, green fuel and its availability, or indirectly through its impact on market freight rates charged to customers. Bunker consumption increased throughout 2024 with re-routing south of Cape of Good Hope caused by the situation in the Red Sea/Gulf of Aden. However, consumption is expected

to decline in 2025, driven by fleet outsourcing, efficiency improvements and the commencement of Gemini Cooperation from February 2025.

Logistics & Services is impacted by rates and volumes across the Logistics & Services product lines, particularly in the Air and Warehousing business. The future growth and productivity of the Fulfilled by Maersk product range is also considered a key assumption as volumes are sensitive to the development of the global economy. Management considers the future economic outlook and expected synergies from completed acquisitions when determining the growth and productivity of Fulfilled by Maersk.

Terminals located in oil-producing countries, e.g. Nigeria and Brazil, are indirectly impacted by the development in oil prices and the consequences for the respective countries' economies, which not only affects volumes handled at the terminals, but also foreign exchange rates. Continued economic deterioration and a lack of cash repatriation opportunities in certain oil-producing countries could also put pressure on the carrying amounts of individual terminals. The repercussions of uncertainty in trade policies and tariffs, stemming from geopolitical tensions, may impact port rates in a few strategic regions. The other key sensitivities impacting Terminals include container moves, revenue and cost per move, and local port rates, all of which are impacted by the local economic outlook and competition, as well as concession right extensions and the discount rate applied.

Inflation is also expected to continue to have a high impact across Maersk in 2025, impacting both the discount rate and terminal growth rates.

Impairment – results of impairment assessments The Ocean cash flow projection is based on the forecast as per Q3 2024, covering the five-year business plan for 2025-29. Management applied an assumption of growth in volumes based on a calculated terminal value with growth equal to 2.1% (2.7%) p.a. In the annual impairment test carried out in November 2024, a pre-tax discount rate of 9.3% (9.8%) p.a. was applied. The impairment test was carried out considering Management's planned fleet renewal programme running until 2030. The impairment test showed headroom between the value in use and the carrying amount. The major part of the carrying amount is comprised of vessels. Management is of the opinion that the assumptions applied are sustainable.

A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Note 3.1 Intangible assets – continued

The Group's most significant goodwill component relates to the Logistics & Services segment. The annual impairment test is based on the estimated value in use from the five-year business plan for 2025-29, where the volume and improved margin growth assumptions, which are region-specific, reflect the current expectations for the relevant period. The applied terminal growth is 2.1% (2.7%). A discount rate of 8.9% (9.0%) p.a. before tax or 8.7% (8.8%) p.a. after tax was applied. The impairment test showed headroom from the value in use to the carrying amount. Management is of the opinion that the assumptions applied are sustainable.

In Terminals, Management assesses indicators of impairment including decreasing volumes and based on these indicators, estimates the recoverable amounts of the individual terminals whereby impairment indicators exist. Management also tests for impairment of the cash-generating units (CGUs) to which goodwill or indefinite life intangible assets are allocated. The cash flow projections for each terminal cover the concession period and extension options deemed likely to be exercised, the latter of which is expected to have positive impact on replacement volumes. The growth rates reflect current market expectations for the relevant period, and the discount rates applied are between 7.2% and 12.0% (7.4% and 12.1%) p.a. after tax. The impairment tests considered fair value less cost of disposal compared to the carrying

amount and resulted in impairment losses on assets of an immaterial amount across two terminals amounting to USD 42m in 2024 (impairment losses of USD 134m across multiple terminals in 2023, of which USD 94m related to a CGU in the Mediterranean), refer to note 3.2 property, plant and equipment. The fair values of individual terminals are measured at fair value less cost of disposal, where the perspective of a potential buyer is assumed. The valuations (fair value level 3) are prepared by discounting expected cash inflows and outflows for the period until concession end. This includes expected concession extensions, and costs and benefits related to restructuring and improvement projects that a potential buyer can be assumed to undertake in order to extract the best value from the terminal. Individual country-specific discount rates are applied.

Impairment – key assumptions sensitivity Using the discount rate as of 31 December 2024 and keeping all other assumptions constant, the Ocean CGU showed headroom of USD 4.1bn (USD 3.9bn) between the value in use and the carrying amount. The following changes in assumptions reflect the related impact on the value in use and thus the headroom for the Ocean CGU. The sensitivities are prepared with all other assumptions kept constant.

Key Ocean CGU assumption Assumption Change Effect on value in use
Growth in terminal period 2.1% +/- 0.5 ppts Approx. USD 2.0bn
Discount rate p.a. before tax as of 31 December 2024 9.9% +/- 0.5 ppts Approx. USD 2.7bn

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Intangible assets are measured at cost less accumulated amortisation and impairment losses. Amortisation is calculated on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful life of the assets. For container terminals operated under certain restrictive price and service conditions, etc., concessional rights to collect usage charges are included under intangible assets. The cost includes the present value of minimum payments under concession agreements and the cost of property, plant and equipment constructed on behalf of the grantor of a concession. The rights are amortised from the commencement of operations over the concession period. The concession period ranges from 10 to 34 years, with an average of 17 years.

Goodwill and terminal rights have indefinite useful lives, while all other classes have definite lives. Intangible assets regarding acquired customer relationships and technology are amortised over a useful life of 10-24 years and 5-10 years, respectively. Internally developed IT software is amortised over a useful life of 3-5 years.

Impairment losses are recognised when the carrying amount of an asset or a cash-generating unit exceeds the higher of the estimated value in use and fair value less costs of disposal. Goodwill is attributed to cashgenerating units on acquisition and impaired before other assets.

Intangible assets and property, plant and equipment are tested for impairment if there is an indication of impairment. However, annual impairment tests are carried out for goodwill and other intangible assets with indefinite useful lives as well as intangible assets that are not yet in use. Impairment losses are included in depreciation, amortisation and impairment, net, in the income statement.

Corporate governance

Executive summary

The integrator

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 3.2 Property, plant and equipment

Vessels,
aircraft,
containers,
Production
facilities and
equipment,
Construction
work in
progress and
Total
etc. etc. payments on
account
Cost
1
January 2024
42,961 8,948 3,631 55,540
Additions 936 237 3,278 4,4511
Disposals 1,106 242 5 1,353
Transfers 2,124 1,106 -3,230 -
Reclassification from/to right-of-use assets 18 -4 -4 10
Exchange rate adjustments -43 -324 -58 -425
31 December 2024 44,890 9,721 3,612 58,223
Depreciation and impairment losses
1
January 2024
24,117 4,364 - 28,481
Depreciation 2,104 575 - 2,679
Impairment losses 1 44 6 51
Reversal of impairment losses 1 6 - 7
Disposals 924 130 2 1,056
Reclassification from/to right-of-use assets 3 -8 - -5
Exchange rate adjustments -17 -149 1 -165
31 December 2024 25,283 4,690 5 29,978
Carrying amount:
31 December 2024 19,607 5,031 3,607 28,245

1 Of which USD 1.2bn related to EU taxonomy-aligned vessels, including milestone payments for the ordered dual-fuel vessels, and USD 533m related to solar panels, charging stations and electrified equipment additions.

Vessels and buildings etc. with a carrying amount of USD 140m (USD 784m) have been pledged as security for loans of USD 84m (USD 443m).

Vessels,
aircraft,
containers,
etc.
Production
facilities and
equipment,
etc.
Construction
work in
progress and
payments on
account
Total
Cost
1
January 2023
48,699 8,209 2,296 59,204
Additions 698 124 2,834 3,6561
Additions from acquired companies - 15 - 15
Disposals 1,785 162 6 1,953
Disposals from companies sold 3,197 62 164 3,423
Transfers 401 855 -1,256 -
Transfers, assets held for sale -1,939 -67 -83 -2,089
Reclassification from/to right-of-use assets 35 4 -3 36
Exchange rate adjustments 49 32 13 94
31 December 2023 42,961 8,948 3,631 55,540
Depreciation and impairment losses
1 January 2023 26,966 4,039 5 31,010
Depreciation 2,100 506 - 2,606
Impairment losses 6 134 - 140
Reversal of impairment losses 12 73 - 85
Disposals 1,542 163 4 1,709
Disposals from companies sold 2,650 62 1 2,713
Transfers, assets held for sale -781 -37 - -818
Reclassification from/to right-of-use assets 9 2 - 11
Exchange rate adjustments 21 18 - 39
31 December 2023 24,117 4,364 - 28,481
Carrying amount:
31 December 2023 18,844 4,584 3,631 27,059

1 Of which USD 638m is related to EU taxonomy-aligned vessels, including milestone payments for the ordered dual-fuel vessels, and USD 386m related to solar panels, charging stations and electrified equipment additions.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Note 3.2 Property, plant and equipment – continued

Net impairment losses recognised on property, plant and equipment are specified as follows:

Impairment losses Reversal of impairment losses
Operating segment Cash-generating unit 2024 2023 2024 2023
Ocean Ocean - - - 12
Logistics & Services Logistics & Services 9 6 - -
Terminals Various terminals 42 134 7 73
Total 51 140 7 85

Impairment analysis

For more information on impairment tests, including sensitivities for the Ocean CGU, refer to note 3.1 intangible assets.

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

Useful life and residual values

Useful lives are estimated annually based on experience. When an asset's useful life changes, Management revises the estimates for individual assets or groups of assets with similar characteristics due to factors such as quality of maintenance and repair, technical development, or environmental requirements. Management has also considered the impact of decarbonisation and climate-related risks on the useful lives of existing assets. Such risks include new climate-related legislation restricting the use of certain assets, new technology demanded by climate-related legislation and the increase in restoration costs for terminal sites due to new and/or more comprehensive policies. The useful lives of vessels and related assets that operate on bunker fuel have been considered in conjunction with the net-zero by 2040 target.

Residual values of vessels are difficult to estimate given their long useful lives, the uncertainty of future economic conditions, the market for conventional fuel vessels and the uncertainty of future steel prices, which is considered the main determinant of the residual value. Additionally, the acceleration of development of vessels with a lower carbon footprint may generate downward pressure on the market for second-hand conventional fuel vessels. Generally, the residual values of vessels are initially estimated at 10% of the purchase price excluding dry-docking costs.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Property, plant and equipment are valued at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. Depreciation is charged to the income statement on a straight-line basis over the useful life at an estimated residual value. The useful lives of new assets are typically as follows:

Vessels, etc. 20-25 years
Containers, etc. 15 years
Buildings 10-50 years
Terminal infrastructure 10-30 years or concession
period, if shorter
Warehouses and related
infrastructure
5-25 years, or lease term,
if shorter
Aircraft and related
components
3-30 years
Plant and machinery, cranes
and other terminal equipment
5-25 years
Other operating equipment,

fixtures, etc. 3-7 years

Estimated useful lives and residual values are reassessed on a regular basis.

The cost of an asset is divided into separate components, which are depreciated separately if the useful life of the individual component differs. Dry-docking costs are recognised in the carrying amount of vessels when incurred and depreciated over the period until the next dry-docking.

The cost of assets constructed by Maersk includes directly attributable expenses. For assets with a long construction period, borrowing costs during the construction period from specific as well as general borrowings are attributed to cost. In addition, the cost includes the net present value of estimated costs of removal and restoration.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Note 3.3 Right-of-use assets

INVESTED CAPITAL

Vessels,
containers,
etc.
Concession
agreements
Real estate
and other
leases
Total
Right-of-use assets
1 January 2024 4,652 2,317 2,701 9,670
Additions 3,265 502 834 4,601
Disposals 261 1 123 385
Depreciation 2,301 203 610 3,114
Transfers, owned assets, etc. -15 - - -15
Exchange rate adjustments 1 -72 -81 -152
31 December 2024 5,341 2,543 2,721 10,605
1 January 2023 6,344 2,411 2,212 10,967
Additions 1,007 69 1,088 2,164
Additions from acquired companies - - 29 29
Disposals 154 1 57 212
Depreciation 2,504 191 555 3,250
Transfers, assets held for sale -17 - -36 -53
Transfers, owned assets, etc. -25 - - -25
Exchange rate adjustments 1 29 20 50
31 December 2023 4,652 2,317 2,701 9,670
Amounts recognised in profit and loss 2024 2023
Depreciation on right-of-use assets 3,114 3,250
Interest expenses (included in finance costs) 611 563
Expenses relating to service elements of leases 938 868
Expenses relating to short-term leases 343 189
Expenses relating to variable lease payments 368 297
Expenses relating to leases of low-value assets 27 26
Total recognised in operating costs 1,676 1,380

As part of the Group's activities, customary leasing agreements are entered, especially regarding the chartering of vessels and leasing of containers and other equipment. In some cases, the leasing agreements comprise purchase options exercisable by the Group and options for extending the lease term. The Group also enters into concession agreements that provide the right to use some existing infrastructure or land as required to carry out the terminal business.

To optimise lease costs during the contract period, the Group sometimes provides residual value guarantees in relation to equipment leases. At the end of 2024, the expected residual values were reviewed if these reflect the actual residual values achieved on comparable assets and expectations about future prices. At 31 December 2024, USD 226m (USD 226m) is expected to be payable and is included in the measurement of the lease liabilities.

Leases to which Maersk is committed, but for which the lease term has not yet commenced, have an undiscounted value of USD 9.8bn (USD 2.6bn). They comprise approx. 78 contracts commencing in 2025-2029.

Certain terminal concession agreements contain variable payment terms that are linked to future performance, i.e., number of containers handled. Such payments are recognised in the income statement in the period in which the condition that triggers those payments occurs.

Total cash outflow from leases was USD 5.3bn (USD 5.2bn), of which USD 3.1bn (USD 3.2bn) relates to repayment of lease liabilities, USD 1.7bn (USD 1.4bn) to other lease expenses and USD 611m (USD 563m) to interest expenses.

Lease liabilities are disclosed in notes 4.2 borrowings and lease liability reconciliation and 4.5 financial instruments and risks.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Right-of-use assets are mainly leased vessels, containers, concession arrangements and real estate. Lease contracts for vessels and containers are typically made for fixed periods of about five years but may have extension options as described together with lease liabilities. Concession arrangements and real estate contracts are negotiated on an individual basis and contain a wide range of terms and conditions.

Leases are recognised as a right-of-use asset with a corresponding lease liability at the date on which the leased asset is available for use. The right-of-use asset is depreciated over the shorter of the asset's useful life and the lease term on a straight-line basis.

Payments associated with short-term leases and leases of low-value assets are recognised on a straightline basis as an expense in the income statement.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 3.4 Acquisition/sale of subsidiaries and activities

Acquisitions during 2024

No material acquisitions took place during 2024.

Acquisitions during 2023

Martin Bencher Group (Logistics & Services)

On 2 January 2023, the Group acquired 100% of the shares in Martin Bencher Group, a Denmark-based project logistics company for the purchase price of USD 53m and resulted in goodwill of USD 11m. Martin Bencher Group complemented the existing Maersk project logistics services, with specialised services offering the combination of solution design, special cargo transportation and project management services.

Grindrod Intermodal Group (Logistics & Services)

On 2 January 2023, the Group completed the acquisition of Grindrod Logistics with a controlling interest of 51% for a purchase price of USD 44m, which resulted in goodwill of USD 15m. The Group partnered with Grindrod Intermodal Group to merge the logistics activities of Grindrod Intermodal business and the ocean activities of the Ocean Africa Container Lines (OACL) with the existing Maersk Logistics & Services products in South Africa.

Acquired goodwill from the above acquisitions were not allowable for tax purposes. For further details, see the 2023 Annual Report.

Sales during 2024

With the demerger of Svitzer and the distribution of the shares of Svitzer Group A/S to the Group's shareholders, the Group lost control over Svitzer A/S and its subsidiaries. Consequently, the Group derecognised the assets and liabilities of Svitzer Group in the consolidated financial statements. This is further disclosed in note 3.6 Assets held for sale or distribution. No other material external sales were undertaken during 2024.

Sales during 2023

US Marine Management

On 20 September 2023, the sale of US Marine Management LLC was completed and resulted in a net gain of USD 92m or USD 74m after tax.

Maersk Supply Service

On 15 May 2023, the sale of Maersk Supply Service to A.P. Møller Holding A/S was completed and resulted in a net gain of USD 15m.

Höegh Autoliners

The Group completed the sale of the 26.4% shareholding in Höegh Autoliners during 2023 and resulted in a gain of USD 57m.

The net gain from the above sales is included in the unallocated items as per note 2.1 segment information. For further details, see the 2023 Annual Report.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Acquisition/sale of subsidiaries and activities

Upon acquisition of new entities, the acquired assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities are measured at fair value at the date when control was achieved using the acquisition method. Identifiable intangible assets are recognised if they arise from a contractual right or can otherwise be separately identified. The difference between the fair value of the acquisition cost and the fair value of acquired identifiable net assets is recognised as goodwill. Contingent consideration is measured at fair value and any subsequent changes to contingent consideration are recognised as financial income or financial expense in the income statement. If contingent consideration is settled by issuing a predetermined number of shares, the contingent consideration is classified as equity and is subsequently not remeasured at fair value. Transaction costs are recognised as operating costs as they are incurred.

When Maersk ceases to have control of a subsidiary, the value of any retained investment is remeasured at fair value, and the value adjustment is recognised in the income statement as a gain/loss on the sale of noncurrent assets. The difference between sales proceeds and the carrying amount of the subsidiary is recognised in the income statement including fair value of contingent consideration at the time of sale. Contingent consideration is remeasured at fair value with changes recognised in the income statement. The effect of the purchase and sale of non-controlling interests without changes in control is included directly in equity.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

158 A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024 Loan receivables, current, amount to USD 15.9bn (USD 12.8bn) and consist primarily of term deposits with a maturity of more than three months amounting to USD 15.9bn (USD 12.8bn). For details on the assessment of the loss allowance on term deposits, refer to note 4.5 financial instruments and risks.

Other receivables primarily consist of prepayments made for operational activities that will be utilised after twelve months amounting to USD 1.9bn (USD 1.3bn) and EUAs amounting to USD 163m (USD 0m). For details on the significant accounting judgements regarding EUAs, refer to note 2.2 operating costs.

Note 3.6 Assets held for sale or distribution

Note 3.5 Term deposits and other receivables

INVESTED CAPITAL

2024 2023
Balance sheet items comprise:
Intangible assets - 59
Property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets 3 1,303
Deferred tax assets - 52
Other assets - 167
Non-current assets 3 1,581
Current assets 209
Assets held for sale or distribution 3 1,790
Provisions - 12
Deferred tax liabilities - 27
Other liabilities - 209
Liabilities associated with assets held for sale or distribution - 248

In 2023, Svitzer and one terminal were classified as held for sale. The divestment of the terminal was discontinued following the withdrawal of the buyer.

Svitzer

At the Extraordinary General Meeting held on 26 April 2024, the demerger and separate listing of Svitzer was completed and approved by the Board of Directors.

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S injected 100% of the shares in Svitzer A/S, including the company's subsidiaries as well as certain other assets and liabilities related to Maersk's towage activities, into the new company, Svitzer Group A/S. The shares of Svitzer Group A/S were admitted to trading and were officially listed on Nasdaq Copenhagen with the first trading day being 30 April 2024.

IFRIC 17 requires recognition of non-cash distributions to shareholders at the fair value of assets distributed. However, it also provides an exception for a distribution of a non-cash asset that is ultimately controlled by the same party or parties before and after the distribution. Due to Svitzer being ultimately controlled by A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal before and after the demerger, this demerger is excluded from the scope of IFRIC 17. A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal, through A.P. Møller Holding A/S, effectively exercises de facto control over Svitzer as it holds significantly more voting rights than any other shareholders, and other shareholdings are widely dispersed. Therefore, the distribution is measured using the carrying value of Svitzer's net assets as of the demerger date amounting to USD 1.0bn. Consequently, no gain or loss on disposal was recognised.

As the demerger did not result in any gain or loss on disposal, Management has selected the accounting policy of transferring the cumulative translation reserve within equity. The cumulative translation reserve of USD 224m related to Svitzer as of the demerger date was reclassified within equity to retained earnings.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Assets held for sale are recognised when the carrying amount of an individual non-current asset, or disposal group of assets, is recovered principally through a sales transaction rather than through continued use. Assets are classified as held for sale when activities to carry out a sale have been initiated, when the activities are available for immediate sale in their present condition, and when the activities are expected to be disposed of within 12 months. Liabilities directly associated with assets held for sale are presented separately from other liabilities.

Assets held for sale are measured at the lower of carrying amount immediately before classification as held for sale and fair value less costs to sell. Impairment tests are performed immediately before classification as held for sale. Non-current assets are not depreciated or amortised while classified as held for sale. Measurement of deferred tax and financial assets and liabilities is unchanged.

When an asset or a disposal group has been classified as held for sale or distribution, but the requirements are no longer met, the assets and related liabilities ceases to be classified as held for sale. The cessation of the classification as held for sale will be reflected in the period in which the change of circumstances has occurred. Comparative figures are not restated, and any adjustments to the carrying value of assets and liabilities previously classified as held for sale are recognised in the period in which the circumstances have changed.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

INVESTED CAPITAL Amounts in USD million

Restructuring Legal dis
putes, etc.
Other Total
1
January 2024
126 1,176 407 1,709
Provision made 57 422 256 735
Amount used 86 251 105 442
Amount reversed 27 181 60 268
Exchange rate adjustments -4 -18 -10 -32
31 December 2024 66 1,148 488 1,702
Of which:
Classified as non-current 11 658 277 946
Classified as current 55 490 211 756
Non-current provisions expected to
be realised after more than five years
- 30 41 71

Restructuring includes provisions for decided and publicly announced restructurings and includes mainly staff redundancy costs. Legal disputes, etc. include, among other things, indirect tax and duty disputes. Other primarily includes provisions for warranties and onerous contracts. Reversals of provisions primarily relate to legal disputes and contractual disagreements, which are recognised in the income statement under operating costs and tax.

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

Provisions for legal disputes

Management's estimate of the provisions for legal disputes, including disputes regarding taxes and duties, is based on the knowledge available on the substance of

of legal disputes through either negotiations or litigation can take several years to be reached and the outcomes are subject to considerable uncertainty.

the cases and a legal assessment of these. The resolution

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Provisions are recognised when Maersk has a present legal or constructive obligation from past events. The item includes, among other things, legal disputes and provisions for onerous contracts and unfavourable contracts

acquired as part of a business combination. Provisions are recognised based on best estimates and are discounted where the time element is significant and where the time of settlement is reasonably determinable.

4. Capital and financing

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) has continued its commitment to distribute value to its shareholders through dividends, share buy-backs and the demerger and spin-off of Svitzer in 2024. This section provides details on the movement in the Group's share capital, including the shares bought back and cancelled during the year. The movements within borrowings and lease liabilities provide insights into the development in the Group's net interest-bearing debt.

This section also includes details on the treasury management and financial risk management objectives and policies, as well as the exposure and sensitivity of the Group to credit, liquidity, interest and foreign exchange risk, and the policies in place to monitor and manage these risks.

4.1 Share capital and earnings per share
160
4.2 Borrowings and lease liability reconciliation
161
4.3 Pensions and similar obligations
163
4.4 Financial income and expenses
165
4.5 Financial instruments and risks
166
4.6 Financial instruments by category
172

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Note 4.1 Share capital and earnings per share

Development in the
number of shares:
A shares of B shares of Nominal value
DKK 1,000 DKK 500 DKK 1,000 DKK 500 DKK million USD million
1 January 2023 10,334,329 214 8,372,645 160 18,707 3,392
Conversions 1 -2 1 -2 - -
Cancellations 227,390 - 910,056 - 1,137 206
31 December 2023 10,106,940 212 7,462,590 158 17,570 3,186
1 January 2024 10,106,940 212 7,462,590 158 17,570 3,186
Conversions 3 -6 18 -36 - -
Cancellations 350,555 - 1,390,218 - 1,741 316
31 December 2024 9,756,388 206 6,072,390 122 15,829 2,870

All shares are fully issued and paid up. One A share of DKK 1,000 holds two votes. B shares have no voting rights. At the Annual General Meeting of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S on 14 March 2024, the shareholders decided on the cancellation of treasury shares whereby the share capital would be decreased from nominally DKK 17,569,715,000 to nominally DKK 15,828,942,000. The cancellation was completed during Q2 2024. The reduction in the share capital has been recorded by applying the historical rate of exchange of USD/DKK 5.5153.

Development in the
holding of treasury shares:
No. of shares of DKK 1,000 Nominal value DKK million % of share capital
Treasury shares 2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023
A shares
1
January
306,636 201,717 307 202 1.75% 1.08%
Additions 43,919 332,309 44 332 0.25% 1.89%
Cancellations 350,555 227,390 351 227 2.00% 1.22%
31 December - 306,636 - 307 - 1.75%
B shares
1
January
1,279,120 887,557 1,279 888 7.28% 4.74%
Additions 244,723 1,327,842 245 1,328 1.47% 7.54%
Cancellations 1,390,218 910,056 1,390 910 7.91% 4.86%
Disposals 13,318 26,223 14 27 0.08% 0.14%
31 December 120,307 1,279,120 120 1,279 0.76% 7.28%

The disposal of treasury shares is related to the share option plan and the restricted shares plan.

From 1 January 2024 to 7 February 2024, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S bought back 22,599 A shares with a nominal value of DKK 23m and 68,181 B shares with a nominal value of DKK 68m from A.P. Møller Holding A/S as well as 21,481 B shares with a nominal value of DKK 21m from A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond, which are considered related parties. The share buy-back programme is carried out with the purpose to adjust the capital structure of the company. Cancellation of shares which are not used for hedging purposes for the long-term incentive programme is proposed at the Annual General Meeting.

Capital management

The capital structure is managed for the Group in accordance with the financial policy, as approved by the Board of Directors.

Capital is managed to meet the objective of a solid capital structure over the business cycle and to maintain a liquidity profile in line with an investment grade credit rating. Maersk remains investment grade-rated and holds a Baa1 (stable) rating from Moody's and a BBB+ (stable) rating from Standard & Poor's. The equity share of total equity and liabilities was 66.1% (67.1%) at the end of 2024. Share buy-backs of maximum 15% of the share capital can be decided by the Board of Directors, and dividends paid out are to be between 30-50% of the underlying profit in accordance with the company's dividend policy.

The basis for calculating earnings per share is the following:

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' share of: 2024 2023
Profit for the period 6,109 3,822
Dilutive effect of outstanding restricted and performance shares and share options 27,234 28,862
Average number of shares (basic) 15,769,838 16,845,180
Average number of cancelled shares 1,055,879 648,188
Average number of treasury shares 743,998 1,213,793
Issued shares 1
January
17,569,715 18,707,161
2024 2023

Note 4.1 Share capital and earnings per share – continued

Dividends

The dividend of DKK 515 per share of DKK 1,000 was paid on 19 March 2024 – a total of DKK 8.1bn, equivalent to USD 1.2bn, excluding treasury shares (dividend of DKK 4,300 per share of DKK 1,000 paid on 31 March 2023 – a total of DKK 74.4bn, equivalent to USD 10.9bn, excluding treasury shares).

The Board of Directors proposes a dividend to the shareholders of DKK 1,120 per share of DKK 1,000 – a total of DKK 17.6bn, equivalent to USD 2.4bn. Payment of dividends is expected to take place on 21 March 2025. Payment of dividends to shareholders does not trigger taxes for Maersk.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Earnings per share is calculated as A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' share of the profit for the year divided by the average number of shares outstanding (of DKK 1,000 each), excluding Maersk's holding of treasury shares. Diluted earnings per share are adjusted for the dilutive effect of the average number of restricted shares, performance shares and share options outstanding as issued by the parent company.

Equity includes total comprehensive income for the year comprising the profit for the year and other comprehensive income. Proceeds on the purchase and sale of treasury shares and dividend from such shares are recognised in equity. The translation reserve is comprised of Maersk's share of accumulated exchange rate differences arising on translation from functional currency into presentation currency. The reserve for other equity investments is comprised of accumulated changes in the fair value of equity investments (at FVOCI), net of tax. Reserves for hedges includes the accumulated fair value change of derivatives qualifying for cash flow hedge accounting, less amounts already reclassified to the income statement or transferred as basis adjustments, net of tax, as well as forward points and currency basis spread.

Note 4.2 Borrowings and lease liability reconciliation

Net debt
31
December
Cash flows Non-cash changes Net debt
31
December
2023 From
financing
activities
Other Addi
tions
Disposals Foreign
exchange
move
ments
Other1 2024
Borrowings:
Bank and other credit
institutions 973 -28 15 - - -34 - 926
Issued bonds2 3,393 875 - - - -153 24 4,139
Total borrowings 4,366 8473 15 - - -187 24 5,065
Classified as non-current 4,169 4,539
Classified as current 197 526
Leases:
Lease liabilities 10,448 -3,046 - 4,609 -389 -210 - 11,412
Classified as non-current 7,798 8,728
Classified as current 2,650 2,684
Total borrowings and leases 14,814 -2,199 15 4,609 -389 -397 24 16,477
Derivatives hedge of
borrowings, net
352 -4 - - - 154 -67 435

1 Other includes fair value changes and amortisation of fees.

2 Of the total issued bonds at 31 December 2024, USD 2.4bn are green bonds primarily used to finance investments in dual-fuel vessels, electrified material handling equipment and construction of low-emission buildings.

3 Cash flows from financing activities of USD 847m are made up of repayments of borrowings of negative USD 705m and proceeds from borrowings of USD 1.6bn, adjusted for borrowings associated with assets held for sale of USD 615m.

The maturity analysis of lease liabilities is disclosed in note 4.5.

The integrator

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.2 Borrowings and lease liability reconciliation – continued

Derivatives hedge
of borrowings, net
532 -46 - - - - -53 -81 352
Total borrowings
and leases
15,643 -3,006 - 2,271 -241 -56 145 58 14,814
Classified as
current
3,032 2,650
Classified as non
current
8,582 7,798
Leases:
Lease liabilities
11,614 -3,226 3 2,2684 -241 -56 84 2 10,448
Classified as
current
255 197
Classified as non
current
3,774 4,169
Total borrowings 4,029 2203 -3 3 - - 61 56 4,366
Issued bonds2 2,976 308 - - - - 53 56 3,393
Borrowings:
Bank and other
credit institutions
1,053 -88 -3 3 - - 8 - 973
2022 From
financing
activities
Other Addi
tions
Disposals Transfers,
assets
held for
sale
Foreign
exchange
move
ments
Other1 2023
31 Net debt
December
Cash flows
Non-cash changes
Net debt
31
December

1 Other includes fair value changes and amortisation of fees.

2 Of the total issued bonds at 31 December 2023, USD 1.3bn are green bonds primarily used to finance the construction of dual-fuel vessels.

3 Cash flows from financing activities of USD 220m are made up of repayments of borrowings of negative USD 660m, adjusted for cash flows from hedges of USD 35m and proceeds from borrowings of USD 845m.

4 Additions include USD 29m of lease liabilities from businesses acquired during 2023.

The maturity analysis of lease liabilities is disclosed in note 4.5 Financial instruments and risks.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Financial liabilities are initially recognised at fair value less transaction costs. Subsequently, the financial liabilities are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method, whereby transaction costs and any premium or discount are recognised as financial expenses over the term of the liabilities. Fixed interest loans subject to fair value hedge accounting are measured at amortised cost with an adjustment for the fair value of the hedged interest component.

Lease liabilities are measured at the present value of the lease payments over the lease term, at the interest rate implicit in the lease, or at Maersk's incremental borrowing rate (IBR). Maersk's IBR reflects the Group's credit risk, leased amount, and contract duration, as well as the nature and quality of the asset's security and economic environment in which the leased assets operate. To determine the IBR, where possible, Maersk uses recent third-party financing received by the individual lessee as a starting point, with adjustments to reflect changes in financing conditions since that financing was received. Where such financing is not available, Maersk uses a build-up approach that starts with a risk- free interest rate adjusted by credit risk and specific risks faced by the lessee such as asset type, geographical risks, etc.

Subsequently, the lease liability is measured at amortised cost with each lease payment allocated between the repayment of the liability and financing cost. The finance cost is charged to the income statement over the lease period, using the IBR that was used to discount the lease payments.

The following lease payments are included in the net present value:

  • fixed payments (including in-substance fixed payments), less any lease incentives receivable
  • variable lease payments that are based on an index or a rate
  • amounts expected to be payable by the lessee under residual value guarantees
  • the exercise price of a purchase option if the lessee is reasonably certain to exercise that option, and payments of penalties for terminating the lease, if the lease term reflects the lessee exercising that option.

Extension and termination options in lease contracts are included in contracts where it is reasonably certain that Maersk will exercise the options. These terms are used to maximise operational flexibility in terms of managing contracts. In determining the lease term, Management considers all facts and circumstances that create an economic incentive to exercise an extension option or to not exercise a termination option. Most of the extension and termination options held are exercisable only by Maersk and not by the respective lessor. This assessment is reviewed if a significant event or a significant change in circumstances occurs which affects this assessment, and which is within the control of the lessee. Where Maersk will probably exercise specific purchase options, those options are included in the measurement of the lease liability with corresponding right-of-use asset depreciated over the asset's useful life rather than lease term.

162

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

CAPITAL AND FINANCING

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

163

A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024

Note 4.3
Pensions and similar obligations
UK Other Total UK Other Total
2024 2024 2024 2023 2023 2023
Specification of net liability
Present value of funded plans 1,151 155 1,306 1,315 152 1,467
Fair value of plan assets -1,269 -88 -1,357 -1,428 -84 -1,512
Net liability of funded plans -118 67 -51 -113 68 -45
Present value of unfunded plans - 98 98 - 97 97
Impact of minimum funding
requirement/asset ceiling 7 - 7 19 - 19
Net liability 31
December
-111 165 54 -94 165 71
Of which:
Pensions, net assets 125 120
Pensions and similar obligations 179 191
UK Total UK Total
Significant financial assumptions 2024 2024 2023 2023
Discount rate 5.5% 5.3% 4.5% 4.5%
Inflation rate 3.3% 3.2% 3.3% 3.3%

As employer, the Group participates in pension plans according to normal practice in the countries in which the Group operates. Generally, the pension plans within the Group are defined contribution plans, where contributions are recognised in the income statement on an accrual basis. A number of entities have defined benefit plans, in which retirement benefits are based on length of service and salary level. To a limited extent, these defined benefit plans also include payment of medical expenses, etc.

In 2025, the Group expects to pay contributions totalling USD 7m (USD 17m) to funded defined benefit plans. 82% of the Group's defined benefit liabilities are in the UK. All of the plans in the UK are funded. Although all of the

UK plans are now closed to new entrants, active members in the two largest plans continue to accrue new benefits. The smaller UK plans are all closed to new accruals, although a salary link remains in some of the plans.

Overall, the plans have an average duration of 11 years, and approximately 60% of the obligation is related to pensioner members.

As well as being subject to the risks of falling interest rates, which would increase the obligation, poor asset returns and pensioners living longer than anticipated, the Group is also subject to the risk of higher-than-expected inflation. This is because many pension benefits, particularly in the UK plans, increase in line with inflation although some minimum and maximum limits apply.

31
December
Life expectancy 2024 2044 2023 2043
65-year-old male in the UK 21.8 23.5 21.7 23.3
65-year-old female in the UK 24.2 25.9 24.1 25.8

The sensitivity of the liabilities and pension costs to the key assumptions are as follows:

Sensitivities for key assumptions in the UK Increase Decrease
Factors 'Change in liability' 2024 2024
Discount rate Increase/(decrease) by 25 basis points 32
Inflation rate Increase/(decrease) by 25 basis points 15 -17
Life expectancy Increase/(decrease) by one year 44 -43
UK Other Total UK Other Total
Specification of plan assets 2024 2024 2024 2023 2023 2023
Insurance contracts 935 56 991 1,036 54 1,090
Shares 35 7 42 20 6 26
Government bonds 201 4 205 224 4 228
Corporate bonds 60 4 64 66 4 70
Real estate 6 2 8 10 1 11
Other assets 32 15 47 72 15 87
Fair value 31 December 1,269 88 1,357 1,428 84 1,512

Rates of life expectancy reflect the most recent mortality investigations, and in line with market practice an allowance is made for future improvements in life expectancy. The Group assumes that future improvements will be in line with the latest projections of 1.25% for all UK plans.

The liabilities are calculated using assumptions that are the Group's best estimate of future experience bearing in mind the requirements of IAS 19.

The Group's plans are funded in accordance with applicable local legislation. In the UK, each plan has a Trustee Board that is required to act in the best interests of plan members. Every three years, a formal valuation of the plan's liabilities is carried out using a prudent basis, and if the plan is in deficit, the Trustees agree with the Group or the sponsoring employer on a plan for recovering that deficit.

Around 80% of the UK liabilities are now covered by insurance policies. Therefore, movement in the liabilities due to change in assumptions would equally impact the assets value related to the buy-in policies, resulting in a reduced movement in the overall balance sheet position.

Corporate governance

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Note 4.3 Pensions and similar obligations – continued

No contributions to the UK plans are expected for 2025. The contributions to the UK plans for 2024 were expected to be USD 12m which were all in respect of deficit recovery contributions, though only USD 4m was actually paid. In most of the UK plans, any surplus remaining after the last member dies may be returned to the Group. However, the Merchant Navy Ratings Pension Fund (MNRPF), and the Merchant Navy Officers Pension Fund (MNOPF) contributions paid by the Group are not refundable in any circumstance and the balance sheet liability reflects an adjustment for any agreed deficit recovery contributions in excess of deficit determined using the Group's assumptions. In 2024, an adjustment of USD 3m (USD 11m) was applied in this respect.

Other than the insurance contracts and a small proportion of other holdings, the plan assets held by the Group are quoted investments.

Change in net liability Present
value of
obligations
Fair value
of plan
assets
Adjust
ments
Net
liability
Of which:
UK
1
January 2024
1,564 1,512 19 71 -94
Current service costs, administration costs, etc. 25 -6 - 31 14
Calculated interest expense/income 68 67 - 1 -4
Recognised in the income statement in 2024 93 61 - 32 10
Return on plan assets, excluding amounts
included in interest
- -118 - 118 124
Actuarial gains/losses from changes in
demographic assumptions
-4 - - -4 -5
Actuarial gains/losses from changes in
financial assumptions
Experience adjustments
-129
10
-
-
-
-
-129
10
-135
4
Adjustments for unrecognised assets
due to asset ceiling
- - -14 -14 -13
Recognised in other comprehensive income in 2024 -123 -118 -14 -19 -25
Contributions from the Group and employees - 23 - -23 -5
Benefit payments -103 -100 - -3 -
Settlements -2 -2 - - -
Exchange rate adjustments -25 -19 2 -4 3
31 December 2024 1,404 1,357 7 54 -111
Change in net liability Present
value of
obligations
Fair value
of plan
assets
Adjust
ments
Net
liability
Of which:
UK
1
January 2023
1,875 1,884 66 57 -121
Current service costs, administration costs, etc. 57 -6 - 63 41
Calculated interest expense/income 83 86 3 - -5
Recognised in the income statement in 2023 140 80 3 63 36
Return on plan assets, excluding amounts
included in interest
- -6 - 6 3
Actuarial gains/losses from changes in
demographic assumptions
-18 - - -18 -19
Actuarial gains/losses from changes in
financial assumptions
4 - - 4 13
Experience adjustments 51 - - 51 53
Adjustments for unrecognised assets
due to asset ceiling
- - -52 -52 -52
Recognised in other comprehensive income in 2023 37 -6 -52 -9 -2
Contributions from the Group and employees 1 23 - -22 -
Benefit payments -146 -140 - -6 -
Settlements1 -186 -181 - -5 -
Transfers, assets held for sale2 -250 -248 -1 -3 -1
Exchange rate adjustments 93 100 3 -4 -6
31 December 2023 1,564 1,512 19 71 -94

1 Relates to the termination and settlement via insurance of the US Maersk Pension Plan.

2 In 2023, the net pension liability of Svitzer Group classified as held for sale was presented as a single amount under present value of obligations. In 2024, this presentation was revised to properly reflect the reduction separately in the present value of obligations, fair value of plan assets and adjustments.

Note 4.3 Pensions and similar obligations – continued

Multi-employer plans

Under collective agreements, certain entities in the Group participate together with other employers in defined benefit pension plans as well as welfare/medical plans (multi-employer plans). In general, the contributions to the schemes are based on man hours worked or cargo tonnage handled, or a combination of these.

For the defined benefit pension plans, the Group has joint and several liabilities to fund total obligations. While the welfare/medical plans are by nature contribution plans funded on a pay-as-you-go basis. The Group's contributions to the pension and welfare/medical plans in 2024 are estimated at USD 66m (USD 86m) and USD 259m (USD 259m), respectively. The contributions to be paid in 2025 are estimated at USD 72m (USD 82m) for the pension plans and USD 284m (USD 249m) for the welfare/medical plans.

No reliable basis exists for allocation of the schemes' obligations and plan assets to individual employer participants. For the pension plans where the Group has an interest and there is a deficit, the net obligations for all employers amount to USD 182m (USD 216m). This net obligation is based on the most recent available financial data from the plan's trustees, calculated in accordance with the rules for such actuarial calculation in US GAAP. The deficit in some of the schemes may necessitate increased contributions in the future. Welfare/medical plans are pay-as-you-go and form a part of the Group's US collective bargaining agreements. They cover a limited part of employees' medical costs as occurred.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Pension obligations are the net liabilities of defined benefit obligations and the dedicated assets adjusted for the effect of minimum funding and asset ceiling requirements. Plans with a funding surplus are presented as net assets on the balance sheet. The defined benefit obligations are measured at the present value of expected future payments to be made in respect of services provided by employees up to the balance sheet date. Plan assets are measured at fair value. The pension cost charged to the income statement consists of calculated amounts for vested benefits and interest in addition to settlement of gains or losses, etc. Interest on plan assets is calculated at the same rates as used for discounting the obligations. Actuarial gains/losses are recognised in other comprehensive income.

Pension plans where Maersk, as part of collective bargaining agreements, participates together with other enterprises – so called multi-employer plans – are treated as other pension plans in the financial statements. Defined benefit multi-employer plans, where sufficient information to apply defined benefit accounting is not available, are treated as defined contribution plans.

Note 4.4 Financial income and expenses

2024 2023
Interest expenses on liabilities1,4 1,002 904
Borrowing costs capitalised on assets2 105 133
Interest income on loans and receivables 1,110 1,202
Fair value adjustment transferred from equity hedge reserve (loss) 32 21
Net interest expenses -181 -410
Exchange rate gains on bank balances, borrowings and working capital 580 335
Exchange rate losses on bank balances, borrowings and working capital 327 522
Net foreign exchange gains/losses 253 -187
Fair value gains from derivatives 179 200
Fair value losses from derivatives 303 56
Net fair value gains/losses -124 144
Dividends received from securities3 1 1
Gains on payable contingent consideration - 66
Loss on payable contingent consideration 2 -
Impairment losses on financial assets 7 6
Reversal of impairment losses on financial assets 15 -
Financial expenses, net -317 -428
Of which:
Financial income 1,885 1,804
Financial expenses 1,568 1,376

1 Of which USD 611m (USD 563m) relates to interest expenses on lease liabilities and USD 340m (USD 280m) to borrowings.

2 The capitalisation rate used to determine the amount of borrowing costs eligible for capitalisation is 6.2% (7.2%).

3 Of which USD 1m (USD 1m) pertains to shares held at the end of the year.

4 Of which USD 0m (USD 10m) relates to expenses from prepayment of issued bonds.

Refer to note 4.5 financial instruments and risks for the analysis of gains and losses from derivatives.

Corporate governance

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Note 4.5 Financial instruments and risks

The gain/losses of the derivatives are recognised as follows: 2024 2023
Hedging foreign exchange risk on revenue -4 -8
Hedging foreign exchange risk on operating costs -50 41
Hedging interest rate risk -32 -21
Hedging foreign exchange risk on the cost of non-current assets - 4
Total effective hedging -86 16
Ineffectiveness recognised in financial expenses 1 -1
Total reclassified from equity reserve for hedges -85 15
Derivatives accounted for as held for trading:
Currency derivatives recognised directly in financial income/expenses -129 154
Interest rate derivatives recognised directly in financial income/expenses 23 44
Oil prices and freight rate derivatives recognised directly in other income/costs -32 -23
Net gains/losses recognised directly in the income statement -138 175
Total -223 190

The Group's derivatives are presented at fair value in the balance sheet.

The Group's activities expose it to a variety of financial risks:

  • Market risks, i.e., currency risk, interest rate risk and oil price risk
  • Credit risk
  • Liquidity risk

The Group's overall risk management programme focuses on the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to minimise the potential adverse effects on the Group's financial performance. The Group uses derivative financial instruments to hedge certain risk exposures.

Risk management is carried out by a central finance department under policies approved by the Board of Directors. The finance department identifies, evaluates and hedges financial risks in close cooperation with the Group's entities.

Market risk is the risk that changes in market prices, such as foreign exchange rates and interest rates, will affect the Group's profit or the value of its holdings of financial instruments. The sensitivity analyses in the currency risk and interest rate risk sections relate to the position of financial instruments at 31 December 2024.

The sensitivity analyses for currency risk and interest rate risk have been prepared on the basis that the amount of net debt, the ratio of fixed to floating interest rates of the debt and the proportion of financial instruments in foreign currencies remain unchanged from hedge designations in place at 31 December 2024. Furthermore, it is assumed that the exchange rate and interest rate sensitivities have a symmetric impact, i.e. an increase in rates results in the same absolute movement as a decrease in rates.

The sensitivity analyses show the effect on profit and equity of a reasonably possible change in exchange rates and interest rates.

Hedges comprise primarily currency derivatives and interest rate derivatives, which are further described in the following sections.

Currency risk

The Group's currency risk relates to the fact that while income from Ocean activities is denominated mainly in USD, the related expenses are incurred in both USD and a wide range of other currencies such as EUR, DKK, CNY and BRL. As the net income is in USD, this is also the primary financing currency. Income and expenses from other activities including Terminals are mainly denominated in local currencies, thus reducing the Group's exposure to these currencies.

The main purpose of hedging the Group's currency risk is to hedge the USD value of the Group's net cash flow and reduce fluctuations in the Group's profit. The Group uses various financial derivatives, including forwards, option contracts and cross-currency swaps, to hedge these risks. The key aspects of the currency hedging policy are:

  • Net cash flows in significant currencies other than USD are hedged using a layered model with a 12-month horizon.
  • Significant capital commitments or divestments in currencies other than USD are hedged.
  • Most non-USD debt is hedged, however, depending on the asset-liability match and the currency of the generated cash flow.

Currency derivatives hedge future revenue, operating costs and investments/divestments, and are recognised on an ongoing basis in the income statement and the cost of property, plant and equipment, respectively. There is not any proxy hedging for the currency risk hedging, and therefore the economic relationship between the hedged exposure and the hedge is high. Effectiveness is assessed using the critical terms match approach according to IFRS 9.

Hedges of future revenue and operating costs matures within a year (matures within a year).

For hedges related to operating and investment cash flows, a loss of USD 127m in 2024 (loss of USD 8m) is recognised in other comprehensive income, and the cash flow hedge reserve amounts to a loss of USD 84m at 31 December (gain of USD 43m). For hedges where the cost of hedging is applied, the forward points are recognised in other comprehensive income and transferred with the effective hedge when the hedged transaction occurs. The cost of hedging reserve amounts to USD 0m (USD 0m). There was no ineffectiveness in 2024 (no ineffectiveness).

Besides the designated cash flow hedges in the table, the Group uses derivatives to hedge currency exposures that do not qualify for hedge accounting. These derivatives are classified as fair value through profit or loss. The average FX hedge rates for swaps in cash flow hedge were EUR/USD 1.13 (1.18) and GBP/USD 1.52 (1.52). The average FX hedge rates for swaps in combined fair value hedge were EUR/USD 1.18 (1.24), GBP/USD 1.52 (1.52), USD/NOK 8.25 (8.25) and USD/JPY 119.39 (119.39).

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

167

A.P. Moller - Maersk Annual Report 2024

Liabilities, net 509 247
Current liabilities 225 72
Non-current liabilities 333 323
Current receivables 47 137
Non-current receivables 2 11
Derivatives recognised at fair value in the balance sheet 2024 2023
Note 4.5
Financial instruments and risks – continued

Total 23 107

Total 55 12

Fair value, asset

EUR 7 36 1,006 EUR/USD 1.08 DKK 1 10 247 USD/DKK 6.84 CNY 2 3 239 USD/CNY 7.12 BRL1 - 19 223 USD/BRL 5.85 Other currencies 13 39 1,362 N/A

EUR 14 2 1,017 EUR/USD 1.10 DKK 3 1 286 USD/DKK 6.76 CNY 5 1 249 USD/CNY 7.04 BRL1 4 2 77 USD/BRL 5.07 Other currencies2 29 6 1,235 N/A

Fair value, liability

Nominal amount of derivative

Average hedge rate

Fair value
Other hedges recognised at fair value through profit and loss 2024 2023
Currency derivatives 14 43
Total 14 43

The Group's sensitivity to an increase in the USD exchange rate of 10% against all other significant currencies to which the Group is exposed is estimated to have the following symmetrical impact.

The sensitivities are based only on the impact of financial instruments that are outstanding at the balance sheet date and are thus not an expression of the Group's total currency risk.

Profit before tax Equity before tax
Currency sensitivity for financial instruments 2024 2023 2024 2023
DKK 63 9 41 -17
EUR 50 41 -40 -50
CNY 23 31 1 8
Other -7 -45 -138 -145
Total 129 36 -136 -204

1 HKD is replaced by BRL as one of the main currencies in 2024.

Hedge of operating and investment cash flows

in foreign currencies

CAPITAL AND FINANCING

Main currencies hedged

2024

2023

2 2023 figures are restated to reflect replacement of HKD by BRL.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.5 Financial instruments and risks – continued

Interest rate risk

Maturity
Interest rate hedging
of borrowings
Fair
value,
asset
Fair
value,
liability
Nominal
amount
of
deriva
tive
0-1 year 2-5 years 5- years Gain/loss
on
hedged
item
Gain/loss
on
hedging
instru
ment
Average
hedge
rate
2024
Combined fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 112 737 - 392 345 -6 -14 6.2%
GBP - 21 88 88 - - 1 -3 6.9%
JPY - 26 79 79 - - - -1 6.2%
NOK - 85 194 - 194 - 8 -12 6.9%
Fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
USD - 39 650 - 400 250 39 -39 6.8%
Cash flow hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 120 1,698 - 392 1,306 - -26 4.2%
GBP - 33 160 160 - - - 1 4.6%
USD 1 - 36 10 26 - - 1 2.8%
Total 1 436 3,642 337 1,404 1,901 42 -93
2023
Combined fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 90 503 - 415 88 15 -32 7.3%
GBP - 24 89 - 89 - 2 -6 7.9%
JPY - 17 88 - 88 - - -2 7.2%
NOK - 68 216 - 216 - 12 -18 7.9%
Fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
USD 11 44 850 - 200 650 32 -33 7.7%
Cash flow hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 88 967 - 414 553 - -29 3.2%
GBP - 33 162 - 162 - - -1 4.6%
USD 2 - 64 - 30 34 - 2 2.6%
Total 13 364 2,939 - 1,614 1,325 61 -119

The Group has most of its debt denominated in USD, but part of the debt (e.g. issued bonds) is in other currencies such as EUR, GBP, NOK and JPY. The Group strives to maintain a combination of fixed and floating interest rates on its net debt, reflecting expectations and risks.

Interest rate risk is managed within a range set for the percentage of gross debt carrying fixed interest, net of hedging. The level at 31 December 2024 is 51% (41%), excluding IFRS 16 Leases.

A general increase in interest rates by 1 percentage point is estimated, all else being equal, to affect profit before tax and equity, excluding tax effect, positively by approx. USD 161m (positively by USD 134m) and positively by approx. USD 121m (positively by USD 113m), respectively.

This analysis assumes that all other variables, in particular foreign currency rates, remain constant.

The hedging of the interest rate risk is done by cross-currency swaps and interest rate swaps. The hedging is a mix of fair value hedging, combined fair value hedging and cash flow hedging.

Combined fair value hedging is applied when cross-currency swaps are entered into to hedge the risk of debt denominated in currencies other than USD. Each hedge relationship is split into a fair value hedge (fixed to floating interest rate swap), where value changes from market rates are recognised directly in profit or loss, and a cash flow hedge, where the value changes from the exchange rate exposure of the credit margin are recognised in other comprehensive income.

Ineffectiveness from cash flow hedges due to buy-back of issued bonds is recognised in the income statement with a cost of USD 0m (USD 1m).

The hedges are expected to be highly effective due to the nature of the economic relationship between the exposure and the hedge. The source of ineffectiveness is the credit risk of the hedging instruments. For hedges where the cost of hedging is applied, the change in basis spread is recognised in other comprehensive income and is a time effect during the lifetime of the swap and at maturity amounts to 0. If the hedged transaction is prepaid, the change in basis spread will be recognised in profit or loss as ineffectiveness. The cost of hedging reserve amounts to USD 0m (gain of USD 7m).

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.5 Financial instruments and risks – continued

Borrowings and lease liabilities by interest rate Carrying Next interest rate fixing
levels inclusive of interest rate swaps amount 0-1 year 1-5 years 5- years
2024
0-3% 1,370 544 279 547
3-6% 9,428 2,133 2,533 4,762
6%- 5,679 2,830 1,692 1,157
Total 16,477 5,507 4,504 6,466
Of which:
Bearing fixed interest 14,120
Bearing floating interest 2,357
2023
0-3% 981 252 123 606
3-6% 9,952 2,390 3,830 3,732
6%- 3,881 2,709 605 567
Total 14,814 5,351 4,558 4,905
Of which:
Bearing fixed interest 12,377
Bearing floating interest 2,437
Oil price risk
Maturity
Quantity,
thousand
metric tonnes1
Average trade
price per
metric tonne
Average
duration
Fair value 0-3 months 4-12 months
2024
Oil swaps -1,221 0-1 year 1 0 1
Buy 11,885 456 123 113 10
Sell -13,106 485 -122 -113 -9
Oil futures -284 0-1 year -5 -5 -
Buy 26 524 0 0 -
Sell -310 491 -5 -5 -
Total -1,505 -4 -5 1
2023
Oil swaps -1,121 0-1 year 10 2 8
Buy 12,365 480 -231 -204 -27
Sell -13,486 519 241 206 35
Oil futures -177 0-1 year 8 7 1
Buy 380 633 -1 -1 -
Sell -557 639 9 8 1
Total -1,298 18 9 9

1 In 2024, the quantity presentation was changed from million metric tonnes to thousand metric tonnes.

The majority of the Group's trading of commodity products is related to inventory stocks of crude oil and bunker oil, as the products are bought in larger quantities and stored for processing and re-sale. The oil price risk arising from these oil price exposures is mitigated by entering into commodity derivative agreements. The overall exposure limit is set in the Group's risk policy, defining a maximum net open position for the Group. On 31 December 2024, the Group entered into oil derivative positions as shown in the table.

The Group's sensitivity to a 5% change in the oil price, all else being equal is estimated to have a symmetrical impact with immaterial difference on profit and equity before tax negatively by approx. USD 31m (USD 24m) with an increase and decrease leading to a positive impact of the same magnitude. The sensitivities are based on the impact of financial instruments that are outstanding at the balance sheet date.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

CAPITAL AND FINANCING

Note 4.5 Financial instruments and risks – continued

Credit risk
Maturity analysis of trade receivables 2024 2023
Receivables not due 4,331 4,065
Less than 90 days overdue 1,330 1,140
91 – 365 days overdue 292 253
More than 1 year overdue 161 127
Receivables, gross 6,114 5,585
Provision for bad debt 265 226
Carrying amount 5,849 5,359

The loss allowance provision for trade receivables as at 31 December 2024 reconciles to the opening loss allowance as follows:

Change in provision for bad debt 2024 2023
1
January
226 265
Provision made 363 258
Amount used 114 88
Amount reversed 205 210
Acquired in business combinations - 4
Disposal on the sale of businesses - 1
Transfers, assets held for sale - -2
Exchange rate adjustments and others -5 -
31 December 265 226

Trade receivables

The Group has exposure to financial and commercial counterparties but has no particular concentration of customers or suppliers. To minimise the credit risk, financial vetting is undertaken for all major customers and financial institutions, adequate security is required for commercial counterparties, and credit limits are set for financial institutions and key commercial counterparties.

The Group applies the simplified approach to providing the expected credit losses prescribed by IFRS 9, which permits the use of the lifetime expected loss provision for all trade receivables. To measure the expected credit losses, trade receivables have been grouped based on shared credit risk characteristics and the days past due. In accordance with IFRS 9, non-due trade receivables have also been considered for impairment.

Approximately 55% (50%) of the provision for bad debt is related to trade receivables overdue by more than one year.

Other financial assets at amortised cost

Other financial assets at amortised cost comprise loans receivable, finance lease receivables and other receivables. These financial assets are considered to have low credit risk, and thus the impairment provision calculated based on 12 months of expected losses is considered immaterial. The financial assets are considered to be low-risk when they have a low risk of default, and the issuer has a strong capacity to meet its contractual cash flow obligations in the near term.

Financial institutions

Deposits and bank balances are primarily held in relationship banks with a credit rating of at least A-. No individual exposure is above 10%. Maersk has ISDA agreements for trading of derivatives, under which the Group has a right to net settlement in the event of certain credit events. This results in the credit risk being limited to the net position per counterparty.

Liquidity risk

Net interest-bearing debt and liquidity reserve 2024 2023
Borrowings 16,477 14,814
Net interest-bearing debt -7,373 -4,658
Cash and bank balances 6,575 6,701
Restricted cash -928 -1,024
Cash management overdrafts -32 -18
Term deposits not included in cash and bank balances 15,731 12,693
Securities 1,580 -
Undrawn revolving credit facilities > 12 months 6,050 6,050
Liquidity reserve1 28,976 24,4022

1 Liquidity reserve is defined as undrawn committed revolving facilities with more than one year to expiry, securities, term deposits and cash and bank balances, net of cash management overdraft, excluding securities, overdrafts and balances in countries with exchange control or other restrictions.

2 The 2023 liquidity reserve was restated from to include the cash management overdrafts of USD 18m.

For information about cash and bank balances in countries with exchange control or other restrictions, refer to note 5.5 Cash flow specifications.

Based on the liquidity reserve, loans for the financing of specific assets, the maturity of outstanding loans, and the current investment profile, the Group's financial resources are deemed satisfactory.

The average term to maturity of loan facilities in the Group was about 5 years (about 5 years) at 31 December 2024.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Annual Report 2024

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Annual Report 2024

CAPITAL AND FINANCING

flow from operating activities.

Note 4.5 Financial instruments and risks – continued

Carrying
amount
Cash flows including interest
Maturities of liabilities
and commitments
0-1 year 1-5 years 5- years Total
2024
Bank and other credit institutions 926 235 658 222 1,115
Lease liabilities 11,412 3,244 6,475 5,189 14,908
– of which interest 560 1,327 1,609 3,496
Issued bonds 4,139 473 1,893 2,793 5,159
Trade payables 6,698 6,698 - - 6,698
Other payables 1,687 1,665 12 10 1,687
Non-derivative financial liabilities 24,862 12,315 9,038 8,214 29,567
Derivatives 558 225 258 75 558
Total recognised in balance sheet 25,420 12,540 9,296 8,289 30,125
Capital commitments 2,994 4,507 914 8,415
Total 15,534 13,803 9,203 38,540
2023
Bank and other credit institutions 973 259 676 273 1,208
Lease liabilities 10,448 3,120 5,811 4,292 13,223
– of which interest 458 1,078 1,239 2,775
Issued bonds 3,393 115 1,907 2,105 4,127
Trade payables 6,401 6,401 - - 6,401
Other payables 1,516 1,479 24 13 1,516
Non-derivative financial liabilities 22,731 11,374 8,418 6,683 26,475
Derivatives 395 72 241 82 395
Total recognised in balance sheet 23,126 11,446 8,659 6,765 26,870
Capital commitments 1,955 2,228 683 4,866
Total 13,401 10,887 7,448 31,736

It is of great importance for the Group to maintain a financial reserve to cover the Group's obligations and investment opportunities and to provide the capital necessary to offset changes in the Group's liquidity due to changes in the cash

The flexibility of the financial reserve is subject to ongoing prioritisation and optimisation, among other things by

focusing on the release of capital and following up on the development in working capital.

Amounts in USD million

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Derivative financial instruments are recognised on the trading date and measured at fair value using generally acknowledged valuation techniques based on relevant observable swap curves and exchange rates.

The effective portion of changes in the value of derivative financial instruments designated to hedge highly probable future transactions is recognised in other comprehensive income until the hedged transactions are realised. At that time, the accumulated gains/losses are transferred to the items in which the hedged transactions are recognised.

The effective portion of changes in the value of derivative financial instruments used to hedge the value of recognised financial assets and liabilities is recognised in the income statement together with changes in the fair value of the hedged assets or liabilities that can be attributed to the hedging relationship. Currency basis spread and forward points are considered a cost of hedging and recognised in other comprehensive income and deferred in equity until realisation.

The ineffective portion of hedge transactions and changes in the fair values of derivative financial instruments, which do not qualify for hedge accounting, are recognised in the income statement as financial income or expenses for interest and currency-based instruments, and as other income/costs for oil price hedges and forward freight agreements.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.6 Financial instruments by category

Carrying amount Fair value3
2024 2023 2024 2023
Carried at amortised cost
Loan receivables 15,999 12,956 16,020 12,973
Lease receivables 31 49
Other interest-bearing receivables and deposits 100 117
Trade receivables 5,849 5,359
Other receivables (non-interest-bearing) 3,557 2,712
Cash and bank balances 6,575 6,701
Financial assets at amortised cost 32,111 27,894
Derivatives 49 148
Carried at fair value through other comprehensive income
Equity investments (FVOCI)1 359 398
Securities2 1,580 -
Financial assets at fair value through OCI 1,939 398
Total financial assets 34,099 28,440
Carried at amortised cost
Bank and other credit institutions 926 973 937 1,000
Lease liabilities 11,412 10,448
Issued bonds 4,139 3,393 4,187 3,339
Trade payables 6,698 6,401
Other payables 1,676 1,500
Financial liabilities at amortised cost 24,851 22,715
Derivatives 558 395
Carried at fair value
Other payables 11 16
Financial liabilities at fair value 11 16
Total financial liabilities 25,420 23,126

1 Designated at initial recognition in accordance with IFRS 9.

2 Investments in bonds measured at fair value through OCI.

3 Where no fair value is stated, the amount equals carrying amount.

Movement during the year
in level 3
Other equity
investments
(FVOCI)
Other
receivables
Total
financial
assets
Other
payables
Total
financial
liabilities
Carrying amount 1 January 2024 377 - 377 16 16
Additions 23 - 23 - -
Disposals 1 - 1 - -
Gains/losses recognised in the
income statement
- - - -5 -5
Gains/losses recognised in other
comprehensive income
-64 - -64 - -
Carrying amount 31 December 2024 335 335 11 11
Carrying amount 1 January 2023 342 3 345 130 130
Additions 25 - 25 22 22
Disposals 5 3 8 70 70
Gains/losses recognised in the
income statement
- - - -66 -66
Gains/losses recognised in other
comprehensive income
15 - 15 - -
Carrying amount 31 December 2023 377 - 377 16 16

Financial instruments measured at fair value

Financial instruments measured at fair value can be divided into three levels:

Level 1 – Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities

Level 2 – Inputs other than quoted prices included in level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly (i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices)

Level 3 – Inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data.

The fair value of listed securities is within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. Non-listed shares and other securities are within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

The fair value of derivatives is mainly within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy and is calculated based on observable market data as of the end of the reporting period. A minor amount of crude oil price derivatives is within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy.

The fair value of level 3 assets and liabilities is primarily based on the present value of expected future cash flows. A reasonably possible change in the discount rate is not estimated to affect the Group's profit or equity significantly.

172

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financial instruments carried at amortised cost

The fair value of the short-term financial assets and other financial liabilities carried at amortised cost is not materially different from the carrying amount. In general, fair value is determined primarily based on the present value of expected future cash flows. Where a market price was available, however, this was deemed to be the fair value.

The fair value of listed issued bonds is within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. The fair value of the remaining borrowing items and financial assets are within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy and is calculated based on discounted future cash flows.

Debt instruments (FVOCI)

The Group's debt instruments at fair value through OCI include investments in quoted debt instruments and are included under Securities in the balance sheet. Interest income, foreign exchange revaluation and impairment losses or reversals are recognised in the income statement and computed in the same manner as for financial assets measured at amortised cost. The remaining fair value changes are recognised in OCI. Upon derecognition, the cumulative fair value change recognised in OCI is recycled to profit or loss.

Other equity investments (FVOCI)

The Group has investments in equity shares of both listed and non-listed companies. The Group holds non-controlling interests (between 0.1% and 15%) in these companies. These investments were irrevocably designated at fair value through OCI as the Group considers these investments to be strategic in nature.

5. Other disclosures

Global shipping activity is subject to various tax regimes, including tonnage tax which calculates corporate income tax based on the net tonnage of the fleet. These regimes apply to the vast majority of A.P. Moller - Maersk's (Maersk) activities and result in a stable annual tax liability.

Given that the liability to tonnage tax is not impacted by financial profits and is payable even in loss-making years, the effective tax rate can fluctuate significantly.

Further, disclosures are given on other statutory information not directly related to the operating activities of the Group.

5.1 Tax and deferred tax
174
5.2 Share-based payments
176
5.3 Commitments
178
5.4 Contingent liabilities
179
5.5 Cash flow specifications
179
5.6 Related parties
180

173

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Note 5.1 Tax and deferred tax

OTHER DISCLOSURES

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Tax recognised in the income statement
Current tax on profits for the year 500 595
Adjustment for current tax of prior periods -9 -65
Utilisation of previously unrecognised deferred tax assets -90 -169
Total current tax 401 361
Origination and reversal of temporary differences 85 -43
Adjustment for deferred tax of prior periods -70 -38
Recognition of previously unrecognised deferred tax assets 22 22
Reassessment of recoverability of deferred tax assets, net 12 17
Total deferred tax 49 -42
Total income tax 450 319
Tonnage and freight tax 134 135
Total tax expense 584 454
Tax reconciliation
Profit/loss before tax 6,816 4,362
Profit/loss subject to Danish and foreign tonnage taxation, etc. -5,283 -2,526
Share of profit/loss in joint ventures -151 -148
Share of profit/loss in associated companies -218 -287
Profit/loss before tax, adjusted 1,164 1,401
Tax using the Danish corporation tax rate (22%) 257 309
Tax rate deviations in foreign jurisdictions 103 66
Pillar Two tax expenses 18 -
Non-taxable income -39 -23
Non-deductible expenses 55 65
Adjustment to previous years' taxes -79 -103
Change in recoverability of prior years' deferred tax assets -56 -130
New deferred tax asset not recognised 34 19
Withholding taxes 156 107
Other differences, net 1 9
Total income tax 450 319
Effective tax rate 8.6% 10.4%
Tax recognised in other comprehensive income and equity -25 3
Of which:
Current tax -24 7
Deferred tax -1 -4
Recognised deferred tax assets and liabilities are attributable to the following:
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- --

2024 2023

Assets Liabilities Net liabilities
2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023
Intangible assets 41 40 552 561 511 521
Property, plant and
equipment
42 40 304 278 262 238
Right-of-use assets 111 106 - - -111 -106
Provisions, etc. 270 255 90 48 -180 -207
Tax loss carry-forwards 103 75 - - -103 -75
Other 53 44 143 96 90 52
Total 620 560 1,089 983 469 423
Offsets -255 -217 -255 -217 - -
Total 365 343 834 766 469 423
Change in deferred tax, net, during the year 2024 2023
1
January
423 484
Intangible assets -2 -11
Property, plant and equipment 26 -10
Right-of-use assets -8 -26
Provisions, etc. 13 21
Tax loss carry-forwards -29 -5
Other 49 -11
Recognised in the income statement 49 -42
Transfer to held for sale - 25
Other including business combinations -3 -44
31 December 469 423
Unrecognised deferred tax assets 2024 2023
Deductible temporary differences 103 103
Tax loss carry-forwards 599 780

The unrecognised deferred tax assets have no significant time limitations. There are no substantial unrecognised tax liabilities on investments in subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures.

Unused tax credits 9 12 Total 711 895

Note 5.1 Tax and deferred tax – continued

Taxation of activities

As a global integrator of container logistics, Maersk generates profits from ocean, air and land-based activities.

The land-based activities, which are subject to normal corporate income tax, include terminals, logistics, services and shipping agencies through which the Group operate one of the world's most comprehensive port and integrated logistics service networks. The logistics products include transportation, warehousing and distribution including cold storage, customs services and supply chain management services. This expanding land-based activity has prompted the establishment and acquisition of entities in numerous countries.

On the ocean, Maersk moves millions of TEUs every year and operates hundreds of vessels delivering cargo to every corner of the globe, including dry cargo commodities, refrigerated cargo and dangerous cargo. This ocean activity, which represents the vast majority of the Group's current revenues, may be subject to special shipping tax rules, including tonnage and freight taxes.

Global Minimum Taxation (OECD Pillar Two)

In an effort to end tax avoidance and to address concerns about the erosion of the global corporate tax base, a global framework for corporate taxation has been formed by the OECD/G20 Inclusive Framework. One of the key elements is to introduce a global minimum tax rate of 15%, based on group accounting income per jurisdiction.

The minimum tax rules are designed as a hierarchy of the right to claim income tax. If the income is not subject to a minimum effective tax rate of 15% in the country where it is earned, then the remaining tax payment (top-up tax) can be picked up by another jurisdiction where the Group is active. For the Group, Denmark will add top-up tax if not applied locally as the ultimate parent entity of the Group, A.P. Møller Holding A/S, is located in Denmark.

The Danish implementation of Council Directive (EU) 2022/2523 of 14 December 2022 is effective from 1 January 2024. This means that Maersk's income is subject to the minimum tax rules for all jurisdictions via Danish implementation for the financial year 2024 and onwards.

Because the Danish implementation covers the Group's global activities, it is not expected that other national implementations will have a significant additional impact on the global tax payments of the Group. It may, however, have an impact on the location where potential top-up taxes will be paid.

Three elements are key to understanding how the rules will impact the Group. First, the Group does not set up artificial structures in low-tax jurisdictions for tax purposes or earn significant profits in such jurisdictions, which means that the Group's business structure itself is not impacted significantly by the rules, but some additional tax may become payable where services are provided in low-tax jurisdictions. Second, tax incentives given to capital projects, such as critical infrastructure, will be considered less effective going forward as it will impact the effective tax rate and thereby the basis for potential top-up tax. Third, although the rules exclude 'international shipping income', the definition is more restrictive than the global definitions usually applied under a tax treaty following the OECD Model Tax Convention or under Danish tonnage tax.

Also, inland transportation is not a part of the international shipping income under the global minimum tax rules. This is relevant for the part of the Group's land transport linked directly to ocean transportation which is recognised as shipping income for tax treatment in the OECD Model Tax Convention. The Group awaits further guidance on the application of the shipping income provision from the OECD Secretariat. Contrary to the purpose of the rules, top-up tax could be triggered by the shipping classification in years where shipping net income is negative. Due to the design of tonnage taxation, the Group's effective tax rate fluctuates significantly depending on the yearly results. In accordance with the Global Minimum Taxation rules, the effective tax rate is calculated on a consolidated basis also including non-shipping activities in the individual countries.

For 2024, the Group top-up tax expense globally amounted to USD 18m, which is in line with the expectations shared last year, and is included in total current tax.

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

Deferred tax assets

Judgement has been applied with respect to Maersk's ability to utilise deferred tax assets. Management considers the likelihood of utilisation based on the latest business plans and the recent financial performances of the individual entities. Net deferred tax assets recognised in entities having recognised an accounting loss in either the current or preceding period amount to USD 181m (USD 156m). These assets mainly relate to unused tax losses or deductible temporary differences generated during the construction of terminals, where taxable profits have been generated either in the current period or are expected to be generated within the foreseeable future.

Uncertain tax positions

Maersk is engaged in a number of disputes with tax authorities of varying scope. Appropriate provisions and recognition of uncertain tax positions have been made where the probability of the tax position being upheld in individual cases is considered less than 50%. Claims for which the probability of Maersk's tax position being upheld is assessed by Management to be at least 50%, are not provided for. Such risks are instead evaluated on a portfolio basis by geographical area and country risk. Provisions and uncertain tax liabilities are recognised when the aggregated probability of the tax position being upheld is considered less than 50%.

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Tax comprises an estimate of current and deferred income tax as well as adjustments to previous years taxes. Income tax is tax on taxable profits, and consists of corporation tax, withholding tax of dividends, etc. Tax is recognised in the income statement to the extent that it arises from items recognised in the income statement, including tax on gains on intra-group transactions that have been eliminated in the consolidation.

Deferred tax is calculated on temporary differences between the carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities. Deferred tax is not recognised for differences on the initial recognition of assets or liabilities, where at the time of the transaction neither accounting nor taxable profit/loss is affected, unless the differences arise in a business combination. In addition, no deferred tax is recognised for undistributed earnings in subsidiaries, when Maersk controls the timing of dividends. No taxable dividends are currently expected. A deferred tax asset is recognised to the extent that it is probable that it can be utilised within a foreseeable future.

Maersk applies the IAS 12 exception to recognising and disclosing information about deferred tax assets and liabilities related to Pillar Two income taxes.

The integrator

Financials

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Note 5.2 Share-based payments

Members of
the Executive
Board1
Employees Total Total fair
value
1,2
Outstanding performance shares No. No. No. USD million
1
January 2024
2,028 4,040 6,068
Granted 2,799 4,951 7,750 10
Granted in connection with the Svitzer demerger 221 414 635 1
Outstanding 31 December 2024 5,048 9,405 14,453
1
January 2023
- - -
Granted 2,028 4,040 6,068 9
Outstanding 31 December 2023 2,028 4,040 6,068

1 The fair value per performance share is equal to the volume-weighted average share price on the date of grant, i.e. 1 April 2024, adjusted for expected dividends during the vesting period. The fair value per performance share is DKK 9,045 (10,299) for members of the Executive Board and employees.

2 Total fair value is at the time of grant.

Performance shares plan

From 2023, performance shares are granted to members of the Executive Board and certain key employees. Each performance share granted is a right to potentially receive an existing B share of nominal DKK 1,000 in A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S.

Transfer of B shares is contingent upon the fulfilment of certain performance criteria being met, which may include, but are not limited to return on invested capital, relative share performance, revenue growth and ESG elements. Vesting is also contingent upon the employee still being employed and not under notice of termination when three years have passed from the date of grant.

Employees are not entitled to any dividends during the vesting period. Special conditions apply regarding illness, death and resignation as well as changes in the company's capital structure, etc. A part of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' treasury B shares will be used to meet the company's obligations in connection with the performance shares plan.

The recognised remuneration expense related to the performance shares plan is USD 6m (USD 2m). The average remaining contractual life of the performance shares as per 31 December 2024 is 1.8 years (2.3 years).

Members of
the Executive
Board
Employees Total Total fair
value
1,2
Outstanding restricted shares No. No. No. USD million
1
January 2024
5,616 24,512 30,128
Granted - 14,468 14,468 17
Granted in connection with the Svitzer demerger 208 926 1,134 2
Exercised and vested3 926 5,437 6,363
Forfeited - 1,410 1,410
Cancelled - 35 35
Outstanding 31 December 2024 4,898 33,024 37,922
1
January 2023
6,557 17,253 23,810
Granted - 14,600 14,600 23
Exercised and vested3 941 6,146 7,087
Forfeited - 1,183 1,183
Cancelled - 12 12
Outstanding 31 December 2023 5,616 24,512 30,128

1 The fair value per restricted share unit is equal to the volume-weighted average share price on the date of grant, i.e. 1 April 2024 (1 April 2023), adjusted for expected dividends during the vesting period. The fair value per restricted share unit is DKK 8,255 (DKK 10,299) for employees. No restricted share units were granted to members of the Executive Board in 2024 or 2023.

2 Total fair value is at the time of grant.

3 The weighted average share price at the settlement date was DKK 9,045 (DKK 12,732).

Restricted shares plan

Restricted share units are granted to members of the Executive Board and certain key employees. Each restricted share unit granted is a right to receive an existing B share of nominal DKK 1,000 in A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S.

Transfer of B shares is contingent upon the employee still being employed and not under notice of termination and takes place when three years have passed from the date of grant. For members of the Executive Board the vesting period is five years.

Employees are not entitled to any dividends during the vesting period. Special conditions apply regarding illness, death and resignation as well as changes in the company's capital structure, etc. A part of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' treasury B shares will be used to meet the company's obligations in connection with the restricted shares plan.

The recognised remuneration expense related to the restricted shares plan is USD 18m (USD 16m).

The average remaining contractual life of the restricted shares as per 31 December 2024 is 1.5 years (1.6 years).

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 5.2 Share-based payments – continued

Members of
the Executive
Board
Employees Total Average
exercise
price2
Total fair
value
Outstanding share options No. No. No. DKK USD million
1
January 2024
15,161 78,626 93,787 14,318
Granted - 22,630 22,630 9,566 8
Granted in connection with
the Svitzer demerger 650 4,422 5,072 13,003 2
Exercised1 1,739 5,216 6,955 8,380
Forfeited - 3,686 3,686 14,150
Lapsed - 655 655 11,292
Outstanding 31 December 2024 14,072 96,121 110,193 13,148
Exercisable 31 December 2024 10,374 37,486 47,860 10,989
1
January 2023
19,600 73,436 93,036 13,452
Granted - 23,323 23,323 13,257 10
Exercised1 4,439 14,697 19,136 8,633
Forfeited - 3,436 3,436 15,327
Outstanding 31 December 2023 15,161 78,626 93,787 14,318
Exercisable 31 December 2023 4,302 22,882 27,184 8,309

1 The weighted average share price at the dates of exercise of share options exercised was DKK 12,606 (DKK 12,674).

2 The weighted average exercise prices for the 2024 stock option movements reflect the exercise prices after the Svitzer modification. The opening balance 1 January 2024 and the 2023 comparative disclosures have not been restated and are based on exercise prices before the Svitzer modification.

Share options plan

Maersk also has a share option plan granted to members of the Executive Board and other key employees. Each share option granted is a call option to buy an existing B share of nominal DKK 1,000 in A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S.

The share options are granted at an exercise price corresponding to 110% of the average of the market price on the first five trading days following the release of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' most recent Annual Report. Exercise of the share options is contingent upon the option holder still being employed at the time of vesting, which takes place when three years have passed from the date of grant. The share options can then be exercised when at least three years and no more than six years (seven years for share options granted to employees not members of the Executive Board) have passed from the date of grant. Special conditions apply regarding illness, death and resignation as well as changes in the company's capital structure etc.

The share options can only be settled in shares. A part of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' holding of treasury B shares will be used to meet the company's obligations in respect of the share option plan.

The recognised remuneration expense related to the share option plan is USD 12m (USD 10m).

The average remaining contractual life of the outstanding share options as per 31 December 2024 is 4.1 years (4.4 years), and the range of exercise prices for the outstanding share options as per 31 December 2024 is DKK 7,271 to DKK 23,994 (DKK 7,605 to DKK 25,096).

Amounts in USD million

The following principal assumptions are used in the 2024 granted share options valuation:

Share options granted to
employees2
2024 2023
Share price, volume-weighted average at the date of grant, 1 April, DKK 9,022 12,732
Share price, five days volume-weighted average after publication of Annual Report, DKK1 9,026 11,992
Exercise price, DKK 9,929 13,191
Expected volatility (based on historic volatility) 37% 35%
Expected term (years) 5.75 5.75
Expected dividend per share, DKK 2.6% 5.0%
Risk-free interest rate 2.41% 2.65%
Fair value per option at grant date, DKK 2,540 3,067

1 The exercise price was determined based on the five-day volume-weighted average share price after the Annual General Meetings in 2024 and 2023.

2 No share options were granted to members of the Executive Board in 2024 and 2023.

The fair value of the options granted is based on the Black-Scholes option pricing model using the assumptions in the table above.

Modification in 2024

In May 2024, as a result of the demerger of Svitzer in April 2024, Maersk reduced the exercise price of the outstanding stock options and increased the number of stock options, restricted share units and performance shares outstanding in order to preserve the value of the outstanding awards. The total incremental fair value of the options, restricted share units and performance shares as a result of the modification is USD 7.5m. For awards that are fully vested, the incremental fair value was recognised immediately and for awards not yet vested, the incremental fair value is recognised over the period from the modification date to the vesting date. The expense for the original awards will continue to be recognised as if the terms had not been modified.

The fair value of the modified awards was determined using the same models and principles as described above, with the following differences in inputs for stock options:

Share price, volume-weighted average at the date of modification, 15 May 2024, DKK 11,335
Exercise price, DKK Original exercise price x adjustment factor
Expected volatility (based on historic volatility) 37%
Expected term (years) 80% of time remaining until option vesting
Expected dividend per share, DKK 2.1%
Risk free interest rate Based on time remaining until expiry

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 5.2 Share-based payments – continued

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Equity-settled performance shares, restricted shares and share options granted to members of the Executive Board and to employees of Maersk as part of Maersk's long-term incentive programme are recognised as remuneration expenses over the vesting period as per the estimated fair value at the grant date and result in a corresponding adjustment to equity.

At the end of each reporting period, Maersk revises its estimated number of awards that are expected to vest based on the non-market vesting conditions and service conditions. Any impact of the revision is recognised in the income statement with a corresponding adjustment to equity.

Short-term and low-value leases

As part of the Group's activities, customary agreements are entered into regarding charter and operating leases of vessels, containers, port facilities etc.

Capital commitments of USD 8.6bn (USD 4.9bn) relate to investments, mainly within Ocean and Terminals. It includes USD 80m in respect of EUA futures contracts deliverable in 2025.

Commitments related to the newbuilding programme are USD 6.1bn (USD 2.8bn) for container vessels.

Newbuilding programme at 31
December 2024,
number of assets
2025 2026 2027 2028 and
beyond
Total
Container vessels 11 5 1 20 37
Total 11 5 1 20 37

Note 5.3 Commitments

The future charter and operating lease payments are:

Lease commitments Ocean Logistics
& Services
Terminals Unallocated
items
Total
2024
Within one year 317 32 9 - 358
Total 317 32 9 - 358
2023
Within one year 129 25 10 - 164
Total 129 25 10 - 164
Capital commitments Ocean Logistics
& Services
Terminals Unallocated
items
Total
2024
Capital commitments relating to
acquisition of non-current assets
7,024 - 524 3 7,511
Commitments towards concession
grantors
- - 864 - 864
Total capital commitments 7,024 - 1,388 3 8,415
2023
Capital commitments relating to
acquisition of non-current assets
3,302 98 363 50 3,813
Commitments towards concession
grantors
- - 1,053 - 1,053
Total capital commitments 3,302 98 1,416 50 4,866
Capital commitments relating to the newbuilding
programme at 31
December 2024
2025 2026 2027 2028 and
beyond
Total
Container vessels 1,742 479 303 3,435 5,959
Total 1,742 479 303 3,435 5,959

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Note 5.4 Contingent liabilities

Contingent liabilities consist of legal cases, tax issues, custom bonds, volume commitments and other disputes.

Legal

OTHER DISCLOSURES

The Group is involved in several legal cases and other disputes. Some of these involve significant amounts and are subject to considerable uncertainty. Management continuously assesses the risks associated with the cases and disputes, and their likely outcome. It is the opinion of Management that, apart from items recognised in the financial statements, the outcome of these cases and disputes are not probable or cannot be reliably estimated in terms of amount or timing. The Group does not expect these to have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

Tax

The Group is subject to a tax audit in Germany concerning allocation of taxation rights to shipping income between Denmark and Germany as well as to a tax investigation in India concerning a deemed supply of services between Indian GST registrations of Maersk in India. The Group is also involved in various other tax disputes including indirect tax disputes, some of which involve significant amounts. Management continuously assesses the risks associated with tax disputes and their likely outcome and considers the risk related to these disputes remote and therefore does not expect these to have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.

Through participation in a joint taxation scheme with A.P. Møller Holding A/S, the Danish companies are jointly and severally liable for taxes payable, etc., in Denmark.

Other

Custom bonds of USD 857m (USD 830m) have been provided to various port authorities in India. Maersk Line and APM Terminals have entered into a number of agreements with terminals and port authorities, etc.

comprising volume commitments, including an extra payment in case minimum volumes are not met.

Except for customary agreements within the Group's activities, no material agreements have been entered into that will take effect, change, or expire upon changes of the control over the company.

Note 5.5 Cash flow specifications

2024 2023
Change in working capital
Trade receivables -754 1,392
Other working capital movements 322 -963
Exchange rate adjustment of working capital 121 -12
Total -311 417
Purchase of intangible assets and property, plant and equipment
Additions1 -9,356 -6,024
Of which is right-of-use assets, etc. 4,601 2,164
Of which is borrowing costs capitalised on assets 105 133
Adjustments of additions for cash flow presentation 122 63
Change in payables to suppliers regarding purchase of assets, etc. 327 18
Total -4,201 -3,646

1 Additions to intangible assets of USD 260m (USD 204m), property, plant and equipment of USD 4.4bn (USD 3.7bn), right-of-use assets of USD 4.6bn (USD 2.2bn) and assets held for sale of USD 44m (USD 0m).

SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING JUDGEMENTS

Operations in countries with limited access to repatriating surplus cash Maersk operates worldwide and, in this respect, has operations in countries where the ability to repatriate surplus cash is complicated and time consuming. In these countries, Management makes judgements as to whether these cash positions can be recognised as cash and cash equivalents.

Amounts in USD million

ACCOUNTING POLICY

Cash flow from operating activities includes all cash transactions other than cash flows arising from investing and financing activities such as investments and divestments, received dividends, principal payments of loans, instalments on lease liabilities, paid and received financial items and equity transactions. Capitalisation of borrowing costs is considered as a non-cash item, and the actual payments of these borrowing costs are included in cash flow from financing. Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash and bank balances net of bank overdrafts where overdraft facilities form an integral part of Maersk's cash management.

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

OTHER DISCLOSURES

Note 5.6 Related parties

Controlling
parties
Associated
companies
Joint ventures Management1
2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023
Income statement
Revenue 16 3 8 65 122 69 - -
Operating costs 103 47 697 570 615 566 - 132
Remuneration to Management - - - - - - 12 10
Financial income 7 95 - - - - - -
Other - 153 - - - 2 - -
Assets
Other receivables, non-current - 6 - - 37 30 - -
Trade receivables 3 3 12 6 10 10 - -
Other receivables, current 627 681 9 8 7 9 - -
Cash and bank balances 271 277 - - - - - -
Liabilities
Bank and other credit institutions,
etc., current 19 - - - 27 67 - -
Trade payables 4 - 102 79 76 89 - 1
Other - - - 1 7 - - -
Shares bought back 2134 1,5694 - - - - - -
Capital increase - - 20 - 1 17 - -
Dividends earned - - 199 219 151 95 - -
Dividends distributed 6555 5,9745 - - - - - -

1 The Board of Directors and the Executive Board of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S, A.P. Møller Holding A/S, A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal and their close relatives (including undertakings under their control). Trade receivables and payables include customary business-related accounts regarding shipping activities.

2 Includes commission and commercial receivables to Maersk Broker K/S from chartering as well as the purchase and sale of vessels.

3 Includes the gain on sale of Maersk Supply Service to A.P. Møller Holding A/S.

4 Includes shares bought back from A.P. Møller Holding A/S and A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond (the Foundation).

5 Includes dividends paid to A.P. Møller Holding A/S, A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond (the Foundation) and Den A.P. Møllerske Støttefond.

Joint usage agreement with A.P. Møller Holding A/S

With the objective of further strengthening the value of the brands, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S in 2018 entered into a joint usage agreement with A.P. Møller Holding A/S regarding the use of commonly used trademarks which historically have benefited both A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S and A.P. Møller Holding A/S. A.P. Møller Holding A/S is the controlling shareholder of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S and is wholly owned by A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal. The joint usage agreement establishes a framework and a branding strategy for the commonly used trademarks and a joint brand board, where the parties can cooperate regarding the use of these trademarks.

A.P. Møller Holding A/S, Copenhagen, Denmark has control over the company and prepares consolidated financial statements. A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal is the ultimate owner.

Share buy-back programme

According to a separate agreement, A.P. Møller Holding A/S and A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond (the Foundation) participated on a pro rata basis to the shares purchased in the company's share buy-back programme. A.P. Møller Holding A/S participated in selling A and B shares and A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond (the Foundation) participated in selling B shares.

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Company overview

Subsidiaries

Company Country of incorporation Owned share
A.P. Moller Singapore Pte. Ltd. Singapore 100%
Aliança Navegação e Logística Ltda. Brazil 100%
APM Terminals - Aarhus A/S Denmark 100%
APM Terminals Algeciras S.A. Spain 100%
APM Terminals Apapa Ltd. Nigeria 94%
APM Terminals B.V. Netherlands 100%
APM Terminals Bahrain B.S.C. Bahrain 64%
APM Terminals Barcelona S.L.U. Spain 100%
APM Terminals Callao S.A. Peru 64%
APM Terminals China Co. Ltd. Hong Kong 100%
APM Terminals Elizabeth, LLC United States 100%
APM Terminals Espagna Holding SL Spain 100%
APM Terminals Gothenburg AB Sweden 100%
APM Terminals India Pvt. Ltd. India 100%
APM Terminals Lazaro Cardenas S.A. de C.V. Mexico 100%
APM Terminals Maasvlakte II B.V. Netherlands 100%
APM Terminals Management (Barcelona) S.L. Spain 100%
APM Terminals Management B.V. Netherlands 100%

Subsidiaries

Company Country of incorporation Owned share
APM Terminals MedPort Tangier S.A. Morocco 80%
APM Terminals Mobile, LLC United States 100%
A.P. Moller - Maersk comprises more than 630 companies, of which the largest APM Terminals Moin S.A. Costa Rica 100%
are listed below. The Danish Financial Statements Act section 97a, par. 4 has APM Terminals North America Inc. United States 100%
been applied in the company overview. A more comprehensive list of companies APM Terminals Pacific LLC United States 90%
is available at: investor.maersk.com/financial-reports APM Terminals Quetzal S.A. Guatemala 85%
APM Terminals Valencia S.A. Spain 75%
Aqaba Container Terminal Company Ltd Jordan 50%
Damco Germany GmbH Germany 100%
Damco Logistics Mexico S.A. de C.V. Mexico 100%
Subsidiaries Damco Poland Sp. z o.o. Poland 100%
Damco Spain S.L. Spain 100%
Company Country of incorporation Owned share Frey A/S Denmark 100%
A.P. Moller Singapore Pte. Ltd. Singapore 100% Gateway Terminals India Pvt. Ltd. India 74%
Aliança Navegação e Logística Ltda. Brazil 100% Grindrod Logistics (PTY) LTD. South Africa 51%
APM Terminals - Aarhus A/S Denmark 100% Gujarat Pipavav Port Ltd. India 44%
APM Terminals Algeciras S.A. Spain 100% Hamburg Süd A/S & Co KG1 Germany 100%
APM Terminals Apapa Ltd. Nigeria 94% Hamburg Südamerikanische Dampfschifffahrts-Gesellschaft A/S & Co KG2 Germany 100%
APM Terminals B.V. Netherlands 100% LF (Philippines), Inc. Philippines 100%
APM Terminals Bahrain B.S.C. Bahrain 64% Maersk A/S Denmark 100%
APM Terminals Barcelona S.L.U. Spain 100% Maersk Agency U.S.A. Inc. United States 100%
APM Terminals Callao S.A. Peru 64% Maersk Air Cargo A/S Denmark 100%
APM Terminals China Co. Ltd. Hong Kong 100% Maersk Aviation Holding A/S Denmark 100%
APM Terminals Elizabeth, LLC United States 100% Maersk Container Industry A/S Denmark 100%
APM Terminals Espagna Holding SL Spain 100% Maersk Container Industry Qingdao Ltd. China 100%
APM Terminals Gothenburg AB Sweden 100% Maersk Contract Logistics (China) Co., Ltd. China 100%
APM Terminals India Pvt. Ltd. India 100% Maersk Contract Logistics (Hong Kong) Limited Hong Kong 100%
APM Terminals Lazaro Cardenas S.A. de C.V. Mexico 100% Maersk Contract Logistics (Jiangsu) Co., Ltd. China 100%
APM Terminals Maasvlakte II B.V. Netherlands 100% Maersk Contract Logistics Holdings (Bermuda) Limited Bermuda 100%
APM Terminals Management (Barcelona) S.L. Spain 100% Maersk Contract Logistics Management (Asia) Limited Hong Kong 100%
APM Terminals Management B.V. Netherlands 100% Maersk Denizcilik A.S. Turkey 100%
Maersk Deutschland A/S & Co. KG3 Germany 100%
1 In accordance with section 264b HGB (German commercial code), HamburgSüd A/S & Co KG, Hamburg is exempt from preparing, auditing and Maersk Eastern Europe ApS Denmark 100%
disclosing statutory financial statements and a management report in accordance with the German commercial law. Maersk Global Service Centres (India) Pvt. Ltd. India 100%
2 In accordance with section 264b HGB (German commercial code), Hambürg Sudamerikanische Dampfschifffahrts-Gesellschaft A/S and Co KG.
KG, Hamburg is exempt from preparing, auditing and disclosing statutory financial statements and a management report in accordance with
Maersk Holding B.V. Netherlands 100%
the German commercial law. Maersk Insurance A/S Denmark 100%
3 In accordance with section 264b HGB (German commercial code), Maersk Deutschland A/S & Co. KG, Hamburg is exempt from preparing,
auditing and disclosing statutory financial statements and a management report in accordance with the German commercial law.
Maersk Line Agency Holding A/S Denmark 100%
COMPANY OVERVIEW
Subsidiaries
Company Country of incorporation Owned share
Maersk Line Crewing Hamburg ApS & Co KG4 Germany 100%
Maersk Line, Limited United States 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services (Hong Kong) Limited Hong Kong 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Australia Pty Ltd Australia 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Brasil Ltda. Brazil 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Canada Inc. Canada 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Chile S.p.A Chile 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services China Limited China 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Denmark A/S Denmark 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services International A/S Denmark 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Japan K.K. Japan 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Netherlands B.V. Netherlands 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Peru S.A. Peru 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services USA Inc United States 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services Vietnam Company Limited Vietnam 100%
Maersk Logistics & Services UK Ltd. United Kingdom 100%
Maersk Oil Trading and Investments A/S Denmark 100%
Maersk Oil Trading Inc. United States 100%
Maersk Oil Trading Panama S.A. Panama 100%
Maersk Oil Trading Singapore Pte. Ltd. Singapore 100%
Maersk Oil Trading Spain, S.L Spain 100%
Maersk Shipping Hong Kong Ltd. Hong Kong 100%
Maersk Warehousing & Distribution Services USA LLC United States 100%
New Times International Transport Service Co. Ltd. China 100%
Pilot Air Freight, LLC United States 100%
Sealand Maersk Asia Pte. Ltd. Singapore 100%
Senator International Freight Forwarding LLC Florida United States 100%
Senator International Spedition GmbH5 Germany 100%
St. Petri Shipping ApS & Co KG6 Germany 100%
Suez Canal Container Terminal SAE Egypt 55%
Terminal 4 S.A. Argentina 100%
Visible Supply Chain Management LLC United States 100%

Associated companies

Company Country of incorporation Owned share
Abidjan Terminal SA Côte d'Ivoire 49%
Brigantine Services Ltd. Hong Kong 30%
Congo Terminal SA Congo 15%
Guangzhou South China Oceangate Container Terminal Co. Ltd. China 20%
Itapoa Terminais Portuarios S.A. Brazil 30%
Kanoo Terminal Services Ltd. Saudi Arabia 50%
Meridian Port Services Ltd Ghana 35%
Pelabuhan Tanjung Pelepas Sdn. Bhd. Malaysia 30%
Qingdao Qianwan United Container Terminal Co. Ltd. China 10%
Salalah Port Services Company SAOG Oman 30%
South Asia Gateway Terminals Pvt Ltd Sri Lanka 33%
Tianjin Port Alliance International Container Terminal Co. Ltd. China 20%

Joint ventures

Company Country of incorporation Owned share
Blue Dragon Logistics Co. Ltd. China 50%
Brasil Terminal Portuario S.A. Brazil 50%
Cai Mep International Terminal Co. Ltd. Vietnam 49%
Cote D'Ivoire Terminal SA Côte d'Ivoire 49%
LCB Container Terminal 1 Ltd. Thailand 35%
LCMT Company Ltd. Thailand 32%
North Sea Terminal Bremerhaven Gmbh and Co KG Germany 50%
Qingdao New Qianwan Container Terminal Co. Ltd. China 19%
Qingdao Qianwan Container Terminal Co. Ltd. China 20%
Shanghai East Container Terminal Co. Ltd. China 49%
Smart International Logistics Company Ltd. China 49%
South Florida Container Terminal LLC United States 49%
Xiamen Songyu Container Terminal Co. Ltd. China 25%

4 In accordance with section 264b HGB (German commercial code), Maersk Line Crewing Hamburg ApS & Co. KG, Hamburg is exempt from preparing, auditing and disclosing statutory financial statements and a management report in accordance with the German commercial law.

5 In accordance with section 264 Abs.3 HGB (German commercial code), Senator International Spedition GmbH, Hamburg is exempt from preparing notes to financial statements and a management report in accordance with the German commercial law.

6 In accordance with section 264b HGB (German commercial code), St. Petri Shipping ApS & Co KG, Hamburg, is exempt from preparing, auditing and disclosing statutory financial statements and a management report in accordance with the German commercial law.

Annual Report 2024

integrator

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Income statement

Income statement

Note 2024 2023
Revenue 1 43
2.1
Operating costs
264 307
Profit/loss before depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, etc. -263 -264
Depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, net 1 1
Gain/loss on sale of companies, non-current assets and liquidation, etc., net 9 54
Profit before financial items -255 -211
4.3
Dividends
75 44,029
4.3
Financial income
2,210 1,787
4.3
Financial expenses
1,171 1,561
Profit/loss before tax 859 44,044
5.1
Tax
232 17
Profit/loss for the year 627 44,027

Statement of comprehensive income

Note 2024 2023
Profit for the year 627 44,027
4.4
Cash flow hedges:
Value adjustment of hedges for the year 11 2
Reclassified to income statement 34 26
5.1
Tax on other comprehensive income
23 -6
Total items that have been or may be reclassified subsequently
to the income statement
68 22
4.5
Other equity investments (FVOCI), fair value adjustments for the year
-2 -1
Total items that will not be reclassified to the income statement -2 -1
Other comprehensive income/loss, net of tax 66 21
Total comprehensive income/loss for the year 693 44,048

Executive

summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

184

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S Annual Report 2024

Balance sheet at 31 December

Note Assets
2024 2023
Intangible assets 3 3
Tangible assets - 24
3.1
Investments in subsidiaries
25,600 24,121
3.1
Investments in associated companies
11 11
Other equity investments 2 4
4.5
Interest-bearing receivables from subsidiaries, etc.
1,677 1,338
4.4
Derivatives
- 10
Financial non-current assets, etc. 27,290 25,484
5.2
Deferred tax
- 8
Total non-current assets 27,293 25,519
Trade receivables 77 4
4.5
Interest-bearing receivables from subsidiaries, etc.
3,888 7,471
4.4
Derivatives
151 131
3.2
Loan receivables
15,732 12,693
Current tax receivables 194 36
Other receivables 387 360
Other receivables from subsidiaries, etc. 49 156
Prepayments 12 45
Receivables, etc. 20,490 20,896
4.5
Securities
1,580 -
Cash and bank balances 5,172 5,123
3.3
Assets held for sale
- 1,376
Total current assets 27,242 27,395
Total assets 54,535 52,914
Note
Equity and liabilities
2024
4.1
Share capital
2,870
Reserves
37,859
Total equity
40,729
4.2
Borrowings, non-current
4,352
4.2
Interest-bearing debt to subsidiaries, etc.
43
Provisions
74
4.4
Derivatives
333
5.2
Deferred tax
6
Other non-current liabilities
413
Total non-current liabilities
4,808
4.2
Borrowings, current
379
37
4.2
Interest-bearing debt to subsidiaries, etc.
7,558
4,938
Trade payables
23
Tax payables
258
4.4
Derivatives
251
Provisions
24
Other payables
486
Other payables to subsidiaries, etc.
7
Deferred income
12
Other current liabilities
1,061
Total current liabilities
8,998
Total liabilities
13,806
Total equity and liabilities
54,535
2023
3,186
39,542
42,728
4,044
95
80
323
-
403
4,542
46
-
134
33
443
-
13
669
5,644
10,186
52,914

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

1991
16.00

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S Annual Report 2024

186

Note 2024 2023
Profit/loss before financial items -255 -211
Depreciation, amortisation and impairment losses, net 1 1
Gain/loss on sale of companies and non-current assets, etc., net -9 -52
5.5
Change in working capital
105 115
Change in provisions, etc. -14 27
Other non-cash items 13 34
Cash flow from operating activities before tax -159 -86
Taxes paid -35 -30
Cash flow from operating activities -194 -116
Purchase/sale of intangible assets and property, plant and equipment, internal - -24
Sale of property, plant and equipment 4 -
Capital increases in subsidiaries and activities -199 -
Sale of subsidiaries and associates 5 1,125
Dividends received 13 43
Other financial investments, paid -27,605 -21,822
Other financial investments, received 22,994 27,703
Movements in interest-bearing loans to/from subsidiaries, etc., net 4,918 3,513
Cash flow from investing activities 130 10,538
4.2
Repayment of borrowings
-584 -559
4.2
Proceeds from borrowings
1,364 742
Purchase of treasury shares -556 -3,120
Financial income received 1,690 1,488
Financial expenses paid -619 -1,028
Sale of treasury shares 9 24
Dividends distributed -1,180 -10,876
Cash flow from financing activities 124 -13,329
Net cash flow for the year 60 -2,907
Cash and cash equivalents 1
January
5,120 8,082
Currency translation effect on cash and cash equivalents -10 -55
Cash and cash equivalents 31 December 5,170 5,120
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and bank balances 5,172 5,123
Overdrafts 2 3
Cash and cash equivalents 31 December 5,170 5,120

Amounts in USD million

Statement of changes in equity

Note Share
capital
Reserve for
other equity
investments
Reserve for
hedges
Retained
earnings
Total
equity
Equity 1
January 2023
3,392 2 -72 9,220 12,542
Other comprehensive income, net of tax - -1 22 - 21
Profit for the year - - - 44,027 44,027
Total comprehensive income for the year - -1 22 44,027 44,048
Dividends to shareholders - - - -10,822 -10,822
5.3
Value of share-based payments
- - - 8 8
4.1
Purchase of treasury shares
- - - -3,072 -3,072
4.1
Sale of treasury shares
- - - 24 24
4.1
Capital increases and decreases
-206 - - 206 -
Total transactions with shareholders -206 - - -13,656 -13,862
Equity 31 December 2023 3,186 1 -50 39,591 42,728
2024
Other comprehensive income, net of tax - -2 68 - 66
Profit for the year - - - 627 627
Total comprehensive income for the year - -2 68 627 693
Dividends to shareholders - - - -1,191 -1,191
5.3
Value of share-based payments
- - - 12 12
4.1
Purchase of treasury shares
- - - -529 -529
4.1
Sale of own shares
- - - 9 9
4.1
Capital increases and decreases
-316 - - 316 -
Distribution of shares in Svitzer to
shareholders of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S
- - - -1,020 -1,020
Other Equity movements - - - 27 27
Total transactions with shareholders -316 - - -2,376 -2,692
Equity 31 December 2024 2,870 -1 18 37,842 40,729

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

Notes

  1. Basis of preparation

4. Capital and financing

1.1 General accounting policies ..... 187

1.2 Significant accounting estimates and judgements ........................... 187

3. Invested capital

3.1 Investments in subsidiaries and associated companies ......... 188 3.2 Term deposits ............................... 189 3.3 Assets held for sale ..................... 189

4.1 Share capital
189
4.2 Borrowings and net debt
reconciliation
190
4.3 Financial income and
expenses
190
4.4 Financial instruments
and risks
191
4.5 Financial instruments
by category
194

5. Other disclosures 5.1 Tax ................................................... 195 5.2 Deferred tax .................................. 195 5.3 Share-based payments ............... 195 5.4 Contingent liabilities .................... 195 5.5 Cash flow specifications ............. 195 5.6 Related parties ............................. 196 5.7 Pledges ........................................... 196

Note 1.1 General accounting policies

Basis of preparation

The financial statements of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S have been prepared on a going concern basis and in accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards as adopted by the EU and additional Danish disclosure requirements for listed companies.

The accounting policies are consistent with those applied in the consolidated financial statements for 2024, except for the changes to accounting standards that were effective from 1 January 2024 and were endorsed by the EU. These changes have not had a material impact on the financial statements.

The accounting policies are furthermore consistent with the accounting policies for the Group's financial statements with the following exceptions:

  • Shares in subsidiaries and associated companies are measured at cost or a lower recoverable amount
  • Dividends from subsidiaries and associated companies are recognised as income at the time of declaration unless considered a return of capital in subsidiary
  • No segment information is disclosed
  • Value of granted share options, restricted shares, and performance shares to employees in subsidiaries is expensed directly in the relevant subsidiary. At the time of the grant, the subsidiary settles the amount with A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S and the counter posting is made in equity. At the time of exercising, the proceeds are included in the company's equity.

New financial reporting requirements

For the new financial reporting requirements, refer to note 1.1 in the consolidated financial statements.

Note 1.2 Significant accounting estimates and judgements

The preparation of the parent company financial statements requires management to make estimates and judgements on an ongoing basis, and to form assumptions that affect the reported amounts. Management forms its estimates and judgements based on historical experience, independent advice, external data points, as well as on in-house specialists and on other factors believed to be reasonable under the circumstances.

Estimates that are material to the company's financial reporting are made on the determination of impairment of financial non-current assets, including subsidiaries and associated companies. Refer to notes 3.1 and 4.3. Management assesses impairment indicators for investments in subsidiaries and associated companies and in general determines the recoverable amounts consistent with the assumptions described in note 3.1 of the consolidated financial statements.

Note 2.1 Operating costs

2024 2023
Rent and lease costs 19 26
Staff costs reimbursed to Rederiet A.P. Møller A/S1 211 213
Other, including recharging of operating costs, net 34 68
Total operating costs 264 307
Average number of employees directly employed by the company 2 2

1 Wages and salaries USD 177m (USD 177m) and pension plan contributions USD 34m (USD 36m). For information about share-based payments, reference is made to note 5.3.

The company's share of fees and remuneration to the Executive Board 2024 2023
Fixed pay 3 3
Short-term cash incentive 4 2
Long-term share-based incentive plans 31 2
Remuneration in connection with redundancy, resignation and release from duty to work - -1
Total remuneration to the Executive Board 10 6

1 In 2024, following the demerger of Svitzer, the outstanding stock options, restricted share units and performance shares were modified, resulting in immediate recognition of a beneficial modification expense for the already vested grants in 2024. The beneficial modifications to unvested programmes will be recognised over the remaining vesting period.

Contract of employment for the Executive Board contains terms customary in Danish listed companies, including termination notice and non-competition clauses. In connection with a possible takeover offer, neither the Executive Board nor the Board of Directors will receive special remuneration. Fees and remuneration do not include pension. The Board of Directors has received fees of USD 2m (USD 2m).

Fees to the statutory auditors 2024 2023
Statutory audit 2 2
Other services 1 1
Total fees 3 3

Fees for other services other than statutory audit of the financial statements provided by PricewaterhouseCoopers Statsautoriseret Revisionspartnerselskab to Maersk mainly consist of transaction advice, accounting and tax-related services.

Note 3.1 Investments in subsidiaries and associated companies

Investments
in subsidiaries
Investments
in associated
companies
Cost
1
January 2024
26,058 11
Additions1 1,099 -
31 December 2024 27,157 11
Impairment losses
1 January 2024 1,937 -
Reversal of impairment losses4 380
31 December 2024 1,557 -
Carrying amount:
31 December 2024 25,600 11
Cost
1
January 2023
29,720 810
Additions2 646 11
Disposals 2,932 810
Transfer to assets held for sale5 1,376 -
31 December 2023 26,058 11
Impairment losses
1 January 2023 3,946 478
Impairment losses3 200 -
Disposal 2,209 478
31 December 2023 1,937 -
Carrying amount:
31 December 2023 24,121 11

1 Capital increases are mainly in Maersk Logistics & Services International A/S of USD 0.9bn and additions of Maersk Aviation Holding of USD 0.2bn.

2 Capital increases were mainly in Maersk Logistics & Services International A/S of USD 0.5bn and additions of Maersk GTD of USD 0.1bn.

3 Impairment losses are recognised when the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount as explained in notes 1.1, 1.2 and 4.3, mainly related to impairment of Maersk Container Industry A/S.

4 Reversal of impairment losses mainly relates to A.P. Moller Finance S.A., holding company of the Aqaba Container Terminal Company Ltd and Maersk Container Industry A/s. The reversals are included in financial income in the income statement.

5 Transfer to assets held for sale was related to Svitzer A/S, demerged in 2024.

Refer to pages 181-182 for a list of significant subsidiaries and associated companies.

Performance

The integrator

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S Annual Report 2024

Note 3.2 Term deposits

Note 3.3 Assets held for sale

instruments and risks.

accounts.

Loan receivables, current, amount to USD 15.7bn (USD 12.7bn) and consist primarily of term deposits with a maturity of more than three months. For details on the assessment of the loss allowance on term deposits, refer to note 4.4 financial

Assets held for sale of USD 1.4bn in 2023 was related to the entity's holding of shares in Svitzer A/S. An impairment of approx. USD 350m was recognised at the time of the listing of Svitzer in 2024 without any impact on the consolidated

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S Annual Report 2024

Note 4.1 Share capital

Shareholder disclosure subject to section 104 of the Danish Financial Statements Act:

Share capital Votes
A.P. Møller Holding A/S, Copenhagen, Denmark
A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond, Copenhagen, Denmark
41.5%
9.8%
51.5%
14.5%
Den A.P. Møllerske Støttefond, Copenhagen, Denmark 4.1% 6.6%

Note 4.1 in the consolidated financial statements includes all additional share capital disclosures including the development in the number of shares and in the holding of treasury shares.

Dividends

The dividend of DKK 515 per share of DKK 1,000 was paid on 19 March 2024 – a total of DKK 8.1bn equivalent to USD 1.2bn, excluding treasury shares (dividend of DKK 4,300 per share of DKK 1,000 paid – total of DKK 74.4bn, equivalent to USD 10.9bn).

The Board of Directors proposes a dividend to the shareholders of DKK 1,120 per share of DKK 1,000 – a total of DKK 17.6bn, equivalent to USD 2.4bn (DKK 515 per share of DKK 1,000 – a total of DKK 8.1bn equivalent to USD 1.2bn). Payment of dividends is expected to take place on 21 March 2025. Payment of dividends to shareholders does not trigger taxes to Maersk.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.2 Borrowings and net debt reconciliation

Net debt
31 December
Cash flows Other changes Net debt
31 December
2023 From
financing
activities
Other Foreign
exchange
move
ments
Other1 2024
Bank and other credit institutions 688 -96 -1 1 - 592
Issued bonds 3,393 876 - -154 24 4,139
Subsidiaries, etc., net -3,776 - 4,918 32 862 2,036
Total borrowings, net 305 7802 4,917 -121 886 6,767
Derivatives hedge of borrowings, net 353 -4 - 154 -67 436
Borrowings classification:
Classified as non-current 4,139 4,395
Classified as current 4,975 7,937

1 Non-cash dividends, capital increases, fair value adjustments, etc.

2 Cash flows from financing activities of USD 780m are made up of repayments of borrowings of negative USD 584m and proceeds from borrowings of USD 1.4bn.

Net debt
31 December
Cash flows Other changes Net debt
31 December
2022 From
financing
activities
Other Foreign
exchange
move
ments
Other1 2023
Bank and other credit institutions 775 -90 3 - - 688
Issued bonds 2,976 308 - 53 56 3,393
Subsidiaries, etc., net 36,060 - 3,513 -12 -43,337 -3,776
Total borrowings, net 39,811 2182 3,516 41 -43,281 305
Derivatives hedge of borrowings, net 532 -54 - -53 -72 353
Borrowings classification:
Classified as non-current 3,635 4,139
Classified as current 40,808 4,975

1 Non-cash dividends, capital increases, fair value adjustments, etc.

2 Cash flows from financing activities of USD 218m are made up of repayments of borrowings of negative USD 559m, adjusted for cash flow hedges of USD 35m, and proceeds from borrowings of USD 742m.

Note 4.3 Financial income and expenses

2024 2023
Interest expenses on liabilities1 610 1,174
Interest income on loans and receivables 1,644 1,596
Fair value adjustment transferred from equity hedge reserve (loss) 35 25
Net interest income 999 397
Exchange rate gains on bank balances, borrowings and working capital 183 30
Exchange rate losses on bank balances, borrowings and working capital 44 162
Net foreign exchange gains/losses 139 -132
Fair value gains from derivatives 3 161
Fair value losses from derivatives 127 -
Net fair value gains/losses -124 161
Dividends received from subsidiaries, associated companies and joint ventures, net2 75 44,029
Total dividend income 75 44,029
Impairment losses, investments in subsidiaries and associated companies3 355 200
Reversal of impairment losses, investments in subsidiaries and associated companies4 380 -
Financial income/expenses, net 1,114 44,255
Of which:
Dividends 75 44,029
Financial income 2,210 1,787
Financial expenses 1,171 1,561

1 Of which USD 0m (USD 10m) relates to expense of prepayment of issued bonds.

2 Mainly relates to dividends from A.P. Moller Finance S.A. and Maersk Container Industry A/S (in 2023 Maersk A/S and Svitzer A/S).

3 Impairment losses in investments in subsidiaries is related to Svitzer A/S, demerged in 2024 (in 2023 Maersk Container Industry A/S).

4 Reversal of impairment losses is mainly related to A.P. Moller Finance S.A., holding company of the Aqaba Container Terminal Company Ltd and Maersk Container Industry A/S. The reversals are included in financial income in the income statement.

Refer to note 4.4 for an analysis of gains and losses from derivatives.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

2024 2023
Non-current receivables - 10
Current receivables 151 131
Non-current liabilities 333 323
Current liabilities 251 134
Liabilities, net 433 316

The company's activities expose it to a variety of financial risks:

  • Market risks, i.e. currency risk and interest rate risk
  • Credit risk
  • Liquidity risk.

The company's overall risk management programme focuses on the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to minimise the potential adverse effects on the company's financial performance. The company uses derivative financial instruments to hedge certain risk exposures.

Risk management is carried out by a central finance department under policies approved by the Board of Directors. The finance department identifies, evaluates and hedges financial risks in close cooperation with the company's entities. Market risk is the risk that changes in market prices, such as foreign exchange rates and interest rates, will affect the company's profit or the value of its holdings of financial instruments. The sensitivity analyses in the currency risk and

interest rate risk sections relate to the position of financial instruments at 31 December 2024.

The sensitivity analyses for currency risk and interest rate risk have been prepared on the basis that the amount of net debt, the ratio of fixed to floating interest rates of the debt and the proportion of financial instruments in foreign currencies remain unchanged from hedge designations in place at 31 December 2024. Furthermore, it is assumed that the exchange rate and interest rate sensitivities have a symmetric impact, i.e. an increase in rates results in the same absolute movement as a decrease in rates.

The sensitivity analyses show the effect on profit and equity of a reasonably possible change in exchange rates and interest rates.

2024 2023
Hedging interest rate risk -35 -24
Total effective hedging -35 -24
Ineffectiveness recognised in financial expenses 1 -1
Total reclassified from equity reserve for hedges -34 -25
Derivatives accounted for as held for trading
Currency derivatives recognised directly in financial income/expenses -127 168
Interest rate derivatives recognised directly in financial income/expenses 21 45
Net gains/losses recognised directly in the income statement -106 213
Total -140 188

Hedges comprise primarily currency derivatives and interest rate derivatives, which are further described in the following sections.

Fair value
Recognised at fair value through profit and loss 2024 2023
Currency derivatives 3 37
Total 3 37

Currency risk

The company's currency risk arises primarily from its treasury activities where financing is obtained and provided in a wide range of currencies other than USD such as EUR, CNY, GBP and NOK.

The main purpose of hedging the company's currency risk is to hedge the USD value of the company's net cash flow and reduce fluctuations in the company's profit. The company uses various financial derivatives, including forwards, option contracts and cross-currency swaps, to hedge these risks. The key aspects of the currency hedging policy are as follows:

  • Net cash flows in other significant currencies than USD are hedged using a layered model with a 12-month horizon
  • Significant capital commitments or divestments in other currencies than USD are hedged
  • Most non-USD debt is hedged, however, depending on the asset-liability match and the currency of the generated cash flow.

The company enters into derivatives to hedge currency exposures that do not qualify for hedge accounting. These derivatives are classified as fair value through profit or loss.

An increase in the USD exchange rate of 10% against all other significant currencies to which the company is exposed is presented in the table.

The sensitivities are based only on the impact of financial instruments that are outstanding at the balance sheet date and are thus not an expression of the company's total currency risk.

Profit before tax Equity before tax
2024 2023 2024 2023
DKK 6 -30 6 -30
Other currencies -14 -3 -14 -3
Total -8 -33 -8 -33

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company

financial statements

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.4 Financial instruments and risks – continued

Maturity
Fair
value,
asset
Fair
value,
liability
Nominal
amount
of
deriva
tive
0-1 years 2-5 years 5- years Gain/loss
on
hedged
item
Gain/loss
on
hedging
instru
ment
Average
hedge
rate
2024
Combined fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 112 737 - 392 345 -6 -14 6.2%
GBP - 21 88 88 - - 1 -3 6.9%
JPY - 26 79 79 - - - -1 6.2%
NOK - 85 194 - 194 - 8 -12 6.9%
Fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
USD - 39 650 - 400 250 39 -39 6.8%
Cash flow hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 120 1,698 - 392 1,306 - -26 4.2%
GBP - 33 160 160 - - - 1 4.6%
Total - 436 3,606 327 1,378 1,901 42 -94
2023
Combined fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 90 503 - 415 88 15 -32 7.3%
GBP - 24 89 - 89 - 2 -6 7.9%
JPY - 17 88 - 88 - - -2 7.2%
NOK - 68 216 - 216 - 12 -18 7.9%
Fair value hedge,
hedge of borrowings
USD 11 44 850 - 200 650 32 -33 7.7%
Cash flow hedge,
hedge of borrowings
EUR - 88 967 - 414 553 - -29 3.2%
GBP - 33 162 - 162 - - -1 4.6%

Amounts in USD million

The average FX hedge rates for swaps in combined fair value hedge were EUR/USD 1.18 (1.24), GBP/USD 1.52 (1.52), USD/NOK 8.25 (8.25), and USD/JPY 119.39 (119.39).

The average FX hedge rates for swaps in cash flow hedge were EUR/USD 1.13 (1.18) and GBP/USD 1.52 (1.52). The sensitivities are based only on the impact of financial instruments that are outstanding at the balance sheet date and are thus not an expression of the company's total currency risk.

Interest rate risk

The company has most of its debt denominated in USD, but part of the debt (e.g. issued bonds) is in other currencies such as EUR, NOK, GBP and JPY. The company strives to maintain a combination of fixed and floating interest rates on its net debt, reflecting expectations and risks.

Interest rate risk is managed within a range set for the percentage of gross debt paying fixed interest, net of hedging. The level at 31 December 2024 is 51% (41%) excluding IFRS 16 Leases.

A general increase in interest rates by one percentage point is estimated, all thing else being equal, to affect profit before tax and equity, excluding tax effect, positively by approx. USD 123m and positively by approx. USD 83m, respectively (positively by approx. USD 149m and positively by approx. USD 128m, respectively).

This analysis assumes that all other variables, in particular foreign currency rates, remain constant.

The hedging of the interest rate risk is done by cross-currency swaps and interest rate swaps. The hedging is a mix of fair value hedging, combined fair value hedging and cash flow hedging. Combined fair value hedging is applied when crosscurrency swaps are entered into to hedge the risk of debt denominated in other currencies than USD. Each hedge relationship is split into a fair value hedge, where value changes from market rates are recognised directly in profit or loss, and a cash flow hedge, where the value changes from the exchange rate exposure of the credit margin are recognised in OCI.

The hedges are expected to be highly effective due to the nature of the economic relationship between the exposure and the hedge. The source of ineffectiveness is the credit risk of the hedging instruments. For hedges where the cost of hedging is applied, the change in basis spread is recognised in other comprehensive income and is a time effect during the lifetime of the swap and at maturity amounts to 0. If the hedged transaction is prepaid, the change in basis spread will be recognised in profit or loss as ineffectiveness. The cost of hedging reserve amounts to a gain of USD 0m (USD 7m).

Borrowings and interest-bearing debt to subsidiaries Carrying Next interest rate fixing
by interest rate levels inclusive of interest rate swaps amount 0-1 year 2-5 years 5- years
2024
0-3% 1,331 814 - 517
3-6% 9,173 7,409 491 1,273
6%- 1,828 1,828 - -
Total 12,332 10,051 491 1,790
Of which:
Bearing fixed interest 2,458
Bearing floating interest 9,874
2023
0-3% 742 196 - 546
3-6% 5,473 4,303 576 594
6%- 2,899 2,899 - -
Total 9,114 7,398 576 1,140
Of which:
Bearing fixed interest 1,730
Bearing floating interest 7,384

192

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.4 Financial instruments and risks – continued

Credit risk

The company has substantial exposure to financial and commercial counterparties but has no particular concentration of customers or suppliers. To minimise the credit risk, financial vetting is undertaken for all major customers and financial institutions, adequate security is required for commercial counterparties, and credit limits are set for financial institutions and key commercial counterparties.

Financial assets at amortised cost

Financial assets at amortised cost comprise loan receivables, lease receivables, and other receivables. These are all considered to have low credit risk and thus the impairment provision calculated based on 12 months of expected losses is considered immaterial. The financial assets are considered to be low risk when they have low risk of default, and the issuer has a strong capacity to meet its contractual cash flow obligations in the near term.

Other financial assets at amortised cost include loans to subsidiaries. As of 31 December 2024, the loans amount to USD 7.6bn (USD 8.8bn) and are considered to have a low credit risk, thus the impairment provision to be recognised during the period is limited to 12 months of expected losses. The credit risk has not increased significantly since the initial recognition and is considered low based on the investment grade credit rating for the Group and consequently the financial strength of the major subsidiaries within the Group.

Financial institutions

Deposits and bank balances are primarily held in relationship banks with a credit rating of at least A-. No individual exposure is above 10%. Maersk has ISDA agreements for trading of derivatives, under which the Group has a right to net settlement in the event of certain credit events. This results in the credit risk being limited to the net position per counterparty.

Liquidity risk

It is of great importance for the company to maintain a financial reserve to cover the company's obligations and investment opportunities and to provide the capital necessary to offset changes in the company's liquidity due to changes in the cash flow from operating activities.

The flexibility of the financial reserve is subject to ongoing prioritisation and optimisation, among other things by focusing on the release of capital and following up on the development in working capital.

Net interest-bearing debt and liquidity 2024 2023
Borrowings 12,332 9,114
Net interest-bearing debt -15,282 -17,159
Cash and bank balances 5,172 5,123
Cash management overdraft -2 -3
Term deposits not included in cash and cash balances 15,731 12,693
Securities 1,580 -
Undrawn revolving credit facilities > 12 months 6,050 6,050
Liquidity reserve1 28,531 23,8632

1 Liquidity reserve is defined as undrawn committed revolving facilities with more than one year to expiry, securities, term deposits and cash and bank balances, net of cash management overdraft, excluding securities, overdrafts and balances in countries with exchange control or other restrictions.

2 The 2023 liquidity reserve was restated to include the cash management overdraft of USD 3m.

For information about cash and bank balances in countries with exchange control or other restrictions, please see text to the consolidated cash flow statement.

Based on the liquidity reserve, loans for the financing of specific assets, the maturity of outstanding loans, and the current investment profile, the company's financial resources are deemed satisfactory.

The average term to maturity of loan facilities in the company was about five years (about five years) at 31 December 2024.

Carrying
Cash flows including interest
Maturities of liabilities amount
and commitments 0-1 year 2-5 years 5- years Total
2024
Bank and other credit institutions 592 87 470 187 744
Issued bonds 4,139 473 1,893 2,793 5,159
Interest-bearing loans from
subsidiaries, etc. 7,601 7,580 43 - 7,623
Trade payables 23 23 - - 23
Other payables 484 484 - - 484
Other payables to subsidiaries, etc. 7 7 - - 7
Non-derivative financial liabilities 12,846 8,654 2,406 2,980 14,040
Derivatives 584 251 258 75 584
Total recognised in balance sheet 13,430 8,905 2,664 3,055 14,624
2023
Bank and other credit institutions 688 84 538 261 883
Issued bonds 3,393 115 1,907 2,105 4,127
Interest-bearing loans from
subsidiaries, etc. 5,033 4,954 95 - 5,049
Trade payables 46 46 - - 46
Other payables 443 443 - - 443
Non-derivative financial liabilities 9,603 5,642 2,540 2,366 10,548
Derivatives 457 134 241 82 457
Total recognised in balance sheet 10,060 5,776 2,781 2,448 11,005

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Sustainability

Annual Report 2024

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Note 4.5 Financial instruments by category

Carrying amount Fair value2
2024 2023 2024 2023
Carried at amortised cost
Interest-bearing receivables from subsidiaries, etc. 5,565 8,809 5,592 8,809
Loan receivables 15,732 12,693 15,754 12,708
Total interest-bearing receivables 21,297 21,502
Trade receivables 77 4
Other receivables (non-interest-bearing) 387 360
Other receivables from subsidiaries, etc. 49 156
Cash and bank balances 5,172 5,123
Financial assets at amortised cost 26,982 27,145
Carried at fair value
Derivatives 151 141
Securities3 1,580 -
Equity investments (FVOCI)1 2 4
Other financial assets 1,733 145
Total financial assets 28,715 27,290
Carried at amortised cost
Bank and other credit institutions 592 688
Issued bonds 4,139 3,393 4,187 3,339
Interest-bearing loans from subsidiaries, etc. 7,601 5,033 7,612
Total borrowings 12,332 9,114
Trade payables 23 46
Other payables 486 443
Other payables to subsidiaries and associated companies 7 -
Financial liabilities at amortised cost 12,848 9,603
Carried at fair value
Derivatives 584 457
Financial liabilities at fair value 584 457
Total financial liabilities 13,432 10,060

1 The company holds only minor equity investments at fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI).

2 Where no fair value is stated, the amount equals carrying amount.

3 Investments in bonds are measured at fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI).

Non-listed shares Total financial assets
Movement during the year in level 3 Equity investments
(FVOCI)
Carrying amount 1
January 2023
4 4
Carrying amount 31 December 2023 4 4
Gains/losses recognised in other comprehensive income -2 -2
Carrying amount 31 December 2024 2 2

Financial instruments measured at fair value

Financial instruments measured at fair value can be divided into three levels:

Level 1 — Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities

Level 2 — Inputs other than quoted prices included in level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability,

either directly (i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices)

Level 3 — Inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data.

Fair value of listed shares falls within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. Non-listed shares and other securities fall within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

Fair value of derivatives falls mainly within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy and is calculated on the basis of observable market data as of the end of the reporting period.

Fair value of level 3 assets and liabilities is primarily based on the present value of expected future cash flows. A reasonably possible change in the discount rate is not estimated to affect the company's profit or equity significantly.

Financial instruments carried at amortised cost

Fair value of the short-term financial assets and other financial liabilities carried at amortised cost is not materially different from the carrying amount. In general, fair value is determined primarily based on the present value of expected future cash flows. Where a market price was available, however, this was deemed to be the fair value. Fair value of listed issued bonds is within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy.

Fair value of the remaining borrowing items is within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy and is calculated on the basis of discounted interests and instalments.

Debt Instruments (FVOCI)

The company's debt instruments at fair value through OCI include investments in quoted debt instruments and are included under securities in the balance sheet. Interest income, foreign exchange revaluation and impairment losses or reversals are recognised in the income statement and computed in the same manner as for financial assets measured at amortised cost. The remaining fair value changes are recognised in OCI. Upon derecognition, the cumulative fair value change recognised in OCI is recycled to profit or loss.

Other equity investments (FVOCI)

The company has investments in equity shares of both listed and non-listed companies. The company holds non-controlling interests (between 0.1% and 15%) in these companies. These investments were irrevocably designated at fair value through OCI as the company considers these investments to be strategic in nature.

Consolidated financial statements Parent company financial statements

Financials

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Of which:

OTHER DISCLOSURES

Note 5.2 Deferred tax

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

195
A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S
Annual Report 2024

Note 5.1
Tax
2024 2023
Tax recognised in the income statement
Current tax on profit for the year 193 51
Adjustment for current tax of prior periods 102 -2
Withholding taxes 6 17
Utilisation of previously unrecognised deferred tax assets -84 -52
Total current tax 217 14
Origination and reversal of temporary differences 15 3
Adjustment for deferred tax of prior periods -84 -52
Recognition of previous unrecognised deferred tax asset 84 52
Total deferred tax 15 3
Total tax expense (income) 232 17
Tax reconciliation:
Profit/loss before tax 859 44,044
Tax using the Danish corporation tax rate (22%) 189 9,690
Tax rate deviations in foreign jurisdictions - 11
Pillar Two tax expenses 18 -
Non-taxable income 17 -
Non-deductible expenses 19 -3
Gains/losses related to shares, dividends, etc. -22 -9,654
Adjustment to previous years' taxes 102 -2
Other differences, net -21 -3
Total income tax 232 17
  • Tax recognised in other comprehensive income and equity 23 -6

Current tax 23 -6

Property, plant and equipment 2 2 - - -2 -2 Provisions, etc. 4 8 - - -4 -8 Liabilities, etc. - - 11 - 11 - Other - - 1 2 1 2 Total 6 10 12 2 6 -8 Offsets -6 -2 -6 -2 - - Total - 8 6 - 6 -8

Assets Liabilities Net liabilities 2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023

For Pillar II tax, refer to note 5.1 in the consolidated financial statements.

Recognised deferred tax assets and liabilities are attributable to the following:

Change in deferred tax, net during the year 2024 2023
1
January
-8 -13
Recognised in the income statement 14 5
31 December 6 -8

There are no unrecognised deferred tax assets and liabilities for 2024.

Note 5.3 Share-based payments

The recognised remuneration expense related to the performance shares plan is USD 3m (USD 1m). The recognised remuneration expense related to the restricted shares plan is USD 4m (USD 3m). The recognised remuneration expense related to the share options plan is USD 5m (USD 4m). For all other disclosures related to share-based payments, refer to note 5.2 in the consolidated financial statements.

Note 5.4 Contingent liabilities

The company is involved in a number of legal disputes. The company is also involved in tax disputes in certain countries. Some of these involve significant amounts and are subject to considerable uncertainty.

Through participation in joint taxation scheme with A.P. Møller Holding A/S, the company is jointly and severally liable for taxes payable, etc. in Denmark.

Note 5.5 Cash flow specifications

2024 2023
Change in working capital
Trade receivables -73 31
Other receivables and prepayments 138 -81
Trade payables and other payables, etc. 25 148
Exchange rate adjustment of working capital 15 17
Total 105 115

Corporate governance

Consolidated financial statements

Parent company financial statements

OTHER DISCLOSURES

Note 5.6 Related parties

Controlling
parties
Subsidiaries Associated
companies
Joint
ventures
Management1
2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023 2024 2023
Continuing operations
Income statement
Revenue 3 - - 39 - - - - - -
Operating costs - - 11 13 - - - - - -
Remuneration to
management - - - - - - - - 12 8
Dividends - - 75 43,986 - 43 - - - -
Financial income 29 46 791 513 - - 4 - - -
Financial expenses 7 24 315 922 - - - 3 - -
Assets
Interest-bearing receivables,
non-current - - 1,675 1,338 - - - 1 - -
Derivatives, non-current - - - - - - - - - -
Trade receivables - - 45 - - - - - - -
Interest-bearing receivables,
current - - 3,883 7,495 5 - - - - -
Derivatives, current - - 101 14 - - - - - -
Other receivables, current 627 683 18 176 - - - - - -
Cash and bank balances 161 161 - - - - - - - -
Liabilities
Interest-bearing debt,
non-current - - - 95 - - 43 - - -
Interest-bearing debt,
current - - 7,559 4,892 - - - - - -
Trade payables - - 47 - - - - - - -
Derivatives, current 3 42 28 63 - - - - - -
Other liabilities, current - - 23 123 - - 7 - - -
Sale of companies, property,
plant and equipment - - - 2,932 4 - 810 - - - -
Capital increases and
purchase of shares
- - 1,099 646 4 - 11 - - - -
Shares bought back2 2132 1,5692 - - - - - - - -
Dividends distributed3 655 3 5,9743 - - - - - - - -

Joint usage agreement with A.P. Møller Holding

With the objective of further strengthening the value of the brands, in 2018 A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S entered into a joint usage agreement with A.P. Møller Holding A/S regarding the use of commonly used trademarks which historically have benefited both A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S and A.P. Møller Holding A/S. A.P. Møller Holding A/S is the controlling shareholder of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S, and is wholly owned by A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal. The joint usage agreement establishes a framework and a branding strategy for the commonly used trademarks and a joint brand board, where the parties can cooperate regarding the use of these trademarks.

Share buy-back programme

According to a separate agreement, A.P. Møller Holding A/S and A.P. Møller og Hustrus Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond participated on a pro rata basis to the shares purchased in the company's share buy-back programme. A.P. Møller Holding A/S participated in selling A and B shares and A.P. Møller og Hustrus Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond participated in selling B shares.

Controlling party

A.P. Møller Holding A/S, Copenhagen, Denmark, has control over the company and prepares consolidated financial statements. A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal is the ultimate owner.

Note 5.7 Pledges

Vessels owned by subsidiaries with a carrying amount of USD 0.0bn (USD 0.6bn) have been pledged as security for loans of USD 0.0bn (USD 0.3bn).

Amounts in USD million

1 The Board of Directors and the Executive Board in A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S, A.P. Møller Holding A/S, A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Fond til almene Formaal and their close relatives (including undertakings under their control). 2 Includes shares bought back from A.P. Møller Holding A/S and A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond.

3 Includes dividends paid to A.P. Møller Holding A/S, A.P. Møller og Hustru Chastine Mc-Kinney Møllers Familiefond and Den A.P. Møllerske Støttefond.

4 The 2023 figures have been restated in order to reflect the changes within sale of companies, property, plant and equipment and capital increases and purchase of shares.

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Sustainability

Management's statement

The Board of Directors and Executive Board have today considered and adopted the Annual Report of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S for the financial year 1 January to 31 December 2024.

The Consolidated Financial Statements and Parent Company Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards as adopted by the EU and further requirements in the Danish Financial Statements Act. The Management Review has been prepared in accordance with the Danish Financial Statements Act.

In our opinion, the Consolidated Financial Statements and the Parent Company Financial Statements give a true and fair view of the financial position at 31 December 2024 of the Group and the Parent Company and of the results of the Group and the Parent Company operations and cash flows for the financial year 2024.

In our opinion, the Management Review includes a fair review of the development in the operations and financial circumstances of the Group and the Parent Company, of the results for the year and of the financial position of the Group and the Parent Company as well as a description of the most significant risks and elements of uncertainty, which the Group and the Parent Company are facing.

Additionally, the Sustainability Statement, which is part of Management Review, is prepared, in all material respects, in accordance with section 99a of the Danish Financial Statements Act. This includes compliance with the European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS), including that the process carried out by Management to identify the reported information (the "Process") is in accordance with the description set out in the section "Double Materiality Assessment". Furthermore, disclosures within subsection "EU Taxonomy Reporting" in the "Environmental" section of the Sustainability Statement are, in all material aspects, in accordance with Article 8 of EU Regulation 2020/852 (the "Taxonomy Regulation Reporting"). Julija Voitiekute 197

The year 2024 marks the initial implementation of section 99a of the Danish Financial Statements Act concerning compliance with ESRS. As such, more clear guidance and practice are anticipated in various areas, which are expected to be issued in the coming years. Furthermore, the Sustainability Statement includes forward-looking statements based on disclosed assumptions about events that may occur in the future and possible future actions by the Group. Actual outcomes are likely to be different since anticipated events frequently do not occur as expected.

are likely to be different since anticipated events frequently do not
occur as expected.
CFO Vice Chair
In our opinion, the Annual Report for 2024 of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S
for the financial year 1 January to 31 December 2024 with the file name
Bernard L. Bot
APMM-2024-12-31-en.zip is prepared, in all material respects, in com
pliance with the ESEF Regulation.
We recommend that the Annual Report be adopted at the Annual
Marika Fredriksson
General Meeting on 18
March 2025.
Arne Karlsson
Copenhagen, 6 February 2025 Thomas Lindegaard Madsen
Amparo Moraleda
Kasper Rørsted
Allan Thygesen

Executive Board

Vincent Clerc CEO

Patrick Jany

Board of Directors

Robert Mærsk Uggla

Chair

Marc Engel

Performance

Corporate governance

Financials

Independent Auditor's Reports

To the shareholders of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S

Report on the audit of the Financial Statements

Our opinion

In our opinion, the Consolidated Financial Statements and the Parent Company Financial Statements (pages 136 to 196) give a true and fair view of the Group's and the Parent Company's financial position at 31 December 2024 and of the results of the Group's and the Parent Company's operations and cash flows for the financial year 1 January to 31 December 2024 in accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards as adopted by the EU and further requirements in the Danish Financial Statements Act.

Our opinion is consistent with our Auditor's Long-form Report to the Audit Committee and the Board of Directors.

What we have audited

The Consolidated Financial Statements and Parent Company Financial Statements of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S for the financial year 1 January to 31 December 2024 comprise income statement and statement of comprehensive income, balance sheet, cash flow statement, statement of changes in equity and notes, including material accounting policy information for the Group as well as for the Parent Company. Collectively referred to as the "Financial Statements".

Basis for opinion

We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (ISAs) and the additional requirements applicable in Denmark. Our responsibilities under those standards and requirements are further described in the Auditor's responsibilities for the audit of the Financial Statements section of our report.

We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion. applied, and tested journal entries on revenue. 198

Independence

We are independent of the Group in accordance with the International Ethics Standards Board for Accountants' International Code of Ethics for Professional Accountants (IESBA Code) and the additional ethical requirements applicable in Denmark. We have also fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these requirements and the IESBA Code.

To the best of our knowledge and belief, prohibited non-audit services referred to in Article 5(1) of Regulation (EU) No 537/2014 were not provided.

Appointment

We were first appointed auditors of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S on 12 April 2012 for the financial year 2012. We have been reappointed annually by shareholder resolution for a total period of uninterrupted engagement of 13 years including the financial year 2024. We were reappointed, following a tendering procedure, at the General Meeting on 15 March 2022.

Key audit matters

Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in our audit of the Financial Statements for 2024. These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the Financial Statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on these matters.

Revenue recognition

Revenue recognition is complex due to the volume of transactions and the variety of different revenue streams within the segments.

We focused on this area due to the significance of amounts involved and because revenue recognition involves accounting estimates and judgements made by Management originating from different customer behaviour, market conditions, terms and nature of services in the various segments.

Further, the volume of transactions and extent of different revenue streams involve internal controls, various IT applications and Management's monitoring hereof, to ensure correct revenue recognition, which are complex and introduce an inherent risk to the revenue recognition process.

Reference is made to note 2.1 in the Consolidated Financial Statements.

How our audit addressed the key audit matter

Our audit procedures included considering the appropriateness of the revenue recognition accounting policies and assessing compliance with applicable accounting standards.

We performed risk assessment procedures with the purpose of updating our understanding of IT-systems and applications, business procedures and relevant controls regarding revenue recognition. For the relevant key internal controls, we assessed whether they were designed and implemented to address the risk of errors in revenue recognised in the Financial Statements. For selected controls that we planned to rely on, we tested whether they were performed on a consistent basis and Management's monitoring hereof.

We applied data analytics on selected revenue streams in order to identify and test transactions outside the ordinary transaction flow, and performed substantive procedures over invoicing and relevant contracts in order to assess the accounting treatment and principles

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Further, we tested timing to ensure that revenue is recognised in the correct financial year.

Finally, we assessed the adequacy of disclosures provided by Management in the Financial Statements.

Recoverability of the carrying amount of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets

The carrying amount of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets comprises a significant part of the financial position.

The most significant risks in relation to Management's assessment of the recoverability of the carrying amount of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets relate to the definition of cash-generating units (CGUs), identification of CGUs with indicators of impairment and, where relevant, the estimate of the fair values less costs to sell and the values in use, including determination of key assumptions.

Management identified impairment indicators for individual terminals and also performed an impairment test related to goodwill in the Ocean CGU and the Logistics & Services CGU.

Considering the generally long-lived nature of the assets, the significant assumptions in estimating the future cash flows are Management's long-term outlook for, among others, freight rates, terminal rates, margins, volumes and CAPEX as well as Management's determination of the discount rates.

We focussed on this area as Management is required to exercise considerable judgement and because of the inherent complexity in estimating the fair value less cost to sell or the value in use.

Reference is made to notes 3.1, 3.2 and 3.3 in the Consolidated Financial Statements.

How our audit addressed the key audit matter

We considered the appropriateness of the defined CGUs within the businesses and examined the methodology used by Management to assess the carrying amount of intangible assets, property, plant and equipment and right-of-use assets assigned to CGUs, as well as the process for identifying CGUs that require impairment testing to determine compliance with IFRS. override of internal control. 199

We performed detailed testing of Management's impairment tests for goodwill and for the CGUs where indicators of impairment were identified, and challenged the significant assumptions affecting the future cash flows, including assumptions related to freight rates, terminal rates, Logistics & Services margins, volumes, CAPEX and operating expenses.

We used our internal valuation specialists to independently challenge the discount rates used. In calculating the discount rates, the key inputs used were independently sourced from market data, and we assessed the methodology applied.

Further, we tested the mathematical accuracy of the impairment models prepared by Management.

Finally, we assessed the adequacy of disclosures provided by Management in the Financial Statements.

Statement on Management Review

Management is responsible for Management Review (pages 4 to 135). Our opinion on the Financial Statements does not cover Management Review, and we do not as part of the audit express any form of assurance conclusion thereon.

In connection with our audit of the Financial Statements, our responsibility is to read Management Review and, in doing so, consider whether Management Review is materially inconsistent with the Financial Statements or our knowledge obtained in the audit, or otherwise appears to be materially misstated.

Moreover, we considered whether Management Review includes the disclosures required by the Danish Financial Statements Act. This does not include the requirements in section 99a related to the Sustainability Statement covered by the separate Auditor's limited assurance report hereon.

Based on the work we have performed, in our view, Management Review is in accordance with the Consolidated Financial Statements and the Parent Company Financial Statements and has been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Danish Financial Statements Act, except for the requirements in section 99a related to the Sustainability Statement, cf. above. We did not identify any material misstatement in the Management Review.

Management's responsibilities for the Financial Statements

Management is responsible for the preparation of consolidated financial statements and parent company financial statements that give a true and fair view in accordance with IFRS Accounting Standards as adopted by the EU and further requirements in the Danish Financial Statements Act, and for such internal control as Management determines is necessary to enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.

In preparing the Financial Statements, Management is responsible for assessing the Group's and the Parent Company's ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis of accounting unless Management either intends to liquidate the Group or the Parent Company or to cease operations, or has no realistic alternative but to do so.

Auditor's responsibilities for the audit of the Financial Statements

Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the Financial Statements as a whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an auditor's report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs and the additional requirements applicable in Denmark will always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of these Financial Statements.

As part of an audit in accordance with ISAs and the additional requirements applicable in Denmark, we exercise professional judgement and maintain professional scepticism throughout the audit. We also:

• Identify and assess the risks of material misstatement of the Financial Statements, whether due to fraud or error, design and perform audit procedures responsive to those risks, and obtain audit evidence that is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion. The risk of not detecting a material misstatement resulting from fraud is higher than for one resulting from error, as fraud may involve collusion, forgery, intentional omissions, misrepresentations, or the

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

  • Obtain an understanding of internal control relevant to the audit in order to design audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Group's and the Parent Company's internal control.
  • Evaluate the appropriateness of accounting policies used and the reasonableness of accounting estimates and related disclosures made by Management.
  • Conclude on the appropriateness of Management's use of the going concern basis of accounting and based on the audit evidence obtained, whether a material uncertainty exists related to events or conditions that may cast significant doubt on the Group's and the Parent Company's ability to continue as a going concern. If we conclude that a material uncertainty exists, we are required to draw attention in our auditor's report to the related disclosures in the Financial Statements or, if such disclosures are inadequate, to modify our opinion. Our conclusions are based on the audit evidence obtained up to the date of our auditor's report. However, future events or conditions may cause the Group or the Parent Company to cease to continue as a going concern.
  • Evaluate the overall presentation, structure and content of the Financial Statements, including the disclosures, and whether the Financial Statements represent the underlying transactions and events in a manner that gives a true and fair view.
  • Plan and perform the group audit to obtain sufficient appropriate audit evidence regarding the financial information of the entities or business units within the group as a basis for forming an opinion on the Consolidated Financial Statements. We are responsible for the direction, supervision and review of the audit work performed for purposes of the group audit. We remain solely responsible for our audit opinion.

We communicate with those charged with governance regarding, among other matters, the planned scope and timing of the audit and significant audit findings, including any significant deficiencies in internal control that we identify during our audit.

We also provide those charged with governance with a statement that we have complied with relevant ethical requirements regarding independence, and to communicate with them all relationships and

other matters that may reasonably be thought to bear on our independence and, where applicable, actions taken to eliminate threats or safeguards applied.

From the matters communicated with those charged with governance, we determine those matters that were of most significance in the audit of the Financial Statements of the current period and are therefore the key audit matters. We describe these matters in our auditor's report unless law or regulation precludes public disclosure about the matter.

Report on compliance with the ESEF Regulation

As part of our audit of the Financial Statements, we performed procedures to express an opinion on whether the Annual Report of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S for the financial year 1 January to 31 December 2024 with the filename APMM-2024-12-31-en.zip is prepared, in all material respects, in compliance with the Commission Delegated Regulation (EU) 2019/815 on the European Single Electronic Format (ESEF Regulation) which includes requirements related to the preparation of the Annual Report in XHTML format and iXBRL tagging of the Consolidated Financial Statements including notes.

Management is responsible for preparing an annual report that complies with the ESEF Regulation. This responsibility includes:

  • The preparing of the Annual Report in XHTML format;
  • The selection and application of appropriate iXBRL tags, including extensions to the ESEF taxonomy and the anchoring thereof to elements in the taxonomy, for all financial information required to be tagged using judgement where necessary;
  • Ensuring consistency between iXBRL tagged data and the Consolidated Financial Statements presented in human-readable format; and
  • For such internal control as Management determines necessary to enable the preparation of an annual report that is compliant with the ESEF Regulation.

Our responsibility is to obtain reasonable assurance on whether the Annual Report is prepared, in all material respects, in compliance with the ESEF Regulation based on the evidence we have obtained, and to issue a report that includes our opinion. The nature, timing and extent

of procedures selected depend on the auditor's judgement, including the assessment of the risks of material departures from the requirements set out in the ESEF Regulation, whether due to fraud or error. The procedures include:

  • Testing whether the Annual Report is prepared in XHTML format;
  • Obtaining an understanding of the company's iXBRL tagging process and of internal control over the tagging process;
  • Evaluating the completeness of the iXBRL tagging of the Consolidated Financial Statements including notes;
  • Evaluating the appropriateness of the company's use of iXBRL elements selected from the ESEF taxonomy and the creation of extension elements where no suitable element in the ESEF taxonomy has been identified;
  • Evaluating the use of anchoring of extension elements to elements in the ESEF taxonomy; and
  • Reconciling the iXBRL tagged data with the audited Consolidated Financial Statements.

In our opinion, the Annual Report of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S for the financial year 1 January to 31 December 2024 with the file name APMM-2024-12-31-en.zip is prepared, in all material respects, in compliance with the ESEF Regulation.

Hellerup, 6 February 2025

PricewaterhouseCoopers

Statsautoriseret Revisionspartnerselskab CVR no 33 77 12 31

Lars Baungaard

State Authorised Public Accountant mne23331

Søren Ørjan Jensen

State Authorised Public Accountant mne33226

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Independent Auditor's limited assurance report on the Sustainability Statement

To the stakeholders of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S

Limited assurance conclusion

We have conducted a limited assurance engagement on the sustainability statement of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S (the "Group") included in the Management Review (the "Sustainability Statement"), pages 53 to 135, for the financial year 1 January – 31 December 2024.

Based on the procedures we have performed and the evidence we have obtained, nothing has come to our attention that causes us to believe that the Sustainability Statement is not prepared, in all material respects, in accordance with the Danish Financial Statements Act section 99a, including:

  • compliance with the European Sustainability Reporting Standards (ESRS), including that the process carried out by Management to identify the information reported in the Sustainability Statement (the "Process") is in accordance with the description set out in the section "Double Materiality Assessment", pages 66 to 68; and
  • compliance of the disclosures in subsection "EU Taxonomy Reporting", pages 96 to 100 within the environmental section of the Sustainability Statement with Article 8 of EU Regulation 2020/852 (the "Taxonomy Regulation").

Basis for conclusion

We conducted our limited assurance engagement in accordance with International Standard on Assurance Engagements (ISAE) 3000 (Revised), Assurance engagements other than audits or reviews of historical financial information ("ISAE 3000 (Revised)") and the additional requirements applicable in Denmark.

The procedures in a limited assurance engagement vary in nature and timing from, and are less in extent than for a reasonable assurance engagement. Consequently, the level of assurance obtained in a limited assurance engagement is substantially lower than the assurance that

would have been obtained had a reasonable assurance engagement been performed.

We believe that the evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our conclusion. Our responsibilities under this standard are further described in the Auditor's responsibilities for the assurance engagement section of our report.

Our independence and quality management

We are independent of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S in accordance with the International Ethics Standards Board for Accountants' International Code of Ethics for Professional Accountants (IESBA Code) and the additional ethical requirements applicable in Denmark. We have also fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these requirements and the IESBA Code.

Our firm applies International Standard on Quality Management 1, which requires the firm to design, implement and operate a system of quality management including policies or procedures regarding compliance with ethical requirements, professional standards and applicable legal and regulatory requirements.

Management's responsibilities for the Sustainability Statement Management is responsible for designing and implementing a process to identify the information reported in the Sustainability Statement in accordance with ESRS and for disclosing this Process in section "Double Materiality Assessment" of the Sustainability Statement. This responsibility includes:

• understanding the context in which A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' activities and business relationships take place and developing an understanding of its affected stakeholders;

  • identification of the actual and potential impacts (both negative and positive) related to sustainability matters, as well as risks and opportunities that affect, or could reasonably be expected to affect, A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' financial position, financial performance, cash flows, access to finance or cost of capital over the short, medium, or long term;
  • assessment of the materiality of the identified impacts, risks and opportunities related to sustainability matters by selecting and applying appropriate thresholds; and
  • making assumptions that are reasonable in the circumstances.

Management is further responsible for the preparation of the Sustainability Statement, which includes the information identified by the Process, in accordance with section 99a of the Danish Financial Statements Act, including:

  • compliance with ESRS;
  • preparing the disclosures as included in subsection "EU Taxonomy Reporting" within the Environmental section of the Sustainability Statement, in compliance with Article 8 of the Taxonomy Regulation;
  • designing, implementing and maintaining such internal control that management determines is necessary to enable the preparation of the Sustainability Statement that is free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; and
  • the selection and application of appropriate sustainability reporting methods and making assumptions and estimates that are reasonable in the circumstances.

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S Annual Report 2024

Executive summary

The integrator

Performance

Corporate governance

Sustainability

Financials

Inherent limitations in preparing the Sustainability Statement In reporting forward-looking information in accordance with ESRS, management is required to prepare the forward-looking information on the basis of disclosed assumptions about events that may occur in the future and possible future actions by A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S. Actual outcomes are likely to be different since anticipated events frequently do not occur as expected.

Auditor's responsibilities for the assurance engagement

Our responsibility is to plan and perform the assurance engagement to obtain limited assurance about whether the Sustainability Statement is free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue a limited assurance report that includes our conclusion. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence decisions of users taken on the basis of the Sustainability Statement as a whole.

As part of a limited assurance engagement in accordance with ISAE 3000 (Revised), we exercise professional judgement and maintain professional scepticism throughout the engagement.

Our responsibilities in respect of the Process include:

  • Obtaining an understanding of the Process, but not for the purpose of providing a conclusion on the effectiveness of the Process, including the outcome of the Process;
  • Considering whether the information identified addresses the applicable disclosure requirements of ESRS; and
  • Designing and performing procedures to evaluate whether the Process is consistent with A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' description of its Process, as disclosed in section "Double Materiality Assessment".

Our other responsibilities in respect of the Sustainability Statement include:

  • Identifying where material misstatements are likely to arise, whether due to fraud or error; and
  • Designing and performing procedures responsive to disclosures in the Sustainability Statement where material misstatements are likely to arise. The risk of not detecting a material misstatement

resulting from fraud is higher than for one resulting from error, as fraud may involve collusion, forgery, intentional omissions, misrepresentations, or the override of internal control.

Summary of the work performed

A limited assurance engagement involves performing procedures to obtain evidence about the Sustainability Statement. The nature, timing and extent of procedures selected depend on professional judgement, including the identification of disclosures where material misstatements are likely to arise, whether due to fraud or error, in the Sustainability Statement.

In conducting our limited assurance engagement, with respect to the Process, we:

  • Obtained an understanding of the Process by performing inquiries to understand the sources of the information used by management; and reviewing A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' internal documentation of its Process; and
  • Evaluated whether the evidence obtained from our procedures about the Process implemented by A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S was consistent with the description of the Process set out in the section "Double Materiality Assessment".

In conducting our limited assurance engagement, with respect to the Sustainability Statement, we:

  • Obtained an understanding of A.P. Møller Mærsk A/S' reporting processes relevant to the preparation of its Sustainability Statement including the consolidation processes by obtaining an understanding of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' control environment, processes and information systems relevant to the preparation of the Sustainability Statement but not evaluating the design of particular control activities, obtaining evidence about their implementation or testing their operating effectiveness;
  • Evaluated whether the information identified by the Process is included in the Sustainability Statement;
  • Evaluated whether the structure and the presentation of the Sustainability Statement are in accordance with ESRS;
  • Performed inquiries of relevant personnel and analytical procedures on selected information in the Sustainability Statement;
  • Performed limited substantive assurance procedures on selected information in the Sustainability Statement;
  • Where applicable, compared disclosures in the Sustainability Statement with the corresponding disclosures in the Financial Statements and Management Review;
  • Evaluated the methods, assumptions and data for developing estimates and forward-looking information; and
  • Obtained an understanding of A.P. Møller Mærsk A/S' process to identify taxonomy-eligible and taxonomy-aligned economic activities and the corresponding disclosures in the Sustainability Statement.

Other Matter

The comparative information included in the Sustainability Statement of A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S for the financial year 1 January – 31 December 2024 was not subject to an assurance engagement. Our conclusion is not modified in respect of this limitation of scope.

Hellerup, 6 February 2025

PricewaterhouseCoopers

Statsautoriseret Revisionspartnerselskab CVR no 3377 1231

Lars Baungaard

State Authorised Public Accountant mne23331

Søren Ørjan Jensen

State Authorised Public Accountant mne33226

Performance

governance

Corporate

Sustainability

Financials

C

A

B Backhaul

as the parent company.

The direction of the trade route that has the lowest volumes, whereas the opposite direction is referred to

A market-based mechanism used in greenhouse gas accounting to allocate emission reductions to

as headhaul. Book and Claim

CAPEX Cash payments for intangible assets and property, plant and equipment, excluding acquisitions and divestments.

Cash conversion

Cash flow from operating activities to EBITDA ratio.

Cash flow, operating activities per share

A.P. Moller - Maersk's operating cash flow from continuing operations divided by the number of shares of DKK 1,000 each, excluding A.P. Moller - Maersk's holding

of treasury shares.

A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) A.P. Moller - Maersk (Maersk) is referred to as the consolidated group of companies and A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S Dual-fuel vessel A dual-fuel vessel is a ship equipped with engines

D

Definition of terms

capable of operating on both conventional fuels (e.g. marine diesel or heavy fuel oil) and a type of green fuel as an alternative fuel (e.g. green methanol or liquefied biomethane).

Dual-fuel methanol vessel/ methanol-capable vessel Refers to a vessel equipped with engines capable of running on both conventional fuels (e.g. marine diesel or heavy fuel oil) and methanol as an alternative fuel.

companies that purchase E

low-emission products or services, even if they do not physically use them. EBIT Earnings Before Interest and Taxes.

EBITDA

Earnings Before Interest, Taxes, Depreciation and Amortisation.

EEOI

The energy efficiency operational indicator (EEOI) is a standard measure defined by the IMO in MEPC.1/Circ.684 that express the efficiency of ocean freight transport. The EEOI is calculated as the gCO₂ per tansport work performed (tonne cargo x nautical mile).

Equity ratio Calculated as equity divided by total assets.

EVs Electric vehicles.

First Mile volumes (FFE in '000) (Logistics & Services) Previously known as intermodal volumes includes intermodal, barge, rail and trucking drayage moves from manufacturing to port and port to warehouse.

FFE Forty Foot container

F

Equivalent unit. Free cash flow (FCF) Cash flow from operating activities, purchase/sale of intangible assets and property, plant and equip-

G

ment, dividends received, repayments of lease liabilities, financial payments and financial expenses paid on lease liabilities.

Green fuels Refers to fuels with low to very low greenhouse (GHG) gas emissions over their lifecycle compared to fossil reference fuels. Different green fuels achieve different

compared to fossil fuels.

H

Headhaul The direction of the trade route that has the highest volume, whereas the return direction is referred to as backhaul.

High potential incident

A high potential incident is defined as a safety incident with a potential severity of 4 or higher in Maersk's HSSE brand-specific risk assessment matrices.

Invested capital

I

IMO

Segment operating assets less segment operating liabilities, including investments and deferred taxes related to the operation.

developed by the Taskforce on Nature-related Financial Disclosures (TNFD) to help

Assess and Prepare. Learning teams

a group of workers brought together to: discuss specific

International Maritime Organization. L LEAP The LEAP approach is an integrated process

lifecycle reductions depending on their production pathway. 'Low' refers to fuels with a lifecycle GHG reduction of 60-80% compared to fossil fuels and 'very low' refers to fuels with a lifecycle GHG reduction of 80-95%

Gross profit

The sum of revenue, less variable costs and loss on debtors.

work, identify performance influencing conditions that make safe work difficult and specify suggestions for improvement.

Loaded freight rate (Ocean) Average freight rate per FFE for all the A.P. Moller - Maersk containers loaded in the period in either Maersk Line or Hamburg Süd vessels or third parties (excluding intermodal). Hamburg Süd is not excluding intermodal.

Loaded volumes (Ocean) Loaded volumes refer to the number of FFEs loaded

on a shipment which is loaded on first load at vessel departure time excluding displaced FFEs.

Lower emission steel

Procuring/specifying/ stocking a minimum of 50% of steel requirement by 2030, meeting one or a combination of the following conditions:

1) Steel produced by a steelmaking site where the site's corporate owner has defined and made public both a long-term and a near-term emissions reduction target, validated by SBTi or another quantitative, scientifically justified target of comparable ambition, quality and

2) Steel meeting the ResponsibleSteel Decarbonisation Progress threshold for "Lower Emission Steel" or equivalent.

Lost time incident frequency (LTIf)

Measures the number of lost time incidents per million exposure hours. Lost time incidents are the sum of fatalities, permanent total disability, permanent partial disability and lost workday cases.

MARPOL

M

MARPOL is the main international convention covering prevention of pollution of the marine environment by ships from operational or accidental causes.

N Net interest-bearing debt

(NIBD) Equals interest-bearing debt, including lease liabilities, fair value of derivatives hedging the underlying debt, less cash and bank balances as well as other interest-bearing assets.

Post-Panamax vessel

P

Vessels whose dimension exceed the Panama Canal's original locks, making them too large to transit through the canal.

R

Return on invested capital after tax (ROIC)

Profit/loss before financial items for the year (EBIT) less tax on EBIT divided by the average invested capital,

Revenue per move (Terminals) Includes terminal revenue, other income and government grants and excludes IFRIC12 construction revenue.

TEU

Twenty-foot container Equivalent Unit.

Time charter

T

Hire of a vessel for a specified period.

Total market capitalisation

Total number of shares – excluding A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S' holding of treasury shares – multiplied by the endof-year price quoted by Nasdaq Copenhagen.

U

Underlying EBITDA Underlying EBITDA is earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortisation

adjusted for restructuring

and integration costs.

Underlying EBIT Underlying EBIT is operating profit before interest and taxes adjusted for restructuring and integration costs, net gains/losses from sale of non-current assets and net impairment losses.

Underlying profit/loss

Underlying profit/loss is profit/loss for the year from continuing operations adjusted for net gains/losses from sale of non-current assets, etc.,

and net impairment losses as well as transaction, restructuring and integration costs related to major transactions. The adjustments are net of tax and include A.P. Moller - Maersk's share of mentioned items in joint ventures and associated companies.

Unit cost, fixed bunker (USD per FFE incl. VSA income) (Ocean)

Cost per FFE assuming a bunker price of USD 550/ tonne excluding intermodal but including hubs and time charter income. Hamburg Süd is not excluding intermodal.

V VSA

A vessel sharing agreement is usually reached between various partners within a shipping consortium who agree to operate a liner service along a specified route using a specified number of vessels.

W

Well-to-wake A term used to illustrate and account for emissions from fuel extraction to the endemissions from use.

last twelve months.

organisations identify and assess nature-related impacts, dependencies, risks and opportunities. LEAP

stands for Locate, Evaluate, A learning team is defined as coverage.

ESEF DATA

Domicile of entity Denmark

Description of nature of entity's operations and principal activities Logistics company

Country of incorporation Denmark

Principal place of business Global

Legal form of entity A/S (Danish limited liability company)

Name of reporting entity or other means of identification

A.P. Møller - Mærsk A/S

Address of entity's registered office Esplanaden 50, DK-1263 Copenhagen K

Design and layout e-Types

Cover photo Ane Mærsk arriving at Port of Tanjung Pelepas, Malaysia, February 2024.

Produced in Denmark 2025

Talk to a Data Expert

Have a question? We'll get back to you promptly.